integration server bis reference

658
webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference VERSION 6.5, SERVICE PACK 2 DECEMBER 2006 webMethods, Inc. South Tower 3877 Fairfax Ridge Road Fairfax, VA 22030 USA 703.460.2500 http://www.webmethods.com Title Page

Upload: surendra-reddy

Post on 01-Dec-2014

524 views

Category:

Documents


1 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: Integration Server Bis Reference

webMethods Integration ServerBuilt-In Services Reference

VERSION 6.5, SERVICE PACK 2

DECEMBER 2006

webMethods, Inc.South Tower3877 Fairfax Ridge RoadFairfax, VA 22030USA703.460.2500http://www.webmethods.com

Title Page

Page 2: Integration Server Bis Reference

B2B Integration Server, Business Process Integration, Cerebra, Get There Faster, Glue, Glueprints, Glueware, Guided SOA Governance, Infravio X-Broker, Infravio X-Registry, Infravio, My webMethods Server, My webMethods, Process Improvement Lifecycle, Process Improvement Lifecycle Methodology, webMethods Access, webMethods Administrator, webMethods Broker, webMethods Central Configuration, webMethods Dashboard, webMethods Designer, webMethods Developer, webMethods Fabric, webMethods Glue, webMethods Infrastructure Data Collector, webMethods Infravio X-Broker, webMethods Infravio X-Registry, webMethods Installer, webMethods Integration Server, webMethods logo, webMethods Mainframe, webMethods Manager, webMethods Modeler, webMethods Monitor, webMethods Optimize for Infrastructure, webMethods Optimize for Process, webMethods Optimize, webMethods Portal, webMethods Process Engine, webMethods Servicenet, webMethods SOA Governance, webMethods SOA Management, webMethods Task Engine, webMethods Trading Networks, webMethods Workflow, and webMethods are either registered trademarks or trademarks of webMethods, Inc. in the United States and/or other countries.

Acrobat and Adobe are registered trademarks, and Reader is a trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated. Amdocs is a registered trademark, and ClarifyCRM is a trademark of Amdocs. Ariba is a registered trademark of Ariba, Inc. BEA, BEA WebLogic Server, Jolt, and Tuxedo are registered trademarks, and BEA WebLogic Platform is a trademark of BEA Systems, Inc. Action Request System, BMC Software, PATROL, and Remedy are registered trademarks of BMC Software, Inc. BroadVision is a registered trademark of BroadVision, Inc. ChemeStandards and CIDX are trademarks of Chemical Industry Data Exchange. Unicenter is a registered trademark of Computer Associates International, Inc. PopChart is a registered trademark of CORDA Technologies, Inc. Kenan and Arbor are registered trademarks of CSG Systems, Inc. Data Connection and SNAP-IX are registered trademarks of Data Connection Corporation. DataDirect, DataDirect Connect, and SequeLink are registered trademarks of DataDirect Technologies. D&B and D-U-N-S are registered trademarks of Dun & Bradstreet Corporation. Entrust is a registered trademark of Entrust, Inc. papiNet is a registered trademark of the European Union and the United States. Financial Information eXchange, F.I.X, and F.I.X Protocol are trademarks of FIX Protocol Ltd. UCCnet and eBusinessReady are registered trademarks, and 1SYNC and Transora are trademarks of GS1 US. Hewlett-Packard, HP, HP-UX, OpenView, PA-RISC, and SNAplus2 are trademarks of Hewlett-Packard Company. i2 is a registered trademark of i2 Technologies, Inc. AIX, AS/400, CICS, DB2, Domino, IBM, Informix, Infoprint, Lotus, Lotus Notes, MQSeries, OS/390, OS/400, RACF, RS/6000, SQL/400, S/390, System/390, VTAM, z/OS, and WebSphere are registered trademarks; and Communications System for Windows NT, DB2 Universal Database, IMS, MVS, and SQL/DS are trademarks of IBM Corporation. InnoDB is a trademark of Innobase Oy. Itanium is a registered trademark of Intel Corporation. JBoss is a registered trademark, and JBoss Group is a trademark of Jboss, Inc. Linux is a registered trademark of Linus Torvalds. W3C is a registered trademark, and X Window System is a trademark of the Massachusetts Institute of Technology. MetaSolv is a registered trademark of Metasolv Software, Inc. ActiveX, Microsoft, Outlook, Visual Basic, Windows, and Windows NT are registered trademarks; and Windows Server is a trademark of Microsoft Corporation. Six Sigma is a registered trademark of Motorola, Inc. Firefox is a registered trademark, and Mozilla is a trademark of the Mozilla Foundation. MySQL is a registered trademark of MySQL AB. nCipher is a trademark of nCipher Corporation Ltd. Teradata is a registered trademark of NCR International, Inc. Netscape is a registered trademark of Netscape Communications Corporation. ServletExec is a registered trademark, and New Atlanta is a trademark of New Atlanta Communications, LLC. SUSE is a registered trademark of Novell, Inc. Appia is a registered trademark and Javelin Technologies is a trademark of NYFIX, Inc. CORBA is a registered trademark of Object Management Group, Inc. JD Edwards, OneWorld, Oracle, PeopleSoft, Siebel, and Vantive are registered trademarks, and PeopleSoft Pure Internet Architecture and WorldSoftware are trademarks of Oracle Corporation. Infranet and Portal are trademarks of Portal Software, Inc. Red Hat is a registered trademark of Red Hat, Inc. PIP and RosettaNet are trademarks of RosettaNet, a non-profit organization. SAP and R/3 are registered trademarks of SAP AG. SWIFT and SWIFTNet are registered trademarks of Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunication SCRL. SPARC and SPARCStation are registered trademarks of SPARC International, Inc. SSA is a registered trademark, and Baan and SSA Global are trademarks of SSA Global Technologies, Inc. EJB, Enterprise JavaBeans, Java, JavaServer, JDBC, JSP, J2EE, Solaris, Sun, and Sun Microsystems are registered trademarks; and Java Naming and Directory Interface, SOAP with Attachments API for Java, JavaServer Pages, and SunSoft are trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. Sybase is a registered trademark of Sybase, Inc. VERITAS is a registered trademark, and VERITAS Cluster Server is a trademark of Symantec Corporation. UNIX is a registered trademark of The Open Group. Unicode is a trademark of Unicode, Inc. VeriSign is a registered trademark of Verisign, Inc.

All other marks are the property of their respective owners.

Copyright © 2006 by webMethods, Inc. All rights reserved, including the right of reproduction in whole or in part in any form.

Document ID: IS-BIS-RF-65SP2-20061222

Copyright& Docu-ment ID

Page 3: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Contents

About This Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23Document Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25Additional Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26

Chapter 1. ART Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30pub.art.connection:disableConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30pub.art.connection:enableConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31pub.art.connection:getConnectionStatistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31pub.art.connection:listAdapterConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32pub.art.connection:queryConnectionState . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32pub.art.listener:disableListener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33pub.art.listener:enableListener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34pub.art.listener:listAdapterListeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34pub.art.listener:queryListenerState . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35pub.art.listener:resumeListener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36pub.art.listener:setListenerNodeConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36pub.art.listener:suspendListener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37pub.art.notification:disableListenerNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37pub.art.notification:disablePollingNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38pub.art.notification:enableListenerNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38pub.art.notification:enablePollingNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38pub.art.notification:listAdapterListenerNotifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39pub.art.notification:listAdapterPollingNotifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40pub.art.notification:queryListenerNotificationState . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41pub.art.notification:resumePollingNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42pub.art.notification:setListenerNotificationNodeListener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43pub.art.notification:setPollingNotificationNodeConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43pub.art.notification:suspendPollingNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44pub.art.service:listAdapterServices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44pub.art.service:setAdapterServiceNodeConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46pub.art.transaction:setTransactionTimeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47pub.art.transaction:startTransaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 3

Page 4: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 2. Client Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50pub.client:ftp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52pub.client.ftp:append . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54pub.client.ftp:cd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55pub.client.ftp:cdls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55pub.client.ftp:delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56pub.client.ftp:dir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57pub.client.ftp:get . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57pub.client.ftp:login . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59pub.client.ftp:logout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61pub.client.ftp:ls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61pub.client.ftp:mdelete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62pub.client.ftp:mget . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63pub.client.ftp:mput . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64pub.client.ftp:put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65pub.client.ftp:putCompletedNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66pub.client.ftp:quote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66pub.client.ftp:rename . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67pub.client.ftp:sessioninfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67pub.client:http . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68pub.client.ldap:add . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73pub.client.ldap:bind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75pub.client.ldap:cancelNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76pub.client.ldap:compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77pub.client.ldap:delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78pub.client.ldap:modify . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79pub.client.ldap:registerNotification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80pub.client.ldap:rename . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82pub.client.ldap:search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83pub.client:smtp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84pub.client:soapHTTP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86pub.client:soapRPC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 4

Page 5: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 3. Cluster Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94pub.cluster:disableServiceRedir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94pub.cluster:disableSessionRedir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95pub.cluster:getClusterHosts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95

Chapter 4. Date Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98pub.date:currentDate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102pub.date:dateBuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102pub.date:dateTimeBuild . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103pub.date:dateTimeFormat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104pub.date:formatDate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105pub.date:getCurrentDate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106pub.date:getCurrentDateString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

Chapter 5. Db Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108pub.db:call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109pub.db:clearTransaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111pub.db:close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112pub.db:closeAll . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113pub.db:commit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113pub.db:connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114pub.db:delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116pub.db:execSQL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117pub.db:getProcInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121pub.db:getProcs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122pub.db:getTableInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123pub.db:getTables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125pub.db:insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126pub.db:query . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128pub.db:rollback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129pub.db:startTransaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130pub.db:update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 5

Page 6: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 6. Document Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134pub.document:documentListToDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135pub.document:documentToDocumentList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136pub.document:documentToXMLValues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137pub.document:XMLValuesToDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

Chapter 7. Event Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140pub.event:addSubscriber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141pub.event:alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144pub.event:alarmInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145pub.event:audit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145pub.event:auditInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146pub.event:callStackItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146pub.event:deleteSubscriber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147pub.event:exception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148pub.event:exceptionInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149pub.event:gdEnd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150pub.event:gdEndInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150pub.event:gdStart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150pub.event:gdStartInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151pub.event:getEventTypes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151pub.event:getSubscribers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152pub.event:modifySubscriber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153pub.event:portStatus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156pub.event:portStatusInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157pub.event:reloadEventManagerSettings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158pub.event:replication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158pub.event:replicationInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159pub.event:sessionEnd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159pub.event:sessionEndInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160pub.event:sessionExpire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160pub.event:sessionExpireInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161pub.event:sessionStart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 6

Page 7: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.event:sessionStartInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162pub.event:stat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162pub.event:statInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163pub.event:txEnd . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164pub.event:txEndInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165pub.event:txStart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165pub.event:txStartInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165pub.event.audit:logToFile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166pub.event.exception:logToFile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166

Chapter 8. File Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170pub.file:getFile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170

Chapter 9. Flow Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174pub.flow:clearPipeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175pub.flow:debugLog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175pub.flow:getLastError . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176pub.flow:getRetryCount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176pub.flow:getSession . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177pub.flow:getTransportInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177pub.flow:restorePipeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178pub.flow:restorePipelineFromFile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179pub.flow:savePipeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180pub.flow:savePipelineToFile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180pub.flow:setResponse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181pub.flow:setResponseCode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182pub.flow:tracePipeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183pub.flow:transportInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184

Chapter 10. IO Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188pub.io:bytesToStream . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188pub.io:close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189pub.io:createByteArray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 7

Page 8: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.io:mark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190pub.io:markSupported . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190pub.io:read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191pub.io:reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191pub.io:skip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192pub.io:streamToBytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192

Chapter 11. LDAP Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194pub.ldap:bind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194pub.ldap:connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195pub.ldap:delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196pub.ldap:disconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196pub.ldap:getAttributeDef . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197pub.ldap:getClassDef . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198pub.ldap:list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199pub.ldap:lookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201pub.ldap:search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202pub.ldap:update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203

Chapter 12. List Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206pub.list:appendToDocumentList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207pub.list:appendToRecordList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207pub.list:appendToStringList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208pub.list:copyListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209pub.list:getListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209pub.list:getRecordListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210pub.list:getStringListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210pub.list:setListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210pub.list:setRecordListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211pub.list:setStringListItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211pub.list:sizeOfList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211pub.list:stringListToDocumentList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212pub.list:stringListToRecordList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 8

Page 9: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 13. Math Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216pub.math:addFloatList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217pub.math:addFloats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218pub.math:addIntList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219pub.math:addInts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219pub.math:addObjects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220pub.math:divideFloats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220pub.math:divideInts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221pub.math:divideObjects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222pub.math:multiplyFloatList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223pub.math:multiplyFloats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224pub.math:multiplyIntList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225pub.math:multiplyInts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225pub.math:multiplyObjects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226pub.math:randomDouble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226pub.math:subtractFloats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227pub.math:subtractInts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228pub.math:subtractObjects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228

Chapter 14. MIME Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232pub.mime:addBodyPart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233pub.mime:addMimeHeader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237pub.mime:createMimeData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238pub.mime:getBodyPartContent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241pub.mime:getBodyPartHeader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242pub.mime:getContentType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244pub.mime:getMimeHeader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246pub.mime:getNumParts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247pub.mime:getPrimaryContentType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248pub.mime:getSubContentType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249pub.mime:mergeHeaderAndBody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 9

Page 10: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 15. Packages Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252pub.packages:activatePackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252pub.packages:disablePackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253pub.packages:enablePackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254pub.packages:installPackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255pub.packages:recoverPackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256pub.packages:reloadPackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257

Chapter 16. PKI Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260pub.pki.pkcs7:sign . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260pub.pki.pkcs7:verify . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261pub.pki.smime.createSignedAndEncryptedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263pub.pki.smime.createSignedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264pub.pki.smime:processEncryptedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265pub.pki.smime:processSignedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266

Chapter 17. PRT Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270pub.prt:CorrelationService . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271pub.prt:ProcessData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272pub.prt.admin:changeProcessStatus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273pub.prt.admin:deleteProcess . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274pub.prt.admin:scanPackage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274pub.prt.correlate:deleteCorrelation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276pub.prt.correlate:establishCorrelation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276pub.prt.correlate:lookupCorrelation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277pub.prt.log:logActivityMessages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279pub.prt.tn:deleteByCID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280pub.prt.tn:getPIDforCID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280pub.prt.tn:getRoleInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281pub.prt.tn:handleBizDoc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282pub.prt.tn:mapCIDtoPID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283pub.prt.tn:RoleInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 10

Page 11: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 18. Publish Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286pub.publish:deliver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287pub.publish:deliverAndWait . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288pub.publish:documentResolverSpec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291pub.publish:envelope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292pub.publish:getRedeliveryCount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296pub.publish:publish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297pub.publish:publishAndWait . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298pub.publish:reply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301pub.publish:waitForReply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302pub.publish.notification:error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304

Chapter 19. Remote Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308pub.remote:invoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308pub.remote.gd:end . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310pub.remote.gd:getStatus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310pub.remote.gd:invoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311pub.remote.gd:restart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311pub.remote.gd:retrieve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312pub.remote.gd:send . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312pub.remote.gd:start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313pub.remote.gd:submit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314

Chapter 20. Record Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316pub.record:length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316pub.record:recordListToRecord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316pub.record:recordToRecordList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317pub.record:recordToXMLValues . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318pub.record:XMLValuesToRecord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 11

Page 12: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 21. Replicator Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320pub.replicator:addReleaseRegistryEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321pub.replicator:deleteReleaseRegistryEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322pub.replicator:distributeViaFTP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323pub.replicator:distributeViaSvcPull . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323pub.replicator:distributeViaSvcPush . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324pub.replicator:generateReplicationEvent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324pub.replicator:getLocalReleasedList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325pub.replicator:getRemoteReleasedList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326pub.replicator:notifyPackageRelease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327pub.replicator:packageCreation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327

Chapter 22. Report Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330pub.report:runFileTemplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330pub.report:runFileTemplateOnPipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331pub.report:runStringTemplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331pub.report:runStringTemplateOnPipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332pub.report:runTemplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332pub.report:runTemplateOnPipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333

Chapter 23. Scheduler Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336pub.scheduler:addComplexTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336pub.scheduler:addOneTimeTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338pub.scheduler:addRepeatingTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339pub.scheduler:cancelTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340pub.scheduler:getTaskIDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341pub.scheduler:getTaskInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341pub.scheduler:resumeTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343pub.scheduler:suspendTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343pub.scheduler:updateComplexTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344pub.scheduler:updateOneTimeTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346pub.scheduler:updateRepeatingTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 12

Page 13: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 24. Schema Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350pub.schema:createXSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350pub.schema:validate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352pub.schema:validatePipeline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354pub.schema.w3c . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355pub.schema.w3c:xml . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355pub.schema.w3c:xsi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355

Chapter 25. Security Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358pub.security:clearKeyAndChain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360pub.security:setKeyAndChain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361pub.security:setKeyAndChainFromBytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361pub.security.outboundPasswords:setPassword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362pub.security.outboundPasswords:getPassword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363pub.security.outboundPasswords:listKeys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364pub.security.outboundPasswords:removePassword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364pub.security.outboundPasswords:updatePassword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364pub.security.pkcs7:sign . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365pub.security.pkcs7:verify . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366pub.security.reverseInvoke:deleteAllConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367pub.security.reverseInvoke:deleteConnection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368pub.security.reverseInvoke:disableListeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368pub.security.reverseInvoke:getNumConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368pub.security.reverseInvoke:getServerType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369pub.security.reverseInvoke:keepAliveConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369pub.security.reverseInvoke:listProxyListeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370pub.security.reverseInvoke:listRegisteredConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372pub.security.reverseInvoke:listRegistrationListeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373pub.security.reverseInvoke:registerReverseConnections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374pub.security.util:createMessageDigest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375pub.security.util:getCertificateInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375pub.security.util:loadPKCS7CertChain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376pub.security.util:createSecureString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376pub.security.util:convertSecureString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377pub.security.util:destroySecureString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 13

Page 14: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 26. SMIME Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380pub.smime:createCertsOnlyData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380pub.smime:createEncryptedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381pub.smime:createSignedAndEncryptedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382pub.smime:createSignedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383pub.smime:processCertsOnlyData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385pub.smime:processEncryptedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385pub.smime:processSignedData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387

Chapter 27. SOAP Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392pub.soap.processor:list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394pub.soap.processor:processMessage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395pub.soap.processor:processRPCMessage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395pub.soap.processor:registerProcessor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396pub.soap.processor:unregisterProcessor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397pub.soap.schema:encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398pub.soap.schema:envelope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399pub.soap.utils:addTrailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401pub.soap.utils:createSoapData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402pub.soap.utils:exitUnableToUnderstand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403pub.soap.utils:getActor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403pub.soap.utils:getBody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405pub.soap.utils:getDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405pub.soap.utils:getHeader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407pub.soap.utils:getMustUnderstand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408pub.soap.utils:getQName . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409pub.soap.utils:getTrailers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409pub.soap.utils:QName . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410pub.soap.utils:removeBodyEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410pub.soap.utils:removeHeaderEntry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 14

Page 15: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.soap.utils:removeTrailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412pub.soap.utils:requestResponseSpec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413pub.soap.utils:soapDataToString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413pub.soap.utils:streamToSoapData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414pub.soap.utils:stringToSoapData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415pub.soap.utils:validateSoapData . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416

Chapter 28. Storage Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418pub.storage:add . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418pub.storage:closeStore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419pub.storage:deleteStore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419pub.storage:get . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420pub.storage:keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421pub.storage:lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421pub.storage:put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422pub.storage:registerStore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422pub.storage:remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423pub.storage:unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423

Chapter 29. String Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426pub.string:base64Decode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427pub.string:base64Encode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427pub.string:bytesToString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427pub.string:concat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428pub.string:HTMLDecode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428pub.string:HTMLEncode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429pub.string:indexOf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429pub.string:length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430pub.string:lookupDictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430pub.string:lookupTable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430pub.string:makeString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431pub.string:messageFormat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432pub.string:numericFormat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432pub.string:padLeft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433pub.string:padRight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 15

Page 16: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.string:replace . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435pub.string:stringToBytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435pub.string:substring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436pub.string:toLower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436pub.string:toUpper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437pub.string:tokenize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437pub.string:trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438pub.string:URLDecode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438pub.string:URLEncode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438

Chapter 30. Sync Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440pub.sync:notify . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440pub.sync:wait . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440

Chapter 31. Synchronization Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444pub.synchronization.latch:isLatchClosed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445pub.synchronization.latch:openLatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446pub.synchronization.xref:createXReference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446pub.synchronization.xref:deleteByObjectId . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447pub.synchronization.xref:deleteXReference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448pub.synchronization.xref:getCanonicalKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448pub.synchronization.xref:getNativeId . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 449pub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450

Chapter 32. Table Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452pub.table:recordListToTable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452pub.table:stringTableToTable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452pub.table:tableToRecordList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453pub.table:tableToStringTable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 16

Page 17: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 33. Task Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 455Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 456pub.task:TaskCallbackService . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457pub.task:TaskCompletionInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 458pub.task:TaskInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459pub.task:TaskQueueInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461pub.task:TaskSearchQuery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462pub.task:TaskSearchQueryTerm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 463pub.task.taskclient:deleteTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 465pub.task.taskclient:getTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 466pub.task.taskclient:queueTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468pub.task.taskclient:updateTask . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469

Chapter 34. Trigger Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472pub.trigger:createTrigger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472pub.trigger:deleteTrigger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479pub.trigger:resourceMonitoringSpec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480pub.trigger:resumeProcessing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481pub.trigger:resumeRetrieval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483pub.trigger:suspendProcessing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486pub.trigger:suspendRetrieval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 488

Chapter 35. UDDI Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 491Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492pub.uddi.client.doc:accessPoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500pub.uddi.client.doc:address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 501pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusItem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusReport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503pub.uddi.client.doc:authToken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingTemplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingTemplates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505pub.uddi.client.doc:businessDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506pub.uddi.client.doc:businessDetailExt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 17

Page 18: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntityExt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 507pub.uddi.client.doc:businessInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508pub.uddi.client.doc:businessInfos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508pub.uddi.client.doc:businessKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508pub.uddi.client.doc:businessList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 508pub.uddi.client.doc:businessService . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509pub.uddi.client.doc:businessServices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509pub.uddi.client.doc:categoryBag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510pub.uddi.client.doc:contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510pub.uddi.client.doc:contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511pub.uddi.client.doc:discoveryURL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511pub.uddi.client.doc:discoveryURLs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511pub.uddi.client.doc:dispositionReport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_categoryBag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 512pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_keyedReference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513pub.uddi.client.doc:email . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513pub.uddi.client.doc:errInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514pub.uddi.client.doc:findQualifier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514pub.uddi.client.doc:findQualifiers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514pub.uddi.client.doc:fromKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514pub.uddi.client.doc:hostingRedirector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514pub.uddi.client.doc:identifierBag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515pub.uddi.client.doc:instanceDetails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515pub.uddi.client.doc:instanceParms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515pub.uddi.client.doc:keyedReference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516pub.uddi.client.doc:keysOwned . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516pub.uddi.client.doc:overviewDoc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516pub.uddi.client.doc:phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517pub.uddi.client.doc:publisherAssertion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517pub.uddi.client.doc:publisherAssertions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 517pub.uddi.client.doc:registeredInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessInfos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 519pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessesList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 519pub.uddi.client.doc:result . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 519

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 18

Page 19: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.uddi.client.doc:schema_uddiv2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 520pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceInfos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521pub.uddi.client.doc:sharedRelationships . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521pub.uddi.client.doc:SOAPFault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522pub.uddi.client.doc:tModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelBag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInfos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceDetails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelList . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525pub.uddi.client.doc:toKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525pub.uddi.client.doc:uploadRegister . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 525pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_binding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 526pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByCategory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByDiscURLs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByIdentity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByName . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessBytModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_relatedBusinesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByBusKey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByCategory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByName . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceBytModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByCategory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByIdentity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByName . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542 pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_bindingDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_businessDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 19

Page 20: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_businessDetailExt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_serviceDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 546 pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_tModelDetail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547pub.uddi.client.publish:add_publisherAssertions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 548pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_binding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_publisherAssertions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_tModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553pub.uddi.client.publish:discard_authToken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 554pub.uddi.client.publish:get_assertionstatusReport . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 555pub.uddi.client.publish:get_authToken . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 556pub.uddi.client.publish:get_publisherAssertions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 557pub.uddi.client.publish:get_registeredInfo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558pub.uddi.client.publish:save_binding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559pub.uddi.client.publish:save_business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 560pub.uddi.client.publish:save_service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561pub.uddi.client.publish:save_tModel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562pub.uddi.client.publish:set_publisherAssertions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563

Chapter 36. UniversalName Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 565Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566pub.universalName:find . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566pub.universalName:list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566

Chapter 37. VCS Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570pub.vcs:getUsers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570pub.vcs:removeCurrentUser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571pub.vcs:removeMultipleUsers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571pub.vcs:setCurrentUser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572pub.vcs:setMultipleUsers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573

Chapter 38. Utils Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 576pub.utils:getServerProperty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 576

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 20

Page 21: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

Chapter 39. Web Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 577Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 578pub.web:createRegions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579pub.web:documentToRecord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581pub.web:freeDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588pub.web:getDocumentType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589pub.web:getNextNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589pub.web:getNodeIterator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590pub.web:loadDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592pub.web:makeArrays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597pub.web:queryDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597pub.web:recordToDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599pub.web:stringToDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604

Chapter 40. XML Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 606pub.xml:documentToXMLString . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607pub.xml:freeXMLNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 612pub.xml:getNextXMLNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613pub.xml:getXMLNodeType . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615pub.xml:loadXMLNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616pub.xml:queryXMLNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 621pub.xml:xmlNodeToDocument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 623pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630

Chapter 41. XSLT Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631Summary of Elements in this Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632pub.xslt.Transformations:transformSerialXML . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632pub.xslt.Cache:removeAllTemplates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634pub.xslt.Cache:removeTemplate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 634

Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 21

Page 22: Integration Server Bis Reference

Contents

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 22

Page 23: Integration Server Bis Reference

About This Guide

About This Guide

The webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference describes the built-in services provided with a standard installation of the webMethods Integration Server. Services are also installed with webMethods add-on packages, such as adapters and monitoring tools. You will find documentation for those services in the user guide provided with the add-on product.

The descriptions in this book are divided into the following folders. These folders reside in the WmPublic package, unless specified otherwise.

Folder Page Contains services you use to…

art 27 (WmART package) Manage adapter components, including connections, adapter services, listeners, and notifications.

client 49 Formulate and submit requests to HTTP, FTP, email, and LDAP servers.

cluster 93 Enable and/or disable load balancing for specific services and sessions in a cluster.

date 97 Generate and format date values.

db 107 (WmDB package) Access JDBC-enabled databases. The webMethods JDBC adapter also provides services that perform operations against JDBC-enabled databases. See the JDBC Adapter User’s Guide for information.

document 133 Perform operations on documents in the pipeline.

event 139 Build audit and event handler services.

file 169 Perform operations on the local file system.

flow 173 Perform debugging and utility-type tasks in a flow service.

io 187 Convert data between byte[ ] and InputStream representations.

ldap 193 Deprecated. Access and update information on an LDAP directory server. Use services in the client.ldap folder instead.

list 205 Retrieve, replace, or add elements in an Object List, Document List, or String List; convert String Lists to Document Lists.

math 215 Add, subtract, multiply, or divide string-based numeric values.

mime 231 Create MIME messages and extract information from MIME messages.

packages 251 Install, load, and/or alter the status of a package on the Integration Server.

pki 259 (WmPKI package) Create and verify PKCS#7 signatures with PKI profiles and create and process S/MIME messages using PKI profiles.

prt 269 (WmPRT package) Interact with the process run-time facility.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 23

Page 24: Integration Server Bis Reference

About This Guide

publish 285 Publish and deliver documents to other Integration Servers via webMethods Broker.

record 315 Deprecated. Perform operations on documents in the pipeline. Use services in the document folder instead.

remote 307 Invoke services on remote webMethods Integration Servers.

replicator 319 Replicate packages across webMethods Integration Servers.

report 329 Apply an output template to the values in the pipeline.

scheduler 335 Schedule services to execute at the times you specify.

schema 349 Validate objects or values in the pipeline.

security 357 Control which client certificates are sent to other services and to digitally sign data and process digital signatures. Store and retrieve outbound passwords to access secure resources.

smime 379 Create digitally signed and/or encrypted MIME messages. Process signed and encrypted MIME messages.

soap 391 Send, receive, and retrieve data from SOAP messages. Register custom SOAP processors.

storage 417 Create, close, delete, and register repository data stores. Insert and retrieve information from data stores.

string 425 Perform string manipulation and substitution operations.

sync 439 Coordinate the execution of services.

synchronization 443 Perform latching and cross-referencing operations in a publish-and-subscribe integration.

table 451 Deprecated. Convert instances of com.wm.util.Table to other data types.

universalName 565 List the contents of the Universal Registry and look up services by their universal names.

UDDI 491 (WmUDDI package) Query about Web service information and publish an existing Integration Server service as a Web service to a UDDI server.

web 577 Deprecated. Perform operations on XML and HTML documents. Use services in the xml folder instead.

xml 605 Perform operations on XML documents.

xslt 631 Transform an XML stream into a byte array, file, or XML node, and to maintain the XSLT stylesheet cache.

Folder Page Contains services you use to…

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 24

Page 25: Integration Server Bis Reference

About This Guide

Built-in services generally have the following default access permissions:

These default access permissions cannot be changed (that is, another ACL cannot be selected).

Document Convent ions

For this type of permission... Built-in services are assigned to this ACL...

List Developers. Members of the Developers ACL can see, in webMethods Integration Server or Developer, that a service exists.

Read WmPrivate. The WmPrivate ACL is a virtual ACL designated by webMethods to protect the proprietary code in the built-in services. As this ACL has no members, no user can edit a service or view its source.

Write WmPrivate.

Execute Internal. Members of the Internal ACL can execute a service.

Convention Description

Bold Identifies elements on a screen.

Italic Identifies variable information that you must supply or change based on your specific situation or environment. Identifies terms the first time they are defined in text. Also identifies service input and output variables.

Narrow font Identifies storage locations for services on the webMethods Integration Server using the convention folder.subfolder:service.

Typewriter font

Identifies characters and values that you must type exactly or messages that the system displays on the console.

UPPERCASE Identifies keyboard keys. Keys that you must press simultaneously are joined with the “+” symbol.

\ Directory paths use the “\” directory delimiter unless the subject is UNIX-specific.

[ ] Optional keywords or values are enclosed in [ ]. Do not type the [ ] symbols in your own code.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 25

Page 26: Integration Server Bis Reference

About This Guide

Addit ional Informat ionThe webMethods Advantage Web site at http://advantage.webmethods.com provides you with important sources of information about webMethods components.

Troubleshooting Information. webMethods provides troubleshooting information for many webMethods components in the webMethods Knowledge Base.

Documentation Feedback. To provide documentation feedback to webMethods, go to the Documentation Feedback Form on the webMethods Bookshelf.

Additional Documentation. All webMethods documentation is available on the webMethods Bookshelf.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 26

Page 27: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 1. ART Folder

You use the elements in the ART folder to manage adapter components; specifically, these elements enable you to manage connections, adapter services, listeners, and notifications. This folder also provides elements to manage any built-in transaction management services supported by your webMethods 6.x adapter. See the documentation provided with your adapter to determine whether your adapter supports the transaction management services.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 27

Page 28: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters WmART. Returns the display name and adapter type name of all registered adapters.

pub.art.connection:disableConnection WmART. Disables a connection node.

pub.art.connection:enableConnection WmART. Enables an existing connection node.

pub.art.connection:getConnectionStatistics WmART. Returns current usage statistics for a connection node.

pub.art.connection:listAdapterConnections WmART. Lists connection nodes associated with a specified adapter.

pub.art.connection:queryConnectionState WmART. Returns the current connection state (enabled/disabled) and error status for a connection node.

pub.art.listener:disableListener WmART. Disables a listener.

pub.art.listener:enableListener WmART. Enables an existing listener.

pub.art.listener:listAdapterListeners WmART. Lists listeners associated with a specified adapter.

pub.art.listener:queryListenerState WmART. Returns the current state for a listener.

pub.art.listener:resumeListener WmART. Resumes a specified listener.

pub.art.listener:setListenerNodeConnection WmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified listener.

pub.art.listener:suspendListener WmART. Suspends a specified listener.

pub.art.notification:disableListenerNotification WmART. Disables a listener notification.

pub.art.notification:disablePollingNotification WmART. Disables a polling notification.

pub.art.notification:enableListenerNotification WmART. Enables an existing listener notification.

pub.art.notification:enablePollingNotification WmART. Enables an existing polling notification.

pub.art.notification:listAdapterListenerNotifications WmART. Lists the listener notifications associated with a specified adapter.

pub.art.notification:listAdapterPollingNotifications WmART. Lists the polling notifications associated with a specified adapter.

pub.art.notification:queryListenerNotificationState WmART. Returns the current state (enabled/disabled) for a listener notification.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 28

Page 29: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState WmART. Returns the current state for a polling notification.

pub.art.notification:resumePollingNotification WmART. Resumes a specified polling notification node.

pub.art.notification:setListenerNotificationNodeListener WmART. Changes the listener used by a specified listener notification.

pub.art.notification:setPollingNotificationNodeConnection WmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified polling notification.

pub.art.notification:suspendPollingNotification WmART. Suspends a specified polling notification.

pub.art.service:listAdapterServices WmART. Lists adapter services associated with a specified adapter.

pub.art.service:setAdapterServiceNodeConnection WmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified adapter service.

pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction WmART. Commits an explicit transaction.

pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction WmART. Rolls back an explicit transaction.

pub.art.transaction:setTransactionTimeout WmART. Manually sets a transaction timeout interval for implicit and explicit transactions.

pub.art.transaction:startTransaction WmART. Starts an explicit transaction.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 29

Page 30: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art : l istRegisteredAdaptersWmART. Returns the display name and adapter type name of all registered adapters.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.art .connect ion:disableConnect ionWmART. Disables a connection node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.connection:enableConnection

registeredAdapterList Document List Information for each adapter registered with the WmART package.

Key Description

adapterDisplayName String The localized name that the Integration Server Administrator displays.

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package. This value can be used as input for the inventory services that take adapterTypeName as input.

connectionAlias String Name of the connection node you want to disable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 30

Page 31: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .connect ion:enableConnect ionWmART. Enables an existing connection node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.connection:disableConnection

pub.art .connect ion:getConnect ionStat ist icsWmART. Returns current usage statistics for a connection node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art.connection:queryConnectionState

connectionAlias String Name of the connection node you want to enable.

aliasName String Name of the connection node for which you want usage statistics returned.

connectionStatistics Document List Information for each connection node.

Key Description

TotalConnections Integer Current number of connection instances.

BusyConnections Integer Number of connections currently in use by services, notifications, and listeners.

FreeConnections Integer Total number of connections created and available for use.

TotalHits Integer Number of times this connection node successfully provided connections since the last reset.

TotalMisses Integer Number of times this connection node unsuccessfully provided connections since the last reset (when the request timed out).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 31

Page 32: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .connect ion: l istAdapterConnect ionsWmART. Lists connection nodes associated with a specified adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Alsopub.art:listRegisteredAdapters

pub.art.connection:queryConnectionState

pub.art .connect ion:queryConnect ionStateWmART. Returns the current connection state (enabled/disabled) and error status for a connection node.

Input Parameters

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package.

connectionDataList Document List Information for each connection node registered with the specified adapter.

Key Description

connectionAlias String The name of the connection node.

packageName String The name of the package in which the connection node resides.

connectionState String Current state of the connection node. The state will have one of these values:

Value Description

disabled Connection node is disabled.

enabled Connection node is enabled.

shuttingdown Connection node is in the process of shutting down.

unknown Connection node is registered but has not yet established its state.

connectionAlias String Name of the connection node for which you want the connection state and error status returned.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 32

Page 33: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art.connection:getConnectionStatistics

pub.art.connection:enableConnection

pub.art.connection:disableConnection

pub.art . l istener:disableListenerWmART. Disables a listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.listener:enableListener

connectionState String Current connection state (enabled/disabled).

hasError Boolean Flag indicating if any error was detected on connection. The values are:

Value Description

true An error was detected.

false No error was detected.

listenerName String Name of the listener you want to disable. The listener should have a state of enabled or suspended.

forceDisable String Optional. Flag to disable the listener regardless of whether it is still waiting for data from a backend resource. The string may have one of these values:

Value Description

true Force the disable.

false Do not force the disable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 33

Page 34: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art . l istener:enableListenerWmART. Enables an existing listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If you do not enable the connection resource associated with the listener, this service will return without performing any action, and the listener will remain disabled. Therefore, you should invoke pub.art.listener:queryListenerState before calling this service to confirm that the listener has been enabled.

See Also

pub.art.listener:queryListenerState

pub.art.listener:disableListener

pub.art . l istener: l istAdapterListenersWmART. Lists listeners associated with a specified adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

listenerName String Name of the listener you want to enable.

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package.

listenerDataList Document List Information for each listener registered with the specified adapter.

Key Description

listenerNodeName String The name of the listener.

packageName String The name of the package in which the listener resides.

listenerEnabled String Current state of the listener. The state will have one of these values:

Value Description

disabled Listener is disabled.

enabled Listener is enabled.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 34

Page 35: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

See Also

pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters

pub.art.listener:queryListenerState

pub.art . l istener:queryListenerStateWmART. Returns the current state for a listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art.listener:enableListener

pub.art.listener:disableListener

enablePending Listener is in the process of starting.

disablePending Listener is in the process of disabling.

suspended Listener is suspended.

suspendPending Listener is in the process of suspending.

listenerName String Name of the listener for which you want the current state returned.

listenerState String Current state of the listener. The state will have one of these values:

Value Description

disabled Listener is disabled.

enabled Listener is enabled.

enablePending Listener is in the process of starting.

disablePending Listener is in the process of disabling.

suspended Listener is suspended.

suspendPending Listener is in the process of suspending.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 35

Page 36: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art . l istener:resumeListenerWmART. Resumes a specified listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If the requested transition is not valid (for example, trying to resume a disabled listener or a listener that is already resumed), the service ignores the request.

After you use this service, you can use pub.art.listener:queryListenerState to verify pub.art.listener:resumeListener correctly changed the state of the listener.

See Also

pub.art.listener:queryListenerStatepub.art.listener:suspendListener

pub.art . l istener:setListenerNodeConnect ionWmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Calling this service for a listener that is disabled is permitted.

Calling this service for a listener that is suspended changes the state of the listener to disabled. The user must enable the listener before using it.

See Also

pub.art.listener:disableListener

listenerName String The name of the suspended listener you want to resume. The service returns an error if you specify an invalid listener.

listenerName String Name of the listener for which you want to change the connection node.

connectionAlias String Name of the new connection node to use with the listener.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 36

Page 37: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art . l istener:suspendListenerWmART. Suspends a specified listener.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If the requested transition is not valid (for example, trying to suspend a disabled listener or a listener that is already suspended), the service ignores the request.

After you use this service, you can use pub.art.listener:queryListenerState to verify pub.art.listener:suspendListener correctly changed the state of the listener.

See Also

pub.art.listener:queryListenerState

pub.art.listener:resumeListener

pub.art .not i f icat ion:disableListenerNot i f icat ionWmART. Disables a listener notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.notification:enableListenerNotification

listenerName String The name of the listener you want to suspend. The service returns an error if you specify an invalid listener.

notificationName String The name of the listener notification you want to disable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 37

Page 38: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .not i f icat ion:disablePol l ingNoti f icat ionWmART. Disables a polling notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.notification:enablePollingNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion:enableListenerNot i f icat ionWmART. Enables an existing listener notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.art.notification:disableListenerNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion:enablePol l ingNoti f icat ionWmART. Enables an existing polling notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

notificationName String The name of the polling notification you want to disable. The polling notification should have a state of enabled or suspended.

notificationName String The name of the listener notification you want to enable.

notificationName String Name of the polling notification you want to enable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 38

Page 39: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

Usage Notes

You must schedule the polling notification before you can run this service. See your adapter user documentation for instructions to schedule the polling notification.

See Also

pub.art.notification:disablePollingNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion: l istAdapterListenerNot i f icat ionsWmART. Lists the listener notifications associated with a specified adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters

pub.art.notification:queryListenerNotificationState

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package.

notificationDataList Document List Information for each listener notification registered with the specified adapter.

Key Description

notificationNodeName String The name of the listener notification.

packageName String The name of the package in which the listener notification resides.

notificationEnabled String The current state of the listener notification. The state will have one of these values:

Value Description

no Listener notification is disabled.

yes Listener notification is enabled.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 39

Page 40: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .not i f icat ion: l istAdapterPol l ingNoti f icat ionsWmART. Lists the polling notifications associated with a specified adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters

pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package.

notificationDataList Document List Information for each polling notification registered with the specified adapter.

Key Description

notificationNodeName String The name of the polling notification.

packageName String The name of the package in which the polling notification resides.

notificationEnabled String The current state of the polling notification. The state will have one of these values:

Value Description

no Polling notification is disabled.

yes Polling notification is enabled.

pending Polling notification is in the process of shutting down.

suspended Polling notification is suspended.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 40

Page 41: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .not i f icat ion:queryListenerNot i f icat ionStateWmART. Returns the current state (enabled/disabled) for a listener notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.art.notification:enableListenerNotification

pub.art.notification:disableListenerNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion:queryPol l ingNoti f icat ionStateWmART. Returns the current state for a polling notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

notificationName String The name of the listener notification for which you want the current state (enabled/disabled) returned.

notificationState String The current state (enabled/disabled) for the listener notification.

notificationName String The name of the polling notification for which you want the current state and schedule settings returned.

notificationState String The current state (enabled, disabled, pending disable, pending suspend, or suspended) for the polling notification.

scheduleSettings IData Object that contains the notification’s schedule settings as follows:

Key Description

notificationInterval Integer Polling frequency of the notification.

notificationOverlap Boolean Flags whether the notification can overlap. The values are:

Value Description

true The notification can overlap.

false The notification cannot overlap.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 41

Page 42: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

See Also

pub.art.notification:enablePollingNotificationpub.art.notification:disablePollingNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion:resumePol l ingNoti f icat ionWmART. Resumes a specified polling notification node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If the requested transition is not valid (for example, trying to resume a disabled polling notification or a polling notification that is already resumed), the service ignores the request.

After you use this service, you can use pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState to verify pub.art.notification:resumePollingNotification correctly changed the state of the polling notification to enabled.

See Also

pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState

pub.art.notification:suspendPollingNotification

notificationImmediate Boolean Flags whether the notification can fire immediately. The values are:

Value Description

true The notification can fire immediately.

false The notification cannot fire immediately.

notificationName String The name of the polling notification you want to resume. The service returns an error if you specify an invalid polling notification.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 42

Page 43: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .not i f icat ion:setListenerNot i f icat ionNodeListenerWmART. Changes the listener used by a specified listener notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service returns an error if the listener notification is enabled.

You can use this service for synchronous and asynchronous listener notifications.

See Also

pub.art.notification:disableListenerNotification

pub.art .not i f icat ion:setPol l ingNot i f icat ionNodeConnect ionWmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified polling notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The polling notification must be in a disabled or suspended state before you call this service. This service returns an error if the polling notification is enabled.

If you use this service on a suspended polling notification, the service changes the state of the polling notification to disabled.

See Also

pub.art.notification:disablePollingNotification

notificationName String Name of the listener notification for which you want to change the listener.

listenerNode String Name of the new listener to use with the listener notification.

notificationName String Name of the polling notification for which you want to change the connection node.

connectionAlias String Name of the new connection node to use with the polling notification.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 43

Page 44: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art .not i f icat ion:suspendPol l ingNot i f icat ionWmART. Suspends a specified polling notification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If the requested transition is not valid (for example, trying to suspend a disabled polling notification or a polling notification that is already suspended), the service ignores the request.

After you use this service, you can use pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState to verify pub.art.notification:suspendPollingNotification correctly changed the state of the polling notification to suspended.

See Also

pub.art.notification:queryPollingNotificationState

pub.art.notification:resumePollingNotification

pub.art .service: l istAdapterServicesWmART. Lists adapter services associated with a specified adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

notificationName String The name of the polling notification you want to suspend. The service returns an error if you specify an invalid polling notification.

adapterTypeName String The name of the adapter as registered with the WmART package.

serviceDataList Document List Information for each adapter service registered with the specified adapter.

Key Description

serviceNodeName String The name of the adapter service.

packageName String The name of the package in which the adapter service resides.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 44

Page 45: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

See Also

pub.art:listRegisteredAdapters

pub.art .service:setAdapterServiceNodeConnect ionWmART. Changes the connection node used by a specified adapter service.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The new connection node must be enabled before you call this service.

See Also

pub.art.connection:enableConnection

pub.art . t ransact ion:commitTransact ionWmART. Commits an explicit transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

serviceName String Name of an existing adapter service for which you want to change the connection node.

connectionAlias String Name of the new connection node to use with the adapter service.

commitTransactionInput Document List Information for each commit request.

Key Description

transactionName String The name of an explicit transaction that you want to commit. The transactionName must have been previously used in a call to pub.art.transaction:startTransaction.

This value must be mapped from the most recent pub.art.transaction:startTransaction that has not previously been committed or rolled back.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 45

Page 46: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

Usage Notes

This service is available only if your adapter supports built-in transaction management services, which you can confirm by checking the user guide for the adapter.

This service must be used in conjunction with the pub.art.transaction:startTransaction service. If the transactionName parameter was not provided in a prior call to pub.art.transaction:startTransaction, a runtime error will be returned.

See Also

pub.art.transaction:startTransaction

pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction

pub.art . t ransact ion:rol lbackTransact ionWmART. Rolls back an explicit transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available only if your adapter supports built-in transaction management services, which you can confirm by checking the user guide for the adapter.

This service must be used in conjunction with the pub.art.transaction:startTransaction service. If the given transactionName parameter was not provided in a prior call to pub.art.transaction:startTransaction, a runtime error will be returned.

See Also

pub.art.transaction:startTransaction

pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction

rollbackTransactionInput Document List Information for each rollback request.

Key Description

transactionName String The name of an explicit transaction that you want to roll back. The transactionName must have been previously used in a call to pub.art.transaction:startTransaction.

This value must be mapped from the most recent pub.art.transaction:startTransaction that has not previously been committed or rolled back.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 46

Page 47: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

pub.art . t ransact ion:setTransact ionTimeoutWmART. Manually sets a transaction timeout interval for implicit and explicit transactions.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available only if your adapter supports built-in transaction management services, which you can confirm by checking the user guide for the adapter.

When you use this service, you are temporarily overriding the Integration Server transaction timeout interval.

You must call this service within a flow before the start of any implicit or explicit transactions. Implicit transactions start when you call an adapter service in a flow. Explicit transactions start when you call the pub.art.transaction:startTransaction service.

If the execution of a transaction takes longer than the transaction timeout interval, all transacted operations are rolled back.

This service only overrides the transaction timeout interval for the flow service in which you call it.

See Also

pub.art.transaction:startTransaction

pub.art . t ransact ion:star tTransact ionWmART. Starts an explicit transaction.

Input Parameters

timeoutSeconds Integer The number of seconds that the implicit or explicit transaction stays open before the transaction manager marks it for rollback.

startTransactionInput Document List Information for each start transaction request.

Key Description

transactionName String Optional. Specifies the name of the transaction to be started. If you leave this parameter blank, the Integration Server will generate a name for you. In most implementations it is not necessary to provide your own transaction name.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 47

Page 48: Integration Server Bis Reference

1. ART Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service is available only if your adapter supports built-in transaction management services, which you can confirm by checking the user guide for the adapter.

This service is intended for use with the pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction or pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction service. The transactionName value returned by a call to this service can be provided to pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction (to commit the transaction) or pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction (to roll back the transaction).

See Also

pub.art.transaction:commitTransaction

pub.art.transaction:rollbackTransaction

startTransactionOutput Document List Information for each start transaction request.

Key Description

transactionName String The name of the transaction the service just started.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 48

Page 49: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 2. Cl ient Folder

You use the elements in the client folder to formulate and submit requests to HTTP, FTP, LDAP, and email servers.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 49

Page 50: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.client:ftp WmPublic. Performs a series of FTP actions.

sample.soap:buildRPC_SendHTTPSimplepub.client.ftp:append

WmPublic. Appends data to a remote file.

pub.client.ftp:cd WmPublic. Changes the working directory on the FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command cd dirpath.)

pub.client.ftp:cdls WmPublic. Changes the working directory on the FTP server and retrieves a list of file names. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP commands cd dirpath and ls namePattern.)

pub.client.ftp:delete WmPublic. Deletes a file in the current working directory on an FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command delete somefile.)

pub.client.ftp:dir WmPublic. Retrieves the file list during an FTP session. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command dir namepattern.)

pub.client.ftp:get WmPublic. Retrieves a file from a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command get.)

pub.client.ftp:login WmPublic. Connects to a remote FTP server and logs in with a specified user name and password.

pub.client.ftp:logout WmPublic. Logs off of the FTP server and ends the current FTP session.

pub.client.ftp:ls WmPublic. Retrieves the file list during an FTP session. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command ls namepattern.)

pub.client.ftp:mdelete WmPublic. Deletes multiple files in the current working directory on an FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command mdelete pattern.)

pub.client.ftp:mget WmPublic. Transfers multiple files from the remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command mget.)

pub.client.ftp:mput WmPublic. Transfers multiple files to a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command input.)

pub.client.ftp:put WmPublic. Transfers a file to a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command put.)

pub.client.ftp:putCompletedNotification

WmPublic. A document type published to the webMethods Broker to notify parties that an FTP put command has completed.

pub.client.ftp:quote WmPublic. Executes a given FTP command.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 50

Page 51: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.client.ftp:rename WmPublic. Renames a file on a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command rename.)

pub.client.ftp:sessioninfo WmPublic. Returns session information for all of the FTP servers that users are currently logged into.

pub.client:http WmPublic. Issues an HTTP request that you specify and returns the HTTP response.

pub.client.ldap:add WmPublic. Inserts a new entry into the directory.

pub.client.ldap:bind WmPublic. Performs an LDAP bind operation that associates the connection with the specified principal.

pub.client.ldap:cancelNotification WmPublic. Cancels a previously created notification request.

pub.client.ldap:compare WmPublic. Compares the value of an attribute in the LDAP directory with a value specified by the service.

pub.client.ldap:delete WmPublic. Removes an entry from the directory.

pub.client.ldap:modify WmPublic. Performs an LDAP modify operation that allows you to specify a list of attributes with corresponding lists of values to add to, replace, or remove from the directory entry.

pub.client.ldap:registerNotification WmPublic. Creates a notification (or “persistent search”) that causes Integration Server to listen for LDAP events. When the notification gets an event, the specified service is called.

pub.client.ldap:rename WmPublic. Performs an LDAP rename (move) operation allowing you to rename an entry.

pub.client.ldap:search WmPublic. Performs an LDAP search operation with the specified parameters and returns the results of the search.

pub.client:smtp WmPublic. Sends a MIME-type email message.

pub.client:soapHTTP WmPublic. Submits a SOAP message to a server via HTTP or HTTPS.

pub.client:soapRPC WmPublic. Submits a SOAP remote procedure call via HTTP or HTTPS.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 51

Page 52: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient: f tpWmPublic. Performs a series of FTP actions.

This service executes the following sequence:

1 Logs on to an FTP server.

2 Changes to a specified working directory.

3 Performs one of the following FTP commands: ls, put, or get.

4 Logs off the FTP server.

Input Parameters

serverhost String Name or IP address of the FTP server (for example, ftp.netscape.com).

serverport String Port number of the FTP server (for example, 4566).

username String Valid FTP user of the remote FTP server (for example, anonymous).

password String Valid password of the FTP user.

command String One of the following FTP commands: ls, put, or get.

dirpath String Working directory of the FTP server (for example, /tmp/pub). If the directory does not exist, the server throws an exception.

transfermode String One of two FTP file transfer modes: ascii or binary. The default is ascii.

transfertype String One of two FTP data transfer types: passive or active. The default is active.

localfile String When command is set to put, this parameter specifies the name of the local file you want to transfer. (If content is specified, this field is ignored.)

When command is set to get, this parameter specifies the name of the local file in which you want the retrieved content saved.

remotefile String When command is set to put, this parameter specifies the name of the remote file in which you want the save the data you are sending.

When command is set to get, this parameter specifies the name of the remote file that you want to retrieve.

content java.io.InputStream, byte[ ], or String Data to be transferred when command is set to put.

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the document is encoded. Specify an IANA-registered character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

This information is required to correctly convert the String object to bytes when performing a get. If parameter is null, the default JVM encoding is used.

timeout String Time (measured in seconds) to wait for a response from the FTP server before timing out and aborting the request. Default is to wait forever.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 52

Page 53: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

putunique String Optional. Indicates whether to send a STOR or a STOU (Store as Unique File) command to the remote FTP server.

Set to... To...

true String Send a STOU (Store as Unique File) command.

false String Default. Send a STOR command.

secure Document Indicates whether the FTP session is with a secure FTP server.

Variables in secure Description

auth String The kind of authentication mechanism to use: None, SSL, TLS, or TLS-P.

None specifies that the FTP session is with a non-secure FTP server. This is the default. If the value of auth is None, the securedata variable is ignored.

TLS-P is a shortcut that is equivalent to the sequence AUTH TLS, PBSZ 0, and PROT P. If the value of auth is TLS-P, the securedata variable is ignored.

securedata String Use the value false for a client sending PROT C (Data Channel Protection Level Clear). Use the value true for a client sending PROT P (Data Channel Protection Level Private).

Note: If you do not set a value, the default is false.

cleanlinefeeds String Optional. Indicates whether the service should retain or remove carriage return characters at the end of each line of text.

Set to... To...

true String Default. Remove carriage returns.

false String Retain carriage returns.

command String FTP command that was executed (ls, get, or put).

dirlist String List File names returned by the ls command.

localfile String Name of the local file used for a get or put operation.

remotefile String Name of the remote file used for a get or put operation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 53

Page 54: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

If you set the auth variable in the secure parameter to SSL, TLS, or TLS-P, pub.client.ftp automatically sends the following sequence of FTP commands prior to sending the USER command:AUTH <SSL | TLS | TLS-P>PBSZ 0PROT <P | C>

The client FTP services will not negotiate for less security than you have specified with the auth parameter. However, if you set the auth variable to None, the client FTP services can operate (in a non-secure mode) with any FTP server.

The FTP services will always connect to a secure FTP server using a non-secure (SSL) socket. After getting a valid reply from the AUTH command, the FTP services will convert the connected socket to an SSL socket and initiate SSL handshaking.

pub.cl ient . f tp:appendWmPublic. Appends data to a remote file.

If the remote file does not exist, the service creates the file.

Input Parameters

content byte[ ] If localfile was not specified, this parameter contains the Content object sent to the remote server (if a put command was executed) or received from the remote server (if a get command was executed).

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log message.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

transfermode String FTP file transfer mode (ascii or binary). The default is ascii.

content java.io.InputStream, byte[ ], or String Data to be transferred to the remote file.

localfile String Optional. Name of the local file to append to the remote file. Used only when content is not specified.

remotefile String Name of the remote file to which to append the data specified in content or localfile.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 54

Page 55: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:cdWmPublic. Changes the working directory on the FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command cd dirpath.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:cdlsWmPublic. Changes the working directory on the FTP server and retrieves a list of file names. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP commands cd dirpath and ls namePattern.)

Input Parameters

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

dirpath String Directory to which you want to switch on the FTP server. For example: pub

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

dirpath String Directory to which you want to switch on the FTP server (for example, pub).

filenamepattern String Optional. Pattern that specifies the file names to list (for example, *.txt).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 55

Page 56: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:deleteWmPublic. Deletes a file in the current working directory on an FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command delete somefile.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

orderby String Optional. The order of the returned file list.

Value of orderby Description

none Default. Sends an NLST command to the remote FTP server.

timestamp Returns the list in order of the timestamp. Sends an NLST -t command to the remote FTP server.

Note: The -t command is not part of the RFC959 standard. Some FTP servers may not support this command. Servers that support this command may return the results in either ascending or descending order of creation time.

dirlist String List List of file names matching filenamepattern.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

remotefile String Name of the file to be deleted from the current working directory. For example: text.txt

If you specify pattern-matching characters in remotefile, all files matching the pattern will be deleted.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 56

Page 57: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . f tp:dirWmPublic. Retrieves the file list during an FTP session. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command dir namepattern.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:getWmPublic. Retrieves a file from a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command get.)

Input Parameters

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

filenamepattern String Optional. Pattern that specifies the names of the files to include in the list (for example, *.txt).

dirlist String List List of file names matching filenamepattern.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

transfermode String FTP file transfer mode (ascii or binary). The default is ascii.

localfile String Optional. Name of a local file where the retrieved file is to be saved.

remotefile String Name of the remote file.

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the file is encoded. This variable is required to convert the file to bytes correctly. Specify an IANA-registered character set (for example: ISO-8859-1).

If this variable is null, the encoding currently set for the FTP session is used. If encoding was never set for this FTP session, the default JVM encoding is used.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 57

Page 58: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

largefilethreshold String Optional. Defines the size (in bytes) of a “large” file; see “Usage Notes”.

If you... Then...

Set to 0 All files will be considered large files. This means:

The output parameter islargefile will always be true.

The file content will be returned in the output parameter contentstream (as a java.io.InputStream object).

The output parameter content will be null.

Set to any value greater than 0

Any file larger than the value you specify will be considered large. This means:

The output parameter islargefile will be true.

The file content will be returned in the output parameter contentstream (as a java.io.InputStream object).

The output parameter content will be null.

Leave blank No file is considered large. This means:

The output parameter islargefile will always be false.

The file content will be returned in the output parameter content ().

The output parameter contentstream will be null.

cleanlinefeeds String Optional. Indicates whether the service should retain or remove carriage return characters at the end of each line of text.

Set to... To...

true String Default. Remove carriage returns.

false String Retain carriage returns.

content byte[ ] Data retrieved from the remote file.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

islargefile String Indicates whether the file is considered to be large (as specified by the input parameter largefilethreshold).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 58

Page 59: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

The largefilethreshold parameter improves the ability of pub.client.ftp:get to retrieve larger files. If a retrieved file is larger than the size specified in the largefilethreshold parameter, and the localfile parameter is empty (which means the retrieved file is retrieved to memory, not to a file on disk), the Integration Server streams the large file to a temporary file. While this will improve the scalability of pub.client.ftp:get, it will also reduce the throughput of the operation because the retrieved file will be written to a temporary file.

Tip! Due to the impact to the throughput of pub.client.ftp:get when streaming is enabled, you should set the value for largefilethreshold to a sufficiently large value so that it causes only minimal degradation to throughput and yet allows the service to retrieve large files without encountering an OutOfMemory exception.

See Also

pub.io:close

pub.cl ient . f tp: loginWmPublic. Connects to a remote FTP server and logs in with a specified user name and password.

You must use this service to initiate an FTP session before using most other services in pub.client.ftp.

Input Parameters

A value of... Indicates that...

true The file is larger than the value of largethreshold.

false The file is not larger than the value of largethreshold (or largethreshold is blank).

contentstream Object An java.io.InputStream object.

serverhost String Name or IP address of the FTP server (for example, ftp.netscape.com).

serverport String Port number on which the FTP server listens for requests (for example, 4566).

The default is 21.

dataport String Optional. Listener port number of the data transfer channel (for example, 3345).

If you do not specify dataport, the Integration Server will choose the listener port number. This value is used only when the transfertype value is active.

username String Valid FTP user on the remote FTP server (for example, anonymous).

password String Valid password for the FTP user specified in username (for example, someone@somewhere).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 59

Page 60: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

account String Optional. The user name for an account on the FTP server. Specify account if your FTP host requires account information. The account is defined in the FTP protocol to further identify the user that is identified by the username and password input variables.

transfertype String Type of the FTP data transfer mode (passive or active). The default is active.

encoding String Optional. Default character set for encoding data transferred during this session. Specify an IANA-registered character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

If you do not set encoding, the default JVM encoding is used.

timeout String Optional. Time (measured in seconds) to wait for a response from the FTP server before timing out and terminating the request. The default is to wait forever.

secure Document Indicates whether the FTP session is with a secure FTP server.

Variables in secure Description

auth String The kind of authentication mechanism to use: None, SSL, TLS, or TLS-P.

None specifies that the FTP session is with a non-secure FTP server. This is the default. If the value of auth is None, the securedata variable is ignored.

TLS-P is a shortcut that is equivalent to the sequence AUTH TLS, PBSZ 0, and PROT P. If the value of auth is TLS-P, the securedata variable is ignored.

securedata String Use the value false for a client sending PROT C (Data Channel Protection Level Clear). Use the value true for a client sending PROT P (Data Channel Protection Level Private).

Note: If you do not set a value, the default is false.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. This session key must be provided to execute most other services in pub.client.ftp.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 60

Page 61: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

If you set the auth variable in the secure parameter to SSL, TLS, or TLS-P, pub.client.ftp:login automatically sends the following sequence of FTP commands prior to sending the USER command:AUTH <SSL | TLS | TLS-P>PBSZ 0PROT <P | C>

The client FTP services will not negotiate for less security than you have specified with the auth parameter. However, if you set the auth variable to None, the client FTP services can operate (in a non-secure mode) with any FTP server.

The FTP services will always connect to a secure FTP server using a non-secure (SSL) socket. After getting a valid reply from the AUTH command, the FTP services will convert the connected socket to an SSL socket and initiate SSL handshaking.

pub.cl ient . f tp: logoutWmPublic. Logs off of the FTP server and ends the current FTP session.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp: lsWmPublic. Retrieves the file list during an FTP session. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command ls namepattern.)

Input Parameters

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

filenamepattern String Optional. Pattern that specifies the names of the files to include in the list (for example, *.txt).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 61

Page 62: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Note

During an FTP session, this service uses the character set specified in the encoding parameter of the pub.client.ftp:login service. If the file list this service retrieves includes characters from other languages, set the encoding parameter appropriately. For example, set encoding to SJIS for file names containing Japanese characters. If you do not set encoding in pub.client.ftp:login, the default JVM encoding is used.

pub.cl ient . f tp:mdeleteWmPublic. Deletes multiple files in the current working directory on an FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command mdelete pattern.)

Input Parameters

orderby String Optional. The order of the returned file list.

Value of orderby Description

none Default. Sends an NLST command to the remote FTP server.

timestamp Returns the list in order of the timestamp. Sends an NLST -t command to the remote FTP server.

Note: The -t command is not part of the RFC959 standard. Some FTP servers may not support this command. Servers that support this command may return the results in either ascending or descending order of creation time.

dirlist String List List of file names matching filenamepattern.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

filenamepattern String Pattern that specifies the names of the files to be deleted from the current working directory (for example, *.txt).

Important! If you do not specify a value for filenamepattern, all files in the working directory are deleted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 62

Page 63: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:mgetWmPublic. Transfers multiple files from the remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command mget.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

transfermode String FTP file transfer mode (ascii or binary). The default is ascii.

localdir String Directory in the local file system where the retrieved files are to be saved (for example, c:\temp\ftpfiles).

filenamepattern String Pattern that specifies the names of the files to be retrieved (for example, *.txt).

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the files are encoded. This variable is required to convert the files to bytes correctly. Specify an IANA-registered character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

If you do not specify encoding, the encoding assigned to the FTP session is used. If the encoding was not set for the FTP session, the default JVM encoding is used.

filenames String List List of files retrieved from the remote FTP server.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 63

Page 64: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . f tp:mputWmPublic. Transfers multiple files to a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command input.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Note

Some FTP servers, such as the Integration Server FTP Listener, do not support “putting” a unique file. When using the pub.client.ftp:put or pub.client.ftp:mput service to put a unique file to an FTP server that does not support putting a unique file, you will encounter an error like this one:com.wm.app.b2b.server.ServiceException: 500 'STOU': command not understood.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

transfermode String FTP file transfer mode (ascii or binary). The default is ascii.

localdir String Local directory containing the files you want to transfer to the remote FTP server (for example, c:\temp\ftpfiles).

filenamepattern String Pattern that specifies the names of the files to be transferred (for example, *.txt).

putunique String Optional. Indicates whether to send a STOR or a STOU (Store as Unique File) command to the remote FTP server.

Set to... To...

true String Send a STOU (Store as Unique File) command.

false String Default. Send a STOR command.

filenames String List List of files transferred to the remote FTP server.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 64

Page 65: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . f tp:putWmPublic. Transfers a file to a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command put.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Some FTP servers, such as the Integration Server FTP Listener, do not support “putting” a unique file. When using the pub.client.ftp:put or pub.client.ftp:mput service to put a unique file to an FTP server that does not support putting a unique file, you will encounter an error like this one:com.wm.app.b2b.server.ServiceException: 500 'STOU': command not understood.

When a client invokes this service to transport a file, the FTP listener determines the content handler to use based on the file’s extension. The content handler converts the file content to the input values for the service to invoke. The Integration Server_directory\lib\mime.types file contains the mappings of file extension to content type.

By default, if this service encounters a file that has no file extension, the default content handler is used. To override this, you can configure any content handler to handle files that have no file

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

transfermode String FTP file transfer mode (ascii or binary). The default is ascii.

content java.io.InputStream, byte[ ], or String Data to be transferred to the remote file.

localfile String Optional. Name of the local file to be appended to the remote file. Used only if content is not specified.

remotefile String The name of the remote file.

secure Document Indicates whether the FTP session is with a secure FTP server.

putunique String Optional. Indicates whether to send a STOR or a STOU (Store as Unique File) command to the remote FTP server.

Set to... To...

true String Send a STOU (Store as Unique File) command.

false String Default. Send a STOR command.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 65

Page 66: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

extension. To do this, add a line in the Integration Server_directory\lib\mime.types file that specifies the content type of the files with no extension, and the ftp_no_extension key. For example, to allow a content handler to accept text/xml files that have no extension, add this line to your mime.types file:text/xml ftp_no_extension

pub.cl ient . f tp:putCompletedNot i f icat ionWmPublic. A document type published to the webMethods Broker to notify parties that an FTP put command has completed.

When a user completes an FTP put command in his or her own user directory (that is, when the STOR command is completed on the server side but the server has not yet acknowledged the client with return code 226), an event is fired to notify interested parties by publishing a document to the webMethods Broker. EDI packages that subscribe to this document will retrieve the file from the server.

Input Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:quoteWmPublic. Executes a given FTP command.

You can use this service to execute non-standard FTP commands.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

username String The login user name through the FTP Listener.

filename String The absolute path name of the document.

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

string String The command to be executed on the FTP server. This service submits the command exactly as it is specified in string.

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 66

Page 67: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . f tp:renameWmPublic. Renames a file on a remote FTP server. (This service corresponds to the standard FTP command rename.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.cl ient . f tp:sessioninfoWmPublic. Returns session information for all of the FTP servers that users are currently logged into.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

sessionkey String Unique key for the current FTP session. The sessionkey is returned by the pub.client.ftp:login service.

oldname String Fully qualified name of the file you want to rename (for example, temp/oldname.txt).

newname String New fully qualified name for the file (for example, temp/newname.txt).

returncode String Standard FTP protocol return code.

returnmsg String Standard FTP protocol return message.

logmsg String FTP log messages for the entire user session.

name Not used. Reserved for future use.

sessioninfo Document List Information about the current FTP sessions. Each document in sessioninfo represents a single session and contains the following information:

Key Description

serverhost String Name or IP address of the FTP server.

serverport String Port number on which the FTP server listens for requests.

dataport String Listener port of the data transfer channel used by this session.

username String User logged on to FTP server.

password String Password for the FTP user specified in username.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 67

Page 68: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

When you start an FTP session with pub.client.ftp:login, you can set the optional dataport parameter to specify the port number for data transfers. During the FTP session, pub.client.ftp:sessionInfo returns the dataport parameter with the port number used for data transfers.

If you do not set the dataport parameter in pub.client.ftp:login, the server uses a random port number. During the FTP session, pub.client.ftp:sessionInfo will return a 0 for the dataport parameter to indicate that the port number used for data transfers is random.

pub.cl ient:ht tpWmPublic. Issues an HTTP request that you specify and returns the HTTP response.

Input Parameters

account String Conditional. The user name for an account on the FTP server. The account is defined in the FTP protocol to further identify the user that is identified by the username and password input variables.

transfertype String Data transfer mode (passive or active) used by this session.

encoding String Conditional. IANA character set used by this session. If encoding is not returned, the encoding was not explicitly set and the default JVM encoding is in effect.

url String URL of the resource that you want to access. For example: http://www.rubicon.com/orders/orders.html

Important! This string must begin with http: or https:.

method String Specifies the HTTP method you want to use. Valid values are:deleteget headoptionspostputtrace

loadAs String Optional. Form in which you want the http service to store the returned document.

Set to... To...

bytes Default. Return the body of the response as a byte[ ]. Use this option if the body will be used as input to a service that operates on whole HTML or XML documents (for example, pub.xml:queryXMLNode).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 68

Page 69: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

stream Return the body of the response as a java.io.InputStream. Use this option if the document will be used as input to a service that can process documents incrementally (for example, Usage Notes).

data Document Data that you want the http service to submit with the HTTP request. Specify data using one or more of the following keys.

Important! When you use more than one key, args is appended first, table is appended second, and string is appended last.

Key Description

args Document Optional. Name=value pairs that you want this service to submit to the resource in url. You can use args to submit data via the POST, GET, or HEAD method.

To specify data using args, create one String element for each name=value pair that you want to submit, where the element’s name represents the name portion of the pair and the element’s value represents the value portion of the pair.

When you use args, the http service will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in args.

Insert the “&” character between pairs, so you do not need to include it in args.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in args via a GET or HEAD. You do not need to include this character in args.

When you submit data using args, the webMethods Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded.

If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type value, you must submit the value using the string or bytes variable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 69

Page 70: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

table String Table Optional. Data that the http service will use to construct a query string to submit to the resource specified in url.

table is similar to args, but it allows you to submit unnamed values in a query string, not just name=value pairs.

To specify data using table, create one row for each value that you want to submit, where the contents of column 0 of the String Table represents the name portion of the pair (leave this column null to submit an unnamed value) and the contents of column 1 represents the value portion of the pair.

When you use table, the http service will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in table.

Insert the “&” character between the pairs (or unnamed values) that it constructs, so you do not need to include it in table.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in table via the GET method. You do not need to include this character in table.

When you submit data using table, the webMethods Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded. If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type, you must submit your data using the string or bytes variable.

string String Optional. Text that you want the http service to submit to the resource in url. You can use string to submit data via the POST, GET, or HEAD method.

If you use string to submit data, make sure that you specify the string exactly as you want it presented in the HTTP request. (If you are using the GET or HEAD method, make sure you URL-encode the contents of string.)

Note: When you use string, the http service will automatically prefix the entire query string with “?” if it submits the data in string via a GET or HEAD. You do not need to include this character in string.

When performing a POST, string will be submitted to the resource defined by url as the body of the request message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 70

Page 71: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

bytes byte[ ] Optional. Data that you want this service to submit to the resource in url. You can use bytes to submit data via the POST method only.

Important! When you use bytes and another element (args, table, or string) to specify data, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the bytes element in the body of the post. If the stream variable is not null, bytes is ignored.

mimeStream java.io.InputStream Optional. MIME or SMIME message that you want this service to submit to the resource in url. A mimeStream is created by the pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream, pub.smime:createEncryptedData, or pub.smime:createSignedData services. It contains both headers and content. The headers in the mimeStream are appended to the http headers.

You can use mimeStream to submit data via the POST method only.

stream java.io.InputStream Optional. Data that you want the http service to submit to the resource in url. You can use stream to submit data via the POST method only.

Important! When you use stream and another element (args, table, string or bytes) to specify data, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the stream element in the body of the post. If the stream input is not null, the bytes input is ignored.

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the URL data parameters are encoded (args or table and/or string). Encoding is required to correctly convert the String object to bytes when generating the URL for a post. Specify an IANA-registered character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

If this variable is null, the default JVM encoding is used. Because string is used in the body of the post and not used for building the URL, you do not need to specify encoding for the data parameter string.

auth Document Optional. Authorization information that the http service will submit if the resource specified in url is protected.

Key Description

type String Type of authentication that you want this service to use when it submits this request. Leave this field blank, as the only option currently available is basic HTTP authentication.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 71

Page 72: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If url begins with https:, you can use pub.security:setKeyAndChain to specify the certificate chain. If you do not specify a certificate chain, pub.client:http uses the default outbound SSL certificate settings to authenticate the resources.

If pub.client:http does not receive a response within the timeout period specified in the server’s watt.net.timeout parameter, it will throw an exception. For information about the watt.net.timeout parameter, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

user String User name that this service will submit when requesting a protected resource.

pass String Password associated with user.

headers Document Optional. Fields that you want to explicitly override in the HTTP request header issued by the http service.

Specify a key in headers for each header field that you want to set, where the key’s name represents the name of the header field and the key’s value represents the value of that header field.

If you do not set headers, the http service uses its default header values.

encodedURL String The URL that was submitted by pub.client:http. This will contain any argument set in args, table, or string.

header Document Conditional. HTTP response headers.

Key Description

lines Document Fields in the response header, where key names represent field names and values represent field values.

status String HTTP status code of the response.

statusMessage String HTTP status message of the response.

body Document Body of the HTTP response.

Key Description

bytes byte[ ] Conditional. Body of the HTTP response represented as a byte[ ]. bytes is returned only when the loadAs input parameter is set to bytes.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. The body of the HTTP response represented as an InputStream. stream is returned only when the loadAs input parameter is set to stream.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 72

Page 73: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:addWmPublic. Inserts a new entry into the directory.

Input Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the directory server to connect to. For example ldap://servername:389.

principal String Optional. The principal for the directory server.

credentials String Optional. Credentials for the directory server.

timeout String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

ldapEnv Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the new entry to add to the directory.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 73

Page 74: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Specify only one of attrs or attrsData. If you specify both, the service uses attrs and ignores attrsData.

attrs Document List Optional. LDAP attributes and their corresponding values. If an attribute is specified more than once, it will be assigned multiple values. The following example shows how to specify a user name of John Smith and one nickname.

attrsData Document Optional. LDAP attributes and their corresponding values. If an attribute is specified more than once, it will be assigned multiple values. The following example shows how to assign a user name of John Smith with two nicknames.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 74

Page 75: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:bindWmPublic. Performs an LDAP bind operation that associates the connection with the specified principal.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 75

Page 76: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:cancelNot i f icat ionWmPublic. Cancels a previously created notification request.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the entry.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

scope String The scope of the search. Must be “object” (only search the specified directory entry), “onelevel” (only search the immediate children of the specified directory entry), or “subtree” (search the directory, its children, and all of their children).

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 76

Page 77: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:compareWmPublic. Compares the value of an attribute in the LDAP directory with a value specified by the service.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the entry whose attribute value you want to compare to attrValue.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

attrName String Name of the attribute whose value you want to compare to attrValue.

attrValue String The string to compare against the value of the attribute identified by attrName.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

result String The result of the compare operation. Can be “true” or “false”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 77

Page 78: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:deleteWmPublic. Removes an entry from the directory.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service does not flag an error if the entry is not deleted. One way to check is to use pub.client.ldap:search to search for the entry. If the entry is not found, you know it has been deleted.

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the entry to delete.

Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

connectionHandle

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 78

Page 79: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:modifyWmPublic. Performs an LDAP modify operation that allows you to specify a list of attributes with corresponding lists of values to add to, replace, or remove from the directory entry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the entry to modify.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

attrs Document List Optional. For each LDAP attribute to change, specifies the attribute name, the values affected, and the action to perform on those values. The following example shows how to specify the removal of John Smith’s nickname Johnny.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 79

Page 80: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:registerNot i f icat ionWmPublic. Creates a notification (or “persistent search”) that causes Integration Server to listen for LDAP events. When the notification gets an event, the specified service is called.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name of the entry to be monitored.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

scope String The scope of the search. Must be “object” (only search the specified directory entry, “onelevel” (only search the immediate children of the specified directory entry), or “subtree” (search the directory entry, its children, and all of their children).

service String The target service to be invoked when the LDAP event is retrieved.

user String Optional. Integration Server user to run service (the target service to be invoked when the LDAP event is retrieved). If you do not specify a user, the service runs as the Default user. Make sure user has the permissions necessary to run the service. Be careful when assigning the user because no password is required when invoking a service in this manner. It is recommended that you create a special account just for invoking the target service.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 80

Page 81: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

When the pub.client.ldap:registerNotification service creates a notification, Integration Server listens for four different types of events: objectAdded, objectRemoved, objectRenamed, and objectChanged. If any one of these events is triggered, pub.client.ldap: registerNotification calls the specified target service and passes these inputs to it:

.

If an error occurs, pub.client.ldap:registerNotification places an input called “exception” in the pipeline. This input includes details on the exception that occurred.

Some LDAP servers do not support persistent searches and therefore do not support notifications.

Pipeline Input Description

type One of the following depending on which event was triggered - “objectAdded”, “objectRemoved”, “objectRenamed”, “objectChanged”.

dn Distinguished name of the entry that triggered the event.

attributes Any additional LDAP attributes from the event.

oldDn Applicable only for objectRenamed event. Distinguished name of the entry before it was renamed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 81

Page 82: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:renameWmPublic. Performs an LDAP rename (move) operation allowing you to rename an entry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

url String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI.

principal

credentials

timeout

ldapEnv

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

newDn String The new name for the entry.

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 82

Page 83: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient . ldap:searchWmPublic. Performs an LDAP search operation with the specified parameters and returns the results of the search.

Input Parametersurl String Optional. URL of the LDAP server to connect to.

principal String Optional. The principal for the LDAP server.

credentials String Optional. Credentials for the LDAP server.

timeout String Optional. Connection timeout in milliseconds.

ldapEnv Record Optional. Key/value parameters to be passed to JNDI to further define the connection environment. See your JNDI documentation or http://java.sun.com/products/jndi/docs.html for more information about parameters you can pass to JNDI

close String Flag that specifies whether to close the connection after the service finishes.

Set to... To...

yes Close the connection. This is the default.

no Leave the connection open and available.

dn String The distinguished name indicating the root from to begin the search.

connectionHandle Object Optional. Connection object returned by a previously invoked LDAP service.

scope String The scope of the search. Must be “object” (only search the specified directory entry), “onelevel” (only search the immediate children of the specified directory entry), or “subtree” (search the directory entry, its children, and all their children).

filter String The filter string conforming to RFC 2254. For more information about RFC 2254, consult http://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc2254.txt.

countLimit String Optional. The maximum number of results to return (0, the default, indicates no limit).

timeLimit String Optional. The number of milliseconds to wait for the search to complete (0, the default, indicates to wait forever).

returnAttributes Record Optional. A list of attribute names to return (an empty array indicates that no results should be returned. A null array, the default, indicates that all attributes should be returned).

returnObjects String Optional. Specifies whether or not objects associated with the results should be returned. Can be “yes” or “no”. The default is “no”.

dereferenceLinks String Optional. Whether to return the symbolic link to the entry or the entry itself. Can be “yes”/“no”.- The default is “yes”, which returns the entry to which the link points.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 83

Page 84: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

To see if no match was found, check for an empty results parameter.

pub.cl ient:smtpWmPublic. Sends a MIME-type email message.

You may attach one or more content objects or files to the message.

Input Parameters

connectionHandle Object Optional. The returned connection object. Returned only if the close parameter is set to “no”.

results Record The returned results of the search.

to String Receiver’s email address. If you specify multiple addresses, separate them with commas.

cc String Optional. Additional receiver’s email addresses. If you specify multiple addresses, separate them with commas.

bcc String Optional. Additional receiver’s email addresses. If you specify multiple addresses, separate them with commas.

subject String Subject of the message.

subjectCharset String Optional. The character set used to encode the MIME message headers (including subject). If subjectCharset is not specified, then charset is used. If charset is not specified, the value in the server parameter watt.server.email.charset is used. If that parameter is not set, the utf-8 encoding is used.

charset String Optional. The character encoding of the body text. If charset is not specified, the value in the server parameter watt.server.email.charset is used. If that parameter is not set, the utf-8 encoding is used.

from String Sender’s email address.

mailhost String SMTP host name for outbound messages. For example: smtp.webMethods.com

mailhostPort String Optional. The number of the port on which the SMTP host listens. This parameter does not need to be set if the host listens on port 25 (the standard SMTP port).

auth Document Optional. Authorization information that the SMTP service will submit.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 84

Page 85: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If you are using filename to attach a file to the message and the file is not a plain text file, you must set the contenttype and encoding. For example, to attach webMethods6\IntegrationServer\mydir\myfile.doc to a pub.client:smtp service, you would invoke the service with the following values in attachments:

contenttype: application/msword

filename: mydir/myfile.doc

encoding: base64

Key Description

user String User name that this service will submit when requesting a protected resource.

pass String Password associated with user.

body String The content of the message.

mimeStream java.io.InputStream Optional. MIME or S/MIME message that you want to send in the email. A mimeStream is created by the pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream, pub.smime:createEncryptedData, or pub.smime:createSignedData services. It contains both headers and content. If the mimeStream already contains the from, to, and subject headers, you do not need to pass them as individual inputs to this service.

attachments Document List Optional. Attachments to the message. Each attachment defines one message part in a multi-part message.

Key Description

contenttype String MIME type of the message. For example:application/x-edi-message

content byte[ ], String, or java.io.InputStream Content of the message.

filename String Name of a local file to be attached to the message. Used only if content is not specified.

encoding String Optional. Encoding of the message. For example: base64 or 7bit. If encoding is not specified, 7bit is used.

charset String Optional. Character set encoding of the attachment. This value is added to the Content-Type header for the attachment. If charset is not specified, the value in the server parameter watt.server.email.charset is used. If that parameter is not set, the utf-8 encoding is used.

status String Final status of service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 85

Page 86: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

pub.cl ient:soapHTTPWmPublic. Submits a SOAP message to a server via HTTP or HTTPS.

Input Parameters

soapRequestData Object SOAP message that is to be sent. This object must be produced with the services in the soap folder. See “Usage Notes” below.

address String URL to which you want the SOAP message sent. For example: https://servername:5555/soap/default

auth Document Optional. Parameters specifying the credentials that are to be submitted to the server specified in address. Each element is defined as follows:

Key Description

type String Type of authentication that the service will perform. Leave this field blank, as the only option currently available is basic HTTP authentication.

user String User name that this service will use if one is requested.

pass String Password that this service will submit if one is requested.

validateSOAP String Optional. Indicates whether or not the response message is to be validated against the SOAP schema.

Set to... To...

true Validate the response message and throw an exception if the response does not conform to the SOAP schema.

false Default. Bypass the validation process.

SOAPAction String Optional. Value to which you want to set the SOAPAction HTTP header.

Note: The SOAPAction header was required by the initial SOAP specification but has since been deprecated. The Integration Server does not use the SOAPAction header and accepts SOAP messages that omit it. If you are designing a completely new solution, we recommend that you avoid using the SOAPAction header. However, if you exchange SOAP messages with systems that require a SOAPAction header, this parameter allows you to set it.

contentType String Optional. Specifies the value of Content-Type in the HTTP header.

Set to... To...

text/xml; charset=”utf-8”

Default. Specify the content type as XML and the character encoding of the message text as UTF-8.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 86

Page 87: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

text/xml Specify the content type as XML. Since the charset parameter is not specified, the character encoding of the message text defaults to US-ASCII.

encoding String Optional. Specifies the encoding method. Default value is UTF-8.

Note: To change the encoding specified by the Web service connector, you must set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline. For a Web service connector that uses the SOAP message protocol, set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline for the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData Invoke step. The subsequent pub.client.soapHTTP Invoke step will honor the encoding specified when the SOAP message was created.

loadAs String Optional. Specifies the format of the soapResponseData. Default value is stream.

Set to... To...

stream Default. Return the body of the response as a java.io.InputStream. Use this option when you will invoke an HTTP Web service.

bytes Return the body of the response as a byte[ ]. Use this option if the body will be used as input to a service that operates on whole HTML or XML documents (for example, pub.xml:queryXMLNode).

byteArrayStream Have the response stream fully read and converted to java.io.ByteArrayStream. This prevents data loss or a truncated SOAP response if the connection closes prematurely. Use this option when you will invoke an HTTPS Web service.

soapResponseData Object The SOAP response message returned by the server specified in address.

header Document Conditional. Headers from the HTTP response. Will contain the following keys:

Key Description

lines Document Header fields from the HTTP response. Each key in lines represents a field (line) of the response header. Key names represent the names of header fields. The keys’ values are Strings containing the values of the fields.

status String Status code from the HTTP response.

statusMessage String Status message from the HTTP response.

soapStatus String Flag indicating whether the SOAP request message was processed successfully.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 87

Page 88: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

If address begins with https:, you can use pub.security:setKeyAndChain to specify the certificate chain. If you do not specify a certificate chain, pub.client:soapHTTP uses the default outbound SSL certificate settings to authenticate the resources.

To send a SOAP message with this service, you must first generate an empty SOAP object with the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData service and then populate it using services such as pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry and pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry. For information about creating and sending SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.client:soapRPC

Examples

sample.soap:buildMsg_sendHTTP

pub.cl ient:soapRPCWmPublic. Submits a SOAP remote procedure call via HTTP or HTTPS.

Input Parameters

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The remote server successfully processed the SOAP request and returned a SOAP response message.

1 The remote server returned a SOAP fault, indicating that the SOAP request was received but was not processed successfully.

2 The server returned an error that was not a SOAP fault. This indicates that some type of HTTP error occurred (often, an HTTP 404). You can check the status element in header to determine the type of HTTP error that occurred.

address String String specifying the numeric address or name of the server on which the remote procedure resides. If you are submitting the request to a webMethods Integration Server, remember to direct it to the RPC processor as shown in the following example:

http://rubicon:5555/soap/rpc

reqParms Document The input parameters that are to be passed to the remote procedure. For example, if you wanted to pass three String parameters, acct, amt, and org, containing the values Cash, 150.00, and Sales, reqParms would contain the following:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 88

Page 89: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Key Value

acct Cash

amt 150.00

org Sales

method Document The QName of the requested procedure where:

Key Value

namespaceName String Namespace portion of the procedure’s QName.

localName String Local portion of the procedure’s QName.

auth Document Optional. User name and password that are to be submitted to the server specified in address.

Key Value

type String Type of authentication that the service will perform. Leave this field blank, as the only option currently available is basic HTTP authentication.

user String User name that this service will use if one is requested.

pass String Password that this service will submit if one is requested.

targetInputSignature String Optional. Fully qualified name of the IS document type to use to validate and encode the contents of reqParms.

targetOutputSignature String Optional. Fully qualified name of the IS document type to use to validate and decode the output value returned by the remote procedure.

SOAPAction String Optional. Value to which you want to set the SOAPAction HTTP header.

Note: The SOAPAction header was required by the initial SOAP specification but has since been deprecated. The Integration Server does not use the SOAPAction header and accepts SOAP messages that omit it. If you are designing a completely new solution, we recommend that you avoid using the SOAPAction header. However, if you exchange SOAP messages with systems that require a SOAPAction header, this parameter allows you to set it.

contentType String Optional. Specifies the value of Content-Type in the HTTP header.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 89

Page 90: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Output Parameters

Set to... To...

text/xml; charset=”utf-8”

Default. Specify the content type as XML and the character encoding of the text as UTF-8.

text/xml Specify the content type as XML. Since the charset parameter is not specified, the character encoding of the text defaults to US-ASCII.

encoding String Optional. Specifies the encoding method. Default value is UTF-8.

Note: To change the encoding specified by the Web service connector, you must set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline. For a Web service connector that uses the SOAP message protocol, set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline for the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData Invoke step. The subsequent pub.client.soapHTTP Invoke step will honor the encoding specified when the SOAP message was created.

loadAs String Optional. Specifies the format of the soapResponseData. Default value is stream.

Set to... To...

stream Default. Return the body of the response as a java.io.InputStream. Use this option when you will invoke an HTTP Web service.

byteArrayStream Have the response stream fully read and converted to java.io.ByteArrayStream. This prevents data loss or a truncated SOAP response if the connection closes prematurely. Use this option when you will invoke an HTTPS Web service

soapResponseData Object A SOAP object containing the SOAP response message returned by the server specified in address.

respParms Document Output parameters returned by the remote procedure. For example, if the remote procedure returned two String parameters, status and balance, containing the values closed and –4.95, respParms would contain the following:

Key Value

status closed

balance -4.95

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 90

Page 91: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

Usage Notes

If address begins with https:, you can use pub.security:setKeyAndChain to specify the certificate chain. If you do not specify a certificate chain, pub.client:soapRPC uses the default outbound SSL certificate settings to authenticate the resources.

See Also

pub.client:soapHTTP

Examples

sample.soap:buildRPC_SendHTTPSimple

header Document Conditional. Headers from the HTTP response. Will contain the following keys:

Key Value

lines Document Header fields from the HTTP response. Each key in lines represents a field (line) of the response header. Key names represent the names of header fields. The keys’ values are Strings containing the values of the fields.

status String Status code from the HTTP response.

statusMessage String Status message from the HTTP response.

soapStatus String Flag indicating whether the SOAP request message was processed successfully.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The remote server successfully processed the SOAP request and returned a SOAP response message.

1 The remote server returned a SOAP fault, indicating that the SOAP request was received but was not processed successfully.

2 The server returned an error that was not a SOAP fault. This indicates that some type of HTTP error occurred (often, an HTTP 404). You can check the status field in header to determine the type of HTTP error that occurred.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 91

Page 92: Integration Server Bis Reference

2. Client Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 92

Page 93: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 3. Cluster Folder

You use the elements in the cluster folder to enable and/or disable load balancing for specific services and sessions in a cluster.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 93

Page 94: Integration Server Bis Reference

3. Cluster Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.cluster:disableServiceRedirWmPublic. Enables or disables load balancing for a service.

Disabling load balancing for a service guarantees that an invocation of that service will not be redirected to another server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Element Package and Description

pub.cluster:disableServiceRedir WmPublic. Enables or disables load balancing for a service.

pub.cluster:disableSessionRedir WmPublic. Enables or disables load balancing for the current session.

pub.cluster:getClusterHosts WmPublic. Returns a list of servers in the cluster.

redir String Optional. Enables or disables load balancing for the service.

Set to... To...

true Enable load balancing for a service.

false Default. Disable load balancing for a service.

service String The fully qualified name of the service for which load balancing is to be enabled or disabled.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 94

Page 95: Integration Server Bis Reference

3. Cluster Folder

pub.cluster:disableSessionRedirWmPublic. Enables or disables load balancing for the current session.

Disabling load balancing for a session guarantees that invocations of services within that session will not be redirected to another server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.cluster:getClusterHostsWmPublic. Returns a list of servers in the cluster.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The hostExternal address may or may not be the same as hostAddress. The hostAddress is used to refer to the server from inside the firewall, while the hostExternal address is used to refer to the server from outside of the firewall (such as when network address translation is done at the firewall).

redir String Optional. Enables or disables load balancing for the session.

Set to... To...

true Enable load balancing for the current session.

false Default. Disable load balancing for the current session.

hosts Document List Conditional. Servers in the cluster.

Key Description

hostExternal String Address of the server as known outside of the firewall.

hostAddress String Configured IP address for the server.

port String Primary HTTP port.

sport String Primary HTTPS port.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 95

Page 96: Integration Server Bis Reference

3. Cluster Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 96

Page 97: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 4. Date Folder

You use the elements in the date folder to generate and format date values.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 97

Page 98: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

Summary of Elements in this FolderThe following elements are available in this folder:

Pattern String Symbols

Many of the date services require you to specify pattern strings describing the data’s current format and/or the format to which you want it converted. For services that require a pattern string, use the symbols in the following table to describe the format of your data. For example, to describe a date in the January 15, 1999 format, you would use the pattern string MMMMM dd, yyyy. To describe the format 01/15/99, you would use the pattern string MM/dd/yy. For more information about these pattern string symbols, see the Sun Java API documentation for the SimpleDateFormat class.

Element Package and Description

pub.date:currentDate WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.date:getCurrentDate or pub.date:getCurrentDateString. Returns the current date as a String in a specified format.

pub.date:dateBuild WmPublic. Builds a date/time String using the specified pattern and the specified date elements.

pub.date:dateTimeBuild WmPublic. Builds a date/time string using the specified pattern and the specified date elements.

pub.date:dateTimeFormat WmPublic. Converts date/time (represented as a String) string from one format to another.

pub.date:formatDate WmPublic. Formats a Date object as a string.

pub.date:getCurrentDate WmPublic. Returns the current date as a Date object.

pub.date:getCurrentDateString WmPublic. Returns the current date as a String in a specified format.

Symbol Meaning Presentation Example

G era designator Text AD

y year Number 1996 or 96

M month in year Text or Number July or Jul or 07

d day in month Number 10

h hour in am/pm (1–12) Number 12

H hour in day (0–23) Number 0

m minute in hour Number 30

s second in minute Number 55

S millisecond Number 978

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 98

Page 99: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

Time Zones

When working with date services, you can specify time zones. The Earth is divided into 24 standard time zones, one for every 15 degrees of longitude. Using the time zone including Greenwich, England (known as Greenwich Mean Time, or GMT) as the starting point, the time is increased by an hour for each time zone east of Greenwich and decreases by an hour for each time zone west of Greenwich. The time difference between a time zone and the time zone including Greenwich, England (GMT) is referred to as the raw offset.

The following table identifies the different time zones for the Earth and the raw offset for each zone from Greenwich, England. The effects of daylight savings time are ignored in this table.

Note: Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) is also known as Universal Time (UT).

E day in week Text Tuesday or Tue

D day in year Number 189

F day of week in month Number 2 (2nd Wed in July)

w week in year Number 27

W week in month Number 2

a am/pm marker Text PM

k hour in day (1–24) Number 24

K hour in am/pm (0–11) Number 0

z time zone Text Pacific Standard Time or PST or GMT-08:00

Z RFC 822 time zone (JVM 1.4 or later)

Number -0800 (offset from GMT/UT)

' escape for text Delimiter

' ' single quote Literal '

ID Raw Offset Name

MIT -11 Midway Islands Time

HST -10 Hawaii Standard Time

AST -9 Alaska Standard Time

PST -8 Pacific Standard Time

PNT -7 Phoenix Standard Time

Symbol Meaning Presentation Example

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 99

Page 100: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

Examples

You can specify timezone input parameters in the following formats:

As a full name. For example:

MST -7 Mountain Standard Time

CST -6 Central Standard Time

EST -5 Eastern Standard Time

IET -5 Indiana Eastern Standard Time

PRT -4 Puerto Rico and U.S. Virgin Islands Time

CNT -3.5 Canada Newfoundland Time

AGT -3 Argentina Standard Time

BET -3 Brazil Eastern Time

GMT 0 Greenwich Mean Time

ECT +1 European Central Time

CAT +2 Central Africa Time

EET +2 Eastern European Time

ART +2 (Arabic) Egypt Standard Time

EAT +3 Eastern African Time

MET +3.5 Middle East Time

NET +4 Near East Time

PLT +5 Pakistan Lahore Time

IST +5.5 India Standard Time

BST +6 Bangladesh Standard Time

VST +7 Vietnam Standard Time

CTT +8 China Taiwan Time

JST +9 Japan Standard Time

ACT +9.5 Australian Central Time

AET +10 Australian Eastern Time

SST +11 Solomon Standard Time

NST +12 New Zealand Standard Time

ID Raw Offset Name

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 100

Page 101: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

You can use the java.util.TimeZone.getAvailableIDs() method to obtain a list of the valid full name time zone IDs that your JVM version supports.

As a custom time zone ID, in the format GMT[+ | -]hh[ [:]mm]. For example:

As a three-letter abbreviation from the table above. For example:

Note: Because some three-letter abbreviations can represent multiple time zones (for example, “CST” could represent both U.S. “Central Standard Time” and “China Standard Time”), all abbreviations are deprecated. Use the full name or custom time zone ID formats instead.

Notes on Invalid Dates

If you use an invalid date with a date service, the date service automatically translates the date to a legal date. For example, if you specify “1999/02/30” as input, the date service interprets the date as “1999/03/02” (two days after 2/28/1999).

If you use “00” for the month or day, the date service interprets “00” as the last month or day in the Gregorian calendar. For example, if you specify “00” for the month, the date service interprets it as 12.

If the pattern yy is used for the year, the date service uses a 50-year moving window to interpret the value of yy. The date service establishes the window by subtracting 49 years from the current year and adding 50 years to the current year. For example, if you are running the webMethods Integration Server in the year 2000, the moving window would be from 1951 to 2050. The date service interprets 2-digit years as falling into this window (for example, 12 would be 2012, 95 would be 1995).

Asia/Tokyo America/Los_Angeles

GMT+2:00 All time zones 2 hours east of Greenwich (that is, Central Africa Time, Eastern European Time, and Egypt Standard Time)

GMT-3:00 All time zones 3 hours west of Greenwich (that is, Argentina Standard Time and Brazil Eastern Time)

GMT+9:30 All time zones 9.5 hours east of Greenwich (that is, Australian Central Time)

PST Pacific Standard Time

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 101

Page 102: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

pub.date:currentDateWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.date:getCurrentDate or pub.date:getCurrentDateString. Returns the current date as a String in a specified format.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.date:dateBui ldWmPublic. Builds a date/time String using the specified pattern and the specified date elements.

Input Parameters

pattern String Pattern representing the format in which you want the date returned. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98.

timezone String Optional. Time zone in which you want the output date and time expressed. Specify a time zone code as shown in “Time Zones” on page 99 (for example, EST for Eastern Standard Time).

If you do not specify timezone, the value of the server’s “user timezone” property is used. If this property has not been set, GMT is used.

value String Current date in the format of pattern.

pattern String Pattern representing the format in which you want the date returned. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98. If you do not specify pattern, dateBuild returns null. If pattern contains a time zone and timezone is not specified, the webMethods Integration Server’s default time zone is used.

year String Optional. The year expressed in yyyy or yy format (for example, 01 or 2001). If you do not specify year or you specify an invalid value, dateBuild uses the current year.

month String Optional. The month expressed as a number (for example, 1 for January, 2 for February). If you do not specify month or you specify an invalid value, dateBuild uses the current month.

dayofmonth String Optional. The day of the month expressed as a number (for example, 1 for the first day of the month, 2 for the second day of the month). If you do not specify dayofmonth or you specify an invalid value, dateBuild uses the current day.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 102

Page 103: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

Output Parameters

pub.date:dateTimeBui ldWmPublic. Builds a date/time string using the specified pattern and the specified date elements.

Input Parameters

timezone String Optional. Time zone in which you want the output date and time expressed. Specify a time zone code as shown in “Time Zones” on page 99 (for example, EST for Eastern Standard Time).

If you do not specify timezone, the value of the server’s “user timezone” property is used. If this property has not been set, GMT is used.

locale String Optional. Locale in which the date is to be expressed. For example, if locale is en (for English), the pattern EEE d MMM yyyy will produce Friday 23 August 2002, and the locale of fr (for French) will produce vendredi 23 août 2002.

value String The date specified by year, month, and dayofmonth, in the format of pattern.

pattern String Pattern representing the format in which you want the time returned. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98. If you do not specify pattern, dateTimeBuild returns null. If pattern contains a time zone and the timezone parameter is not set, the webMethods Integration Server’s time zone is used.

year String Optional. The year expressed in yyyy or yy format (for example, 01 or 2001). If you do not specify year or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses the current year.

month String Optional. The month expressed as a number (for example, 1 for January, 2 for February). If you do not specify month or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses the current month.

dayofmonth String Optional. The day of the month expressed as a number (for example, 1 for the first day of the month, 2 for the second day of the month). If you do not specify dayofmonth or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses the current day.

hour String Optional. The hour expressed as a number based on a 24-hour clock (for example, 0 for midnight, 2 for 2am, 14 for 2pm). If you do not specify hour or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses 0 as the hour value.

minute String Optional. Minutes expressed as a number. If you do not specify minute or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses 0 as the minute value.

second String Optional. Seconds expressed as a number. If you do not specify second or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses 0 as the second value.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 103

Page 104: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

Output Parameters

pub.date:dateTimeFormatWmPublic. Converts date/time (represented as a String) string from one format to another.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

As described in “Notes on Invalid Dates” on page 101, if the pattern yy is used for the year, dateTimeFormat uses a 50-year moving window to interpret the value of the year. If you need to change this behavior so that the year is interpreted as 80 years before or 20 years after the current date (as

millis String Optional. Milliseconds expressed as a number. If you do not specify millis or you specify an invalid value, dateTimeBuild uses 0 as the millis value.

timezone String Optional. Time zone in which you want the output date and time expressed. Specify a time zone code as shown in “Time Zones” on page 99 (for example, EST for Eastern Standard Time).

If you do not specify timezone, the value of the server’s “user timezone” property is used. If this property has not been set, GMT is used.

locale String Optional. Locale in which the date is to be expressed. For example, if locale is en (for English), the pattern EEE d MMM yyyy will produce Friday 23 August 2002, and the locale of fr (for French) will produce vendredi 23 août 2002.

value String Date and time in format of pattern.

inString String Date/time that you want to convert.

Important! If inString contains a character in the last position, that character is interpreted as 0. This can result in an inaccurate date. For information about invalid dates, see page 101.

currentPattern String Pattern string that describes the format of inString. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98.

newPattern String Pattern string that describes the format in which you want inString returned. For pattern-string syntax, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98.

locale String Optional. Locale in which the date is to be expressed. For example, if locale is en (for English), the pattern EEE d MMM yyyy will produce Friday 23 August 2002, and the locale of fr (for French) will produce vendredi 23 août 2002.

value String The date/time given by inString, in the format of newPattern.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 104

Page 105: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

described in the Java class java.text.SimpleDateFormat), set the server configuration parameter watt.server.pubDateTimeFormat.javaSlidingWindow to true. For information about setting configuration parameters, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

By default, the Integration Server throws an exception if no input is passed to the service. To suppress the error message and return a null value for the value parameter, set the server configuration parameter watt.server.date.suppressPatternError to true. For information about setting configuration parameters, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

If currentPattern does not contain a time zone, the value is assumed to be in the time zone of the webMethods Integration Server.

If newPattern contains a time zone, the time zone of the webMethods Integration Server is used.

pub.date: formatDateWmPublic. Formats a Date object as a string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

date java.util.Date Optional. Date/time that you want to convert.

pattern String Pattern string that describes the format in which you want the date returned. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98.

timezone String Optional. Time zone in which you want the output date and time expressed. Specify a time zone code as shown in “Time Zones” on page 99 (for example, EST for Eastern Standard Time).

If you do not specify timezone, the value of the server’s “user timezone” property is used. If this property has not been set, GMT is used.

locale String Optional. Locale in which the date is to be expressed. For example, if locale is en (for English), the pattern EEE d MMM yyyy will produce Friday 23 August 2002, and the locale of fr (for French) will produce vendredi 23 août 2002.

value String The date/time given by date in the format specified by pattern.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 105

Page 106: Integration Server Bis Reference

4. Date Folder

pub.date:getCurrentDate WmPublic. Returns the current date as a Date object.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.date:getCurrentDateStr ingWmPublic. Returns the current date as a String in a specified format.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

date java.util.Date Current date.

pattern String Pattern representing the format in which you want the date returned. For pattern-string notation, see “Pattern String Symbols” on page 98.

timezone String Optional. Time zone in which you want the output date and time expressed. Specify a time zone code as shown in “Time Zones” on page 99 (for example, EST for Eastern Standard Time).

If you do not specify timezone, the value of the server’s “user timezone” property is used. If this property has not been set, GMT is used.

locale String Optional. Locale in which the date is to be expressed. For example, if locale is en (for English), the pattern EEE d MMM yyyy will produce Friday 23 August 2002, and the locale of fr (for French) will produce vendredi 23 août 2002.

value String Current date in the format specified by pattern.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 106

Page 107: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 5. Db Folder

You use the elements in the db folder to access JDBC-enabled databases.

Note: The webMethods JDBC adapter also provides services that perform operations against JDBC-enabled databases. See the JDBC Adapter User’s Guide for information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 107

Page 108: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.db:call WmDB. Invokes a stored procedure on a target database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:clearTransaction WmDB. Clears the transactional state within a database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:close WmDB. Closes a specified database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:closeAll WmDB. Closes all database connections that the session has opened. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:commit WmDB. Commits changes to a database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:connect WmDB. Creates a connection to the database using the supplied JDBC URL, user name, and password. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:delete WmDB. Removes all rows in the specified table that meet the given criteria. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:execSQL WmDB. Executes the specified SQL statement. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:getProcInfo WmDB. Retrieves information about one or more stored procedures. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:getProcs WmDB. Retrieves the names of stored procedures for the specified database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:getTableInfo WmDB. Retrieves information about columns in the specified table. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:getTables WmDB. Retrieves the names of tables in the specified database and schema. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 108

Page 109: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

pub.db:cal lWmDB. Invokes a stored procedure on a target database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

pub.db:insert WmDB. Inserts one or more rows into the specified table. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:query WmDB. Retrieves all rows from the specified table that meet the given criteria. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:rollback WmDB. Discards changes to a database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:startTransaction WmDB. Begins a transaction on a database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

pub.db:update WmDB. Updates all rows in a table that meet the given criteria. Rows are updated with the supplied new data. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Element Package and Description

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Alias of the database on which you want to execute the stored procedure.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user specified in $dbUser.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 109

Page 110: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to invoke a stored procedure from a database other than the one to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the stored procedure’s location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the stored procedure belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value of HR% would represent any schema beginning with characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the stored procedure’s AuthID.

$dbProc String The name of the stored procedure you want to invoke.

$dbProcSig Document List Optional. Set of parameters containing information about the stored procedure you want to invoke.

Key Description

name String Parameter name defined in the stored procedure.

sqlType String Type of procedure parameter for name as defined in the database. Set to one of the following values: BIT TINYINTSMALLINT INTEGERBiGINT FLOATREAL DOUBLENUMBERIC DECIMALCHAR VARCHARLONGVARCHAR DATETIME TIMESTAMPBINARY VARBINARYLONGVARBINARY NULL

direction String Way in which the parameter is used by the stored procedure. Set to one of the following values: inoutinoutreturn value

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 110

Page 111: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The output will also contain output parameters and procedure return values (the return value is called RETURN_VALUE).

pub.db:clearTransact ionWmDB. Clears the transactional state within a database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$dbParamsByOrder String Optional. Indicates whether the contents of $data should be sent to the database in order.

Set to... To...

true Send the contents of $data to the database in the order they are listed in $data.

false Default. Send the contents of $data to the database in no particular order.

$data Document Optional. Parameter values for the stored procedure.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Alias of the database connection on which you want to clear the transactional state. The alias is passed automatically if the database is connected.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 111

Page 112: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

On some databases, exceptional conditions within transactions will automatically abort the entire transaction. When this happens, the standard commit/rollback operations are meaningless because there is no current transaction. If this occurs, use the clearTransaction service to clear the transactional state and prepare for a new transaction. You should only use this service if you have begun a transaction and cannot end it with a standard commit or rollback.

The clearTransaction service does not involve a database operation; it is entirely internal to the webMethods Integration Server.

pub.db:closeWmDB. Closes a specified database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbMessage String A message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 112

Page 113: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

pub.db:closeAl lWmDB. Closes all database connections that the session has opened. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.db:commitWmDB. Commits changes to a database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$closeDbConnection String Optional. Indicates whether to remove the database connection from the pool or return it to the pool for future use.

Set to... To...

true Close the connection and remove it from the pool.

false Default. Close the connection and return it to the pool for future use.

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Alias of the database on which you want to commit changes. The alias is passed automatically if the database is connected.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 113

Page 114: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service returns an exception if an error occurs when committing changes to the database. The most common reason for this error is that no transaction has been started (see pub.db:startTransaction).

pub.db:connectWmDB. Creates a connection to the database using the supplied JDBC URL, user name, and password. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

You can also specify a JDBC driver specific to the database.

Input Parameters

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbDriver, $dbProperties

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 114

Page 115: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Database connections opened by pub.db:connect are associated with the current session.

Multiple attempts to connect to the same database by the same client will result in the same connection being reused. This means that if client A and client B request connections to the same database, they each get their own new connection. If client A makes another call to pub.db:connect, the previous connection is reused. Associating the database connection with the client session prevents remote clients from having to reconnect repeatedly to a target database.

Connections are not pooled or shared across sessions. Unless explicitly closed (by calling pub.db:close or pub.db:closeAll), connections associated with a session are closed when the session is flushed from memory. This happens at a regular interval, which can be configured using the Integration Server Administrator. For more information about setting the session timeout limit, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

$dbProperties Document Optional. Set of connection parameters that are to be used to make the database connection. Within $dbProperties, key names represent the names of the connection parameters that are to be used to establish the connection, and the value of a key specifies the value of that particular parameter.

In most cases, you will include the keys user and password in $dbProperties to specify the user name and password parameters that are to be used to connect to the database. You may include additional parameters as needed.

The following example shows how $dbProperties would look if you wanted to set the weblogic.codeset parameter to GBK in order to extract Unicode data out of the database:

Key Value

user dbu

password dbu

weblogic.codeset GBK

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Connection object.

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 115

Page 116: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

pub.db:deleteWmDB. Removes all rows in the specified table that meet the given criteria. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to delete rows from a table that is not in the database to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or if you want to delete rows from the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 116

Page 117: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

pub.db:execSQLWmDB. Executes the specified SQL statement. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

The service does not perform any parsing on the SQL statement.

Input Parameters

$dbTable String Name of the table to remove rows from.

$data Document Optional. Criteria that the rows to delete must meet.

Important! If no criteria are provided, all rows are deleted from the table.

$updateCount String Number of rows deleted.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 117

Page 118: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to retrieve information from a database to which you are not currently connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

$dbSQL String SQL statement to execute.

$dbProcessEsc String Optional. Flag that indicates whether JDBC SQL escapes will be processed. These escapes allow database-independent access to database-dependent functionality. For example, different dialects of SQL have different syntax for date literals. Using a JDBC escape, you can encode a date literal in a SQL string that should work on any database. Documentation on JDBC SQL escapes is widely available.

Set to... To...

true Default. Process JDBC SQL escapes.

false Skip processing JDBC SQL escapes.

$dbProcessReporterTokens String Optional. Flag that indicates whether reporter tags (for example, %value xxx%) will be processed in the SQL. Including these tokens in your SQL allows dynamic construction of complex SQL statements, at the possible expense of some execution speed.

Set to... To...

true Process tags.

false Default. Ignore tags.

$dbParamValues Object List Optional. If the “?” parameters in the SQL statement are not supplied indirectly (with the $dbParamNames parameter), they can be supplied directly via this parameter. See “Usage Notes” below. Objects in $dbParamValues can be of any type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 118

Page 119: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service does not support updates from a Web browser or HTML form.

SQL supports host variables (“?”) in statements to be executed. Because the pipeline is based on named values and individual host variables are not named, $dbParamNames and $dbParamTypes are used to supply an index-to-name mapping for each SQL statement executed. For example, consider the following SQL query:

SELECT * FROM royalties WHERE pub_id = ? and roy_amt > ?

To execute this SQL query, you could supply the following values to the pub.db:execSQL service:

$dbParamNames String List Optional. Names of any “?” parameters in the SQL. See “Usage Notes” below.

$dbParamTypes String List Optional. SQL type names for each parameter. Use type names from the JDBC 1.2 specification ( “INTEGER”, “VARCHAR”, etc.).

sql String Conditional. SQL as it was actually passed to the target database. This can be helpful in debugging calls to this service when dynamic SQL is used (that is, you are using either JDBC SQL escapes or webMethods Reporter tokens in your SQL).

paramsAsStrings String List Conditional. Values used for each of the parameters in the SQL statement. This can be helpful in debugging calls to this service when “?” parameters are being used.

$rowCount String Conditional. Number of rows in results.

results com.wm.util.Table Conditional. Results from the SQL statement. The Integration Server recognizes and treats this parameter as a Document List at run time.

$updateCount String Conditional. Number of rows updated.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

Key Value Description

$dbSQL SELECT * FROM royalties WHERE pub_id = ? and roy_amt > ?

SQL query to execute.

$dbParamNames pub_idroy_amt

Pipeline items to use for the host variables.

$dbParamTypes varcharinteger

SQL types for the host variables.

pub_id P1053 Values for the host variables.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 119

Page 120: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Example: Consider the following SQL query, which contains an INSERT with three host variables: INSERT INTO books VALUES (?, ?, ?)

To execute this SQL query, you could supply the following values to the pub.db:execSQL service:

roy_amt 10 Values for the host variables.

Note: Even if there is only one host variable in the SQL statement, both $dbParamNames and $dbParamTypes are String arrays.

Key Value Description

$dbSQL INSERT INTO books VALUES (?, ?, ?) SQL query to execute.

$dbParamNames book_idpub_idbook_title

Pipeline items to use for the host variables.

$dbParamTypes varcharvarcharvarchar

SQL types for the host variables.

book_id B234 Values for the host variables.

pub_id P1053 Values for the host variables.

book_title The Importance of Being Earnest Values for the host variables.

Note: The SQL type names used in the examples are defined in the java.sql.Types and SQL92. Even if you used an Oracle database, which calls long string types “varchar2,” you would call them varchar. The standard names from SQL92 will be mapped into database-specific type names.

Key Value Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 120

Page 121: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

pub.db:getProcInfoWmDB. Retrieves information about one or more stored procedures. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to retrieve information about a stored procedure that is not in the database to which you are currently connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the stored procedure’s location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the stored procedure’s AuthID.

$dbProc String Name of the procedure about which you want information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 121

Page 122: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

This service returns one document (IData object) for each item in the stored procedure’s signature that matches the specified input criteria. Each document contains information about the signature item. The document’s key will be the same as the signature item’s name. For a description of what information is supplied by your database, see java.sql.DatabaseMetaData.getProcedureColumns in your JDBC documentation.

pub.db:getProcsWmDB. Retrieves the names of stored procedures for the specified database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to retrieve a list of stored procedures from a database other than the one to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 122

Page 123: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

This service returns one document (IData object) for each stored procedure that matches the specified input criteria. Each document contains information about a stored procedure. The document’s key will be the same as the stored procedure name. For a description of what information is supplied by your database, see java.sql.DatabaseMetaData.getProcedures in your JDBC documentation.

pub.db:getTableInfoWmDB. Retrieves information about columns in the specified table. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the stored procedures belong.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the database’s AuthID.

$dbProcNamePattern String Optional. Pattern-matching string that specifies the procedures that you want included in the returned list, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value DATE% would represent any procedure beginning with the characters DATE.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 123

Page 124: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

This service returns one document (IData object) for each column that matches the specified input criteria. Each document contains information about a column. The document’s key will be the same as the column name.

Usage Notes

This service accepts input from a Web browser or HTML form.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want information about a table that is not in the database to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or you want information about a table in the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify a pattern-matching string for the schema name, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

$dbTable String Name of table whose column names you want to retrieve.

$dbColumnNamePattern String Optional. Pattern-matching string that specifies the column names that you want to retrieve, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value ADDR% would represent any column name beginning with the characters ADDR.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 124

Page 125: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

pub.db:getTablesWmDB. Retrieves the names of tables in the specified database and schema. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want information from a database that is not the one to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or you want information about the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema for which you want the names of tables.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify a pattern-matching string for the schema name, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you want the table names from all schemas, set $dbSchemaPattern to null.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 125

Page 126: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

This service returns one document (IData object) for each table that matches the specified input criteria. Each document contains information about a table. The document’s key will be the same as the table name.

Usage Notes

This service accepts input from a Web browser or HTML form.

pub.db: insertWmDB. Inserts one or more rows into the specified table. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$dbTableNamePattern String Optional. Pattern string describing the tables whose names you want to retrieve.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any table name beginning with the characters HR.

If you want all table names, set $dbTableNamePattern to null.

$dbTableTypeList String List Optional. Set of parameters specifying the types of tables whose names you want to retrieve. Common JDBC table types include: TABLE, VIEW, SYSTEM TABLE, ALIAS, and SYNONYM. Check your driver documentation for others.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 126

Page 127: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts input from a Web browser or HTML form.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to insert rows into a table that is not in the database to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or if you want to insert rows into the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

$dbTable String Name of table in which you want to insert rows.

$dbRollbackOnFail String Optional. Flag that determine whether changes are committed if a failure occurs while processing multiple inserts.

Set to... To...

true Undo changes on failure.

false Default. Commit changes on failure.

$data Document or Document List Optional. Data to insert.

$updateCount String Number of rows the service inserted.

$failCount String Number of rows the service failed to insert.

$errors Document Conditional. Error messages generated during service execution.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 127

Page 128: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

pub.db:queryWmDB. Retrieves all rows from the specified table that meet the given criteria. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to query a table that is not in the database to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or if you want to query a table in the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 128

Page 129: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts input from a Web browser or HTML form.

pub.db:rol lbackWmDB. Discards changes to a database. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

$dbTable String Name of table to query.

$data Document Optional. Criteria that the rows to retrieve must meet.

results com.wm.util.Table Conditional. Results of the query. The Integration Server recognizes and treats this parameter as a Document List at run time.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the success or failure of an operation.

$rowCount String Conditional. Number of rows for the table that meet the criteria specified in $data.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Alias of the database for which you want to discard changes. This information is passed automatically.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 129

Page 130: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service throws an exception if an error occurs when discarding changes to the database. The most common reason for this error is that no transaction has been started (see pub.db:startTransaction).

pub.db:startTransact ionWmDB. Begins a transaction on a database connection. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

By default, all database connections are opened in “auto commit” mode, meaning the results of a operation are automatically committed to the database when that operation succeeds. To use a

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Alias of the database for which you want to start the transaction. This information is passed automatically.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

$dbMessage String Message indicating the success or failure of the operation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 130

Page 131: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

connection in a transactional context, you must first call pub.db:startTransaction to take that connection out of “auto commit” mode.

This service returns an exception if an error occurs when starting the new transaction. Common reasons for an error when starting a new transaction are:

A transaction is already in progress (see pub.db:commit, pub.db:rollback, or pub.db:clearTransaction).

The target database does not support transactions.

After a transaction has been started, it must be terminated with a call to either pub.db:commit (to save all changes to the database) or pub.db:rollback (to discard changes).

pub.db:updateWmDB. Updates all rows in a table that meet the given criteria. Rows are updated with the supplied new data. As an alternative to this service, consider using the services provided with the webMethods JDBC adapter.

Input Parameters

You may specify the connection parameters in one of the following ways:

$dbAlias

–OR–

$dbURL, $dbUser, $dbPass, $dbDriver

–OR–

$dbConnection

$dbAlias String Optional. Database alias.

$dbURL String Optional. JDBC URL that identifies the database resource.

$dbUser String Optional. User name to use to log into the database.

$dbPass String Optional. Password for the user.

$dbDriver String Optional. Name of the JDBC driver to use.

$dbConnection com.wm.app.b2b.server.DBConnection Optional. Connection object returned by pub.db:connect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 131

Page 132: Integration Server Bis Reference

5. Db Folder

Output Parameters

$dbCatalog String Optional. Name of the database’s system catalog. Include this parameter if your DBMS supports distributed databases and you want to update rows in a table that is not in the database to which you are connected.

If you are not using a distributed database system or if you want to update rows in the database to which you are connected, you do not need to specify this parameter.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the database location.

$dbSchemaPattern String Optional. Name of the schema to which the table belongs.

If your database supports pattern-matching on schemas, you may specify the schema name with a pattern-matching string, where _ represents a single character and % represents any string of characters. For example, the value HR% would represent any schema beginning with the characters HR.

If you are running against DB2, you use this parameter to specify the table’s AuthID.

$dbTable String Name of table to update.

$criteria Document Criteria that the rows to update must meet.

Important! If no criteria are provided, all rows are updated.

$set Document New data with which to update rows.

$updateCount String Number of rows updated.

$dbMessage String Conditional. Message indicating the operation failed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 132

Page 133: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 6. Document Folder

You use the elements in the document folder to perform operations on documents in the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 133

Page 134: Integration Server Bis Reference

6. Document Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.document:documentListToDocument WmPublic. Constructs a document (an IData object) from a document list (an IData[ ]) by generating key/value pairs from the values of two elements that you specify in the document list.

pub.document:documentToDocumentList WmPublic. Expands the contents of a document into a list of documents.

pub.document:documentToXMLValues WmPublic. Converts a document (IData object) to a String by encoding it in webMethods XMLValues format.

pub.document:XMLValuesToDocument WmPublic. Decodes a String containing an XMLValues-encoded document and produces a document (IData object).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 134

Page 135: Integration Server Bis Reference

6. Document Folder

pub.document:documentListToDocumentWmPublic. Constructs a document (an IData object) from a document list (an IData[ ]) by generating key/value pairs from the values of two elements that you specify in the document list.

The following illustrates how documentListToDocument would convert a document list that contains three documents to a single document containing three key/value pairs. When you use documentListToDocument, you specify which two elements from the source list are to be transformed into the keys and values in the output document. In this example, the values from the pName elements in the source list are transformed into key names, and the values from the pValue elements are transformed into the values for these keys.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

A document List containing these 3 documents... Would be converted to a document containing these 3 keys...

Key Value Key Value

pName cx_timeout cx_timeout 1000

pValue 1000 cx_max 2500

cx_min 10

pName cx_max

pValue 2500

pName cx_min

pValue 10

documentList Document List Set of documents (IData[ ]) that you want to transform into a single document (IData object).

Note: If documentList contains a single document instead of a Document List, documentListToDocument does nothing.

name String Name of the element in documentList whose value provides the name of each key in the resulting document.

Important! The data type of the element that you specify in name must be String.

value String Name of the element in documentList whose values will be assigned to the keys specified in name. This element can be of any data type.

document Document Document (IData object) containing the key/value pairs generated from documentList.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 135

Page 136: Integration Server Bis Reference

6. Document Folder

pub.document:documentToDocumentListWmPublic. Expands the contents of a document into a list of documents.

Each key/value pair in the source document is transformed to a single document containing two keys (whose names you specify). These two keys will contain the key name and value of the original pair.

The following shows how a document containing three keys would be converted to a document list containing three documents. In this example, the names pName and pValue were specified as names for the two new keys in the document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

A document containing these 3 keys... Would be converted to a document list containing these 3 documents...

Key Value Key Value

cx_timeout 1000 pName cx_timeout

cx_max 2500 pValue 1000

cx_min 10

pName cx_max

pValue 2500

pName cx_min

pValue 10

document Document Document (IData object) to transform.

name String Name to assign to the key that will receive the key name from the original key/value pair (in the example above, this parameter was set to pName).

value String Name to assign to the key that will receive the value from the original key/value pair (in the example above, this parameter was set to pValue).

documentList Document List List containing a document for each key/value pair in document. Each document in the list will contain two keys, whose names were specified by name and value. The values of these two keys will be the name and value (respectively) of the original pair.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 136

Page 137: Integration Server Bis Reference

6. Document Folder

pub.document:documentToXMLValuesWmPublic. Converts a document (IData object) to a String by encoding it in webMethods XMLValues format.

To convert the encoded String back into an IData object, use pub.document:XMLValuesToDocument.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.document:XMLValuesToDocumentWmPublic. Decodes a String containing an XMLValues-encoded document and produces a document (IData object).

An XMLValues-encoded document is produced using pub.document:documentToXMLValues.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

document Document Document (IData object) to convert. This document can contain any number of other fields, lists, and other documents.

xmlvalues String String representation of document, encoded in webMethods XMLValues format.

xmlvalues String An XMLValues encoding of a document.

Important! This String must contain a webMethods XMLValues encoding of a document. No other encoding format is accepted.

document Document Document (IData object) result of the decoding of xmlvalues.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 137

Page 138: Integration Server Bis Reference

6. Document Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 138

Page 139: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 7. Event Folder

You use the elements in the event folder to write your own event handler services. webMethods provides the pub.event.audit:logToFile and pub.event.exception:logToFile services as samples of audit and exception events and for backward compatibility with earlier versions of the webMethods Integration Server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 139

Page 140: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Summary of Elements in this FolderThe following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.event:addSubscriber WmPublic. Creates a subscription for a specified event.

pub.event:alarm WmPublic. Specification for alarm event handlers.

pub.event:alarmInfo WmPublic. Document type for alarm event information.

pub.event:audit WmPublic. Specification for audit event handlers.

pub.event:auditInfo WmPublic. Document type for audit event information.

pub.event:callStackItem WmPublic. Document type for the name of the service in the invocation path when an exception occurred.

pub.event:deleteSubscriber WmPublic. Removes an event handler from the subscription list for a specified event.

pub.event:exception WmPublic. Specification for exception event handlers.

pub.event:exceptionInfo WmPublic. Document type for exception information.

pub.event:gdEnd WmPublic. Specification for gdEnd event handlers.

pub.event:gdEndInfo WmPublic. Document type for gdEnd event information.

pub.event:gdStart WmPublic. Specification for gdStart event handlers.

pub.event:gdStartInfo WmPublic. Document type for gdStart event information.

pub.event:getEventTypes WmPublic. Returns the list of supported event types.

pub.event:getSubscribers WmPublic. Returns the list of subscribers for a specified event type.

pub.event:modifySubscriber WmPublic. Modifies the information about a subscription.

pub.event:portStatus WmPublic. Specification for a port status event.

pub.event:portStatusInfo WmPublic. Document type for port event information.

pub.event:reloadEventManagerSettings WmPublic. Reloads the settings from the event manager’s configuration file (eventcfg.bin) on the server.

pub.event:replication WmPublic. Specification for replication event handlers.

pub.event:replicationInfo WmPublic. Document type for replication event information.

pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings WmPublic. Saves the current subscriber information to the event manager’s configuration file (eventcfg.bin) on the server.

pub.event:sessionEnd WmPublic. Specification for sessionEnd event handlers.

pub.event:sessionEndInfo WmPublic. Document type for sessionEnd event information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 140

Page 141: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:addSubscr iberWmPublic. Creates a subscription for a specified event.

Important! Subscriptions that you add using this service take effect immediately; however, they are not made permanent unless you also persist them to disk with the pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings service. If you do not run pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings after adding subscribers, your changes will be lost when the server is restarted.

pub.event:sessionExpire WmPublic. Specification for sessionExpire event handlers.

pub.event:sessionExpireInfo WmPublic. Document type for sessionExpire event information.

pub.event:sessionStart WmPublic. Specification for sessionStart event handlers.

pub.event:sessionStartInfo WmPublic. Document type for sessionStart event information.

pub.event:stat WmPublic. Specification for stat event handlers.

pub.event:statInfo WmPublic. Document type for stat event information.

pub.event:txEnd WmPublic. Specification for txEnd event handlers.

pub.event:txEndInfo WmPublic. Document type for txEnd event information.

pub.event:txStart WmPublic. Specification for txStart event handlers.

pub.event:txStartInfo WmPublic. Document type for txStart event information.

pub.event.audit:logToFile WmPublic. Deprecated—Logs audit events to the audit log.

pub.event.exception:logToFile WmPublic. Deprecated—Logs exception events to the error log.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 141

Page 142: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Input Parameters

EventType String Type of event to which the event handler is subscribing. Must be one of the following:

Alarm EventAudit EventException EventGD End EventGD Start EventPort Status EventReplication EventSession End EventSession Expire EventSession Start EventStat EventTx End EventTx Start Event

Tip! To view the current list of event types, you can execute the pub.event:getEventTypes service in Developer.

Filter String Selects (filters) the set of events within EventType to which the event handler is subscribing. addSubscriber uses Filter as a pattern string to filter a particular attribute of an event.

The pattern string can be composed of literal characters, which match a character exactly, and/or the “*” character, which matches any sequence of characters. For example:

This pattern string... Would match...

* Any string

M* Any string that starts with an uppercase “M.”

M*X Any string that starts with an uppercase “M” and ends with an uppercase “X.”

The following table shows the attribute that is filtered for each event type. Note that some event types cannot be filtered.

EventType Filtered attribute

Alarm Event Message generated by the alarm event.

Audit Event Fully qualified name of the service that generates the audit event.

Exception Event

Fully qualified name of the service that generates the exception event.

GD End Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 142

Page 143: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

GD Start Event Fully qualified name of the service that generates the GD Start Event.

Port Status Event

None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Replication Event

Name of the package being replicated.

Session End Event

None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Session Expire Event

None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Session Start Event

User ID of the user starting the session or the groups to which the user belongs. (The filter is applied to a space-delimited list of groups, composed of group names suffixed with the user’s user ID.)

The following examples show how you might filter session start events for various groups and/or user IDs:

To select session starts for any user in the Administrators group, the filter would be:

*Administrators*

To select session starts for the user ID “LRMalley” in the Administrators group, the filter would be:

*Administrators*LRMalley

To select session starts for the user ID “LRMalley” in any group, the filter would be:

*LRMalley

Stat Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Tx End Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Tx Start Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Service String Fully qualified name of the event-handler service (the service that will execute when the event specified by EventType and Filter occurs).

Comment String Descriptive comment for this subscription. This comment is displayed when subscriptions are viewed with Developer.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 143

Page 144: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.event:deleteSubscriberpub.event:modifySubscriberpub.event:getSubscriberspub.event:saveEventManagerSettings

pub.event:a larmWmPublic. Specification for alarm event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

Enabled String Flag specifying the status of the subscription. Must be one of the following values:

Set to... To...

true Make the subscription active.

false Default. Make the subscription inactive.

Note: Although the default value is false, you will generally want to set Enabled to true to activate the subscription immediately when it is added.

Result String Flag indicating whether the subscriber was successfully added.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The subscriber was added successfully.

false The subscriber was not added.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

msg String Text describing the alarm.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 144

Page 145: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:alarmInfoWmPublic. Document type for alarm event information.

Parameters

pub.event:auditWmPublic. Specification for audit event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

msg String Text describing the alarm.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

sessionID String Session ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Description of the audit point.

A value of... Indicates that...

begin This event marks the beginning of a service.

ok This event marks the end of a service that executed successfully.

errorInfo This event marks the end of a service that executed unsuccessfully (that is, threw an exception). This string will start with the characters “error” and be followed by additional text containing specific error information about the exception.

pipeline Document Optional. State of the pipeline at the audit point.

userName String User ID that invoked the service that generated the event.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 145

Page 146: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager. Not all audit handlers that you code will log information.

When writing your own audit handler, be careful to not modify the pipeline variable within your handler.

pub.event:audit InfoWmPublic. Document type for audit event information.

Parameters

pub.event:cal lStackI temWmPublic. Document type for the name of the service in the invocation path when an exception occurred.

Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

sessionID String Session ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Description of the audit point.

A value of... Indicates that...

begin This event marks the beginning of a service.

ok This event marks the end of a service that executed successfully.

errorInfo This event marks the end of a service that executed unsuccessfully (that is, threw an exception). This string will start with the characters “error” and be followed by additional text containing specific error information about the exception.

pipeline Document Optional. State of the pipeline at the audit point.

userName String User ID that invoked the service that generated the event.

service String Fully qualified name of the last service (that is, most recently called) on the call stack.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 146

Page 147: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:deleteSubscr iberWmPublic. Removes an event handler from the subscription list for a specified event.

Important! Deletions made using this service take effect immediately; however, they are not made permanent unless you persist them to disk with the pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings service. If you do not run pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings after deleting subscribers, your changes will be lost when the server is restarted.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.event:addSubscriberpub.event:modifySubscriberpub.event:getSubscriberspub.event:saveEventManagerSettings

EventType String Type of event from which the event handler is unsubscribing. Must be one of the following values:

Alarm EventAudit EventException EventGD End EventGD Start EventPort Status EventReplication EventSession End EventSession Expire EventSession Start EventStat EventTx End EventTx Start Event

Tip! To view the current list of event types, you can execute the pub.event:getEventTypes service in Developer.

gID String ID of the subscriber that you want to delete. To get a list of subscriber IDs, execute the pub.event:getSubscribers service.

Result String Flag indicating whether the subscriber was successfully deleted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The subscriber was deleted successfully.

false The subscriber was not deleted (typically an invalid subscriber ID was provided in gID).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 147

Page 148: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:except ionWmPublic. Specification for exception event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Not all exception handlers that you code will log information.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

error String Optional. Error message of the exception.

localizedError String Optional. Error message in the language that corresponds to the locale of your webMethods installation.

errorType String Exception type that was thrown.

errorDump String More detailed information about the exception.

service String Optional. Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

user String User that requested the service that generated the event.

callStack Document List Optional. A document list containing information about the services on the callstack when the exception occurred. The structure of the documents in this list is defined by pub.event:callStackItem.

pipeline Document Optional. State of the pipeline at the time the exception occurred.

threadID String Thread ID identifying the thread that invoked the service.

ssnid String Session ID during which the exception occurred.

errorMsgID String Optional. The identification number for the error message.

errorDetails Document Optional. Additional exception information provided by the author of the Java service. For more information about constructing exceptions to return additional information, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.util.LocalizedException class.

nestedErrorInfo Document Optional. Nested errors and exceptions, if any. The structure of this document is defined by pub.event:exceptionInfo.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 148

Page 149: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:except ionInfoWmPublic. Document type for exception information.

Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

error String Optional. Error message of the exception.

localizedError String Optional. Error message in the language that corresponds to the locale of your webMethods installation.

errorType String Exception type that was thrown.

errorDump String More detailed information about the exception.

service String Optional. Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

user String User that requested the service that generated the event.

callStack Document List Optional. The callstack when the exception occurred. Each document represents a service on the callstack. The structure of this document is defined by pub.event:callStackItem.

pipeline Document Optional. State of the pipeline at the time the exception occurred.

threadID String Thread ID identifying the thread that invoked the service.

ssnid String Session ID during which the exception occurred.

errorMsgID String Optional. The identification number for the error message.

errorDetails Document Optional. Additional exception information provided by the author of the Java service. For more information about constructing exceptions to return additional information, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.util.LocalizedException class.

nestedErrorInfo Document Optional. Nested errors and exceptions, if any. The structure of this document is defined by pub.event:exceptionInfo.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 149

Page 150: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:gdEndWmPublic. Specification for gdEnd event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.event:gdEndInfoWmPublic. Document type for gdEnd event information.

Parameters

pub.event:gdStartWmPublic. Specification for gdStart event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

svcname String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 150

Page 151: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:gdStart InfoWmPublic. Document type for gdStart event information.

Parameters

pub.event:getEventTypesWmPublic. Returns the list of supported event types.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

svcname String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

EventTypes Document The types of events that the server supports:Alarm EventAudit EventException EventGD End EventGD Start EventPort Status EventReplication EventSession End EventSession Expire EventSession Start EventStat EventTx End EventTx Start Event

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 151

Page 152: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:getSubscribersWmPublic. Returns the list of subscribers for a specified event type.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

EventType String Type of event for which you want the list of subscribers. Must be one of the following values:

Alarm EventAudit EventException EventGD End EventGD Start EventPort Status EventReplication EventSession End EventSession Expire EventSession Start EventStat EventTx End EventTx Start Event

Tip! To view the current list of event types, you can execute the pub.event:getEventTypes service in Developer.

Subscribers Document The list of subscribers. For each subscriber, Subscribers will contain a key that is the subscriber ID. The value of that key is a document containing the following information about the subscriber:

Key Description

Service String Fully qualified name of the event-handler service (that is, the service that subscribes to the event in EventType).

Filter String Filter associated with the subscription. This is a pattern string that selects (filters) an event based on a particular attribute. Filter is composed of literal characters, which match a character exactly, and/or the “*” character, which matches any sequence of characters. For example:

This string... Would match...

* Any string

M* Any string that starts with an uppercase “M.”

M*X Any string that starts with an uppercase “M” and ends with an uppercase “X.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 152

Page 153: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

See Also

pub.event:addSubscriberpub.event:modifySubscriberpub.event:deleteSubscriber

pub.event:modifySubscr iberWmPublic. Modifies the information about a subscription.

Important! The changes you make with this service take effect immediately; however, they are not made permanent unless you also persist them to disk with the pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings service. If you do not run pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings after modifying subscribers, your changes will be lost when the server is restarted.

For a list of attributes to which the filter is applied, see pub.event:addSubscriber.

Comment String Descriptive comment associated with the description. If a comment has not been assigned to the subscription, Comment will be empty.

gID String Subscriber ID.

Enabled String Flag indicating the status of the subscription. Will be one of the following values:

Key Description

true Subscription is active.

false Subscription is inactive.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 153

Page 154: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Input Parameters

EventType String Event type that you want the subscription to have:Alarm EventAudit EventException EventGD End EventGD Start EventPort Status EventReplication EventSession End EventSession Expire EventSession Start EventStat EventTx End EventTx Start Event

Tip! To view the current list of event types, you can execute the pub.event:getEventTypes service in Developer.

gID String ID of the subscriber that you want to modify. To get the current list of subscriber IDs, execute thepub.event:getSubscribers service.

Filter String Filter that you want subscription to have. Filter is a pattern-matching string composed of literal characters, which match a character exactly, and/or the “*” character, which matches any sequence of characters. For example:

This pattern string... Would match...

* Any string

M* Any string that starts with an uppercase “M.”

M*X Any string that starts with an uppercase “M” and ends with an uppercase “X.”

The following table shows the attribute that is filtered for each event type. Note that some event types cannot be filtered.

EventType Filtered attribute

Alarm Event Message generated by the alarm event.

Audit Event Fully qualified name of the service that generates the audit event.

Exception Event Fully qualified name of the service that generates the exception event.

GD End Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 154

Page 155: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

GD Start Event Fully qualified name of the service that generates the GD Start Event.

Port Status Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Replication Event Name of the package being replicated.

Session End Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Session Expire Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Session Start Event User ID of the user starting the session or the groups to which the user belongs. (The filter is applied to a space delimited list of groups, composed of group names suffixed with the user’s user ID.)

The following examples show how you might filter session-start events for various groups and/or user IDs:

To select session starts for any user in the Administrators group, the filter would be:

*Administrators*

To select session starts for the user ID “LRMalley” in the Administrators group, the filter would be:

*Administrators*LRMalley

To select session starts for the user ID “LRMalley” in any group, the filter would be:

*LRMalley

Stat Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Tx End Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Tx Start Event None. This event type cannot be filtered. Filter is ignored for this event type.

Service String Fully qualified name of the event-handler service that you want the subscription to specify.

Comment String Descriptive comment that you want to assign to the subscription.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 155

Page 156: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.event:addSubscriberpub.event:deleteSubscriberpub.event:getSubscriberspub.event:saveEventManagerSettings

pub.event:portStatusWmPublic. Specification for a port status event.

Input Parameters

Enabled String Flag specifying the status of the subscription. Must be one of the following values:

Set to... To...

true Make the subscription active.

false Default. Make the subscription inactive.

Note: Although the default value is false, you will generally want to set Enabled to true to activate the subscription immediately after it is modified.

Result String Flag indicating whether the subscriber was successfully modified.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The subscriber was updated successfully.

false The subscriber was not updated (typically because an invalid subscriber ID was provided in gID).

portStatusInfo Document List List of documents (Data[ ] objects) containing the following information for each port.

Key Description

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

port String Number for the port.

status String Status of the port.

protocol String Type of port (for example, http, https, ftp, or email).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 156

Page 157: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

None.

pub.event:portStatusInfoWmPublic. Document type for port event information.

Parameters

primary String Primary port. By default, the webMethods Integration Server designates an HTTP port at port 5555 as the primary port.

enabled String Flag indicating whether or not the port is enabled.

Set to... To indicate that...

true The port is enabled.

false The port is disabled.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

port String Number for the port.

status String Status of the port.

protocol String Type of port (for example, http, https, ftp, or email).

primary String The primary port. By default, the webMethods Integration Server designates an HTTP port at port 5555 as the primary port.

enabled String A flag indicating whether or not the port is enabled.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The port is enabled.

false The port is disabled.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 157

Page 158: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:re loadEventManagerSett ingsWmPublic. Reloads the settings from the event manager’s configuration file (eventcfg.bin) on the server.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.event:saveEventManagerSettings

pub.event:repl icat ionWmPublic. Specification for replication event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager. When you subscribe an event handler to a replication event, you can create a filter to specify the package that, when replicated, will invoke the event handler.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

action String Description of the event (such as create or push). The value of action can be used to maintain separate logs for each action type.

package String Name of package being replicated.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 158

Page 159: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:repl icat ionInfoWmPublic. Document type for replication event information.

Parameters

pub.event:saveEventManagerSett ingsWmPublic. Saves the current subscriber information to the event manager’s configuration file (eventcfg.bin) on the server.

Important! Always run this service after making any permanent changes to subscriber information (for example, add subscribers, modify subscribers, or delete subscribers). Otherwise, your changes will be lost the next time the server is restarted.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

None.

See Also

pub.event:addSubscriberpub.event:deleteSubscriberpub.event:modifySubscriberpub.event:reloadEventManagerSettings

pub.event:sessionEndWmPublic. Specification for sessionEnd event handlers.

Input Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

action String Description of the event (such as create or push). The value of action can be used to maintain separate logs for each action type.

package String Name of package being replicated.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

time String Date and time that the event occurred, in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 159

Page 160: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

pub.event:sessionEndInfoWmPublic. Document type for sessionEnd event information.

Parameters

pub.event:sessionExpireWmPublic. Specification for sessionExpire event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

rpcs String Number of service calls the session has performed.

age String Number of milliseconds the session existed before it ended.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

rpcs String Number of service calls the session has performed.

age String Number of milliseconds the session existed before it ended.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

rpcs String Number of service calls the session has performed.

age String Number of milliseconds the session existed before it expired.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 160

Page 161: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:sessionExpireInfoWmPublic. Document type for sessionExpire event information.

Parameters

pub.event:sessionStartWmPublic. Specification for sessionStart event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager. When you subscribe an event handler to a Session Start event, you can create a filter so that only session start events generated by a specific user or by a member of a specific group invoke the event handler.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String Session ID of the service firing the alarm.

rpcs String Number of service calls the session has performed.

age String Number of milliseconds the session existed before it expired.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String ID of the new session.

userid String User ID that the IS client or developer used to log on to the webMethods Integration Server.

sessionName String Name of the new session.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 161

Page 162: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event:sessionStart InfoWmPublic. Document type for sessionStart event information.

Parameters

pub.event:statWmPublic. Specification for stat event handlers.

Input Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

sessionID String ID of the new session.

userid String User ID that the IS client or developer used to log on to the webMethods Integration Server.

sessionName String Name of the new session.

startTime String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

uptime String Amount of time the server has been up. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

totalMem String Total amount of used and unused storage available to the JVM, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

freeMem String Amount of unused storage available to the Integration Server, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

usedMem String Amount of storage used by the Integration Server, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

freeMemPer String Percent of total memory unused.

usedMemPer String Percent of total memory used.

svrT String Number of services currently running.

svrTMax String Peak number of servers ever running concurrently.

sysT String Number of JVM threads running.

sysTMax String Peak number of threads ever running.

conn String Number of current sessions.

connMax String Peak number of concurrent sessions.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 162

Page 163: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

pub.event:stat InfoWmPublic. Document type for stat event information.

Parameters

reqTotal String Cumulative total number of services processed.

reqAvg String Average duration of service.

newReqPM String New requests per minute.

endReqPM String End requests per minute.

errSvc String Number of services completed in error state.

svcRate String Number of end/start(s) per second.

ssnUsed String Number of licensed sessions currently active.

ssnPeak String Number of licensed sessions that have ever run concurrently on the server.

ssnMax String Maximum number of sessions for which the server is licensed.

errSys String Number of unknown errors.

startTime String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

uptime String Amount of time the server has been up. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

totalMem String Total amount of used and unused storage available to the JVM, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

freeMem String Amount of unused storage available to the Integration Server, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

usedMem String Amount of storage used by the Integration Server, in kilobytes. For example, a value of 65535 represents 64 megabytes of storage.

freeMemPer String Percent of total memory unused.

usedMemPer String Percent of total memory used.

svrT String Number of services currently running.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 163

Page 164: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event: txEndWmPublic. Specification for txEnd event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

svrTMax String Peak number of servers ever running concurrently.

sysT String Number of JVM threads running.

sysTMax String Peak number of threads ever running.

conn String Number of current sessions.

connMax String Peak number of concurrent sessions.

reqTotal String Cumulative total number of services processed.

reqAvg String Average duration of service.

newReqPM String New requests per minute.

endReqPM String End requests per minute.

errSvc String Number of services completed in error state.

svcRate String Number of end/start(s) per second.

ssnUsed String Number of licensed sessions currently active.

ssnPeak String Number of licensed sessions that have ever run concurrently on the server.

ssnMax String Maximum number of sessions for which the server is licensed.

errSys String Number of unknown errors.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 164

Page 165: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event: txEndInfoWmPublic. Document type for txEnd event information.

Parameters

pub.event: txStartWmPublic. Specification for txStart event handlers.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Remember to register your handler with the Event Manager.

pub.event: txStart InfoWmPublic. Document type for txStart event information.

Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Status of the transaction.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 165

Page 166: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

pub.event .audi t : logToFi leWmPublic. Deprecated—Logs audit events to the audit log.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

When writing your own audit handler, be careful to not modify the pipeline variable within your handler.

pub.event .except ion: logToFi leWmPublic. Deprecated—Logs exception events to the error log.

This service will also send an email notice if your SMTP settings are configured properly.

Input Parameters

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

TID String Transaction ID of the service that generated the event.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

sessionID String Session ID of the service that generated the event.

result String Description of the audit point (“begin”, “ok”, “error”, …).

pipeline Document Optional. State of the pipeline at the audit point.

userName String User ID that invoked the service that generated the event.

time String Date and time that the event occurred. Given in the format yyyy/MM/dd HH:mm:ss.SS.

error String Error message of the exception.

errorType String Exception type that was thrown.

errorDump String More detailed information about the exception.

service String Fully qualified name of the service that generated the event.

user String User that requested the service that generated the event.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 166

Page 167: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

Output Parameters

None.

callStack Document List Optional. A document list containing information about the services on the callstack when the exception occurred. The structure of the documents in this list is defined by pub.event:callStackItem.

pipeline Document State of the pipeline at the time the exception occurred.

threadID String The thread ID identifying the thread that invoked the service.

ssnid String Session ID during which the exception occurred.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 167

Page 168: Integration Server Bis Reference

7. Event Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 168

Page 169: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 8. Fi le Folder

You use the elements in the file folder to perform operations on the local file system.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 169

Page 170: Integration Server Bis Reference

8. File Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.f i le:getFi leWmPublic. Retrieves a specified file from the local file system.

If the file contains an XML document, you can use the services in the XML Folder to convert it to an XML node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.file:getFile WmPublic. Retrieves a specified file from the local file system.

filename String Complete path to the file in the local file system. For example: c:\rubicon\document.xml

loadAs String Optional. Form in which you want getFile to make the contents of the file available to subsequent services.

Set to... To...

bytes Default. Return the file as a byte array. Use this option if the contents of the file will be used as input to a service that operates on whole documents (for example, pub.xml:queryXMLNode).

stream Return the file as an input stream. Use this option if the contents of the file will be used as input to a service that can process a document incrementally (for example, Usage Notes).

bufferSize String Optional. Buffer size (in bytes) to use if you are loading an InputStream (that is, loadAs=stream). The default is 4096 bytes. For example: 1024

body Document Document (IData object) containing the file as a byte[ ] or an InputStream. body will contain one of the following keys, depending on how loadAs was set:

Key Description

bytes byte[ ] Conditional. File contents in a byte array (if loadAs is set to bytes.)

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. File contents as an InputStream (if loadAs is set to stream).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 170

Page 171: Integration Server Bis Reference

8. File Folder

Usage Notes

getFile does not automatically generate an XML node from the contents of the file. To generate an XML node, pass the output from this service to pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode.

See Also

pub.io:close

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 171

Page 172: Integration Server Bis Reference

8. File Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 172

Page 173: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 9. Flow Folder

You use the elements in the flow folder to perform debugging and utility-type tasks in a flow service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 173

Page 174: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.flow:clearPipeline WmPublic. Removes all fields from the pipeline. You may optionally specify fields that should not be cleared by this service.

pub.flow:debugLog WmPublic. Writes a message to the server log.

pub.flow:getLastError WmPublic. Obtains detailed information about the last exception that was trapped within a flow.

pub.flow:getRetryCount WmPublic. Retrieves the retry count and the maximum retry count for a service.

pub.flow:getSession WmPublic. Retrieves information about the protocol from which the current service was invoked.

pub.flow:getTransportInfo WmPublic. Retrieves information about the protocol from which the current service was invoked.

pub.flow:restorePipeline WmPublic. Restores a pipeline previously saved by pub.flow:savePipeline.

pub.flow:restorePipelineFromFile WmPublic. Restores a pipeline that was previously saved to a file.

pub.flow:savePipeline WmPublic. Saves a pipeline into memory, for later retrieval with pub.flow:restorePipeline.

pub.flow:savePipelineToFile WmPublic. Saves the current pipeline to a file on the machine running webMethods Integration Server.

pub.flow:setResponse WmPublic. Forces a specified response string to be returned by the webMethods Integration Server to a calling process (such as a browser or application server).

pub.flow:setResponseCode WmPublic. Specifies the HTTP response code to be returned by Integration Server to a calling process (such as a browser or application server).

pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry WmPublic. Throws an ISRuntimeException and instructs the Integration Server to re-execute a service using the original service input.

pub.flow:tracePipeline WmPublic. Writes the names and values of all fields in the pipeline to the server log.

pub.flow:transportInfo WmPublic. Document type used to return information about the protocol through which a service was invoked.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 174

Page 175: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:clearPipel ineWmPublic. Removes all fields from the pipeline. You may optionally specify fields that should not be cleared by this service.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.f low:debugLogWmPublic. Writes a message to the server log.

Each log message contains a timestamp, a message ID, the function name field, and message field. The following is an example:

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

preserve String List Optional. Field names that should not be cleared from the pipeline.

message String Optional. Text of the message to write to the log.

function String Optional. Function name, typically an abbreviation used to identify the source of the message.

level String Optional. Debug level at which to display this message. Defaults to 1. If the debug level on the server is set to a value less than this parameter, the message will not be written.

2002-08-16 11:01:23 EDT [PRT.0111.0003D] My function – My message

messagefunction

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 175

Page 176: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:getLastErrorWmPublic. Obtains detailed information about the last exception that was trapped within a flow.

An exception is trapped in a flow when a service failure occurs inside a SEQUENCE step that executes until DONE, or when a service failure occurs inside a REPEAT step that repeats on FAILURE.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If this service is not invoked from within a flow service, an exception is thrown.

Each execution of a service (whether the service succeeds or fails) updates the value returned by getLastError. Consequently, getLastError itself resets the value of lastError. Therefore, if the results of getLastError will be used as input to subsequent services, map the value of lastError to a variable in the pipeline.

If a map has multiple transformers, then a subsequent call to getLastError will return the error associated with the last failed transformer in the map, even if it is followed by successful transformers.

pub.f low:getRetryCountWmPublic. Retrieves the retry count and the maximum retry count for a service.

The retry count indicates the number of times the Integration Server has re-executed a service. For example, a retry count of 1 indicates that the Integration Server tried to execute the service twice (the initial attempt and then one retry). The maximum retry count indicates the maximum number of times the Integration Server can re-execute the service if it continues to fail because of an ISRuntimeException.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

lastError Document Information about the last error, translated into the language used by the Integration Server. The structure of this document is defined by pub.event:exceptionInfo.

retryCount String The number of times the Integration Server has re-executed the service.

maxRetryCount String The maximum number of times the Integration Server can re-execute the service. A value of -1 indicates that the service is being invoked by a trigger configured to retry until success.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 176

Page 177: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

Usage Notes

Although the pub.flow:getRetryCount service can be invoked at any point in a flow service, the pub.flow:getRetryCount service retrieves retry information for the service within which it is invoked. That is, you can use the pub.flow:getRetryCount service to retrieve retry information for top-level services or services invoked by a trigger only. The pub.flow:getRetryCount service does not retrieve retry information for a nested service (a service that is invoked by another service).

The Integration Server retries a service that is configured to retry if the service uses the pub.flow:throwISRuntimeException service to catch a transient error and re-throw it as an ISRuntimeException. The Integration Server will also retry a service written in Java if the service throws an exception using com.wm.app.b2b.server.ISRuntimeException(). For more information about constructing com.wm.app.b2b.server.ISRuntimeExceptions in Java services, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.ISRuntimeException class.

The maximum number of times the Integration Server retries a service depends on the value of the Max attempts property for the service. If the service is invoked by a trigger, the retry behavior is determined by the trigger retry properties.

See Also

pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry

pub.f low:getSessionWmPublic. Inserts the Session object into the pipeline as a document named $session.

Session is useful for associating values with particular clients or users. Once $session is added to the pipeline, it can be used like any other document in a flow. This permits more powerful flows that perform work spanning several user requests.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.f low:getTransport InfoWmPublic. Retrieves information about the protocol from which the current service was invoked.

Input Parameters

None.

$session Document Information for the current user session. Setting, copying, or dropping fields within $session is effectively manipulating the Session object on the server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 177

Page 178: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The value of the protocol key in transport indicates which protocol was used to invoked the service. For example, if the service was invoked via the email protocol, protocol would be set to email. transport will also contain a document (whose key is protocol-dependent) that holds protocol-specific details.

To use this service, first check the value of the protocol parameter to determine which protocol had been used. Then, depending on the value of protocol, extract the appropriate protocol information from transport. See pub.flow:transportInfo for the structure of the document that holds the protocol details.

pub.f low:restorePipel ineWmPublic. Restores a pipeline previously saved by pub.flow:savePipeline.

Input Parameters

transport Document Information about the protocol that invoked the service. The structure of this document is defined by pub.flow:transportInfo.

$name String Name of the saved pipeline. Because multiple pipelines can be saved, this parameter is necessary to identify the pipeline in memory. If this value is left null or the name is unknown, an exception will be thrown.

$merge String Optional. Flag that indicates whether or not to merge the values in the existing pipeline with the values in the saved pipeline.

Set to... To...

false Default. Clear the existing pipeline before restoring the saved pipeline.

true Merge the existing pipeline with the saved pipeline. If a field exists in the saved pipeline and the existing pipeline, the saved field takes precedence.

$remove String Optional. Flag that indicates whether or not the saved pipeline will remain in memory after this service is executed.

Set to... To...

false Default. Retain the saved pipeline in memory so that future calls to restorePipeline with the same $name will still return the saved pipeline.

true Remove the saved pipeline from memory after the service executes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 178

Page 179: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

Output Parameters

The output is dynamic, based on the contents of the saved and existing pipelines.

Usage Notes

After a successful invocation of restorePipeline, the pipeline will contain all fields that were present immediately before pub.flow:savePipeline was invoked. restorePipeline clears existing pipeline values unless the optional $merge field is specified.

This service is helpful in the interactive development or debugging of an application.

See Also

pub.flow:savePipelinepub.flow:restorePipelineFromFile

pub.f low:restorePipel ineFromFi leWmPublic. Restores a pipeline that was previously saved to a file.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

The output is dynamic, based on the contents of the saved and existing pipelines.

Usage Notes

This service is helpful in the interactive development or debugging of an application.

Be aware that variables that exist in the saved pipeline but are not defined in the flow will not appear on the Pipeline tab and, therefore, will not be available for explicit mapping.

See Also

pub.flow:savePipelineToFilepub.flow:restorePipeline

fileName String Relative path and file name of a file containing a saved pipeline on the Integration Server. If the file is not found at run time, an exception is thrown.

merge String Optional. Flag that determines whether or not to merge the saved values into the existing pipeline.

Set to... To...

false Default. Replace the existing pipeline with the saved values.

true Merge the saved values into the existing pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 179

Page 180: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:savePipel ineWmPublic. Saves a pipeline into memory, for later retrieval with pub.flow:restorePipeline.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

After a successful invocation of savePipeline, a snapshot of all pipeline fields will be saved in memory under the key provided by $name. Note that since the pipeline is saved to memory, it will not be available after a server restart.

This service is helpful in the interactive development or debugging of an application.

See Also

pub.flow:restorePipelinepub.flow:savePipelineToFile

pub.f low:savePipel ineToFi leWmPublic. Saves the current pipeline to a file on the machine running webMethods Integration Server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is helpful in the interactive development or debugging of an application.

See Also

pub.flow:restorePipelineFromFilepub.flow:savePipeline

$name String Name that will identify the pipeline in memory. An exception will be thrown if this value is not specified.

fileName String Relative path to a file on webMethods Integration Server in which to save the contents of the pipeline. If the file does not exist, the service creates it. If the file already exists, the service overwrites it.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 180

Page 181: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:setResponseWmPublic. Forces a specified response string to be returned by the webMethods Integration Server to a calling process (such as a browser or application server).

Formatting of the response is normally handled by templates, which format values from the pipeline. If templates are not appropriate for a particular integration scenario, a response message can be created within the flow and then returned to the caller using this service.

Typical usage of this service is to create an XML response to an XML request. A flow that creates an XML document by calling pub.xml:documentToXMLString can use pub.flow:setResponse to return the XML document to the caller. In your flow, you would map xmldata (output of pub.xml:documentToXMLString) to response (input to setResponse). Calling setResponse will cause the server to return the XML document that you’ve mapped to response instead of processing the pipeline through a template.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The webMethods Integration Server detects the type of request and sets the Content-Type value to text/XML (for requests in XML format) or text/HTML (for requests in all other formats). Be aware that if you specify a value for contentType, Developer will not be able to decode or display output from flows that include this service. This is because your contentType setting will override the Content-Type value that the Integration Server uses to return output to Developer. If you use Run to test the flow, Developer will not display any results. Instead, you will receive an error message. Therefore, if you include this service in a flow and you want to test the flow from Developer, use the Run in Browser command.

response String Response to be returned to the caller.

contentType String Optional. MIME type of the response data. By default, the server’s response will match the MIME type of the request. This field allows this behavior to be overridden.

Note: If you explicitly set this value with Developer, you will see two choices: text/XML and text/HTML. You are not limited to these two values. You may either select one of these or type a new value.

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the response is encoded.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 181

Page 182: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:setResponseCodeWmPublic. Specifies the HTTP response code to be returned by Integration Server to a calling process (such as a browser or application server).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.f low:throwExcept ionForRetryWmPublic. Throws an ISRuntimeException and instructs the Integration Server to re-execute a service using the original service input.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Use the pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry service to handle transient errors that might occur during service execution. A transient error is an error that arises from a condition that might be resolved quickly, such as the unavailability of a resource due to network issues or failure to connect to a database. The service might execute successfully if the Integration Server waits and then retries the service. If a transient error occurs, the service can catch this error and invoke pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry to instruct the Integration Server to retry the service.

responseCode String HTTP status code to be returned to the caller.

The responseCode parameter can be set to one of the following:

"100", "101", "200", "201", "202", "203", "204", "205", "206", "300", "301", "302", "303", "304", "305", "306", "307", "400", "401", "402", "403", "404", "405", "406", "407", "408", "409", "410", "411", "412", "413", "414", "415", "416", "417", "500", "501", "502", "503", "504", "505"

wrappedException Object Optional. Any exception that you want to include as part of this ISRuntimeException. This might be the exception that causes the pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry service to execute. For example, if the service attempts to connect to a database and the connection attempt fails, you might map the exception generated by the database connection failure to the wrappedException parameter.

message String Optional. A message to be logged as part of this exception.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 182

Page 183: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

The pub.flow:throwExceptionForRetry service should be used for transient errors only.

Only top-level services or trigger services can be retried. That is, a service can be retried only when it is invoked directly by a client request or by a trigger. The service cannot be retried when it is invoked by another service (that is, when it is a nested service).

You can invoke the pub.flow:getRetryCount service to retrieve the current retry count and the maximum specified retry attempts for a service.

If the trigger service is written in Java, the service can use ISRuntimeException() to throw an exception and retry the service. For more information about constructing ISRuntimeExceptions in Java services, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.ISRuntimeException class.

For information about configuring retry for services, see webMethods Developer User’s Guide. For more information about configuring retry for triggers, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.flow:getRetryCount

pub.f low:tracePipel ineWmPublic. Writes the names and values of all fields in the pipeline to the server log.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

level String Optional. Debug level at which to write the pipeline. Defaults to 1. If the debug level on the webMethods Integration Server is set to a value less than this parameter, the pipeline will not be written to the server log.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 183

Page 184: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

pub.f low:transport InfoWmPublic. Document type used to return information about the protocol through which a service was invoked.

Parameters

protocol String Name of protocol about which transportInfo contains information. Will be one of the following values:

A value of... Indicates that...

email The email protocol was used to invoke the service. Detailed information is contained in the email parameter.

http The http protocol was used to invoke the service. Detailed information is contained in the http parameter.

ftp The ftp protocol was used to invoke the service. Detailed information is contained in the ftp parameter.

filePolling The file polling protocol was used to invoke this service. Detailed information is contained in the filePolling parameter.

subprotocol String Conditional. HTTP subprotocol as follows:

A value of... Indicates that...

HTTP The service was invoked through HTTP.

HTTPS The service was invoked through HTTPS.

This parameter is returned only when the service was invoked via HTTP.

email Document Conditional. Information about the email transport. Returned only if the email transport invoked the service.

Key Description

to String List Email addresses for the recipients of the email.

from String List Email addresses for the senders of the email.

cc String List Conditional. Email addresses receiving a copy of the email.

bcc String List Conditional. Email addresses receiving a blind copy of the email.

replyto String List Conditional. Email address to which replies of this email should be sent

subject String Subject of the email.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 184

Page 185: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

filename String Conditional. Name of the attached file.

contenttype String Conditional. Content-Type of the attached file.

content java.io.InputStream Conditional. Contents of the attached file.

recvdate String Conditional. Date the email was received in String format. recvdate may be passed as parameter for the java.util.Date constructor.

sentdate String Conditional. Date the email was sent in String format. sentdate may be passed as parameter for the java.util.Date constructor.

http Document Conditional. Information about the http transport. Returned only if the service was invoked via http.

Key Description

requestUrl String URL used by client to invoke the service.

query String Conditional. Query portion of request URL.

requestHdrs Document Fields in the request header, where key names represent header field names and values represent the header field values.

ipInfo Document Information about the http socket connection has a local ip address and a remote ip address (port also). Contains the following information:

Key Description

localIp String Local IP address for this socket connection to client.

localPort String Local port number for this socket connection to client.

remoteIp String Remote IP address for this socket connection to client.

remotePort String Remote port number for this socket connection to client.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 185

Page 186: Integration Server Bis Reference

9. Flow Folder

Usage Notes

A document with this structure is output by the pub.flow:getTransportInfo service.

ftp Document Conditional. Information about the ftp transport. Returned only if the ftp transport invoked the service.

Key Description

filename String Name of file that was put into the service directory.

mimetype String Conditional. Content type of the file (for example, text/xml, text/plain, or image/jpeg). The server determines content type based on the extension of the file and the extension’s corresponding content type defined in webMethods6\IntegrationServer\lib\mime.types.

filePolling Document Conditional. Information about the file polling transport. Returned only if the file polling transport invoked the service.

Key Description

filename String Fully qualified name of the file submitted to the file polling listener.

originalFilename String Name of the file when it was submitted to the file polling listener.

contenttype String Conditional. Content type of the file (for example, text/xml, text/plain, or image/jpeg). The server determines content type based on the extension of the file and the extension’s corresponding content type defined in webMethods6\IntegrationServer\lib\mime.types.

length String The original file length in bytes.

lastModified Object Java date object (java.util.Date) indicating when the original file was last modified.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 186

Page 187: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 10. IO Folder

You use the elements in the io folder to convert data between byte[ ] and InputStream representations. These services behave like the corresponding methods in the java.io.InputStream class. For more information about InputStreams, see the Java documentation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 187

Page 188: Integration Server Bis Reference

10. IO Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder Note: The services in this folder may only be invoked by other services on the Integration Server. Streams cannot be passed between clients and the Integration Server, so these services will not execute if they are invoked from a client.

The following elements are available in this folder:

pub. io:bytesToStreamWmPublic. Creates a java.io.ByteArrayInputStream from a byte[ ].

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service constructs stream from the byte array using the constructor ByteArrayInputStream(byte[ ]). This constructor does not make a copy of the byte array, so any changes to bytes will be reflected in the data read from the stream.

Element Package and Description

pub.io:bytesToStream WmPublic. Creates a java.io.ByteArrayInputStream from a byte[ ].

pub.io:close WmPublic. Closes a java.io.InputStream object.

pub.io:createByteArray WmPublic. Creates a byte array of the specified length.

pub.io:mark WmPublic. Marks the current position in the InputStream.

pub.io:markSupported WmPublic. Enables you to test whether your InputStream supports the mark and reset operations.

pub.io:read WmPublic. Reads a number of bytes from the InputStream and stores them into a buffer.

pub.io:reset WmPublic. Repositions the InputStream to the position at the time the pub.io:mark service was last invoked on the stream.

pub.io:skip WmPublic. Skips over and discards the specified number of bytes from this InputStream.

pub.io:streamToBytes WmPublic. Creates a byte[ ] from data that is read from an InputStream.

bytes byte[ ] The byte array that you want to convert.

stream java.io.ByteArrayInputStream An open InputStream created from the contents of bytes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 188

Page 189: Integration Server Bis Reference

10. IO Folder

pub. io:closeWmPublic. Closes the InputStream.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If the InputStream is already closed, invoking this service has no effect. However, leaving an InputStream open may cause errors that are not recoverable until the Integration Server is shut down. Use the pub.io:close service to explicitly close the Input stream when a service leaves it open. For example, pub.file:getFile and pub.client.ftp:get leave the InputStream open in the pipeline.

pub. io:createByteArrayWmPublic. Creates a byte array of the specified length.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The pub.io:read service reads data from an InputStream into a byte array. You can use this service to create the byte array. Invoking this service is the equivalent of the Java code new byte[length].

stream java.io.InputStream An open InputStream.

None.

length String The length of the byte array to be created.

bytes Object The new byte array.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 189

Page 190: Integration Server Bis Reference

10. IO Folder

pub. io:markWmPublic. Marks the current position in the InputStream.

A subsequent call to pub.io:reset repositions this stream at the last marked position so that subsequent reads re–read the same bytes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If the InputStream does not support the mark operation, invoking this service has no effect.

pub. io:markSupportedWmPublic. Enables you to test whether your InputStream supports the mark and reset operations.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

stream Object The InputStream.

limit String The maximum number of bytes that can be read before the mark position becomes invalid. If more than this number of bytes are read from the stream after the mark service is invoked, the pub.io:reset service will have no effect.

stream Object The InputStream.

stream Object The InputStream.

stream Object The InputStream.

supported String

Set to ... If ...

true The InputStream supports the mark and reset operations.

false The InputStream does not support the mark and reset operations.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 190

Page 191: Integration Server Bis Reference

10. IO Folder

pub. io:readWmPublic. Reads a number of bytes from the InputStream and stores them into a buffer.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub. io:resetWmPublic. Repositions the InputStream to the position at the time the pub.io:mark service was last invoked on the stream.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If the InputStream does not support the reset operation, invoking this service has no effect.

stream Object The InputStream. This service attempts to read bytes from this object and store them into buffer.

offset String (optional) The offset into the byte array in the buffer to which the data is written. If no value is supplied, this defaults to 0.

length String (optional) The maximum number of bytes to read from the InputStream. If no value is supplied, the default is the length of buffer.

If the value supplied for length is greater than the length of buffer, and there are more bytes remaining in stream than the length of buffer, an exception will be thrown.

buffer Object The buffer into which data is read. This is a byte array, which can be created from a Flow service by invoking pub.io:createByteArray.

stream Object The InputStream. If any bytes were read from the stream, the stream is repositioned after the last byte read.

buffer Object The buffer into which data was read.

bytesRead String The number of bytes read from the InputStream and copied to buffer. If there is no more data because the end of the stream has been reached, bytesRead will be -1.

stream Object The InputStream.

stream Object The InputStream.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 191

Page 192: Integration Server Bis Reference

10. IO Folder

pub. io:skipWmPublic. Skips over and discards the specified number of bytes from this InputStream.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The pub.io:skip service uses the InputStream.skip method, which might, for a variety of reasons, skip some smaller number of bytes, possibly zero (0). This might result from any number of conditions (reaching the end of file before n bytes have been skipped is only one possibility). See the Java documentation on the InputStream class.

pub. io:streamToBytesWmPublic. Creates a byte[ ] from data that is read from an InputStream.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service reads all of the bytes from stream until the end of file is reached, and then it closes the InputStream.

stream Object The InputStream.

length String The number of bytes to skip.

stream Object The InputStream.

bytesSkipped String The actual number of bytes that were skipped.

stream java.io.InputStream The InputStream that you want to convert.

bytes byte[ ] The bytes read from stream.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 192

Page 193: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 11. LDAP Folder

You use the elements in the ldap folder to access and update information on an LDAP directory server.

By default, these services return the LDAP attribute objectGUI in a form that is not human-readable. To receive the attribute in human-readable form, you must set the value of the java system environment variable java.naming.ldap.attributes.binary to objectGUID. This property is specified on the watt.config.systemProperties property in the Integration Server configuration file. If the watt.config.systemProperties property already exists in the server configuration file, be sure to use a comma to append the java.naming.ldap.attributes.binary property to the end of the server configuration property, as shown below:

watt.config.systemProperties=mail.imap.partialfetch=true,java.naming.ldap.attributes.binary=objectGUID

See the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide for instructions on updating the server configuration file.

Important! The services in this folder have been deprecated. To access and update information on an LDAP directory server, use the services in the client.ldap folder instead.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 193

Page 194: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub. ldap:bindWmPublic. Adds an entry into the LDAP server.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.ldap:bind WmPublic. Adds an entry into the LDAP server.

pub.ldap:connect WmPublic. Connects to an LDAP server.

pub.ldap:delete WmPublic. Deletes an entry from the LDAP server.

pub.ldap:disconnect WmPublic. Closes a connection to an LDAP server.

pub.ldap:getAttributeDef WmPublic. Gets the definition of an attribute in the directory server’s schema.

pub.ldap:getClassDef WmPublic. Gets the definition of an objectclass in the directory server’s schema.

pub.ldap:list WmPublic. Lists the bindings within a particular directory context.

pub.ldap:lookup WmPublic. Looks up a single entry in the directory server.

pub.ldap:search WmPublic. Searches the directory for entries matching a set of criteria.

pub.ldap:update WmPublic. Modifies attributes of an entry in the LDAP directory.

ldapTargetName String Name of the entry that you want to add. For example, to add a user entry for Joe Krebbs in the ou=People context, specify cn=Joe Krebbs, ou=People for ldapTargetName.

ldapTargetObject Object Optional. Java Object that you want to store into this entry. Some LDAP servers restrict the kinds of objects you can store (some do not even support storage of Java objects). Typically, the objects must implement the java.io.Serializable interface. The default value for ldapTargetObject is null.

ldapTargetAttributes Document Optional. Attributes to assign to the new entry. The key/value pairs that you will need to supply in ldapTargetAttributes will vary depending on your LDAP server. Most servers will require an “objectclass” attribute, but other attributes are usually site-specific. Refer to the schema of your server to determine which attributes it requires. The following shows inputs you might use to add the user Joe Krebbs:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 194

Page 195: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

You must have the appropriate permissions to add entries into an LDAP directory. For most simple insertions, you should not need to supply a Java object value for the ldapTargetObject input parameter.

pub. ldap:connectWmPublic. Connects to an LDAP server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The connection key returned by this service can be used to invoke the rest of the pub.ldap services (including pub.ldap:disconnect). The connection to the directory server remains open until the server shuts down or until the connection is disconnected.

To connect to a subdirectory, specify the URL of the subtree for ldapUrl. For example, if your directory starts at ldap://mydir.com and you only want to operate on the subtree rooted at ou=People, specify ldap://mydir.com/ou=People for ldapUrl.

Key Value

objectclass organizationalPerson

cn Joe

sn Krebbs

uid jkrebbs

mail [email protected]

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned by pub.ldap:connect.

ldapUrl String URL of the directory server to connect with. For example: ldap://bigfoot.com

ldapUser String Optional. User name to use to connect to the directory server.

ldapPass String Optional. Password to use to connect to the directory server.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 195

Page 196: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

pub. ldap:deleteWmPublic. Deletes an entry from the LDAP server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

You must have the appropriate permissions to delete entries in an LDAP directory.

pub. ldap:disconnectWmPublic. Closes a connection to an LDAP server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Use this service to disconnect from an LDAP server when you are done using the connection.

ldapLookupName String Name of the entry that you want to delete. For example, to delete Joe Krebbs from the ou=People context, specify cn=Joe Krebbs, ou=People for ldapLookupName.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 196

Page 197: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

pub. ldap:getAttr ibuteDefWmPublic. Gets the definition of an attribute in the directory server’s schema.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service has been tested for the Netscape Directory servers. If you use a different LDAP directory server, test this service to ensure it works for your server.

ldapAttributeName String Name of the attribute for which you want to get the definition. For example, to get the definition of the “mail” attribute on the directory server, specify mail for ldapAttributeName.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapAttributeDef Document Definition of the attribute specified in ldapAttributeName. This document will contain the following information:

Key Description

NAME String Name of the objectclass.

NUMERICOID String Numeric OID of the objectclass.

SYNTAX String Numeric OID of the syntax for the attribute.

DESC String Description of this objectclass.

For example, the following shows what the returned output might look like for an attribute named “mail:”

Key Value

NAME mail

NUMERICOID 2.16.840.1.113730.3.2.2

SYNTAX 1.3.6.1.4.1.1466.115.121.1.15

DESC Standard Attribute

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 197

Page 198: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

pub. ldap:getClassDefWmPublic. Gets the definition of an objectclass in the directory server’s schema.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

ldapObjectClass String Name of the objectclass for which you want to retrieve the definition. For example, to get the definition of the “organizationalPerson” class, specify organizationalPerson for ldapObjectClass.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned by pub.ldap:connect.

ldapObjectClassDef Document Definition of the objectclass specified in ldapObjectClass. This document will contain the following information:

Key Description

NAME String Name of the objectclass.

NUMERICOID String Numeric OID of the objectclass.

MAY String List Names of optional attributes.

MUST String List Names of required attributes.

DESC String Description of this objectclass.

SUP String Superclass of this objectclass.

For example, the following shows what the returned output might look like for a class named “inetOrgPerson:”

Key Value

NAME inetOrgPerson

NUMERICOID 2.16.840.1.113730.3.2.2

MAY acidescriptionssealsoetc.

MUST objectclasssncn

DESC Standard ObjectClass

SUP organizationalPerson

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 198

Page 199: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Usage Notes

This service has been tested for the Netscape Directory servers. If you use a different LDAP server, test this service to ensure it works for your server.

pub. ldap: l istWmPublic. Lists the bindings within a particular directory context.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapListRoot String Optional. Relative name of the context to list. If you do not specify a value for ldapListRoot, the default is "", which indicates the root context for the directory server.

ldapReturnObjects String Optional. Flag that specifies whether you want the directory to return objects from the bindings or just the attributes. For example, if your directory contains persisted Java objects, you would set this attribute to true to have those objects returned.

Set to... To...

true Return objects from the bindings.

false Default. Return only attributes.

ldapReturnAttributes String Optional. Comma-separated list of attribute names to return for each of the listed bindings. For example, to return only the “mail” and “uid” attributes, you would set this parameter to mail,uid.

If you do not specify ldapReturnAttributes, all attributes are returned.

ldapListing Document List Conditional. Objects bound within the specified directory context. The list will contain one document for each object. Each document will contain the following information:

Key Description

$name String Fully qualified name of the binding.

$class String Conditional. Java class of the returned object. This key is present if you set ldapReturnObjects to true.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 199

Page 200: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Usage Notes

Suppose the directory server running on myCompany.com contains an ou=Users context, which contains an entry (binding) for each user in the directory server. To list the user ID and email address of each user, specify the following input parameters for the pub.ldap:list service:

The resulting document list might look like this (perhaps with more entries):

$object Object Conditional. Object bound to this name in the directory. This key is present if you set ldapReturnObjects to true.

ldapListing contains one set of keys for each returned attribute.

Key Value

ldapListRoot ou=Users

ldapReturnObjects false

ldapReturnAttributes uid,mail

Key Value

$name cn=Arthur Milberg, ou=People

uid amilberg

mail [email protected]

$name n=Dorothy Hadden, ou=People

uid dhadden

mail [email protected]

$name cn=Scott Treezak, ou=People

uid streezak

mail [email protected]

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 200

Page 201: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

pub. ldap: lookupWmPublic. Looks up a single entry in the directory server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

To reduce network traffic, it is recommended that you set the ldapReturnAttributes parameter to return a limited set of attributes. Try to avoid requesting all attributes.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapLookupName String Relative name of the context to look up (for example, ou=People, cn=Arthur Milberg).

ldapReturnObject String Optional. Flag that specifies whether you want the directory to return objects from the bindings or just the attributes. For example, if your directory contains persisted Java objects, you would set this attribute to true to have an object returned.

Set to... To...

true Return objects.

false Default. Return only attributes.

ldapReturnAttributes String Optional. Comma-separated list of attribute names to return for each of the listed bindings. For example, to return only the “mail” and “uid” attributes, set this parameter to mail,uid.

If you do not specify a value for ldapReturnAttributes, all attributes are returned.

ldapObject Object Conditional. The object bound to the given name in the directory. This parameter is present if you set ldapReturnObject to true.

ldapAttributes Document Attributes associated with the given name in the directory. The document will contain one key for each attribute requested in ldapReturnAttributes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 201

Page 202: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

pub. ldap:searchWmPublic. Searches the directory for entries matching a set of criteria.

Input Parameters

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection to the directory server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapSearchFilter String Filter describing which entries to return. For example, to retrieve all entries with the objectClass “groupOfNames” and the cn of “Engineers”, you might use:

(&(objectclass=groupOfNames)(cn=Engineers))

For more information about LDAP search filters, consult your directory server documentation or look for RFC 1558.

ldapSearchRoot String Optional. Name of the context in which to start the search. Default is the root entry. The search will be recursive unless you specify the ldapSearchOneLevel parameter (see below). For example, to search only the “ou=Engineers” subcontext, you would set this parameter to ou=Engineers.

ldapSearchOneLevel String Optional. Flag specifying whether to search only the current node or the current node and everything below it.

Set to... To...

true Search only the current node.

false Default. Search the current node and everything below it.

ldapReturnObjects String Optional. Specifies whether the directory server is to return an object for the matching entries or just attributes. For example, if your directory contains persisted Java objects, you would set this attribute to true to receive the actual objects.

Set to... To...

true Return objects.

false Default. Return only attributes.

ldapReturnAttributes String Optional. Comma-separated list of attribute names to return for each of the returned entries. For example, to return only the mail and uid attributes, set this parameter to mail, uid.

If you do not specify ldapReturnAttributes, all attributes are returned.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 202

Page 203: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

To reduce network traffic, speed up searches, and avoid returning unnecessary data, be specific when you define search criteria. Also keep in mind that different servers respond to search filters in different ways based on their schema. For instance, the (uid=a*) filter might be rejected on a server that does not allow substring searches on the uid attribute.

pub. ldap:updateWmPublic. Modifies attributes of an entry in the LDAP directory.

Input Parameters

ldapSearchResults Document List Conditional. Objects matching the search filter. The list will contain one document for each object. Each document will contain the following information:

Key Description

$name String Fully qualified name of the binding.

$object byte[ ] Conditional. Object bound to this name on the directory server (returned only if you specified true for ldapReturnObjects).

ldapSearchResults contains one set of keys for each returned attribute.

ldapLookupName String Name of the entry that you want to modify. For example, to modify the entry for Joe Krebbs in the ou=People context, specify cn=Joe Krebbs, ou=People for ldapLookupName.

ldapConnectionKey String Key for the connection on the Integration Server; this is the key returned from the execution of pub.ldap:connect.

ldapAttributeMods Document List The changes that you want to make. For each change, provide a document (IData object) containing the following information:

Key Description

$name String Name of the attribute to modify.

$modtype String Optional. Action to take. Specify remove, replace, or add. The default is add.

$value String Optional. New value to assign, if you are adding or replacing the attribute.

For example, the following shows the values you would use to change (replace) Joe Krebbs’ email address:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 203

Page 204: Integration Server Bis Reference

11. LDAP Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

You must have the appropriate permissions to modify entries in an LDAP directory. You cannot use this service to change the value of an entry itself (that is, if you have bound Java objects in your directory, you must delete them and rebind the name to a different Java object).

Key Value

$name mail

$modtype replace

$value [email protected]

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 204

Page 205: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 12. List Folder

You use the elements in the list folder to retrieve, replace, or add elements in an Object List, Document List, or String List. You also use list services to convert String Lists to Document Lists.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 205

Page 206: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.list:appendToDocumentList WmPublic. Adds documents to a document list.

pub.list:appendToRecordList WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:appendToDocumentList. Adds documents to a document list.

pub.list:appendToStringList WmPublic. Adds Strings to a String list.

pub.list:copyListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Copies an element from one index in an Object list to another index in a different Object list or the same Object list.

pub.list:getListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves an element from an Object list.

pub.list:getRecordListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves an individual document from a document list.

pub.list:getStringListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves a String from a String list.

pub.list:setListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces an element in an Object list with a new element.

pub.list:setRecordListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces a document in a document list with a new document.

pub.list:setStringListItem WmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces a String in a String list with a new String.

pub.list:sizeOfList WmPublic. Returns the number of elements in a list.

pub.list:stringListToDocumentList WmPublic. Converts a String list to a document list.

pub.list:stringListToRecordList WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:stringListToDocumentList. Converts a String list to a document list.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 206

Page 207: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

pub. l ist :appendToDocumentListWmPublic. Adds documents to a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The documents contained in fromList and fromItem are not actually appended as entries to toList. Instead, references to the documents in fromList and fromItem are appended as entries to toList. Consequently, any changes made to the documents in fromList and fromItem also affect the resulting toList.

pub. l ist :appendToRecordListWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:appendToDocumentList. Adds documents to a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

toList Document List Optional. List to which you want to append documents. If you do not specify toList, the service creates a new list.

fromList Document List Optional. Documents you want to append to the end of toList.

fromItem Document Optional. Document you want to append to the end of toList. If you specify both fromList and fromItem, the service adds the document specified in fromItem after the documents in fromList.

toList Document List The toList document list with the documents in fromList and fromItem appended to it.

toList Document List Optional. List to which you want to append documents. If you do not specify toList, the service creates a new list.

fromList Document List Optional. Documents to append to the end of toList. Documents are added after the entries of toList.

fromItem Document Optional. Document to append to the end of toList. If you specify both fromList and fromItem, the service adds the document specified in fromItem after the documents in fromList.

toList Document List The toList document list with the documents in fromList and fromItem appended to it.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 207

Page 208: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

Usage Notes

The documents contained in fromList and fromItem are not actually appended as entries to toList. Instead, references to the documents in fromList and fromItem are appended as entries to toList. Consequently, any changes made to the documents in fromList and fromItem also affect the resulting toList.

pub. l ist :appendToStringListWmPublic. Adds Strings to a String list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The Strings contained in fromList and fromItem are not actually appended as entries to toList. Instead, references to the Strings in fromList and fromItem are appended as entries to toList. Consequently, any changes made to the Strings in fromList and fromItem also affect the resulting toList.

toList String List Optional. List to which you want to append Strings. If the value of toList is null, a null pointer exception error is thrown. If you do not specify toList, the service creates a new list.

fromList String List Optional. List of Strings to add to toList. Strings are added after the entries of toList.

fromItem String Optional. String you want to append to the end of toList. If you specify both fromList and fromItem, the service adds the String specified in fromItem after the Strings specified in fromList.

toList String List The toList String list with the Strings from fromList and fromItem appended to it.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 208

Page 209: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

pub. l ist :copyList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Copies an element from one index in an Object list to another index in a different Object list or the same Object list.

The copied element replaces the existing element in the destination index.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

String lists and document lists can also be used with this list service because they are also Object lists.

Note: To copy an element from one index in an object list to another index in the same object list, you can delete the toList on the Input/Output tab. Then, in the editor, map the fromList to the toList.

pub. l ist :getList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves an element from an Object list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

fromList Object Object list containing the element that you want to copy.

toList Object Object list in which you want to place the copied element.

fromIndex String Index of the element you want to copy.

toIndex String Index in which you want to place the copied element.

list Object Object list containing the element you want to retrieve.

index String Index of the element you want to retrieve.

item Object Object at the specified index.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 209

Page 210: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

pub. l ist :getRecordList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves an individual document from a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub. l ist :getStr ingList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Retrieves a String from a String list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub. l ist :setList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces an element in an Object list with a new element.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

list Document List List containing the document you want to retrieve.

index String Index of the document you want to retrieve.

item Document Document at the specified index.

list String List List containing the String you want to retrieve.

index String Index of the String you want to retrieve.

item String String at the specified index.

list Object Object list containing the element you want to replace.

index String Index of the element in list that you want to replace.

item Object Object to use to replace Object at index.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 210

Page 211: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

pub. l ist :setRecordList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces a document in a document list with a new document.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub. l ist :setStr ingList I temWmPublic. Deprecated—Replaces a String in a String list with a new String.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub. l ist :s izeOfListWmPublic. Returns the number of elements in a list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

list Document List List containing the document you want to replace.

index String Index of the document in list that you want to replace.

item Document Document to use to replace document at index.

list String List List containing the String you want to replace.

index String Index of the String in list that you want to replace.

item String String to use to replace String at index.

fromList Document List, String List, or Object List Optional. List whose size you want to discover. If fromList is not specified, the service returns a size of 0.

size String Number of entries in fromList.

fromList Document List, String List or Object List Original list.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 211

Page 212: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

Usage Notes

For example, if fromList consists of:

fromList[0] = "a"

fromList[1] = "b"

fromList[2] = "c"

The result would be:

size="3"

pub. l ist :str ingListToDocumentListWmPublic. Converts a String list to a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Creates a document list containing one document for each element in the fromList. Each document will contain a single String element named key.

For example, if fromList consists of:

fromList[0] = "a"

fromList[1] = "b"

fromList[2] = "c"

key = "myKey"

fromList String List Optional. List of Strings (a String[ ]) that you want to convert to a list of documents (an IData[ ]). If fromList is not specified, the service returns a zero length array for toList.

key String Optional. Key name to use in the generated document list.

toList Document List Resulting document list.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 212

Page 213: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

The result would be:

pub. l ist :str ingListToRecordListWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:stringListToDocumentList. Converts a String list to a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Creates a document list containing one document for each element in the fromList. Each document will contain a single String element named key.

For example, if fromList consists of:

fromList[0] = "a"

fromList[1] = "b"

fromList[2] = "c"

key = "myKey"

The result would be:

fromList String List Optional. List you want to convert to a document list.

key String Optional. Key to use in the generated document list.

toList Document List Resulting document list.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 213

Page 214: Integration Server Bis Reference

12. List Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 214

Page 215: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 13. Math Folder

You use the elements in the math folder to add, subtract, multiply, or divide string-based numeric values.

Note: Services that operate on integer values use Java’s long data type (64-bit, two’s complement). Services that operate on float values use Java’s double data type (64-bit IEEE 754). If extremely precise calculations are critical to your application, you should write your own Java services to perform math functions.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 215

Page 216: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.math:addFloatList WmPublic. Adds a list of floating point numbers (represented in a String list) and returns the sum.

pub.math:addFloats WmPublic. Adds one floating point number (represented as a String) to another and returns the sum.

pub.math:addIntList WmPublic. Adds a list of integers (represented in a String list) and returns the sum.

pub.math:addInts WmPublic. Adds one integer (represented as a String) to another and returns the sum.

pub.math:addObjects WmPublic. Adds one java.lang.Number object to another and returns the sum.

pub.math:divideFloats WmPublic. Divides one floating point number (represented as a String) by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

pub.math:divideInts WmPublic. Divides one integer (represented as a String) by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

pub.math:divideObjects WmPublic. Divides one java.lang.Number object by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

pub.math:multiplyFloatList WmPublic. Multiplies a list of floating point numbers (represented in a String list) and returns the product.

pub.math:multiplyFloats WmPublic. Multiples one floating point number (represented as String) by another and returns the product.

pub.math:multiplyIntList WmPublic. Multiplies a list of integers (represented in a String list) and returns the product.

pub.math:multiplyInts WmPublic. Multiplies one integer (represented as a String) by another and returns the product.

pub.math:multiplyObjects WmPublic. Multiplies one java.lang.Number object by another and returns the product.

pub.math:randomDouble WmPublic. Returns the next pseudorandom, uniformly distributed double between 0.0 and 1.0.

pub.math:subtractFloats WmPublic. Subtracts one floating point number (represented as a String) from another and returns the difference.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 216

Page 217: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:addFloatListWmPublic. Adds a list of floating point numbers (represented in a String list) and returns the sum.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in numList are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

pub.math:subtractInts WmPublic. Subtracts one integer (represented as a String) from another and returns the difference.

pub.math:subtractObjects WmPublic. Subtracts one java.lang.Number object from another and returns the difference.

Element Package and Description

numList String List Numbers (floating point numbers represented as Strings) to add.

value String Sum of the numbers in numList. If a sum cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, adding a number to infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 + NaN = NaN).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 217

Page 218: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:addFloatsWmPublic. Adds one floating point number (represented as a String) to another and returns the sum.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

num1 String Number to add.

num2 String Number to add.

value String Sum of the numbers in num1 and num2. If a sum cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, adding a number to infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 + NaN = NaN).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 218

Page 219: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:addIntListWmPublic. Adds a list of integers (represented in a String list) and returns the sum.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in numList are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

pub.math:addIntsWmPublic. Adds one integer (represented as a String) to another and returns the sum.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the result of your calculation is less than 64 bits in width (the maximum width for the long data type). If the result exceeds this limit, it will generate a data overflow.

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

numList String List Numbers (integers represented as Strings) to add.

value String Sum of the numbers in numList.

num1 String Number (integer represented as a String) to add.

num2 String Number (integer represented as a String) to add.

value String Sum of num1 and num2.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 219

Page 220: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:addObjectsWmPublic. Adds one java.lang.Number object to another and returns the sum.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts the following sub-classes of java.lang.Number: java.lang.Byte, java.lang.Double, java.lang.Float, java.lang.Integer, java.lang.Long, java.lang.Short.

This service applies the following rules for binary numeric promotion to the operands in order:

If either operand is of type Double, the other is converted to Double.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Float, the other is converted to Float.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Long, the other is converted to Long.

Otherwise, both operands are converted to type Integer.

These promotion rules mirror the Java rules for numeric promotion of numeric types.

pub.math:divideFloatsWmPublic. Divides one floating point number (represented as a String) by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

Input Parameters

num1 java.lang.Number Number to add. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

num2 java.lang.Number Number to add. See “Usage Notes”” for supported sub-classes.

value java.lang.Number Sum of the numeric values of num1 and num2.

num1 String Number (floating point number represented as a String) that is the dividend.

num2 String Number (floating point number represented as a String) that is the divisor.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 220

Page 221: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

pub.math:divideIntsWmPublic. Divides one integer (represented as a String) by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

value String The quotient of num1 / num2. If a quotient cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, dividing a number by infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, the result of an illegal operation such as dividing zero by zero or any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 + NaN = NaN).

num1 String Number (integer represented as a String) that is the dividend.

num2 String Number (integer represented as a String) that is the divisor.

value String The quotient of num1 / num2.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 221

Page 222: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:divideObjectsWmPublic. Divides one java.lang.Number object by another (num1/num2) and returns the quotient.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts the following sub-classes of java.lang.Number: java.lang.Byte, java.lang.Double, java.lang.Float, java.lang.Integer, java.lang.Long, java.lang.Short.

This service applies the following rules for binary numeric promotion to the operands in order:

If either operand is of type Double, the other is converted to Double.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Float, the other is converted to Float.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Long, the other is converted to Long.

Otherwise, both operands are converted to type Integer.

These promotion rules mirror the Java rules for numeric promotion of numeric types.

num1 java.lang.Number Number that is the dividend. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

num2 java.lang.Number Number that is the divisor. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

value java.lang.Number Quotient of num1 / num2.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 222

Page 223: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:mult ip lyFloatListWmPublic. Multiplies a list of floating point numbers (represented in a String list) and returns the product.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in numList are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

numList String List Numbers (floating point numbers represented as Strings) to multiply.

value String Product of the numbers in numlist. If a product cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, multiplying a number by infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, the result of an illegal operation such as multiplying zero by zero or any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 + NaN = NaN).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 223

Page 224: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:mult ip lyFloatsWmPublic. Multiples one floating point number (represented as String) by another and returns the product.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

num1 String Number (floating point number represented as a String) to multiply.

num2 String Number (floating point number represented as a String) to multiply.

value String Product of the numeric values of num1 and num2. If a product cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, multiplying a number by infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, the result of an illegal operation such as multiplying zero by zero or any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 + NaN = NaN).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 224

Page 225: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:mult ip ly IntListWmPublic. Multiplies a list of integers (represented in a String list) and returns the product.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the result of your calculation is less than 64 bits in width (the maximum width for the long data type). If the result exceeds this limit, it will generate a data overflow.

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in numList are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

pub.math:mult iply IntsWmPublic. Multiplies one integer (represented as a String) by another and returns the product.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the result of your calculation is less than 64 bits in width (the maximum width for the long data type). If the result exceeds this limit, it will generate a data overflow.

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

numList String List Numbers (floating point numbers represented as Strings) to multiply.

value String Product of the numbers in numList.

num1 String Number (integer represented as a String) to multiply.

num2 String Number (integer represented as a String) to multiply.

value String Product of num1 and num2.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 225

Page 226: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:mult ip lyObjectsWmPublic. Multiplies one java.lang.Number object by another and returns the product.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts the following sub-classes of java.lang.Number: java.lang.Byte, java.lang.Double, java.lang.Float, java.lang.Integer, java.lang.Long, java.lang.Short.

This service applies the following rules for binary numeric promotion to the operands in order:

If either operand is of type Double, the other is converted to Double.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Float, the other is converted to Float.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Long, the other is converted to Long.

Otherwise, both operands are converted to type Integer.

These promotion rules mirror the Java rules for numeric promotion of numeric types.

pub.math:randomDoubleWmPublic. Returns the next pseudorandom, uniformly distributed double between 0.0 and 1.0.

Random number generators are often referred to as pseudorandom number generators because the numbers produced tend to repeat themselves over time.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

num1 java.lang.Number Number to multiply. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

num2 java.lang.Number Number to multiply. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

value java.lang.Number Product of num1 and num2.

number String Generated random number.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 226

Page 227: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:subtractFloatsWmPublic. Subtracts one floating point number (represented as a String) from another and returns the difference.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

num1 String Number (floating point number represented as a String).

num2 String Number (floating point number represented as a String) to subtract from num1.

value String Difference of num1 – num2. If a difference cannot be produced, value contains one of the following:

Value Description

Infinity The computation produces a positive value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

-Infinity The computation produces a negative value that overflows the representable range of a float type.

0.0 The computation produces a value that underflows the representable range of a float type (for example, subtracting a number from infinity).

NaN The computation produces a value that cannot be represented as a number (for example, the result of an illegal operation such as multiplying zero by zero or any operation that uses NaN as input, such as 10.0 - NaN = NaN).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 227

Page 228: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

pub.math:subtract IntsWmPublic. Subtracts one integer (represented as a String) from another and returns the difference.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Make sure the result of your calculation is less than 64 bits in width (the maximum width for the long data type). If the result exceeds this limit, it will generate a data overflow.

Make sure the strings that are passed to the service in num1 and num2 are in a locale-neutral format (that is, using the pattern -####.##). Passing locally formatted strings may result in unexpected results. For example, calling pub.math:addFloats in a German locale with the arguments 1,23 and 2,34 will result in the value 357, not 3.57 or 3,57.

pub.math:subtractObjectsWmPublic. Subtracts one java.lang.Number object from another and returns the difference.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service accepts the following sub-classes of java.lang.Number: java.lang.Byte, java.lang.Double, java.lang.Float, java.lang.Integer, java.lang.Long, java.lang.Short.

This service applies the following rules for binary numeric promotion to the operands. The following rules are applied in order:

If either operand is of type Double, the other is converted to Double.

num1 String Number (integer represented as a String).

num2 String Number (integer represented as a String) to subtract from num1.

value String Difference of num1 – num2.

num1 java.lang.Number Number. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

num2 java.lang.Number Number to subtract from num1. See “Usage Notes” for supported sub-classes.

value java.lang.Number Difference of num1 - num2.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 228

Page 229: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Float, the other is converted to Float.

Otherwise, if either operand is of type Long, the other is converted to Long.

Otherwise, both operands are converted to type Integer.

These promotion rules mirror the Java rules for numeric promotion of numeric types.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 229

Page 230: Integration Server Bis Reference

13. Math Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 230

Page 231: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 14. MIME Folder

You use the elements in the mime folder to create MIME messages and extract information from MIME messages.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 231

Page 232: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Service Function

pub.mime:addBodyPart WmPublic. Adds a body part (header fields and content) to a specified MIME object.

pub.mime:addMimeHeader WmPublic. Adds one or more header fields to a specified MIME object.

pub.mime:createMimeData WmPublic. Creates a MIME object.

pub.mime:getBodyPartContent WmPublic. Retrieves the content (payload) from the specified MIME object.

pub.mime:getBodyPartHeader WmPublic. Returns the list of header fields for the specified body part.

pub.mime:getContentType WmPublic. Returns the value of the Content-Type message header from the specified MIME object.

pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream WmPublic. Generates an InputStream representation of a MIME message from a specified MIME object.

pub.mime:getMimeHeader WmPublic. Returns the list of message headers from a specified MIME object.

pub.mime:getNumParts WmPublic. Returns the number of body parts in the specified MIME object.

pub.mime:getPrimaryContentType WmPublic. Returns the top-level portion of a MIME object’s Content-Type value.

pub.mime:getSubContentType WmPublic. Returns the sub-type portion of a MIME object’s Content-Type value.

pub.mime:mergeHeaderAndBody WmPublic. Concatenates the contents of the header and body returned by the pub.client:http service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 232

Page 233: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:addBodyPartWmPublic. Adds a body part (header fields and content) to a specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

mimeData Document MIME object to which you want to add a body part. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

content java.io.InputStream or Object Content that you want to add to the MIME object. content can be an InputStream or another MIME object. Use an InputStream to add an ordinary payload. Use a MIME object to add a payload that is itself a MIME message.

isEnvStream String Flag that specifies whether content is to be treated as a MIME entity.

Important! This parameter is only used if content is an InputStream.

Set this parameter to one of the following values:

Set to... To...

yes Treat content as a MIME entity. addBodyPart will strip out the header fields from the top of content and add them to mimeData as part headers. The remaining data will be treated as the payload.

Note: addBodyPart assumes that all data up to the first blank line represents the entity’s header fields.

no Treat content as an ordinary payload.

mimeHeader Document Specifies the part headers that you want to add with this body part. Key names represent the names of the header fields. The values of the keys represent the values of the header fields.

For example, if you wanted to add the following header fields:X-Doctype: RFQX-Severity: 10

You would set mimeHeader as follows:

Key Value

X-Doctype RFQ

X-Severity 10

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 233

Page 234: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Be aware that the following MIME headers are automatically inserted by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream when it generates the MIME message:

Message-IDMIME-Version

Additionally, you use the content, encoding, and description parameters to set the following fields:

Content-TypeContent-Transfer-EncodingContent-Description

If you set these header fields in mimeHeader and you create a single-part message, the values in contenttype, encoding, and description, if specified, will override those in mimeHeader. See usage notes.

contenttype String Optional. The value of the Content-Type header for this body part. For single-part messages, this value overrides the Content-Type value in mimeHeader, if one is present. Defaults to text/plain.

See usage notes.

encoding String Optional. Specifies how the body part is to be encoded for transport and sets the value of the Content-Transfer-Encoding header. For single-part messages, this value overrides the Content-Transfer-Encoding value in mimeHeader, if one is present. Defaults to 7bit.

See usage notes.

Note: This parameter determines how the payload is to be encoded for transport. When you add a payload to mimeData, it should be in its original format. The pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream service will perform the encoding (as specified by encoding) when it generates the final MIME message.

Set to... To...

7bit Default. Specify that content is 7-bit, line-oriented text that needs no encoding.

8bit Specify that content is 8-bit, line-oriented text that needs no encoding.

Note: This encoding value is not recommended for messages that will be transported via SMTP over the Internet, because the data can be altered by intervening mail servers that can’t accommodate 8-bit text. To safely transport 8-bit text, use quoted-printable encoding instead.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 234

Page 235: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Output Parameters

binary Specify that content contains binary information that needs no encoding.

Note: This encoding value is not recommended for messages that will be transported via SMTP over the Internet, because the data can be altered by intervening mail servers that can’t accommodate binary data. To safely transport binary data, use base64 encoding instead.

quoted-printable

Specify that content contains 7 or 8-bit, line-oriented text that you want to encode using the quoted-printable encoding scheme.

base64 Specify that content contains an arbitrary sequence of octets that you want to encode using the base64 encoding scheme.

uuencode Specify that content contains an arbitrary sequence of octets that you want to encode using the uuencode encoding scheme.

description String Optional. Specifies the value of the Content-Description header for this body part.

multipart String Optional. Flag that determines how addBodyPart behaves if mimeData already contains one or more body parts.

By default, addBodyPart simply appends a new body part to mimeData if it already contains a payload. (This allows you to construct multi-part messages.) However, you can override this behavior if you want to either replace the existing payload with the new body part or throw an exception under these circumstances (see replace parameter, below).

Set to... To...

yes Default. Append a new body part to mimeData.

no Replace the existing payload with the new body part. (Depending on the value of replace, this setting may cause addBodyPart to throw an exception.)

replace String Optional. Flag that specifies whether addBodyPart replaces the existing payload or throws an exception when it receives a mimeData that already contains a payload. This parameter is only used when multipart is set to no.

Set to... To...

yes Default. Replace the existing payload with the new body part.

no Throw an exception.

mimeData Document MIME object to which the body part was added.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 235

Page 236: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

The way in which the contenttype and encoding parameters are applied depends on whether the finished message is single-part or multipart.

For single-part messages:

contenttype specifies the Content-Type for the entire MIME message. It overrides any value assigned to the Content-Type header in mimeHeader. If Content-Type is not specified in contenttype or mimeHeader, the value of the Content-Type header defaults to text/plain.

encoding specifies the Content-Transfer-Encoding for the entire MIME message. It overrides any value assigned to the Content-Transfer-Encoding header in mimeHeader. If Content-Transfer-Encoding is not specified in encoding or mimeHeader, the value of the Content-Transfer-Encoding header defaults to 7bit.

For multipart messages:

contenttype specifies the Content-Type for an individual body part. The Content-Type for the entire MIME message is automatically set to multipart/mixed, or to multipart/subType if a subtype was specified when the MIME object was created. See pub.mime:createMimeData.

encoding specifies the Content-Transfer-Encoding for an individual body part. The Content-Transfer-Encoding header in mimeHeader, if present, specifies the encoding for the entire MIME message. If Content-Transfer-Encoding is not specified in mimeHeader, or if the specified value is not valid for a multipart message, the value of the Content-Transfer-Encoding header defaults to 7bit. (7bit, 8bit, and binary are the only encoding values valid for multipart messages.)

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getBodyPartContentpub.mime:addMimeHeader

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following services, which reside in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:build_SimpleMIMEsamples.mime:build_MultipartMIME

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 236

Page 237: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:addMimeHeaderWmPublic. Adds one or more header fields to a specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

If you add MIME headers before you add multiple body parts, the header fields will be added to each of the body parts. If you do not want this behavior, either drop mimeHeader from the pipeline immediately after you execute addMimeHeader, or invoke addMimeHeader after you’ve added all body parts to the MIME object.

Be aware that the contenttype and encoding parameters used by the pub.mime:addBodyPart service will override any Content-Type or Content-Transfer-Encoding settings in mimeData. Moreover, in certain cases, the pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream will override these settings when it generates a multipart message. For information about how the Content-Type or Content-Transfer-Encoding headers are derived at run time, see the “Usage Notes”under pub.mime:addBodyPart.

mimeData Document MIME object to which you want the header fields added. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

mimeHeader Document Header fields that you want to add to the MIME object. Key names represent the names of the header fields. The values of the keys represent the values of the header fields. For example, to add the following header fields:

X-Doctype: RFQX-Severity: 10

You would set mimeHeader as follows:

Key Description

X-Doctype RFQ

X-Severity 10

Be aware that the following MIME headers are automatically inserted by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream when it generates the MIME message:

Message-IDMIME-Version

If you set these values in mimeHeader, pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream will overwrite them at run time.

mimeData Document MIME object to which the header fields were added.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 237

Page 238: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getMimeHeaderpub.mime:addBodyPart

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following services, which reside in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:build_SimpleMIME

pub.mime:createMimeDataWmPublic. Creates a MIME object.

If no input parameter is passed to this service, the service creates an empty MIME object. Otherwise, the service creates a MIME object containing the elements (header fields and content) from the MIME message in input.

If you are building a MIME message, you use this service to create an empty MIME object. You populate the empty MIME object with header fields and content, and then pass it to pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream, which produces the finished MIME message.

If you are extracting data from a MIME message, you use this service to parse the original MIME message into a MIME object so that you can extract its header fields and content using other webMethods services.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 238

Page 239: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

input java.io.InputStream Optional. MIME entity you want to parse. If input is not provided, createMimeData creates an empty MIME object.

mimeHeader Document Optional. Specifies header fields that you want to add to the MIME object. Key names represent the names of the header fields. The values of the keys represent the values of the header fields.

Note: This parameter is ignored when input is passed to this service.

For example, if you wanted to add the following header fields:X-Doctype: RFQX-Severity: 10

You would set mimeHeader as follows:

Key Value

X-Doctype RFQ

X-Severity 10

Be aware that the following MIME headers are automatically inserted by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream when it generates the MIME message:

Message-IDMIME-Version

If you set these values in mimeHeader, pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream will overwrite them at run time.

subType String Optional. String that specifies the subtype portion of the Content Type header, when the message is a multipart message and \you want something other than the default value of mixed. For example, if you want the Content Type header to be multipart/related in the resulting message, set subType to related.

subType is ignored if the resulting message is not a multipart message.

mimeData Document MIME object. If input was passed to createMimeData, mimeData will contain the parsed MIME message. If input was not passed to createMimeData, mimeData will be empty.

encrypted String Conditional. Indicates whether input was an encrypted message. This parameter is not present when the service creates a new, empty MIME object.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The message is encrypted (the original message stream is in stream).

false The message is not encrypted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 239

Page 240: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Usage Notes

All of the other MIME services operate on the mimeData IData object produced by this service. They do not operate directly on MIME message streams.

Important! You can examine the contents of mimeData during testing and debugging. However, because the internal structure of mimeData is subject to change without notice, do not explicitly set or map data to/from these elements in your service. To manipulate or access the contents of mimeData, use only the MIME services that webMethods provides.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:addMimeHeaderpub.mime:addBodyPartpub.mime:getMimeHeaderpub.mime:getBodyPartContentpub.mime:getEnvelopeStream

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following services, which reside in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:build_SimpleMIMEsamples.mime:build_MultipartMIME

signed String Conditional. Flag whose value indicates whether input was a signed message. This parameter is not present when the service creates a new, empty MIME object.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The message is signed (the original message stream is in stream).

false The message is not signed.

certsOnly String Conditional. Flag whose value indicates whether input contained only digital certificates. (This type of message can be produced by the pub.smime:createCertsOnlyData service and allows digital certificates to be transported via the network as a MIME message.) This parameter is not present when the service creates a new, empty MIME object.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The message contains only certificates.

false The message contains a regular payload.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. InputStream containing the original MIME message from input. This parameter is present only when input is an S/MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 240

Page 241: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

samples.mime:extract_SimpleMIMEsamples.mime:extract_MultipartMIME

pub.mime:getBodyPartContentWmPublic. Retrieves the content (payload) from the specified MIME object.

You use this service for both single-part and multi-part messages.

To retrieve content from a multi-part message, you set the index (to select the part by index number) or contentID (to select the part by contentID value) parameter to specify the body part whose content you want to retrieve. To get the content from a single-part message, you omit the index and contentID parameters or set index to 0.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

mimeData Document MIME object whose content you want to retrieve. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

index String Optional. Index number of the body part whose content you want to retrieve (if you want to retrieve the content from a specific body part). The first body part is index number zero.

Note: If contentID is specified, index is ignored.

contentID String Optional. Value of the Content-ID header field of the body part whose content you want to retrieve (if you want to retrieve the payload from a specific body part).

content java.io.InputStream The payload of the specified body part.

encrypted String Flag whose value indicates whether content is an encrypted MIME message.

A value of... Indicates that...

true content is an encrypted message.

false content is not an encrypted message.

signed String Flag indicating whether content is a signed MIME message.

A value of... Indicates that...

true content is a signed MIME message.

false content is not a signed MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 241

Page 242: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

If you omit index or contentID when retrieving content from a multi-part message, getBodyPartContent returns the payload from the first body part. If you use index or contentID to select a body part that does not exist in mimeData, content will be null.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:addBodyPartpub.mime:getBodyPartHeader

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following services, which reside in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:extract_SimpleMIMEsamples.mime:extract_MultipartMIME

pub.mime:getBodyPartHeaderWmPublic. Returns the list of header fields for the specified body part.

Input Parameters

certsOnly String Flag whose value indicates whether content is a certs-only MIME message.

A value of... Indicates that...

true content is a certs-only message.

false content is not a certs-only message.

mimeData Document MIME object whose message headers you want to retrieve. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData)

index String Optional. Index number of the body part whose header fields you want to retrieve. The first body part is index zero.

Note: If contentID is specified, index is ignored.

contentID String Optional. Value of the Content-ID header field of the body part whose header fields you want to retrieve.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 242

Page 243: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

If you omit index or contentID, getBodyPartHeader returns the message headers from the first body part. If you use index or contentID to select a body part that does not exist in mimeData, content will be null.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:addBodyPartpub.mime:getMimeHeader

decodeHeaders String Conditional. Flag whose value indicates whether to decode encoded headers in the MIME object.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The headers should be decoded.

false Default. The headers should not be decoded.

mimeHeader Document IData object containing the message headers. Key names represent the names of the header fields. The value of a key represents the value of that header field.

For example, if the original message contained the following message header fields:Content-Type: text/xmlX-Doctype: RFQX-Severity: 0

getBodyPartHeader would return the following IData object:

Key Value

Content-Type text/xml

X-Doctype RFQ

X-Severity 0

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 243

Page 244: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:getContentTypeWmPublic. Returns the value of the Content-Type message header from the specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getSubContentTypepub.mime:getPrimaryContentTypepub.mime:getMimeHeaderpub.mime:getBodyPartHeader

pub.mime:getEnvelopeStreamWmPublic. Generates an InputStream representation of a MIME message from a specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

mimeData Document MIME object whose Content-Type you want to discover. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

contentType String Value of the MIME object’s Content-Type header field. Note that this service returns only the media type and subtype portion of this header field’s value. It does not return any parameters the value may include. For example, if the message’s Content-Type header were:

Content-Type: text/plain;charset=UTF8

contentType would contain:text/plain

mimeData Document MIME object from which you want to generate the MIME message. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

index String Optional. Index number of the body part for which you want to generate the MIME message (if you want to generate the message from a specific body part). The first body part is index number zero.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 244

Page 245: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

If you omit index or contentID, getEnvelopeStream generates the MIME message from the entire contents of the mimeData. If you use index or contentID to select a body part that does not exist in mimeData, content will be null.

getEnvelopeStream automatically inserts the MIME-Version and Message-ID message headers into the MIME message it puts into envStream.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:addBodyPartpub.mime:addMimeHeader

contentID String Optional. Value of the Content-ID header field of the body part from which you want to generate the MIME message (if you want to generate the message from a specific body part).

Note: If index is specified, contentID is ignored.

suppressHeaders String List Optional. Names of header fields that are to be omitted from message. You can use this option to exclude header fields that getEnvelopeStream generates by default, such as Content-Type and content-encoding.

createMultipart String Optional. Specifies whether a multipart message is to be created, even if mimeData contains only one body part.

Set to... To...

yes Create a multipart message (Content-Type message header is set to “multipart/mixed”).

no Default. Create a message based on the number of body parts in mimeData.

If the message contains only one body part, Content-Type is set according to the contenttype setting specified when that body part was added to mimeData.

If the message contains multiple body parts, Content-Type is automatically set to “multipart/mixed.”

envStream java.io.InputStream The MIME message as an InputStream.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 245

Page 246: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following services, which reside in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:build_SimpleMIMEsamples.mime:build_MultipartMIME

pub.mime:getMimeHeaderWmPublic. Returns the list of message headers from a specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

mimeData Document MIME object whose message headers you want to retrieve. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

mimeHeader Document Conditional. An IData object containing the message headers. Key names represent the names of the header fields. The value of a key represents the value of the header fields.

For example, if the original message contained the following message header fields:Message-ID: <[email protected]>From: "[email protected]" <[email protected]>To: <[email protected]>MIME-Version: 1.0Content-Type: text/xmlX-Doctype: RFQX-Severity: 0

getMimeHeader would return the following:

Key Value

Message-ID <[email protected]>

From "[email protected]" <[email protected]>

To <[email protected]>

MIME-Version 1.0

Content-Type text/xml

X-Doctype RFQ

X-Severity 0

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 246

Page 247: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:addMimeHeaderpub.mime:getBodyPartHeader

pub.mime:getNumPartsWmPublic. Returns the number of body parts in the specified MIME object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by createMimeData.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getBodyPartContentpub.mime:addBodyPart

Examples

For examples of how to use this service, see the following service, which resides in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site.

samples.mime:extract_MultipartMIME

mimeData Document MIME object whose parts you want to count. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

numParts String The number of body parts in the MIME object.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 247

Page 248: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:getPr imaryContentTypeWmPublic. Returns the top-level portion of a MIME object’s Content-Type value.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getContentTypepub.mime:addMimeHeaderpub.mime:getBodyPartHeader

mimeData Document MIME object whose Content-Type you want to discover. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

primContentType String Message’s top-level Content-Type. For example, if the message’s Content-Type header were:

Content-Type: multipart/mixed

primContentType would contain:multipart

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 248

Page 249: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:getSubContentTypeWmPublic. Returns the sub-type portion of a MIME object’s Content-Type value.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service operates on the MIME object (mimeData) produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guidee.

See Also

pub.mime:createMimeDatapub.mime:getContentTypepub.mime:addMimeHeaderpub.mime:getBodyPartHeader

mimeData Document MIME object whose sub-type you want to discover. (This IData object is produced by pub.mime:createMimeData.)

subContentType String Message’s sub-type. For example, if the message’s Content-Type header were:Content-Type: multipart/mixed

subContentType would contain:mixed

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 249

Page 250: Integration Server Bis Reference

14. MIME Folder

pub.mime:mergeHeaderAndBodyWmPublic. Concatenates the contents of the header and body returned by the pub.client:http service.

You can use this service to reassemble the message into its original form so that it can be used as input to the pub.mime:createMimeData service (or any other service that requires the entire http response as an InputStream).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use this service to merge the results produced by pub.client:http to get the original MIME message.

See Also

pub.client:httppub.mime:createMimeData

headerLines Document IData object containing the message headers returned by pub.client:http. (The message headers are returned in the lines document inside the header output parameter that is produced by pub.client:http.)

body Document IData object containing the body of the message returned by pub.client:http. This document must contain the body of the message in one of the following keys:

Key Description

bytes byte[ ] Optional. Body of the message (if pub.client:http returned the body as a byte[ ]).

stream java.io.InputStream Optional. The body of the message (if pub.client:http returned the body as an InputStream).

stream java.io.InputStream InputStream containing the reassembled http message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 250

Page 251: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 15. Packages Folder

You use the elements in the packages folder to install, load, and/or alter the status of a package on the Integration Server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 251

Page 252: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.packages:act ivatePackageWmPublic. Activates (makes available to clients) an inactive package.

You use this service to activate a package that was not activated when it was initially installed or recovered.

Note: This service activates packages from an inactive state (that is, packages that are installed on the server but are not registered in the active-package list). To enable a package that is in a disabled state, you use pub.packages:enablePackage.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service will throw an exception if the package specified in package does not exist or cannot otherwise be activated.

Element Package and Description

pub.packages:activatePackage WmPublic. Activates (makes available to clients) an inactive package.

pub.packages:disablePackage WmPublic. Disables a package, thus prohibiting access to the services in the package.

pub.packages:enablePackage WmPublic. Enables a package that has been disabled.

pub.packages:installPackage WmPublic. Installs a package that has been published to this server.

pub.packages:recoverPackage WmPublic. Recovers a package that exists in the server’s salvage directory.

pub.packages:reloadPackage WmPublic. Loads a new copy of the package into memory from disk.

package String Name of the package that you want to activate. Package names are case sensitive.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that you receive when you activate a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 252

Page 253: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

When a package is activated, it is loaded into memory in an enabled state (that is, activatePackage automatically activates and enables the package.) You do not need to explicitly enable it with pub.packages:enablePackage.

See Also

pub.packages:enablePackagepub.packages:installPackagepub.packages:recoverPackage

pub.packages:disablePackageWmPublic. Disables a package, thus prohibiting access to the services in the package.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

When a package is disabled, the services in the package are no longer available to the clients. To re-enable a package that has been disabled, use pub.packages:enablePackage.

Important! Never disable the WmRoot package. Doing so would disable the server.

Be aware that if you disable a package while services in the package are being executed, those services will most likely fail. disablePackage does not wait for in-progress services to finish before disabling a package.

This service will throw an exception if the package specified in package does not exist or cannot otherwise be disabled.

See Also

pub.packages:enablePackage

package String Name of the package that you want to disable. Package names are case sensitive.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that you receive when you disable a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 253

Page 254: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

pub.packages:enablePackageWmPublic. Enables a package that has been disabled.

Note: This service enables a package that is in a disabled state (that is, a package that has been disabled through the Integration Server Administrator or the pub.packages:disablePackage service). To activate a package that is in an inactive state, you use enablePackage.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

When you enable a package, the package is reloaded into memory from disk.

This service will throw an exception if the package specified in package does not exist, has not been activated, or cannot otherwise be enabled.

See Also

pub.packages:disablePackagepub.packages:activatePackagepub.packages:reloadPackage

package String Name of the package that you want to enable. Package names are case sensitive.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that you receive when you enable a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 254

Page 255: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

pub.packages: instal lPackageWmPublic. Installs a package that has been published to this server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If the installed package replaces an existing package on the server, installPackage will automatically put a backup copy of the existing package in webMethods6\IntegrationServer\replicate\salvage before it installs the new package.

This service will throw an exception if the file named in packageFile does not exist or cannot otherwise be installed correctly.

See Also

pub.packages:activatePackagepub.packages:recoverPackage

packageFile String Name of the distribution file that contains the package that you want to install. This file must reside in the server’s inbound directory (webMethods6\IntegrationServer\replicate\inbound).

When specifying packageFile,

Do include the .zip extension in the file name.

Do not include the directory path.

For example: myPackageFileAug2001.zip

activateOnInstall String Flag that specifies whether you want the server to automatically activate the package after it is installed.

Set to... To...

yes Activate the package after installation and make it immediately available to clients.

no Install the package without activating it afterwards. If you install a package in this mode, it will not be accessible until it is explicitly activated through the Integration Server Administrator or the pub.packages:activatePackage service.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that is displayed when you install a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 255

Page 256: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

pub.packages:recoverPackageWmPublic. Recovers a package that exists in the server’s salvage directory.

The salvage directory (webMethods6\IntegrationServer\replicate\salvage) is where the server keeps packages that are deleted with the “safe delete” option or replaced with newer installed versions.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You can only recover packages that exist in the server’s salvage directory.

If you recover a package that is currently installed on the server, the package from the salvage directory replaces the version that is currently installed. (Be aware that the server does not retain a copy of the version that it replaces.)

This service will throw an exception if the file named in package does not exist in the server’s salvage directory or cannot otherwise be recovered.

See Also

pub.packages:activatePackage

package String Name of the package that you want to recover. Package names are case sensitive.

activateOnRecover String Flag that specifies whether you want the server to automatically activate the package after it is recovered.

Set to... To...

yes Activate the package after it is recovered and make it immediately available to clients.

no Recover the package without activating it afterwards. If you recover a package in this mode, it will not be accessible until it is explicitly activated through the Integration Server Administrator or the pub.packages:activatePackage service.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that is displayed when you recover a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 256

Page 257: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

pub.packages:reloadPackageWmPublic. Loads a new copy of the package into memory from disk.

If you make changes to the service in a package while the server is running, you must use reloadPackage to put those changes into effect.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Be aware that if you reload a package while services in the package are being executed, those services will most likely fail. reloadPackage does not wait for in-progress services to finish before reloading a package.

This service will throw an exception if the file named in package does not exist or cannot otherwise be reloaded.

package String Name of the package that you want to reload. Package names are case sensitive.

message String Message from server. (This is the same message that is displayed when you reload a package with the Integration Server Administrator.)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 257

Page 258: Integration Server Bis Reference

15. Packages Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 258

Page 259: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 16. PKI Folder

You use the elements in the pki folder to create and verify PKCS#7 signatures with PKI profiles. You also use elements in this folder to create and process S/MIME messages using PKI profiles.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 259

Page 260: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.pki .pkcs7:signWmPKI. Creates a PKCS7 SignedData object using a PKI profile.

This service enables multiple entities to sign the specified data. Each signerInfo block contained in the resulting signature contains two authenticated attributes: the content type and a timestamp.

Note: This service is similar to pub.security.pkcs7:sign except that it uses a PKI profile to create the PKCS7 SignedData object.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.pki.pkcs7:sign WmPKI. Creates a PKCS7 SignedData object using a PKI profile.

pub.pki.pkcs7:verify WmPKI. Processes a digital signature to make sure that the provided data has not been modified.

pub.pki.smime.createSignedAndEncryptedData WmPKI. Digitally signs a MIME message and then encrypts it.

pub.pki.smime.createSignedData WmPKI. Digitally signs a MIME message using a specified PKI profile.

pub.pki.smime:processEncryptedData WmPKI. Decrypts an encrypted S/MIME message using a specified PKI profile.

pub.pki.smime:processSignedData WmPKI. Verifies the signature from a signed S/MIME entity using a specified PKI profile, and then extracts the message from the S/MIME entity.

signerInfo Document List Information about a single signer of the signed data object.

Note: This service accepts only one signerInfo.

Key Description

profileAlias String PKI profile alias used to sign the data. This service retrieves the key from the profile to perform the signing operation and includes the associated public and CA certificates in the signature that it generates.

hashAlgorithm String Optional. The algorithm to use when computing the digest of the provided data (SHA-1 or MD5). The default value is SHA-1.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 260

Page 261: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

Output Parameters

pub.pki .pkcs7:veri fyWmPKI. Processes a digital signature to make sure that the provided data has not been modified.

Note: This service is similar to pub.security.pkcs7:verify except that it uses a PKI profile to obtain the certificate against which to verify the signer’s signature.

Input Parameters

data byte[ ] Data to be digitally signed.

detachedSignature String Flag specifying whether to generate a detached signature. A detached signature does not include the data that was signed.

Set to... To...

true Generate a detached signature.

false Default. Generate an implicit signature (one that includes the signed data).

signature byte[ ] Signature generated from the supplied data. This is a DER-encoded representation of the SignedData object as specified in PKCS#7.

profileAlias String Name of the PKI profile to be used for certificate verification.

signature byte[ ] Signature to use to determine whether the signed data is intact (a DER-encoded representation of the SignedData object as specified in PKCS#7). If you are processing a detached signature, pass the signature in signature. If you are processing an implicit signature, pass the entire signed entity in signature.

data byte[ ] Optional. The data that was signed. If you are processing an implicitly signed message, you do not need to supply data because both the data and the signature reside in signature.

detachedSignature String Flag indicating whether the message has a detached signature.

Key Description

true The message has a detached signature.

false Default. The message has an implicit signature.

signerCertChain byte[ ][ ] Optional. Certificate chains of the parties that signed the message.

Note: If the signers included the certificate chain with the digital signature, you do not need to supply signerCertChain.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 261

Page 262: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

Output Parameters

content byte[ ] Conditional. The data (for example, the document that was originally signed) extracted from an implicit signature. If you are verifying a detached signature, content is not returned.

Note: The extracted data is returned in content even if signature verification fails.

signerInfo Document List Information about the signers. Each document in the list provides the following information about a single signer:

Key Description

certChain java.security.cert.X509Certificate[ ] Certificate chain of the signer. The chain will appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s X.509 certificate in element 0.

timeStamp java.util.Date Time at which the signer signed the data.

trusted String Flag indicating whether the certificate chain presented by the signer is trusted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The chain is trusted.

false The chain is not trusted.

status String Code indicating whether the signatures were successfully verified. If successful, status contains verified. If the signatures were not successfully verified, status contains an error message.

errorMessage String Conditional. If the signatures were not successfully verified, this parameter contains the text “Invalid signer certificate file information.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 262

Page 263: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

pub.pki .smime.createSignedAndEncryptedDataWmPKI. Digitally signs a MIME message and then encrypts it.

Note: This service is similar to pub.smime:createSignedAndEncryptedData except that a PKI profile is used to provide signing key and certificate information.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

envStream java.io.InputStream The MIME message that you want to sign and encrypt (for example, the output produced by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream).

profileAlias String PKI profile alias to use to sign the data. This service retrieves the key from the profile to perform the signing operation and includes the associated public and CA certificates in the signature that it generates.

explicit String Optional. Flag indicating whether an implicit or explicit signature is to be generated.

Set to... To...

true Default. Generate an explicit (detached) signature.

false Generate an implicit signature.

recipientCerts byte[ ][ ] X.509 certificates of the recipients for whom this message will be encrypted. Each element in the list contains the certificate for a single recipient, in the form of a byte array.

Note: For multiple recipients, this service creates a single message that is encrypted for all recipients. It does not create a separate message for each recipient.

encryptionAlg String Optional. Code specifying the encryption algorithm to use. Must be one of the following values:

TripleDESDESRC2

Default is TripleDES

keyLength String Optional. Length of the encryption key for RC2 encryption. Must be one of the following values:

4064128

Default is 128. This parameter is ignored if encryptionAlg is not RC2.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream Signed and encrypted MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 263

Page 264: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

pub.pki .smime.createSignedDataWmPKI. Digitally signs a MIME message using a specified PKI profile.

Note: This service is similar to pub.smime:createSignedData except that a PKI profile supplies signing key and certificate information.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

envStream java.io.InputStream MIME message that you want to sign (for example, the output produced by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream).

profileAlias String PKI profile alias to use to sign the message. This service retrieves the key from the profile to perform the signing operation and includes the associated public and CA certificates in the signature that it generates.

explicit String Optional. Flag indicating whether an implicit or explicit signature is to be generated.

Set to... To...

true Default. Generate an explicit (detached) signature.

false Generate an implicit signature.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream Signed MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 264

Page 265: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

pub.pki .smime:processEncryptedDataWmPKI. Decrypts an encrypted S/MIME message using a specified PKI profile.

Note: This service is similar to pub.smime:processEncryptedData except that a PKI profile supplies signing key and certificate information.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream The encrypted S/MIME entity (for example, the output produced by pub.smime:createEncryptedData).

profileAlias String PKI profile to use to decrypt the message. This service retrieves the decryption key and public encryption certificate from the profile to perform the decryption operation.

mimeData Document MIME object containing the decrypted MIME message.

contentDigest String Message digest of the encrypted content, base64-encoded. (Some sites return this digest to the sender to acknowledge their receipt of the message.)

encrypted String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is encrypted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is encrypted.

false The MIME entity is not encrypted.

signed String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is signed.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is signed.

false The MIME entity is not signed.

certsOnly String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

false The MIME entity is not a certs-only entity.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. The decrypted MIME entity. This parameter is present only when the decrypted entity is an S/MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 265

Page 266: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

pub.pki .smime:processSignedDataWmPKI. Verifies the signature from a signed S/MIME entity using a specified PKI profile, and then extracts the message from the S/MIME entity.

Note: This service is like pub.smime:processSignedData except that a PKI profile supplies the certificates against which the signature is verified.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream Signed MIME entity (for example, the output produced by pub.pki.smime.createSignedData).

profileAlias String PKI profile to use for certificate validation.

signerCertChain byte[ ][ ] Optional. Certificate chain of the party that signed the message. Certificates must appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s certificate in element 0.

The following shows how the elements of a complete chain would appear for a certificate that was issued through two intermediate CAs.

Element Contents

0 Signer’s certificate

1 Intermediary CA Certificate

2 Intermediary CA Certificate

3 Root CA Certificate

Note: If the signer included the certificate chain with the digital signature, you do not need to supply signerCertChain.

mimeData Document MIME object containing the extracted MIME entity.

contentDigest String Message digest (base64-encoded) that processSignedData recalculated.

signerCert java.security.cert.X509Certificate Signer’s X509 certificate.

encrypted String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is encrypted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is encrypted.

false The MIME entity is not encrypted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 266

Page 267: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

signed String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is signed.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is signed.

false The MIME entity is not signed.

certsOnly String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

false The MIME entity is not a certs-only entity.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. Extracted MIME entity. This parameter is present only when the decrypted entity is an S/MIME message.

verify String Flag indicating whether the signature was successfully processed (that is, the signature was successfully verified with the public key supplied by the PKI profile).

A value of... Indicates that...

true Signature processing was successful.

false Signature processing failed. The signature could not be verified because errorCode 1 or 4 occurred (see errorCode below).

trusted String The signer is a trusted entity. For the signer to be trusted, the signer’s certificate or one of its root certificates should be present in the trusted CA directory.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The signer is a trusted entity.

false The signer is not a trusted entity.

errorCode String Conditional. Number indicating what kind of error occurred, if any, while processing the signature. See errorMessage for possible values.

If no error occurred, errorCode is not returned.

errorMessage String Conditional. Textual error message indicating what kind of error occurred, if any, while processing the signature.

errorCode errorMessage

1 Invalid signer certificate chain file information.

4 Signature cannot be verified.

5 Expired certificate chain.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 267

Page 268: Integration Server Bis Reference

16. PKI Folder

Usage Notes

If verify is false, the errorCode and errorMessage values will indicate the error that caused the failure. Note that errorCode values 5 through 7 do not represent signature-verification failures, and therefore do not cause the verify flag to be set to false.

If the extracted entity is signed or encrypted, mimeData will be empty and the extracted entity will reside in stream. You can check the state of the signed and encrypted output variables to determine whether the extracted entity requires additional processing, then pass stream to the processEncryptedData service as necessary.

See Also

pub.smime:processEncryptedDatapub.smime:createSignedData

6 Error in certificate chain.

7 Untrusted certificate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 268

Page 269: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 17. PRT Folder

You use the elements in the prt folder to work with the Process Engine.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 269

Page 270: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.prt:CorrelationService WmPRT. Specification that describes the inputs and outputs required for a correlation service.

pub.prt:ProcessData WmPRT. Document type that describes the structure of the ProcessData section of the pipeline for a process.

pub.prt.admin:changeProcessStatus WmPRT. Terminates the process by broadcasting a request to all servers participating in the process to change the process status.

pub.prt.admin:deleteProcess WmPRT. Deletes from the Process Engine database component the storage information associated with a process, as well as any mappings to correlation IDs.

pub.prt.admin:scanPackage WmPRT. Tells the Process Engine to scan a specified package for new or updated process model version fragments and use these fragments to update its internal model index.

pub.prt.correlate:deleteCorrelation WmPRT. Deletes all mappings between the specified process instance ID and any correlation IDs or conversation IDs.

pub.prt.correlate:establishCorrelation WmPRT. Sets up a correlation between a correlation ID and a process ID or between a conversation ID (for a Trading Networks document) and a process ID.

pub.prt.correlate:lookupCorrelation WmPRT. Returns the process instance ID that is associated with the specified correlation ID or conversation ID. If no association exists, creates a new process instance ID and mapping.

pub.prt.log:logActivityMessages WmPRT. Logs process activity messages to the IS Core Audit Log database.

pub.prt.tn:deleteByCID WmPRT. Deletes a process instance associated with a given conversation ID.

pub.prt.tn:getPIDforCID WmPRT. Returns the process instance ID for a given conversation ID.

pub.prt.tn:getRoleInfo WmPRT. Fetches role information for a specified role in process.

pub.prt.tn:handleBizDoc WmPRT. Sends a Trading Networks BizDocEnvelope (Trading Networks document) to the Process Engine, to allow the document to be processed as part of a business process.

pub.prt.tn:mapCIDtoPID WmPRT. Sets up a mapping between the specified conversation ID and process instance ID.

pub.prt.tn:RoleInfo WmPRT. Document type that describes information maintained for roles in a process.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 270

Page 271: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt :Correlat ionServiceWmPRT. Specification that describes the inputs and outputs required for a correlation service.

A correlation service is associated with one or more steps in a process model version. The Process Engine uses the correlation service associated with a step to route IS documents as inputs into that step to a running instance of the model, where appropriate. For more about correlation services, see the webMethods Designer Online Help.

Input Parameters

ProcessModelID String ID of the process model with which this invocation of the correlation service is involved (for example, P100099FF3).

ProcessModelVersion String Version of the process model with which this invocation of the correlation service is involved.

Note: Because a single correlation service can be associated with steps from more than one process model version, you can use the ProcessModelID and ProcessModelVersion to identify the process model version using the correlation service at run time.

LogicalServer String Name of the logical server that is associated with the step in the process model version with which this invocation of the correlation service is involved. In other words, the name of the logical server on which this correlation service is running (for example, Design_Server).

Because a single correlation service can be used with steps that execute on different servers, you can use LogicalServer to identify the specific server at run time.

ProcessStepID String ID of the step in the process model version with which this invocation of the correlation service is involved (for example, N3).

Because a single correlation service can be associated with multiple steps in a process model version, you can use ProcessStepID to identify the specific step at run time.

DocumentName String Name of this document as used in the process model version (for example, “OrderDocument”).

DocumentType String Name of this document type (for example, “orders.sap:OrderDocument”).

Document Document The document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 271

Page 272: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Output Parameters

pub.prt :ProcessDataWmPRT. Document type that describes the structure of the ProcessData section of the pipeline for a process.

This pipeline is automatically filled in by the Process Engine for every step of a process. The service for that step is executed with this data.

Parameters

See Also

pub.prt.tn:RoleInfo

ProcessCorrelationID String Conditional. An abstract ID that correlates to the actual process instance ID of the running process. For example: “CUSTOMER-0003456977::ORDER-19477593-AR9-1000”. All documents bound for the same instance of the process must return the same correlation ID. Similarly, correlation IDs must be unique across all process instances.

CorrelateAsTN String Conditional. Flag that indicates whether the correlation ID in ProcessCorrelationID is a conversation ID.

A value of... Indicates that...

true ProcessCorrelationID is a Trading Networks conversation ID.

false Default. ProcessCorrelationID is not a Trading Networks conversation ID.

ProcessInstanceID String Process instance ID of the running process.

ProcessIteration String Number of times the process has been restarted (that is, iteration count).

ProcessModelID String Model ID of the process model that the running process is using.

ProcessModelVersion String Model version of the process model that the running process is using.

ProcessStepID String Step ID of the running step in the process.

LogicalServer String Name of the logical server on which the running step was assigned and is executing.

TryCount String The current iteration of the step.

Roles Document Conditional. If this process involves Trading Networks, this will contain information about the roles in the process. The key will be the role name, and the value will be an instance of the pub.prt.tn:RoleInfo IS document type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 272

Page 273: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt .admin:changeProcessStatusWmPRT. Terminates the process by broadcasting a request to all servers participating in the process to change the process status.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Note: If this service runs to completion, it means that the request for a status change has been made. The servers involved handle these requests asynchronously. You can track the status of a process using webMethods Monitor.

Usage Notes

The most typical use of this service is to “fail” a process after handling some unexpected error.

ProcessInstanceID String ID of the process instance that you want to terminate.

ProcessIteration String The iteration of the process instance that you want to terminate.

ProcessModelID String Optional. ID of the process model (ModelID) to terminate.

ProcessModelVersion String Optional. Version of the process model to terminate.

Action String Termination code that is to be broadcast. Indicates how the process was terminated.

Set to... To...

CANCEL Quit with a status of “cancelled”, indicating that the process was intentionally terminated.

FAIL Indicate that some abnormal error condition dictates that the process must terminate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 273

Page 274: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt .admin:deleteProcessWmPRT. Deletes from the Process Engine database component the storage information associated with a process, as well as any mappings to correlation IDs.

The system automatically deletes most storage information when the process has finished running, but it does not delete correlation and conversation IDs. These must be deleted manually using this service. In general, you should not delete these IDs unless you want to re-use them across processes. However, webMethods strongly recommends that each ID be unique, and thus that you not re-use them across processes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Using this service to delete storage information for a running process will produce unpredictable results.

See Also

pub.prt.tn:deleteByCID

pub.prt .admin:scanPackageWmPRT. Tells the Process Engine to scan a specified package for new or updated process model version fragments and use these fragments to update its internal model index.

This service updates the Process Engine index as follows:

If a fragment file is new, scanPackage adds information from this file to the Process Engine index.

If a fragment file is modified, scanPackage replaces existing index information to reflect the modifications.

If a fragment file no longer exists, scanPackage deletes the corresponding index information.

ProcessInstanceID String ID of the process instance for which you want to delete storage information.

success String Flag indicating whether the process storage information was deleted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The process storage information was deleted.

false The process storage information was not deleted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 274

Page 275: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use this service before or after replicating a package that contains Process Engine process model version fragments to accomplish the following:

After unzipping a package onto a new server but before enabling it, invoke this service to force the Process Engine to pick up the new fragments.

After disabling all related process model versions, zipping a package, and deleting the package from an old server, invoke this service to force the Process Engine to discard information about the old model version.

Package String Name of the package that you want to scan. If the named package does not exist on the Integration Server, information about any fragments previously loaded from that package will be deleted from the Process Engine model index.

ExistingFragments String List Conditional. Number of fragments contained in the package that were already known to the Process Engine.

ModifiedFragments String List Conditional. Number of fragments contained in the package that had been modified since the Process Engine last read them.

MissingFragments String List Conditional. Number of fragments contained in the package that have been deleted since the Process Engine last read them.

NewFragments String List Conditional. Number of fragments contained in the package that are new since the Process Engine last scanned the named package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 275

Page 276: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt .correlate:deleteCorrelat ionWmPRT. Deletes all mappings between the specified process instance ID and any correlation IDs or conversation IDs.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use this service with care. Deleting correlation mappings for running process instances could have unpredictable results.

pub.prt .correlate:establ ishCorrelat ionWmPRT. Sets up a correlation between a correlation ID and a process ID or between a conversation ID (for a Trading Networks document) and a process ID.

Input Parameters

ProcessInstanceID String Process instance ID for the mapping(s) you want to delete.

success String Flag indicating whether any mappings were deleted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true One or more mappings were deleted.

false No mappings were deleted.

ProcessCorrelationID String The correlation ID or conversation ID that you want to map to the specified process instance ID.

ProcessInstanceID String Process instance ID that you want to map to the specified correlation ID or conversation ID.

MappingType String Optional. Flag indicating the type of ID that you supplied.

Set to... To indicate that...

IS Default. This is a correlation ID.

TN This is a Trading Networks conversation ID.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 276

Page 277: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The Process Engine automatically establishes these mappings when Trading Networks or IS documents are used to start processes, or when a Trading Networks document is output from a running process. Use this service when there is no way for the Process Engine to determine the mapping itself (for example, when a process starts with an IS document and then waits for a Trading Networks document).

Use this service with care. Be sure to create correct mappings; an invalid mapping could prevent other processes from completing successfully.

pub.prt .correlate: lookupCorrelat ionWmPRT. Returns the process instance ID that is associated with the specified correlation ID or conversation ID. If no association exists, creates a new process instance ID and mapping.

Input Parameters

success String Flag indicating whether the mapping took place.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The mapping was successfully established.

false The mapping could not be established.

ProcessCorrelationID String Correlation ID or conversation ID for which you want to return the process instance ID.

MappingType String Optional. Flag indicating whether ProcessCorrelationID specifies a correlation ID or a conversation ID.

Set to... To indicate that...

IS Default. ProcessCorrelationID is a correlation ID for an IS document.

TN ProcessCorrelationID is a Trading Networks conversation ID for a Trading Networks document.

CreateIfMissing String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want a mapping to be created if none is found.

Set to... To...

true Create a new process instance ID and mapping if none is found.

false Default. Take no action if the mapping is not found.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 277

Page 278: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use this service to check on mappings that were established with previous calls to pub.prt.correlate:establishCorrelation or, under certain circumstances, to check on the existence of a process with a particular correlation ID or conversation ID.

See Also

pub.prt.correlate:establishCorrelation

ProcessInstanceID String Conditional. The process instance ID mapped to the specified correlation ID or conversation ID (if any).

Created String Conditional. Flag that indicates whether the process instance ID in ProcessInstanceID was created by this service invocation because you specified true for CreateIfMissing.

A value of... Indicates that...

true This process instance ID was created by this service invocation.

false This process instance ID was already mapped to the specified correlation ID or conversation ID.

success String Flag indicating whether a process instance ID was returned.

A value of... Indicates that...

true A process instance ID was found or created and returned.

false A process instance ID was not returned because the correlation ID or conversation ID was not established.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 278

Page 279: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt . log: logAct iv i tyMessagesWmPRT. Logs process activity messages to the IS Core Audit Log database.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service can be added either to the flow service generated for a process step or to services called within that step. The service logs the input parameters to the WMSERVICEACTIVITYLOG log file in the IS Core Audit Log database. Logged activity messages can be viewed in webMethods Monitor on the Process Instance Status and Service Details pages. For more information about viewing activity messages in webMethods Monitor, see the webMethods Monitor documentation.

FullMessage String Optional. Complete message to record in the IS Core Audit Log database. The message can be up to 1024 bytes.

BriefMessage String Optional. Shortened version of the full message. The message can be up to 240 bytes.

EntryType String Flag indicating the type of message.

Set to... To...

Message Indicate that the message is informational and no action is needed.

Warning Indicate that the message is a warning message. The process can complete successfully even if the circumstance causing the warning is not addressed.

Error Default. Indicate that the message is an error message. The process cannot complete successfully until the circumstance causing the error is resolved.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 279

Page 280: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt . tn:deleteByCIDWmPRT. Deletes a process instance associated with a given conversation ID.

Use this service to delete process state for processes that involve webMethods Trading Networks and for which you have a conversation ID rather than a process ID.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service invokes pub.prt.correlate:lookupCorrelation to look up the mapped ProcessInstanceID and invokes pub.prt.admin:deleteProcess to delete the process state information.

Using this service to delete state of a running process will produce unpredictable results.

See Also

pub.prt.admin:deleteProcess

pub.prt . tn:getPIDforCIDWmPRT. Returns the process instance ID for a given conversation ID.

Use this service within a process that involves webMethods Trading Networks when you have a conversation ID but need the corresponding process instance ID. This service is a wrapper around pub.prt.correlate:lookupCorrelation.

Input Parameters

ConversationID String Conversation ID for the process instance for which you want to delete process state information.

success String Flag indicating whether the process state was deleted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The process state was deleted.

false The process state was not deleted.

ConversationID String Conversation ID for which you want the associated process instance ID.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 280

Page 281: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.prt.tn:mapCIDtoPID

pub.prt . tn:getRoleInfoWmPRT. Fetches role information for a specified role in process.

Use this service within processes that involve webMethods Trading Networks.

The returned information includes the internal ID of the partner within the Trading Networks system, which you can use to retrieve the Trading Networks profile information.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.prt.tn:RoleInfopub.prt:ProcessData

ProcessInstanceID String Conditional. The process instance ID related to the specified conversation ID (if there is one).

success String Flag indicating whether the process ID was retrieved.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The process ID was retrieved.

false The process ID was not retrieved.

ProcessData Document The ProcessData portion of the pipeline, which is standard information available for all processes. The structure of this document (IData object) is defined by pub.prt:ProcessData.

roleName String Name of the role for which you want to retrieve information.

roleInfo Document Conditional. Role information that is currently available for the specified role. The structure of this document (IData object) is defined by pub.prt.tn:RoleInfo. This parameter is not present if no documents have been sent to or received for this role.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 281

Page 282: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt . tn:handleBizDocWmPRT. Sends a Trading Networks BizDocEnvelope (Trading Networks document) to the Process Engine, to allow the document to be processed as part of a business process.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Trading Networks automatically sends documents to the Process Engine if it extracts a conversation ID from the document. If you did not have Trading Networks extract a conversation ID, you can use this service to supply a conversation ID and send the document to the Process Engine to be processed as part of a business process.

bizdoc com.wm.app.tn.doc.BizDocEnvelope Trading Networks BizDocEnvelope document that you want to send to the Process Engine.

ConversationID String Optional. Conversation ID for the document. Specify ConversationID if the document has no conversation ID or if you want to use an alternate conversation ID.

ProcessModelID String Optional. ID of the process model that you want the Process Engine to use to process the document.

ProcessModelVersion String Optional. Version of the process model that you want the Process Engine to use to process the document.

Note: Specifying ProcessModelID and ProcessModelVersion overrides the normal process of matching a document to a process model version.

prtIgnoreDocument String Optional. A flag indicating whether this document is to be ignored or processed by the Process Engine.

Set to... To...

true Ignore the document and not send it to the Process Engine for processing. Setting the flag to true causes this service to do nothing.

false Send the document to the Process Engine for processing.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 282

Page 283: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

pub.prt . tn:mapCIDtoPIDWmPRT. Sets up a mapping between the specified conversation ID and process instance ID.

This service is a wrapper around pub.prt.correlate:establishCorrelation.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Note: If this service runs to completion, the mapping has been established.

Usage Notes

The Process Engine automatically establishes this mapping when a Trading Networks document (bizdoc) is used to start a process or is modeled as an output from a process step. Use this service when there is no way for the Process Engine to determine the mapping itself (for example, when a process is started with a non-Trading Networks document and later waits for a Trading Networks document).

Use this service with care. Be sure to create correct conversation ID to process instance ID mappings; an invalid mapping could prevent other processes from completing successfully.

See Also

pub.prt.tn:getPIDforCID

pub.prt . tn:RoleInfoWmPRT. Document type that describes information maintained for roles in a process.

Parameters

ConversationID String Conversation ID that you want to map to the specified process instance ID.

ProcessInstanceID String Process instance ID that you want to map to the specified conversation ID.

success String Flag indicating whether the mapping was established.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The mapping was established.

false The mapping was not established.

ProfileID String Trading Networks internal ID of this trading partner.

String Corporation name that is specified in the Trading Networks profile for this trading partner.

CorporationName

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 283

Page 284: Integration Server Bis Reference

17. PRT Folder

OrgUnitName String Organizational unit name that is specified in the Trading Networks profile for this trading partner.

Type String The type of software the partner uses to connect to the trading network.

A value of... Indicates that...

TNServer The partner is using webMethods Trading Networks.

TNPartner The partner is using webMethods for Partners.

Browser The partner is using a Web browser.

TNPartner The partner is using some other method.

Status String Status (active or inactive) of the Trading Networks profile for this trading partner.

PreferredProtocol String The delivery protocol that the partner prefers you to use when sending documents to it.

A value of... Indicates that...

ftp1 The partner prefers documents sent using the primary FTP protocol.

ftp2 The partner prefers documents sent using the secondary FTP protocol.

http1 The partner prefers documents sent using the primary HTTP protocol.

http2 The partner prefers documents sent using the secondary HTTP protocol.

https1 The partner prefers documents sent using the primary HTTPS protocol.

https2 The partner prefers documents sent using the secondary HTTPS protocol.

smtp1 The partner prefers documents sent using the primary e-mail protocol.

smtp2 The partner prefers documents sent using the secondary e-mail protocol.

null The partner prefers documents sent using the polling protocol.

LastSendingLocale String Locale associated with the last transmission from this trading partner. Whenever a document is received from this trading partner, this field is updated with the locale information specified in the transmission. For example, if the trading partner uses HTTP to post an XML document to a Trading Networks server and specifies the “ja_JA” locale in the HTTP transmission, this field will contain ja_JA.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 284

Page 285: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 18. Publ ish Folder

You use the elements in the publish folder to publish documents to other Integration Servers via webMethods Broker.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 285

Page 286: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.publish:deliver WmPublic. Delivers a document to a specific destination.

pub.publish:deliverAndWait WmPublic. Requests a reply document from a specific client. The service waits for the reply or indicates that the pub.publish:waitForReply service should retrieve the reply later.

pub.publish:documentResolverSpec WmPublic. Specification for the signature of a service that determines whether a document’s status is New, Duplicate, or In Doubt.

pub.publish:envelope WmPublic. Document type that defines the content and structure of the envelope that accompanies a published document.

pub.publish:getRedeliveryCount WmPublic. Retrieves the redelivery count for a document.

pub.publish:publish WmPublic. Publishes a document locally or to the Broker.

pub.publish:publishAndWait WmPublic. Broadcasts a request for a document from any client subscribed to a specific document type. The service waits for the reply or indicates that the pub.publish:waitForReply service should retrieve the reply later.

pub.publish:reply WmPublic. Delivers a reply document to the requesting client.

pub.publish:waitForReply WmPublic. Retrieves the reply for an asynchronous request. If a reply is not available, the Integration Server continues to wait for the document until the time specified in the waitTime parameter of the pub.publish:deliverAndWait or pub.publish:publishAndWait service elapses.

pub.publish.notification:error WmPublic. Publishable document type that defines the document that the Integration Server generates and delivers when a trigger encounters an error or exception condition during processing.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 286

Page 287: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish:del iverWmPublic. Delivers a document to a specific destination.

Note: You must be connected to a Broker to use this service.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To view a list of client IDs on the Broker, use the Broker Administrator or use Developer to test the publishable document type that you want to deliver.

For more information about how the Integration Server and Broker deliver documents and for information about building a service that delivers a document, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type being delivered.

The publishable document type must be synchronized with the associated Broker document type. If the document types are not synchronized, publication fails.

document Document Document (IData object) conforming to the publishable document type in documentTypeName.

destId String The client ID to which the document will be delivered. You can specify the default client ID for an Integration Server, or you can specify the client ID for an individual trigger. If you specify an incorrect client ID, the Integration Server delivers the document to the Broker, but the Broker never delivers the document to the intended recipient and no error is produced.

delayUntilServiceSuccess String Optional. Flag indicating whether the Integration Server should publish the document when the pub.publish:deliver service executes or after the top-level service successfully completes. If the top-level service fails, the Integration Server will not publish the document.

Set to... To...

true Delay publishing until after the top-level service executes successfully.

false Default. Publish the document when the pub.publish:deliver service executes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 287

Page 288: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

If outbound client-side queuing is disabled (the watt.server.publish.useCSQ property is set to “never”), Integration Server throws a ServiceException if the Broker is not available when this service executes. Make sure to code your service to handle this situation.

See Also

pub.publish:publishpub.publish:deliverAndWaitpub.publish:envelope

pub.publ ish:del iverAndWaitWmPublic. Requests a reply document from a specific client. The service waits for the reply or indicates that the pub.publish:waitForReply service should retrieve the reply later.

Note: You must be connected to a Broker to use this service.

Input Parameters

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type being delivered.

Note: The publishable document type must be synchronized with the associated Broker document type. If the document types are not synchronized, publication fails.

document Document Document (IData object) conforming to the publishable document type in documentTypeName.

receiveDocumentTypeName String Optional. Fully qualified name of the publishable document type expected as a reply. If no value is specified, the service uses the first reply document of any type it receives, as long as the value of tag in the envelope of the reply document matches the tag in the envelope of the published document. All other reply documents are discarded.

destId String The client ID to which the document will be delivered. You can specify the default client ID for an Integration Server, or you can specify the client ID for an individual trigger. If you specify an incorrect client ID, the Integration Server delivers the document to the Broker, but the Broker never delivers the document to the intended recipient and no error is produced.

waitTime String Optional. Specifies the time to wait (in milliseconds) for the response to arrive. If no value is specified, the service waits indefinitely until it receives a reply.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 288

Page 289: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Output Parameters

async String Optional. Flag specifying whether this is an asynchronous or synchronous request/reply.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that this is an asynchronous request/reply. After publishing the document, the Integration Server executes the next step in the flow service immediately. The Integration Server does not wait for a reply before continuing service execution.

Note: To retrieve the reply to an asynchronous request, invoke the pub.publish:waitForReply service.

false Default. Indicate that this is a synchronous request/reply. After publishing the document, the Integration Server waits for a reply before executing the next step in the flow service.

receivedDocument Document A Document (IData object) received as reply.

Important! The Integration Server treats all reply documents as volatile documents. If the Integration Server shuts down before processing the reply document, the reply document is lost.

tag String Conditional. A unique identifier for a deliver request. The Integration Server uses the tag value to match the requesting document with its corresponding reply document.

The service produces a tag output value only when the async field is set to true. The tag value is required input when using the pub.publish:waitForReply service to retrieve the reply.

Note: The tag output value is the same value that the Integration Server places in the tag field of the request document’s envelope.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 289

Page 290: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Usage Notes

You can use the pub.publish:deliverAndWait service to initiate and continue a private conversation between two Broker clients. This is a variation of the request/reply model. One client executes a service that delivers a document to a specific client. This document requests information from the receiving client.

In a synchronous request/reply, the delivering service stops executing while it waits for a response. When the service receives a reply document from the specified client, the servers resumes executing. If the waitTime elapses before the service receives a reply, the Integration Server ends the request, and the service returns a null document indicating that the request timed out. The Integration Server then executes the next step in the flow service. If a reply document arrives after the flow service resumes execution, the Integration Server rejects the document and creates a journal log message stating that the document was rejected because there is no service thread waiting for the document.

In an asynchronous request/reply, the delivering service continues executing the steps in the service after publishing the document. To retrieve the reply, the delivering service must invoke the pub.publish:waitForReply service. If the wait time elapses before the pub.publish:waitForReply service receives a document, the pub.publish:waitForReply service returns a null document indicating that the request timed out.

A service that contains multiple asynchronous deliver requests allows the service to deliver all the requests before collecting the replies. This approach can be more efficient than delivering a request, waiting for a reply, and then delivering the next request.

If you create a service that contains multiple asynchronous requests, make sure to link the tag output to another field in the pipeline. Each asynchronous delivery produces a tag field in the pipeline. If the tag field is not linked to another field, the next asynchronous delivery request (that is, the next execution of the pub.publish:deliverAndWait service) will overwrite the first tag value.

To view a list of client IDs on the Broker, use the Broker Administrator or use Developer to test the publishable document type that you want to deliver.

Use pub.publish:deliverAndWait if you need to know that a specific client successfully received and processed the request document.

For more information about how to build a services that initiate synchronous or asynchronous request/reply scenarios, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

If outbound client-side queuing is disabled (the watt.server.publish.useCSQ property is set to “never”), Integration Server throws a ServiceException if the Broker is not available when this service executes. Make sure to code your service to handle this situation.

See Also

pub.publish:waitForReplypub.publish:publishAndWaitpub.publish:replypub.publish:envelope

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 290

Page 291: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish:documentResolverSpecWmPublic. Specification for the signature of a service that determines whether a document’s status is New, Duplicate, or In Doubt.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the document whose status is In Doubt.

redeliveryCount String Number of times the document has been redelivered to the trigger queue on the Integration Server.

uuid String Universally unique identifier for the document. The publishing application assigns the uuid to a document.

document Document The document (IData object) whose status needs to be resolved. This document must conform to the publishable document type specified in documentTypeName.

transport String The transport (such as LOCAL or BROKER) used to send the document to the Integration Server.

triggerName String The name of the trigger that received the document whose status needs to be resolved.

status String Indicates the status of the document. The value of this field determines whether the Integration Server processes the document, discards the document, or sends the document to the audit log. The status field must have one of the following values.

Key Description

NEW Indicates the document is new and has not been processed by the trigger. The Integration Server instructs the trigger to process the document.

DUPLICATE Indicates the document is a duplicate of one already processed by the trigger. The Integration Server discards the document and generates a journal log message.

IN_DOUBT Indicates the status of the document is still in doubt. The document resolver service could not conclusively determine whether the trigger already processed the document. If the audit log is a database, the audit subsystem logs the document and the Integration Server generates a journal log message.

message String Conditional. A user-specified string that indicates why the document status is DUPLICATE or IN_DOUBT. The Integration Server writes the message to the journal log when the server discards the document or routes it to the audit log.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 291

Page 292: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Usage Notes

The pub.publish:documentResolverSpec must be used as the signature for any service used to resolve the processing status of a document. For information about building a document resolver service and enabling exactly once processing for a trigger, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

pub.publ ish:envelopeWmPublic. Document type that defines the content and structure of the envelope that accompanies a published document.

The envelope records information such as the sender’s address, the time the document was sent, password and certificate information, and other useful information for routing and control. Every publishable document type contains a document reference to this document type.

Read/Write Parameters

You can set the following parameters within your service.

activation String Optional. A unique identifier that any Broker client (including the Integration Server) assigns to all documents published as a result of the one-time execution of the integration solution. If a document does not have an activation ID, the Integration Server assigns one when the document is published.

If you are using a trigger to join documents published by different services, you must explicitly set the activation ID of the documents. The services that publish the documents must assign the same activation ID to the documents.

appLastSeqn java.lang.Integer Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

appPassword String Optional. The password of the user specified in appUserName. If the resource that processes the document requires authentication before it begins processing, specify the password in this field.

appSeqn java.lang.Integer Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

appUserName String Optional. The user name for logging into the application that processes the document. Use the appPassword field to specify the password for this user name.

businessContext String Optional. Used by the Integration Server to track business process context and audit context across multiple Integration Servers.

Important! The businessContext field is reserved for internal use by the webMethods Integration Server. Do not set or overwrite the value of the businessContext field.

controlLabel java.lang.Short[ ] Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

errorsTo String Optional. The client ID to which the Integration Server sends an error notification document if errors occur during document processing by subscribers. If this parameter is not set, error notifications will be sent to the document publisher. The errors document is an instance of pub.publish.notification:error.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 292

Page 293: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Read-only Parameters

The Broker or Integration Server set the following parameters. You cannot set these parameters within your service, but you can retrieve their values.

errorRequestsTo String Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

locale String Optional. Locale of the publishing client expressed as a URN (Uniform Resource Name). Trigger services examine the locale value to determine the locale to use when processing the document. If the locale field is empty, the locale of the current Integration Server is used instead.

maxResults java.lang.Integer Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

replyTo String Optional. The client ID to which the replies to the published document should be sent. If this parameter is not set, replies will be sent to the document publisher as specified in pubId.

runLevel java.lang.Integer Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

signature byte[ ] Optional. A byte sequence that holds a digital signature. Specify a digital signature if clients receiving this document requires one.

signatureType String Optional. The type of digital signature being used.

startResult java.lang.Integer Optional. This field is provided for backward compatibility.

tag java.lang.Integer Optional. Used with pub.publish:publishAndWait and pub.publish:deliverAndWait to match a request document with its corresponding reply document.

Important! The tag field is reserved for internal use by the webMethods Integration Server. Do not set or overwrite the value of the tag field in the envelope.

trackId String Optional. A unique identifier assigned to a published document by the publishing client application. If no value is specified, Integration Server populates this field with the value of the uuid field.

transactionId String Optional. This field is provided for backwards compatibility.

transformState String Optional. An indication of a document’s current state, set by a publishing client application that transforms data. For example, a client could publish a document with a transformState value of “USEnglish” and a receiving client could translate the document into French and publish it with a transformState value of “French.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 293

Page 294: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

age java.lang.Integer Optional. The cumulative time, in seconds, that the document spends on all Brokers. The Broker starts tracking the document age when it receives the document from the publishing client. The Broker stops tracking the document age when the subscribing client removes the document from the client queue. If the document is routed to successive Brokers, age also includes the length of time the document spends on the other Brokers.

connectionIntegrity String Optional. An indication of whether the received document passed over a link that is not secure. This field can have one of the following values:

Key Description

<empty> At some point, the document passed through a connection that was not encrypted.

U.S Export All the connections used to transport the event had an encryption strength of ENCRYPT_LEVEL_US_EXPORT or greater.

U.S. Domestic The event traveled exclusively over connections with an encryption strength of ENCRYPT_LEVEL_US_DOMESTIC.

destId String Optional. The ID of the client to which the document is being delivered. The publishing client sets the destID when it publishes the document. For example, the Integration Server uses the destID value specified in the pub.publish:deliver service or the pub.publish:deliverAndWait service to populate the destID value in the document envelope

enqueueTime java.util.Date Optional. The date and time that the Broker placed the document into the client queue.

logBroker String Optional. The name of the Broker that contains the document in its document log. The Broker sets this parameter when Broker-based document logging and the logging utility are enabled.

logHost String Optional. The host name and port number of the Broker that contains the document in its document log. The Broker sets this parameter when Broker-based document logging and the logging utility are enabled.

pubDistinguishedName String Optional. The distinguished name of the publisher’s SSL certificate. The Broker sets this parameter when the publisher has an SSL connection to the Broker and clears this parameter when the publisher has a non-SSL connection.

pubId String Optional. The client ID of the document’s publisher. If the publishing client is connected to a different Broker than the recipient, the Broker uses the fully qualified client ID (that is, the Broker prefixes the client ID with the name of the publisher’s Broker). You can use the Integration Server Administrator to view the client ID for an Integration Server. You can use the Broker Administrator to view the client IDs for all clients connected to a Broker.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 294

Page 295: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

For more information about setting and using a document’s envelope parameters, see the webMethods Broker Client Java API Reference Guide, the webMethods Broker Client C API Programmer’s Guide, Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide, and the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

See Also

pub.publish:deliverpub.publish:deliverAndWaitpub.publish:publishpub.publish:publishAndWaitpub.publish:publishAndWaitpub.publish.notification:error

pubNetAddr byte[ ] Optional. The IP address and port number of the document’s publisher.

pubSeqn java.lang.Long Optional. This field is provided for backwards compatibility.

pubLabel java.lang.Short[ ] Optional. This field is provided for backwards compatibility.

recvTime java.util.Date Optional. The date and time the document was received by the Broker.

route Document List Optional. Information about the Brokers through which a document passed. When a Broker receives a document, the Broker sets the broker and recvTime keys. When the Broker places the document in the queue for the next Broker, the first Broker sets enqueueTime. The Broker only sets these fields when document is forwarded from one Broker to another. The Broker does not set these fields when the publishing and receiving clients are connected to the same Broker.

Key Description

broker String Optional. The name of the Broker.

recvTime java.util.Date Optional. The time the Broker received the document from the publishing client or another Broker.

enqueueTime java.util.Date Optional. The time the Broker placed the document in the queue for the next Broker.

uuid String Optional. Universally unique identifier for the document. The Integration Server assigns the UUID when it publishes the document. The receiving Integration Server uses the UUID to detect duplicate documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 295

Page 296: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish:getRedel iveryCountWmPublic. Retrieves the redelivery count for a document.

The redelivery count indicates the number of times the document has been redelivered to the trigger queue on the Integration Server. A document is redelivered to a trigger queue if the Integration Server shuts down before processing and acknowledging the document.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If you do not want to use the exactly once processing capabilities Developer provides, you can invoke the pub.publish:getRedeliveryCount service within your trigger service. The redelivery count for a document can provide an initial indication of whether the Integration Server has already processed the document.

The Integration Server retrieves the redelivery count for the document currently maintained in the invoke state. That is, the Integration Server retrieves the redelivery count for the document that caused the trigger service to execute.

When a trigger service satisfied by an All (AND) join condition invokes pub.publish:getRedliveryCount, the pub.publish:getRedeliveryCount service returns the redelivery count for the last document received by the join. For example, suppose that documents A and B satisfied an All (AND) join condition. If the Integration Server receives document A first and document B second, when pub.publish:getRedliveryCount executes, it retrieves the redelivery count for document B.

redeliveryCount String Specifies the number of times the trigger queue on the Integration Server has received the document. The redelivery count can be one of the following:

Value Description

-1 Indicates the transport used to send the document does not maintain a document redelivery count. For example, a document received from a Broker version 6.0.1 has a redelivery count of -1. (Brokers that are version 6.0.1 or earlier do not maintain document redelivery counts.)

The Integration Server document may or may not have received the document before.

0 Indicates the document has been received only once.

> 0 Indicates the number of times document has been redelivered.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 296

Page 297: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish:publ ishWmPublic. Publishes a document locally or to the Broker.

This service broadcasts the document (that is, distributes the document to all clients that subscribe to it).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If outbound client-side queuing is disabled (the watt.server.publish.useCSQ property is set to “never”), Integration Server throws a ServiceException if the Broker is not available when this service executes. Make sure to code your service to handle this situation.

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type being published.

If you intend to publish the document to the Broker, the publishable document type must be in sync with the associated Broker document type. If the document types are not synchronized, publication fails.

document Document Document (IData object) conforming to the document type in documentTypeName.

local String Optional. Flag specifying whether the document is to be published locally or to the Broker.

Set to... To...

true Publish locally (to this Integration Server only).

false Default. Publish to the Broker connected to this Integration Server.

If no Broker is configured for the Integration Server, all publishes become local (that is, the local flag is set implicitly to true).

delayUntilServiceSuccess String Optional. Flag indicating whether the publish should happen when the pub.publish:publish service executes or after the top-level service successfully completes. If the top-level service fails, the Integration Server will not publish the document.

Set to... To...

true Delay publishing until after the top-level service executes successfully.

false Default. Publish the document when the publish service executes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 297

Page 298: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

For more information about building a service that publishes a document locally or to the Broker, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.publish:deliverpub.publish:publishAndWaitpub.publish:envelope

pub.publ ish:publ ishAndWaitWmPublic. Broadcasts a request for a document from any client subscribed to a specific document type. The service waits for the reply or indicates that the pub.publish:waitForReply service should retrieve the reply later.

Input Parameters

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type being published.

If you intend to publish the document to the Broker, the publishable document type must be in sync with the associated Broker document type. If the document types are not synchronized, publication fails.

document Document Document (IData object) conforming to the document type in documentTypeName.

receiveDocumentTypeName String Optional. Fully qualified name of the document type expected as a reply. If no value is specified, the service uses the first reply document of any type it receives, as long as the value of tag in the reply document envelope matches the tag in the envelope of the published document. All other reply documents are discarded.

local String Optional. Flag specifying whether the document is to be published locally or to the Broker.

Set to... To...

true Publish locally (to this Integration Server only).

false Default. Publish to the Broker attached to this Integration Server.

If no Broker is configured for the Integration Server, all publishes become local (that is, the local flag is set implicitly to true).

waitTime String Optional. Time to wait (in milliseconds) for the response to arrive. If no value is specified, the service waits indefinitely for a reply.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 298

Page 299: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You can use the pub.publish:publishAndWait service to initiate a request/reply. The publishing client broadcasts a request for information. Subscribers to the broadcast document compose and send a reply document that contains the information the publisher requested.

A single publish and wait request might receive many response documents. The Integration Server that made the publish and wait request uses only the first reply document it receives from the Broker.

async String Optional. Flag specifying whether this is an asynchronous or synchronous publish.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that this is an asynchronous request/reply. After publishing the document, the Integration Server executes the next step in the flow service immediately. The Integration Server does not wait for a reply before continuing service execution.

Note: To retrieve the reply to an asynchronous publish, invoke the pub.publish:waitForReply service.

false Default. Indicate that this is a synchronous request/reply. After publishing the document, the Integration Server waits for a reply before executing the next step in the flow service.

receivedDocument Document Document (IData object) received as response. If no matching document is received within the wait time, this will be null.

Important! The Integration Server treats all reply documents as volatile documents. If the Integration Server shuts down before processing the reply document, the reply document is lost.

tag String Conditional. A unique identifier for a publish request. The Integration Server uses the tag value to match the request document with its corresponding reply document.

The service produces a tag output value only when the async field is set to true. The tag value is required input when using the pub.publish:waitForReply service to retrieve the reply.

Note: The tag output value is the same value that the Integration Server places in the tag field of the request document’s envelope.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 299

Page 300: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

The Integration Server discards all other replies. First is arbitrarily defined. There is no guarantee provided for the order in which the Broker processes incoming replies. If you need a reply document from a specific client, use the pub.publish:deliverAndWait service instead.

The publishAndWait service can be useful in situations where multiple sources contain the response data. For example, suppose that an enterprise uses one application for managing customer data, another for storing master customer records, and a mainframe system for saving customer lists. Each of these applications could answer a published request for customer data. The publishing service will use the first reply document it receives.

A service can issue a publish and wait request in a synchronous or asynchronous manner.

In a synchronous request/reply, the publishing flow service stops executing while it waits for a response. When the service receives a reply document, the service resumes execution. If the waitTime elapses before the service receives a reply, the Integration Server ends the request, and the service returns a null document that indicates that the request timed out. The Integration Server then executes the next step in the flow service. If a reply document arrives after the flow service resumes execution, the Integration Server rejects the document and creates a journal log message stating that the document was rejected because there was no thread waiting for the document.

In an asynchronous request/reply, the publishing flow service continues executing the steps in the service after publishing the document. To retrieve the reply, the publishing flow service must invoke the pub.publish:waitForReply service. If the wait time elapses before the pub.publish:waitForReply service receives a document, the pub.publish:waitForReply service returns a null document indicating that the request timed out.

A service that contains multiple asynchronous publish and wait invocations allows the service to publish all the requests before collecting the replies. This approach can be more efficient than publishing a request, waiting for a reply, and then publishing the next request.

If you create a service that contains multiple asynchronous requests, make sure to link the tag output to another field in the pipeline. Each asynchronously published request produces a tag field in the pipeline. If the tag field is not linked to another field, the next asynchronously published request (that is, the next execution of the pub.publish:publishAndWait service) will overwrite the first tag value.

For more information about building a service that follows the request/reply model, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

If outbound client-side queuing is disabled (the watt.server.publish.useCSQ property is set to “never”), Integration Server throws a ServiceException if the Broker is not available when this service executes. Make sure to code your service to handle this situation.

See Also

pub.publish:waitForReplypub.publish:replypub.publish:envelope

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 300

Page 301: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish:replyWmPublic. Delivers a reply document to the requesting client.

If the replyTo envelope parameter is set, the reply document is delivered to that destination; otherwise, the reply document is sent to the client ID of the publisher specified in the envelope’s pubId field. This service also correctly maps the required fields from the request document to the reply document.

Note: All reply documents are volatile documents. If the requesting Integration Server shuts down before processing the reply document, the reply document is lost.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

A reply document can be a simple acknowledgment, or it can contain information asked for by the publisher of the request document.

receivedDocumentEnvelope Document Optional. The envelope of the document to which you are replying. By default receivedDocumentEnvelope specifies the envelope of the document that triggered this service. (In case of a join, it will specify the last document that satisfied the join condition.) However, you may specify the envelope of any published document to which you want to reply.

documentTypeName String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type for the document that you are sending as a reply. Keep in mind that the publisher of the requesting document might be expecting a reply document that conforms to specific publishable document type.

document Document The reply IData object. This document must conform to the publishable document type specified in documentTypeName.

delayUntilServiceSuccess String Optional. Flag indicating whether the Integration Server should publish the document when the pub.publish:reply service executes or after the top-level service successfully completes. If the top-level service fails, the Integration Server will not publish the document.

Set to... To...

true Delay publishing until after the top-level service executes successfully.

false Default. Publish the document when the publish service executes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 301

Page 302: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

If you are building a service to reply to documents that meet join conditions, keep the following in mind:

All (AND) join conditions. If the replying service executes because two or more documents satisfied an All (AND) join condition, the Integration Server uses the envelope of the last document that satisfied the join condition to determine where to send the reply document. If you want the Integration Server to use the envelope of a different document, link the envelope of that document to receivedDocumentEnvelope. If you want to reply to all documents received as part of an All (AND) join, invoke pub.publish:reply once for each document received and map the envelope from the received document to receivedDocumentEnvelope for each call.

Any (OR) or Only one (XOR) join conditions. If the replying service executes because a document satisfied an Any (OR) or Only one (XOR) join condition, do not map or assign a value to receivedDocumentEnvelope. It is impossible to know which document in the Any (OR) or Only one (XOR) join will be received first. For example, suppose that an Only one (XOR) join condition specified document types A and B. The Integration Server uses the envelope of the document it received first as the receivedDocumentEnvelope value. If you map the envelope of document A to receivedDocumentEnvelope, but the Integration Server receives document B first, your replying service will fail.

Important! Services that publish or deliver a document and wait for a reply can specify a publishable document type to which reply documents must conform. If the reply document is not of the type specified in the receiveDocumentTypeName parameter of the pub.publish:publishAndWait or pub.publish:deliverAndWait service, the publishing service will wait forever for a reply. Work closely with the developer of the publishing service to make sure that your reply document is an instance of the correct publishable document type.

For more information about building a reply service, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.publish:deliverAndWaitpub.publish:publishAndWaitpub.publish:envelope

pub.publ ish:waitForReplyWmPublic. Retrieves the reply for an asynchronous request. If a reply is not available, the Integration Server continues to wait for the document until the time specified in the waitTime parameter of the pub.publish:deliverAndWait or pub.publish:publishAndWait service elapses.

Input Parameters

tag String A unique identifier for the publish request for which you are retrieving a reply. The Integration Server uses the tag value to match the request document with its corresponding reply document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 302

Page 303: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The waitTime value of the publishing service specifies how long the Integration Server will keep the request open while waiting for a reply. When building an asynchronous request/reply service, keep the following information about the waitTime in mind:

The waiting interval for the reply document starts when the Integration Server executes the request service (pub.publish:deliverAndWait or pub.publish:publishAndWait). The execution of the pub.publish:waitForReply service does not affect the waitTime interval.

If the waitTime interval elapses before the pub.publish:waitForReply service executes, the service immediately returns a null document which indicates that the wait time has expired.

If the Integration Server has not received the reply when the pub.publish:waitForReply service executes, the service waits the remainder of the waitTime interval. If the Integration Server does not receive a reply by the time the waitTime interval elapses, the request completes. The service returns a null document which indicates that the wait time has expired.

If the reply document arrives after the waitTime interval elapses, the Integration Server rejects the document because the request is closed.

A single publish and wait request might receive many response documents. The Integration Server that made the publish and wait request uses only the first reply document it receives from the Broker. The Integration Server discards all other replies. First is arbitrarily defined. There is no guarantee provided for the order in which the Broker processes incoming replies. If you need a reply document from a specific client, use the pub.publish:deliverAndWait service instead.

For more information about building an asynchronous request/reply service, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.publish:deliverAndWaitpub.publish:publishAndWait

receivedDocument Document Document (IData object) received as the reply to the request. If the request expires (that is, the waitTime elapses) before the Integration Server receives the reply document, the receivedDocument field contains a null document.

Important! The Integration Server treats all reply documents as volatile documents. If the Integration Server shuts down before processing the reply document, the reply document is lost.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 303

Page 304: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

pub.publ ish.not i f icat ion:errorWmPublic. Publishable document type that defines the document that the Integration Server generates and delivers when a trigger encounters an error or exception condition during processing.

The Integration Server generates an error document if the trigger service cannot successfully process a document for one of the following reasons:

The trigger service encounters an exception condition (that is not an ISRuntimeException) during execution.

The Integration Server makes the maximum number of attempts to re-execute the trigger service and the service still fails because of a transient error condition.

Some other system exception occurred.

Note: The Integration Server does not generate an error document if the subscribing trigger is part of a disabled process model version because the trigger service associated with a disabled process model version never executes.

The Integration Server delivers the error document to the client ID specified in the errorsTo field contained in the received document’s envelope. If the errorsTo field is empty, the Integration Server delivers the error document to the original document’s publisher (as specified in the pubId envelope field). The error document notifies the publisher or other designated recipient that the subscriber cannot process the document successfully.

Note: If a trigger service cannot process a locally published document successfully, the Integration Server produces and delivers an error document only if the Integration Server is connected to a Broker.

Parameters

adapterType String Optional. The resource producing the error. The Integration Server sets the value of this field to Integration Server.

errorCategory String Optional. Type of exception. The Integration Server sets the value of this field to Application.

errorText String Optional. Exception text message. At Dispatcher debug level 9, a stack trace of the exception will also be returned.

eventID java.lang.Long Optional. The event ID of the document that caused this exception. If the trigger service executed because a document satisfied a join condition, then the eventID is the event ID of the last document that satisfied the condition.

_env Document Optional. A document reference to the pub.publish:envelope document type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 304

Page 305: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

Usage Notes

The client to which the Integration Server delivers the error document needs to subscribe to the pub.publish.notification:error document type. If the client does not have a trigger that subscribes to this document type, the client will never receive or process the error document. If the client receiving the error document is an Integration Server, it generates the message [ISS.0098.0024V2] No trigger available for incoming Document pub.publish.notification:error.

See Also

pub.publish:envelope

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 305

Page 306: Integration Server Bis Reference

18. Publish Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 306

Page 307: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 19. Remote Folder

You use the elements in the remote folder to invoke services on other webMethods Integration Servers.

You can also use remote services for guaranteed delivery transactions. For more information about guaranteed delivery transactions, see the Guaranteed Delivery Developer’s Guide and the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 307

Page 308: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.remote: invokeWmPublic. Invokes a service on a remote webMethods Integration Server.

The remote server is identified by an alias, which is configured on the Remote Servers tab in the Integration Server Administrator. Connection and authentication to the remote server is managed transparently to the caller of this service.

All current pipeline inputs are passed to the remote service. To improve performance and minimize the amount of data sent over the wire, scope the pipeline to a separate document or drop unneeded fields before invoking this service. The same advice applies to the output values of the remote service because all values returned from the service are sent over the wire in response to the caller.

Element Package and Description

pub.remote:invoke WmPublic. Invokes a service on a remote webMethods Integration Server.

pub.remote.gd:end WmPublic. Ends a guaranteed delivery transaction.

pub.remote.gd:getStatus WmPublic. Returns the status of the guaranteed delivery transaction.

pub.remote.gd:invoke WmPublic. Invokes the service for a guaranteed delivery transaction by making a synchronous call to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

pub.remote.gd:restart WmPublic. Restarts an expired guaranteed delivery transaction.

pub.remote.gd:retrieve WmPublic. Retrieves the results of a guaranteed delivery transaction submitted asynchronously or synchronously to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

pub.remote.gd:send WmPublic. Makes a guaranteed one-way call (fire-and-forget) to the webMethods Integration Server to invoke a service for which no output is needed or expected.

pub.remote.gd:start WmPublic. Starts a guaranteed delivery transaction.

pub.remote.gd:submit WmPublic. Invokes a service for a guaranteed delivery transaction by making an asynchronous call to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 308

Page 309: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Returns the output of the invoked service. The output signature matches the output signature of the invoked service.

Usage Notes

If pub.remote:invoke does not receive a response within the timeout period specified in the server’s watt.net.timeout parameter, it will throw an exception. For information about the watt.net.timeout parameter, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

$alias String Name of the target server on which to invoke the specified service. This name and its associated connection attributes are defined on the Create Remote Server Alias screen in the Integration Server Administrator.

Note: If you protect the alias using an Access Control List, the user invoking invoke must be a member of this list or the invocation will fail.

$service String Fully qualified name of the service to invoke on the remote server, in the format folderName.folderName:serviceName (for example: wm.server:ping).

$scope String Flag that specifies how the session to the remote server should be managed.

Set to... To...

SESSION Default. Store the remote session in the current user session. Further calls by the same user to pub.remote:invoke for the same server alias reuse the existing remote session with the server.

Stateful interactions with the remote server are maintained and protected inside the current user’s session.

When the current user disconnects, the remote session expires, or the local server is shut down, the remote session is automatically disconnected.

GLOBAL Store the remote session in a shared pool of sessions. If another user invokes a service on the same remote server with GLOBAL scope, the session will be reused.

Stateful interactions with the remote server could be destroyed by other users’ invocations.

When the remote session expires due to inactivity or the local server is shut down, the remote session is automatically disconnected.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 309

Page 310: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

pub.remote.gd:endWmPublic. Ends a guaranteed delivery transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is used to eliminate a guaranteed delivery transaction from the jobstore.

pub.remote.gd:getStatusWmPublic. Returns the status of the guaranteed delivery transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use the pub.remote.gd:restart service to restart a FAILED (expired) guaranteed delivery transaction.

tid String Transaction ID of the transaction you want to end.

tid String Transaction identification number.

status String Current status of the transaction. status can have one of the following values:

A value of... Indicates that...

NEW The transaction is new.

PENDING The transaction is pending.

DONE The transaction is completed.

FAILED The transaction expired because the time-to-live or the retry limit has been exceeded.

UNKNOWN The transaction identification number in tid is not recognized.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 310

Page 311: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

pub.remote.gd: invokeWmPublic. Invokes the service for a guaranteed delivery transaction by making a synchronous call to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

To use an asynchronous call to the server to invoke a service for a guaranteed delivery transaction, use the pub.remote.gd:submit service.

If the remote server does not respond within the timeout limit specified in this server’s watt.net.timeout setting, the Integration Server treats it as a failed attempt and retries the request.

pub.remote.gd:restartWmPublic. Restarts an expired guaranteed delivery transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If a guaranteed delivery transaction failed because of server or network failure, use this service to restart the transaction without resubmitting it.

service String Name of the service to be run on the remote webMethods Integration Server.

tid String Transaction identification number for the service.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing the inputs for the service.

results Document Conditional. Document (IData object) containing the pipeline as it exists after the service is invoked.

tid String Transaction identification number for the guaranteed delivery transaction you want to restart.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 311

Page 312: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

pub.remote.gd:retr ieveWmPublic. Retrieves the results of a guaranteed delivery transaction submitted asynchronously or synchronously to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If block is false, and the results of the transaction are still pending when this service executes, the results are returned as null.

pub.remote.gd:sendWmPublic. Makes a guaranteed one-way call (fire-and-forget) to the webMethods Integration Server to invoke a service for which no output is needed or expected.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

tid String Transaction identification number.

block String Optional. Flag that specifies whether to block or poll for the results of the transaction.

Set to... To...

true Default. Wait until the invoked service completes before retrieving results. This is also known as blocking mode.

false Retrieve the results immediately, whether or not the invoked service is completed. This is also known as polling mode.

results Document Conditional. Document (IData object) containing the results of the service in the guaranteed delivery transaction.

service String Service to be run on the remote Integration Server.

tid String Transaction identification number for the service.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing the inputs for the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 312

Page 313: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

Usage Notes

The results of the service specified in service cannot be retrieved. However, errors that occur will be logged when the guaranteed delivery transaction ends.

Use the pub.remote.gd:send service to invoke a service remotely only if you want to run a guaranteed delivery transaction and are not concerned about the results of the invoked service. After pub.remote.gd:send completes the call, the service ends the transaction; therefore, you do not need to use the pub.remote.gd:end service to end the transaction.

pub.remote.gd:star tWmPublic. Starts a guaranteed delivery transaction.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

alias String Name of the webMethods Integration Server on which you want to invoke a guaranteed delivery transaction. This name and its associated connection attributes are defined on the Remote Servers tab of the Integration Server Administrator.

ttl String Optional. Transaction time-to-live measured in minutes. The transaction expires when ttl is exceeded.

Default is the value set in the watt.tx.defaultTTLMins property or, if the property is not set, 30 minutes.

retries String Optional. Maximum number of times to retry the transaction. Default is 0 (no retry limit).

followtid String Optional. Identification number of the transaction you want this guaranteed delivery transaction to follow. The current transaction executes only after the transaction indicated by followtid completes.

tid String Transaction identification number.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 313

Page 314: Integration Server Bis Reference

19. Remote Folder

pub.remote.gd:submitWmPublic. Invokes a service for a guaranteed delivery transaction by making an asynchronous call to a remote webMethods Integration Server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To remove the transaction from the remote webMethods Integration Server, use the pub.remote.gd:end service.

To use a synchronous call to invoke the service, use the pub.remote.gd:invoke service.

service String Service to be run on the remote webMethods Integration Server.

tid String Transaction identification number for the service.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing the inputs for the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 314

Page 315: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 20. Record Folder

You use the elements in the record folder to perform operations on documents (IData objects) in the pipeline.

Important! The services in this folder have been deprecated. To operate on documents (IData objects), use the services in the document folder.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 315

Page 316: Integration Server Bis Reference

20. Record Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.record: lengthWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:sizeOfList.

Returns the number of documents in a document list.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.record:recordListToRecordWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentListToDocument.

Constructs a document (an IData object) from a document list (an array of IData objects) by generating key/value pairs from the values of two elements that you specify in the document list.

The following illustrates how pub.record:recordListToRecord would convert a document list that contains three documents to a single document containing three key/value pairs. When you use recordListToRecord, you specify which two elements from the source list are to be transformed into the keys and values in the output document. In this example, the values from the pName elements in the source list are transformed into key names, and the values from the pValue elements are transformed into the values for these keys.

Element Package and Description

pub.record:length WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.list:sizeOfList.

pub.record:recordListToRecord WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentListToDocument.

pub.record:recordToRecordList WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentToDocumentList.

pub.record:recordToXMLValues WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentToXMLValues.

pub.record:XMLValuesToRecord WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:XMLValuesToDocument.

recordList Document List Document list whose length you want to discover.

length String Number of documents in the input document list. This parameter is not present if the input document list is null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 316

Page 317: Integration Server Bis Reference

20. Record Folder

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.record:recordToRecordListWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentToDocumentList.

Expand the contents of a document into a list of documents. Each name/value pair in the target document will become a new document in a document list with constant keys for name and value.

A document List containing these 3 documents... Would be converted to a document containing these 3 keys...

Key Value Key Value

pName cx_timeout cx_timeout 1000

pValue 1000

pName cx_max cx_max 2500

pValue 2500

pName cx_min cx_min 10

pValue 10

recordList Document List List of documents (IData[ ]) whose contents you want to transform into a single document (IData object).

Note: If recordList contains an IData instead of an IData[ ], pub.record:recordListToRecord does nothing.

name String Name of the element in recordList whose value will provide the name of each key in the resulting document.

Important! The data type of the element that you specify in name must be String.

value String Name of the element in recordList whose value will be assigned to the key specified in name. This element can be of any data type.

record Document Document (IData object) containing the key/value pairs generated from recordList.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 317

Page 318: Integration Server Bis Reference

20. Record Folder

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.record:recordToXMLValuesWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:documentToXMLValues.

Converts a document (IData object) in the pipeline to a String by encoding it as webMethods XMLValues format.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.record:XMLValuesToRecordWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.document:XMLValuesToDocument.

Converts an XML String in webMethods XMLValues format to a document.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

record Document Target document to transform.

name String Name to use for the keys of the target document.

value String Name to use for the values of the target document.

recordList Document List Resulting document list. The length of the document list is equal to the number of fields in the input document. Each document contains two fields: name and value.

record Document Target document to convert. This document can contain any number of other fields, lists, and other documents.

xmlvalues String String representation of record, encoded in webMethods XMLValues format.

xmlvalues String Representation of a document in webMethods XML Values encoded form. No other format is accepted.

record Document List Document resulting from the decoding of xmlvalues.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 318

Page 319: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 21. Repl icator Folder

You use the elements in the replicator folder to replicate packages across webMethods Integration Servers. This folder contains services that you can use to push packages from your webMethods Integration Servers to a subscriber’s server. It also contains services that you can use to pull packages from a publisher’s server to your webMethods Integration Server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 319

Page 320: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.replicator:addReleaseRegistryEntry WmPublic. Adds an entry to the webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

pub.replicator:deleteReleaseRegistryEntry WmPublic. Deletes an entry from the webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

pub.replicator:distributeViaFTP WmPublic. Allows a publisher to send a package to a subscriber via FTP or allows a subscriber to retrieve a package from a publisher via FTP.

pub.replicator:distributeViaSvcPull WmPublic. Pulls a specified package release from a publisher’s server.

pub.replicator:distributeViaSvcPush WmPublic. Pushes a package from your server to a list of subscribers (other webMethods Integration Servers).

pub.replicator:generateReplicationEvent WmPublic. Generates a replication event.

pub.replicator:getLocalReleasedList WmPublic. Returns all entries in your webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

pub.replicator:getRemoteReleasedList WmPublic. Queries the publisher for released packages.

pub.replicator:notifyPackageRelease WmPublic. Sends an email message to subscribers who have said that they want to be notified when a new release becomes available.

pub.replicator:packageCreation WmPublic. Creates a distribution file (a zip file) for the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 320

Page 321: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:addReleaseRegistryEntryWmPublic. Adds an entry to the webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

package String Name of the package. The service confirms that this package exists on the server before adding an entry to the Package Release Registry.

name String Name of the release. This name could be different from the name of the package.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patchNums String One or more comma-separated patch numbers included in this release.

JVMVersion String Minimum JVM version number that this release requires.

description String Brief description of this release. You may want to use this parameter to summarize the nature and purpose of the release.

packages Document List Entries in the server’s Package Release Registry.

Key Description

name String Name of the release.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Conditional. Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patch_nums String Conditional. Comma-separated list of patch numbers included in this release.

time String Time when the package was released.

jvm_version String Minimum JVM version number that the release requires.

description String Conditional. Brief description of this release.

source_server_version String Version number of Integration Server that released the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 321

Page 322: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

Usage Notes

Before using this service, use pub.replicator:packageCreation to create a package zip file in the server’s outbound directory. When you use addReleaseRegistryEntry to add an entry to the Package Release Registry, the package name you specify in package should match the package name you specified in pub.replicator:packageCreation.

pub.repl icator:deleteReleaseRegistryEntryWmPublic. Deletes an entry from the webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

packageName String Name of the release that you want to delete.

packages Document List Entries that remain in the server’s Package Release Registry.

Key Description

name String Name of the release.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Conditional. Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patch_nums String Conditional. Comma-separated list of patch numbers included in this release.

time String Time when the package was released.

jvm_version String Minimum JVM version number that the release requires.

description String Conditional. Brief description of the release.

source_server_version String Version number of Integration Server that released the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 322

Page 323: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:distr ibuteViaFTPWmPublic. Allows a publisher to send a package to a subscriber via FTP or allows a subscriber to retrieve a package from a publisher via FTP.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.repl icator:distr ibuteViaSvcPul lWmPublic. Pulls a specified package release from a publisher’s server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

packageName String Name of the released package.

action String Flag that specifies whether you want to send (put) a package to another Integration Server or whether you want to retrieve (get) a package from another Integration Server.

Set to... To...

get Default. Retrieve a package from the publisher’s server.

put Send a package to a subscriber’s server.

serverhost String Host name or IP address of the remote Integration Server.

serverport String Number of the FTP port on the remote Integration Server.

username String User name that your server will use to log on to the remote Integration Server.

password String Password that your server will use to log on to the remote Integration Server.

packageName String Name of the release.

publisher String Alias of the publisher’s server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 323

Page 324: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:distr ibuteViaSvcPushWmPublic. Pushes a package from your server to a list of subscribers (other webMethods Integration Servers).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.repl icator:generateRepl icat ionEventWmPublic. Generates a replication event.

You might invoke this service in conjunction with other services to make the package replication process generate an event. The replication event handler would listen for this event and perform some prescribed action that you have specified.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

packageName String The name of the release.

subscriber String List List of the subscriber’s host names or IP addresses.

packageName String Name of the package.

action String User-defined string that describes the replication event, such as “pulled” or “pushed.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 324

Page 325: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:getLocalReleasedListWmPublic. Returns all entries in your webMethods Integration Server’s Package Release Registry.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

packages Document List Entries in the server’s Package Release Registry.

Key Description

name String Name of the release.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Conditional. Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patch_nums String Conditional. Comma-separated list of the patch numbers included in this release.

time String Time when the package was released.

jvm_version String Minimum JVM version number that the release requires.

description String Conditional. Brief description of the release.

source_server_version String Version number of webMethods Integration Server that released the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 325

Page 326: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:getRemoteReleasedListWmPublic. Queries the publisher for released packages.

This service gets a list of released packages to which your server subscribes. You can use the list to find out if any new packages, or newer versions of existing packages, have been released.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publisher String Alias of the publishing server.

packages Document List List of released packages on the publishing server to which you subscribe.

Key Description

name String Name of the release.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Conditional. Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patch_nums String Conditional. Comma-separated list of the patch numbers included in this release.

time String Time when the package was released.

jvm_version String Minimum JVM version number that the release requires.

description String Conditional. Brief description of the release.

source_server_version String Version number of webMethods Integration Server that released the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 326

Page 327: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

pub.repl icator:noti fyPackageReleaseWmPublic. Sends an email message to subscribers who have said that they want to be notified when a new release becomes available.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.repl icator:packageCreat ionWmPublic. Creates a distribution file (a zip file) for the package.

Input Parameters

packageName String Name of the release.

package String Name of the package.

name String Name of the release.

version String Version number of the release, in the format #.# or #.#.# (for example, 1.2 or 1.2.1).

build String Build number of the release (for example, 12, 530).

patchNums String Comma-separated list of patch numbers included in the release.

targetPkgVersion String Version number of the target package. To prevent the installation program from overwriting an existing (higher) version of the package, this field is checked when the subscriber installs this package over an existing package.

targetServerVersion String Version number of the webMethods Integration Server that this release requires.

JVMVersion String Minimum JVM version number that this release requires.

description String Brief description of this release. You might use this parameter to summarize the nature and purpose of the release.

type String Flag indicating the type of release.

Set to... To...

full Default. Indicate a full package.

partial Indicate a patch or an update for the package.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 327

Page 328: Integration Server Bis Reference

21. Replicator Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

After you use packageCreation to create the package, use pub.replicator:addReleaseRegistryEntry to add an entry to the Package Release Registry. The package name you specify in packageCreation should match the package name you specify in pub.replicator:addReleaseRegistryEntry.

filter String Flag that specifies whether all files are to be included in the distribution file or only selected files.

If only selected files are to be included, use this parameter in conjunction with fileList to specify which files to include.

Set to... To...

includeall Default. Include all the files in the distribution file.

include Include selected files in the distribution file.

exclude Include all except selected files in the distribution file.

fileList String List Names of files to include or exclude from the distribution file, depending on the value of filter.

fileNamePattern String Pattern string that specifies the names of files to be included in the distribution file. The asterisk (*) is the only wildcard character allowed in a pattern string. All other characters are treated literally (for example, *.java, *.dsp).

filesToDeleteList String List Optional. The names of files that will be deleted from the target package when the subscribing server installs the package created by this service.

$result String Conditional. If the distribution file is created successfully, this parameter contains the value OK. If the distribution file was not created successfully, this parameter is not present in the output signature and the service throws an exception.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 328

Page 329: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 22. Report Folder

You use the elements in the report folder to apply an output template to a Values object. Each service requires an output template and a Values object. They can be used in order to generate any type of dynamic XML, EDI, or HTML document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 329

Page 330: Integration Server Bis Reference

22. Report Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.report :runFi leTemplateWmPublic. Applies a template file to a document (IData object).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If a template is not available in a templates directory of any of the packages on the server, you can use this service by passing in a File object representing the template.

Element Package and Description

pub.report:runFileTemplate WmPublic. Applies a template file to a document (IData object).

pub.report:runFileTemplateOnPipe WmPublic. Applies a template to the pipeline.

pub.report:runStringTemplate WmPublic. Applies an output template to a specified document (IData object).

pub.report:runStringTemplateOnPipe WmPublic. Applies a template to the pipeline.

pub.report:runTemplate WmPublic. Applies a template in a file to a specified document (IData object).

pub.report:runTemplateOnPipe WmPublic. Applies a template in a file to the pipeline.

$template java.io.File Template file.

$values Document Document (IData object) to bind against $template.

fileEncoding String Optional. The encoding of the template file. If fileEncoding is not specified, the default file encoding specified in the watt.server.netEncoding server parameter or the system file encoding will be used. Examples: SJIS, ASCII, ISO8859_1.

$txt String Results from applying $template to $values.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 330

Page 331: Integration Server Bis Reference

22. Report Folder

pub.report :runFi leTemplateOnPipeWmPublic. Applies a template to the pipeline.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If a template is not available in a templates directory of any of the packages on the server, you can use this service to pass a File object representing the template file.

pub.report :runStr ingTemplateWmPublic. Applies an output template to a specified document (IData object).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service is typically invoked from other services that already have a template in a String object and an IData object that will be used to bind against the template.

$template java.io.File Template file.

fileEncoding String Optional. The encoding of the template file. If fileEncoding is not specified, the default file encoding specified in the watt.server.netEncoding server parameter or the system file encoding will be used. Examples: SJIS, ASCII, ISO8859_1.

$txt String Results from applying $template to the pipeline.

$template String Template to apply.

$values Document Document (IData object) to bind against $template.

$txt String Results from applying $template to $values.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 331

Page 332: Integration Server Bis Reference

22. Report Folder

pub.report :runStr ingTemplateOnPipeWmPublic. Applies a template to the pipeline.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service is typically invoked from other services that already have a template in a String object and need the template to bind against the pipeline.

pub.report :runTemplateWmPublic. Applies a template in a file to a specified document (IData object).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The service locates the output template by its file name and the name of the package in which it resides. To apply a template that resides in webMethods6\IntegrationServer\packages\Default\templates\mytemp.xml, invoke the service with the following values.

$template: mytemp.xml

$package: Default

$template String Template to apply to pipeline.

$txt String Result from applying $template to the pipeline.

$template String Name of the template file (for example, mytemp.html or mytemp.xml).

$package String Name of the package where the template resides (for example, Default).

$values Document Document (IData object) to bind against $template.

fileEncoding String Optional. The encoding of the template file. If fileEncoding is not specified, the default file encoding specified in the watt.server.netEncoding server parameter or the system file encoding will be used. Examples: SJIS, ASCII, ISO8859_1.

$txt String Result from applying the template to $values.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 332

Page 333: Integration Server Bis Reference

22. Report Folder

pub.report :runTemplateOnPipeWmPublic. Applies a template in a file to the pipeline.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The service locates the output template by its file name and the name of the package in which it resides. To apply a template that resides in webMethods6\IntegrationServer\packages\Default\templates\mytemp.xml, Invokes the service with the following values.

$template: mytemp.xml

$package: Default

$template String Name of template file (for example, mytemp.html or mytemp.xml).

$package String Name of the package in which the template resides (for example, Default).

fileEncoding String Optional. The encoding of the template file. If fileEncoding is not specified, the default file encoding specified in the watt.server.netEncoding server parameter or the system file encoding will be used. Examples: SJIS, ASCII, ISO8859_1.

$txt String Results from applying the template file to the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 333

Page 334: Integration Server Bis Reference

22. Report Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 334

Page 335: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 23. Scheduler Folder

You use the elements in the scheduler folder to execute services at the times you specify. Services that you schedule are referred to as user tasks or just tasks. The Scheduler feature on the webMethods Integration Server handles execution of the tasks.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 335

Page 336: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.scheduler:addComplexTaskWmPublic. Adds a complex task to the Scheduler.

The webMethods Integration Server runs the service for a complex task on the day(s) and time(s) that you specify either during a specified date range or indefinitely.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.scheduler:addComplexTask WmPublic. Adds a complex task to the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:addOneTimeTask WmPublic. Adds a task that runs only once to the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:addRepeatingTask WmPublic. Adds a recurring task to the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:cancelTask WmPublic. Removes a task from the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:getTaskIDs WmPublic. Retrieves a list of identification numbers for of all tasks currently in the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:getTaskInfo WmPublic. Retrieves information about a task on the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:resumeTask WmPublic. Resumes a suspended task.

pub.scheduler:suspendTask WmPublic. Suspends a task on the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:updateComplexTask WmPublic. Updates a complex task on the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:updateOneTimeTask WmPublic. Updates a one-time task on the Scheduler.

pub.scheduler:updateRepeatingTask WmPublic. Updates a repeating task to the Scheduler.

service String Name of the service you want to schedule for execution on the server.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed. If you do not specify a user name, the “Default” access rights are used.

persistJob String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the task to persist after the server is restarted.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 336

Page 337: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

runInCluster String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing the input to the scheduled service.

startTime String Optional. Time at which the task is scheduled to start, in the format HH:mm:ss. If you do not specify a startTime, the current time is used.

startDate String Optional. Date on which the task is scheduled to start, in the format yyyy/MM/dd. If you do not specify a startDate, the current date is used.

endTime String Optional. Time at which the task expires, in the format HH:mm:ss. If you do not specify an endTime, the server uses 00:00:00 (midnight).

endDate String Optional. Date on which the task expires, in the format yyyy/MM/dd. If you do not specify an endDate, the server executes this service for an indefinite period of time.

months String List Optional. Months during which the task is scheduled to run. Months are represented by integers between 1 and 12, where “1” indicates January and “12” indicates December. If you do not specify months, the task will run every month.

hours String List Optional. Hours at which the task is scheduled to run. Hours are represented by integers between 0 and 23. If you do not specify hours, the task runs every hour.

minutes String List Optional. Minutes at which the task is scheduled to run. Minutes are represented by integers between 0 and 59. If you do not specify minutes, the task runs every minute.

daysOfMonth String List Optional. Days of the month on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 31. If you do not specify daysOfMonth, the task runs every day of the month.

daysOfWeek String List Optional. Days of the week on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 7, where “1” indicates Sunday and “7” indicates Saturday. If you do not specify daysOfWeek, the task runs every day of the week.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 337

Page 338: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Output Parameters

pub.scheduler:addOneTimeTaskWmPublic. Adds a task that runs only once to the Scheduler.

The Integration Server executes the service a single time on the date and time you specify.

Input Parameters

taskID String Identification number of the task added to the scheduler.

type String Code indicating the type of task added. For this type of task, the value of type will be complex.

taskAdded String Indicates whether the task was successfully added to the Scheduler. If the task was successfully added to the Scheduler, taskAdded contains true. If the task was not successfully added, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

service String Name of the service you want to schedule for execution.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed. If you do not specify a user name, the “Default” access rights are used.

persistJob String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the server to maintain the scheduled task in the event that the server is restarted before the task completely executes.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

runInCluster String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing input to the scheduled service.

date String Date on which to run the service, in the format yyyy/MM/dd.

time String Time at which to run the service, in the format HH:mm:ss.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 338

Page 339: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Output Parameters

pub.scheduler:addRepeat ingTaskWmPublic. Adds a recurring task to the Scheduler.

The webMethods Integration Server continually executes a repeating task at the interval you specify.

Input Parameters

taskID String Identification number of the task added to the scheduler.

type String Code indicating the type of task added. For this type of task, the value of type will be once.

taskAdded String Indicates whether the task was successfully added to the Scheduler. If the task was successfully added to the Scheduler, taskAdded contains true. If the task was not successfully added, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

service String Name of the service you want to schedule for execution on the server.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed. If you do not specify a user name, the “Default” access rights are used.

persistJob String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the task to persist after the server is restarted.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

runInCluster String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing input to the scheduled service.

interval String Time interval (measured in seconds) between executions of the task.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 339

Page 340: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Output Parameters

pub.scheduler:cancelTaskWmPublic. Removes a task from the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For information about the tasks on the Scheduler, run the pub.scheduler:getTaskIDs and pub.scheduler:getTaskInfo services.

doNotOverlap String Optional. Flag that indicates whether you want executions of this task to overlap.

Set to... To...

true Prevent executions of the scheduled task from overlapping. After a scheduled task finishes executing, the Scheduler waits the number of seconds specified in interval before running the task again.

false Default. Allow executions of the scheduled task to overlap. The Scheduler runs the task every time the value of interval elapses.

taskID String Identification number of the task added to the Scheduler.

type String Code indicating the type of task added. For this type of task, the value of type will be repeat.

taskAdded String Indicates whether the task was successfully added to the Scheduler. If the task was successfully added to the Scheduler, taskAdded contains true. If the task was not successfully added, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

taskID String Identification number of the task to remove from the Scheduler.

taskCancelled String Indicates whether the task was successfully removed from the Scheduler. If the task was successfully removed from the Scheduler, taskCancelled contains true. If the task was not successfully removed, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 340

Page 341: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

pub.scheduler:getTaskIDsWmPublic. Retrieves a list of identification numbers for of all tasks currently in the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.scheduler:getTaskInfoWmPublic. Retrieves information about a task on the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

taskIDs String List Identification numbers for the tasks on the Scheduler.

taskID String Task identification number.

type String Code indicating the task’s type. Will be one of the following:complexoncerepeat

runAsUser String The user ID whose access rights are used to execute the service.

service String Name of the service associated with the task.

runInCluster String Flag indicating whether or not the task is permitted to run in a clustered environment.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The task runs in a clustered environment.

false The task does not run in a clustered environment.

persistJob String Flag indicating whether the task persists if the server on which the task is running is restarted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The task persists if server is restarted.

false The task does not persist if server is restarted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 341

Page 342: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

nextRun String Next date and time that the task is scheduled to run. The date and time is expressed as the number of milliseconds from January 1, 1970, 00:00:00 GMT.

execState String Current state of the task. Tasks can be in one of two states:

A value of... Indicates that...

running The task is currently active.

suspended The task has been suspended.

inputs Document Conditional. Document (IData object) containing the inputs, if any, to the scheduled service.

oneTimeTaskInfo Document Conditional. Information about the complex task represented by taskID. This parameter is present only if type is once.

Key Description

date String Conditional. Date on which to run the task, in yyyy/MM/dd format.

time String Conditional. Time at which to run the task, in HH:mm:ss format.

repeatingTaskInfo Document Conditional. Information about the task represented by taskID. This parameter is present only if type is repeat.

Key Description

interval String Conditional. Time interval (measured in seconds) between repetitions of the task.

doNotOverlap String Conditional. Indicates whether recurrences of this task will overlap.

complexTaskInfo Document Conditional. Information about the task. This parameter is present only if type is complex.

Key Description

startDate String Conditional. Date on which the task is scheduled to start, in yyyy/MM/dd format.

startTime String Conditional. Time at which the task is scheduled to start, in HH:mm:ss format.

endDate String Conditional. Date on which the task expires, in yyyy/MM/dd format.

endTime String Conditional. Time at which the task expires, in HH:mm:ss format.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 342

Page 343: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

pub.scheduler:resumeTaskWmPublic. Resumes a suspended task.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.scheduler:suspendTaskWmPublic. Suspends a task on the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

minutes String List Conditional. Minutes at which the task is scheduled to run. Minutes are represented by integers between 0 and 59.

hours String List Conditional. Hours when the task is scheduled to run. Hours are represented by integers between 0 and 23.

months String List Conditional. Months during which the task is scheduled to run. Months are represented by integers between 1 and 12, where “1” indicates January and “12” indicates December.

daysOfWeek String List Conditional. Days of the week on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 7, where “1” indicates Sunday and “7” indicates Saturday.

daysOfMonth String List Conditional. Days of the month on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 31.

taskID String Identification number of the task to resume.

taskResumed String Indicates whether the task was successfully resumed. If the task was successfully resumed, taskResumed contains true. If the task was not successfully resumed, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

taskID String Identification number of the task to suspend.

taskSuspended String Indicates whether the task was successfully suspended. If the task was successfully suspended, taskSuspended contains true. If the task was not successfully suspended, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 343

Page 344: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Usage Notes

If you want to cancel a task or remove a task from the scheduler, use the pub.scheduler:cancelTask service.

pub.scheduler:updateComplexTaskWmPublic. Updates a complex task on the Scheduler.

The Integration Server runs the service for a complex task on the day(s) and time(s) that you specify either during a specified date range or indefinitely.

Input Parameters

taskID String Identification number of the task to be updated.

service String Optional. Name of the service you want to schedule for execution on the server.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed. If you do not specify a user name, the “Default” access rights are used.

persistJob String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to persist after the server is restarted.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

runInCluster String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing input to the scheduled service.

startTime String Optional. Time at which the task is scheduled to start, in HH:mm:ss format. If you do not specify a startTime, the current time is used.

startDate String Optional. Date on which the task is scheduled to start, in yyyy/MM/dd format. If you do not specify date, the current date is used.

endTime String Optional. Time at which the task expires, in HH:mm:ss format. If you do not specify an endTime, the server uses 00:00:00 (midnight).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 344

Page 345: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You can use pub.scheduler:getTaskIDs and pub.scheduler:getTaskInfo services to get information about the task you want to update.

Unlike the services pub.scheduler:updateOneTimeTask and pub.scheduler:updateRepeatingTask, this service updates all the fields in the task by default (that is, except values for taskID and type, all the parameter values you specified when you created or last updated the task are overwritten). Using this service to update a task is similar to creating a new complex task with the original taskID and type.

endDate String Optional. Date on which the task expires, in yyyy/MM/dd format. If you do not specify an endDate, the server executes this service for an indefinite period of time.

months String List Optional. Months during which the task is scheduled to run. Months are represented by integers between 1 and 12, where “1” indicates January and “12” indicates December. If you do not specify months, the task will run every month.

hours String List Optional. Hours at which the task is scheduled to run. Hours are represented by integers between 0 and 23. If you do not specify hours, the task runs every hour.

minutes String List Optional. Minutes at which the task is scheduled to run. Minutes are represented by integers between 0 and 59. If you do not specify minutes, the task runs every minute.

daysOfMonth String List Optional. Days of the month on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 31. If you do not specify daysOfMonth, the task runs every day of the month.

daysOfWeek String List Optional. Days of the week on which the task is scheduled to run. Days are represented by integers between 1 and 7, where “1” indicates Sunday and “7” indicates Saturday. If you do not specify daysOfWeek, the task runs every day of the week.

type String Code indicating the type of task that was updated. For this type of task, the value of type will be complex.

taskUpdated String Indicates whether the task was successfully updated. If the task was successfully updated, taskUpdated contains true. If the task was not successfully updated, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 345

Page 346: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

pub.scheduler:updateOneTimeTaskWmPublic. Updates a one-time task on the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Unlike pub.scheduler:updateComplexTask, this service does not overwrite all the original parameter values. This service only updates the parameters for which you specify new values.

taskID String Identification number of the task to be updated.

service String Optional. Name of the service to be scheduled.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed.

persistJob String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to persist after the server is restarted.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

runInCluster String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing inputs to the scheduled service.

date String Optional. Date on which to run the task, in yyyy/MM/dd format.

time String Optional. Time at which to run the service, in HH:mm:ss format.

type String Code indicating the type of task that was updated. For this type of task, the value of type will be once.

taskUpdated String Indicates whether the task was successfully updated. If the task was successfully updated, taskUpdated contains true. If the task was not successfully updated, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 346

Page 347: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

pub.scheduler:updateRepeat ingTaskWmPublic. Updates a repeating task to the Scheduler.

Input Parameters

taskID String Identification number of the task to be updated.

service String Optional. Name of the service run by the task.

runAsUser String Optional. User ID under which the service is to be executed. If you do not specify a user name, the “Default” access rights are used.

persistJob String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to persist after the server is restarted.

Set to... To...

true Persist the task after the server is restarted.

false Default. Do not persist the task after the server is restarted.

runInCluster String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want the task to run in a clustered environment.

Set to... To...

true Run the task in a clustered environment.

false Default. Run the task in a non-clustered environment.

inputs Document Optional. Document (IData object) containing inputs to the scheduled service.

interval String Optional. Time interval (measured in seconds) between repetitions of the task.

doNotOverlap String Optional. Flag indicating whether or not you want the executions of this task to overlap.

Set to... To...

true Prevent executions of the scheduled task from overlapping. After a scheduled task finishes executing, the Scheduler waits the number of seconds specified in interval before running the task again.

false Default. Allow executions of the scheduled task to overlap. The Scheduler runs the task every time the value of interval elapses.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 347

Page 348: Integration Server Bis Reference

23. Scheduler Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Unlike pub.scheduler:updateComplexTask, this service does not overwrite all the original parameter values. This service only updates the parameters for which you specify new values.

type String Code indicating the type of task updated. For this type of task, the value of type will be repeat.

taskUpdated String Indicates whether the task was successfully updated. If the task was successfully updated, taskUpdated contains true. If the task was not successfully updated, the server throws an exception and terminates the service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 348

Page 349: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 24. Schema Folder

You use the elements in the schema folder to validate objects and to validate the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 349

Page 350: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.schema:createXSDWmPublic. Creates an XML Schema definition from a document type, from the input and output parameters of a service, or from a specification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.schema:createXSD WmPublic. Creates an XML Schema definition from a document type, from the input and output parameters of a service, or from a specification.

pub.schema:validate WmPublic. Validates an object using an IS document type or a schema.

pub.schema:validatePipeline WmPublic. Validates the pipeline against a document type.

pub.schema.w3c WmPublic. This folder contains definitions for XML Schemas as defined in the W3C specification XML Schema Part 2: Datatypes.

pub.schema.w3c:xml WmPublic. A schema containing the XML Namespace components, such as xml:lang and xml:space, as defined in the W3C specifications Namespaces in XML and Extensible Markup Language (XML) 1.0.

pub.schema.w3c:xsi WmPublic. A schema containing the XML Schema instance components, such as xsi:nil, xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation, xsi:schemaLocation, and xsi:type, as defined in the W3C XML Schema recommendation Part 1: Structures.

name String Fully qualified name of a document type, service, or specification on the Integration Server.

isSuccessful String Flag indicating whether the schema definition was created successfully.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The schema definition was created successfully.

false The schema definition was not created successfully. See errors for detailed information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 350

Page 351: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

Usage Notes

If the document type, service signature, or specification you are providing as input to createXSD contains fields that belong to multiple XML namespaces, createXSD generates multiple XML Schema definitions (one for each XML namespace) and imports them into the XML Schema contained in the source field. These imported XML Schema definitions appear as children of xsd in the pipeline.

When using createXSD to create an XML Schema definition, keep the following points in mind:

Top-level strings are not allowed.

String tables beneath the top level are not allowed.

Field names must conform to QName lexical rules (that is, the prefix and local name must conform to NCName rules specified in http://www.w3.org/TR/REC-xml-names/#NT-NCName).

Field names cannot contain a prefix without an associated XML namespace.

Fields of type other than scalar string cannot have names that begin with the character @ or be named *body.

Fields at the same level (that is, beneath the same parent field in the input or output of the same signature) can have the same name but different types or properties. However, only one field's type and properties is used for all fields with that name at that level. Because the method used to select the field is not defined, webMethods recommends avoiding this case.

xsd Document Conditional. The schema definition xsd has the following keys:

Key Description

url String Conditional. Relative url of the generated schema.

source String Conditional. Schema definition.

errors Document List Conditional. List of fatal errors, if any, that occurred when generating the XSD. Each document in the list has the following structure:

Key Description

errorMessage String Text of the error message.

When fatal errors occur, the service does not generate an XSD file.

warnings Document List Conditional. List of non-fatal errors, if any, that were encountered while generating the XSD. Each document in the list has the following structure:

Key Description

warningMessage String Text of the warning message.

When non-fatal errors occur, the service generates the XSD file but also returns warnings to indicate that it encountered unusual or unexpected conditions during the process.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 351

Page 352: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

Only one field named *body can occur at the same level.

Duplicate field names that begin with the character @ cannot repeat at the same level.

Fields at different levels can have the same name with duplicate XML Namespace values, even if the fields have different types or properties. However, only one field's type and properties are used for all fields with that name at that level. Because the method used to select the field is not defined, webMethods recommends avoiding this case.

Object constraints are allowed. However, the Integration Server does not represent them in the XSD.

Strings constrained by older schema types (types defined before the W3C XML 2001 Schema recommendations) are allowed. However, the Integration Server translates them into 2001 XML Schema types.

If you use createXSD to create multiple XML Schema definitions that refer to each other, place the XSD files in the same folder or base path. To ensure that the references resolve correctly, make sure the relative URLs specified in the XSD files reflect the names of the XSD files within this folder or base path.

pub.schema:val idateWmPublic. Validates an object using an IS document type or a schema.

Input Parameters

object Document or com.wm.lang.xml.Document or com.wm.lang.xml.Node Object to be validated.

conformsTo String Document type or schema to validate object against.

If object is a document (IData object), conformsTo must specify the fully qualified name of a document type on the Integration Server.

If object is a com.wm.lang.xml.Document or com.wm.lang.xml.Node object, conformsTo must specify the fully qualified name of a schema on the Integration Server.

Note: The specified schema is used only for validating nodes with “Names” that are not from XML Namespaces (that is, qualified nodes whose XML Namespace Name properties are absent).

maxErrors String Optional. Number of errors to be collected. Default value is 1. When the number of errors found is equal to maxErrors, the validation processor stops validation and returns the result. If maxErrors is set to -1, the validation processor returns all errors.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 352

Page 353: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

Output Parameters

ignoreContent String Optional. Flag that specifies whether the validation processor will validate content keys of the type String, String List, or String Table.

Set to... To...

true Ignore content (that is, do not validate keys of these types).

false Default. Validate content.

failIfInvalid String Optional. Flag that indicates whether the service should fail and throw an exception if the object is invalid.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that the service should fail if the object is invalid.

false Default. Indicate that service should signal success and return errors to the pipeline if object is invalid.

isValid String Flag that indicates whether or not the validation was successful.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The validation was successful.

false The validation was unsuccessful.

errors Document List Errors encountered during validation. Each document will contain the following information:

Key Description

pathName String Location of the error in XQL.

errorCode String Error code (for example, VV-001).

errorMessage String Error message (for example, Missing Object).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 353

Page 354: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

pub.schema:val idatePipel ineWmPublic. Validates the pipeline against a document type.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

conformsTo String Fully qualified name of the document type that you want to validate against.

maxErrors String Optional. Number of errors to be collected. Default value is 1. When the number of errors found is equal to maxErrors, the validation processor stops validation and returns the result. If maxErrors is set to -1, the validation processor returns all errors.

ignoreContent String Optional. Flag that specifies whether the validation processor will validate content keys of the type String, String List, or String Table.

Set to... To...

true Ignore content (that is, do not validate keys of these types).

false Default. Validate content.

failIfInvalid String Optional. Flag that indicates whether the service should fail and throw an exception if the object is invalid.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that service should fail if object is invalid.

false Default. Indicate that service should simply signal success and return errors to the pipeline if object is invalid.

isValid String Flag that indicates whether or not the validation was successful.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The validation was successful.

false The validation was unsuccessful.

errors Document List Errors encountered during validation. Each document will contain the following information:

Key Description

pathName String Location of the error in XQL.

errorCode String Error code (for example, VV-001).

errorMessage String Error message (for example, Missing Object).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 354

Page 355: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

pub.schema.w3cWmPublic. This folder contains definitions for XML Schemas as defined in the W3C specification XML Schema Part 2: Datatypes.

For more information about schemas and datatypes, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide and the webMethods Integration Server Schema Reference.

pub.schema.w3c:xmlWmPublic. A schema containing the XML Namespace components, such as xml:lang and xml:space, as defined in the W3C specifications Namespaces in XML and Extensible Markup Language (XML) 1.0.

pub.schema.w3c:xsiWmPublic. A schema containing the XML Schema instance components, such as xsi:nil, xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation, xsi:schemaLocation, and xsi:type, as defined in the W3C XML Schema recommendation Part 1: Structures.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 355

Page 356: Integration Server Bis Reference

24. Schema Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 356

Page 357: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 25. Security Folder

Use the elements in the security folder to:

Control which client certificates are sent to other services.

Digitally sign data.

Process digital signatures.

Store and retrieve outbound passwords to access secure resources.

The services pub.security:setKeyAndChain, pub.security:setKeyAndChainFromBytes, and pub.security:clearKeyAndChain are used to control which client certificate the webMethods Integration Server presents to remote servers. You need to use these services to switch between certificates and certificate chains if you are not using aliases for remote servers. For more information about aliases for remote servers, see webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

Important! The pub.security.reverseInvoke services in this folder have been deprecated.

The pub.security.outboundPasswords services support the use of encrypted outbound passwords to access secure resources. You may wish to have a flow service access a secure resource such as a remote Integration Server, proxy server, or database. The service would need to provide a valid password to access the resource. The pub.security.outboundPass-words services allow a flow service to store passwords in and retrieve passwords from the Integration Server’s outbound password store. The outbound password store is an encrypted store of passwords managed by the Integration Server. For more information about the outbound password store, see webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 357

Page 358: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.security:clearKeyAndChain WmPublic. Associates the default key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services.

pub.security:setKeyAndChain WmPublic. Associates a key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services. Use this service to associate a key and certificate chain that is different from the default settings, and if your key and certificate information is located in files (rather than byte arrays).

pub.security:setKeyAndChainFromBytes WmPublic. Associates a key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services. Use this service to associate a key and certificate chain that is different from the default settings, and if your key and certificate information is located in byte arrays (rather than files).

pub.security.outboundPasswords:setPassword WmPublic. Stores a key and password in the password store.

pub.security.outboundPasswords:getPassword WmPublic. Retrieves the password associated with a given key.

pub.security.outboundPasswords:listKeys WmPublic. Lists the keys in the password store.

pub.security.outboundPasswords:removePassword WmPublic. Removes the password associated with a given key.

pub.security.outboundPasswords:updatePassword WmPublic. Changes the password associated with a given key.

pub.security.pkcs7:sign WmPublic. Creates a PKCS7 SignedData object.

pub.security.pkcs7:verify WmPublic. Processes a digital signature to make sure that the provided data has not been modified.

pub.security.reverseInvoke:deleteAllConnections WmPublic. Deprecated—Deletes all registration connections to a proxy server from an internal server.

pub.security.reverseInvoke:deleteConnection WmPublic. Deprecated—Deletes registered connections to a proxy server from an internal server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 358

Page 359: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.security.reverseInvoke:disableListeners WmPublic. Deprecated—Disables specified listener on a proxy or relay server.

pub.security.reverseInvoke:getNumConnections WmPublic. Deprecated—Gets number of connections to a proxy server. (For use on an internal server only.)

pub.security.reverseInvoke:getServerType WmPublic. Deprecated—Reports the type that this server is running as.

pub.security.reverseInvoke:keepAliveConnections WmPublic. Deprecated—Creates the maximum number of configured connections to the proxy server.

pub.security.reverseInvoke:listProxyListeners WmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the details about the proxy ports through which external clients make requests to the internal server. (For use on the reverse invoke server.)

pub.security.reverseInvoke:listRegisteredConnections WmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the connections to a proxy (when executed on an internal server) or lists the connections to an internal server (when executed on a proxy server).

pub.security.reverseInvoke:listRegistrationListeners WmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the details about registration listeners that accept connections from internal servers (for use on the reverse invoke server).

pub.security.reverseInvoke:registerReverseConnections WmPublic. Deprecated—Registers connections to the proxy server.

pub.security.util:createMessageDigest WmPublic. Generates a message digest for a given message.

pub.security.util:getCertificateInfo WmPublic. Retrieves information such as serial number, issuer, and expiration date from a digital certificate.

pub.security.util:loadPKCS7CertChain WmPublic. Converts a certificate chain that is in PKCS #7 format to a list of byte arrays.

pub.security.util:createSecureString WmPublic. Converts a Java String, byte array, or character array to a WmSecureString.

pub.security.util:convertSecureString WmPublic. Converts a WmSecureString to a Java String, byte array, or character array.

pub.security.util:destroySecureString WmPublic. Destroys a WmSecureString such that it is no longer in memory and removed from the pipeline.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 359

Page 360: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty:clearKeyAndChainWmPublic. Associates the default key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The following scenario describes a situation in which you would use the pub.security:setKeyAndChain and pub.security:clearKeyAndChain services.

Company A has a webMethods Integration Server with one certificate chain. Company A wants to start trading with two new companies: Company B and Company C. Due to explicit business decisions, both Company B and Company C require that secure requests to their servers use certificates issued by their company’s certificate authority. Company A now has three certificate sets that it must manage: one for connections to B, one for connections to C, and one for all other requests. Below is a high-level process flow of what Company A would do if documents needed to be forwarded to companies B, C, and D (some arbitrary partner without the stringent security).

Assume all network communication is done using HTTPS. Documents are sent to the companies in the following order: Company D, Company B, Company C, Company D. All data transfers make use of the pub.client:http service.

1 Invoke pub.client:http to send data to Company D.

2 Invoke pub.security:setKeyAndChain using the key and certificate chain for Company B.

3 Invoke pub.client:http to send data to Company B.

4 Invoke pub.security:setKeyAndChain using the key and certificate chain for Company C.

5 Invoke pub.client:http to send data to Company C.

6 Invoke pub.security:clearKeyAndChain to revert back to the default key and certificate chain for Company A’s server.

7 Invoke pub.client:http to send data to Company D.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 360

Page 361: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty:setKeyAndChainWmPublic. Associates a key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services. Use this service to associate a key and certificate chain that is different from the default settings, and if your key and certificate information is located in files (rather than byte arrays).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.securi ty:setKeyAndChainFromBytesWmPublic. Associates a key and certificate chain with the subsequent set of invoked services. Use this service to associate a key and certificate chain that is different from the default settings, and if your key and certificate information is located in byte arrays (rather than files).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To enable this service to work properly if you use the FTPS protocol, you must set the secure parameter to True in the pub.client:http and pub.client.ftp:login services.

You can use pub.security:clearKeyAndChain with pub.security:setKeyAndChainFromBytes. See the Usage Notes for pub.security:clearKeyAndChain for more information about using the pub.security:setKeyAndChainFromBytes service.

privKeyFile String Absolute (for example, D:\certs\cert1.der) or relative path of the file containing the private key. A relative path is the path relative to the directory from which the Integration Server has been started (for example, webMethods6\IntegrationServer\config\certs\cert1.der).

certFiles String List List of file names containing the certificates that comprise the certificate chain. The list should start with the user’s certificate followed by (in order) intermediate certificates and the root CA certificate.

Absolute or relative paths of the files can be specified.

privKey Object A byte array containing the client’s private key.

certs Object List List of byte arrays containing the client’s certificate chain. The list should start with the user’s certificate followed by (in sequence) intermediate certificates and the root CA certificate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 361

Page 362: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty.outboundPasswords:setPasswordWmPublic. Stores a key and password in the password store.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This is the basic process a flow service should follow to store an outbound password:

1 Call pub.security.util:createSecureString to create a WmSecureString object containing the password to be stored.

For security reasons, the flow service should be run manually requiring an authorized person to type the password to be stored. This will eliminate the need to save the password on disk in an unencrypted format.

2 Call pub.security.outboundPasswords:setPassword to save the password in encrypted form in the outbound password store.

The pub.security.outboundPasswords:setPassword service requires a key to be supplied which is basically a key to the password. This key must be saved in some way; any flow service wishing to use the password to access a secure resource will need to supply the key to retrieve the password from the outbound password store.

3 Once the password is successfully stored, call pub.security.util:destroySecureString to remove the password from memory.

Internal and Public Passwords

Internal passwords are passwords for use by the Integration Server itself to access secure resources (e.g., remote Integration Servers, JDBC connection pools, LDAP servers, etc.). Internal passwords are managed using the Integration Server Administrator and are stored in the outbound password store. Flow services are also allowed to store passwords in the outbound password store. However, by default, passwords stored by a flow service are considered “public,” as opposed to internal. This distinction allows flow services to use the outbound password store as a secure mechanism for storing and retrieving passwords, but protects the Integration Server’s internal passwords.

key String Key to be associated with the password entry.

value WmSecureString Password to be stored.

isInternal String “true” if this should be saved as an internal password; “false” if it should be saved as a public password. Default is “false”. (See “Internal and Public Passwords” for more information.)

result String “true” if password was successfully stored; “false” otherwise.

message String “successful” or reason for failure.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 362

Page 363: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

When calling any of the pub.security.outboundPasswords services (i.e. setPassword, getPassword, list-Keys, removePassword, and updatePassword) the isInternal input parameter indicates whether the service is working with internal or public passwords. Note that even if this parameter is set to “true”, you cannot access internal passwords if the Integration Server is configured to deny access to internal passwords. Access to internal passwords is controlled by the watt.security.ope.AllowInternalPasswordAccess configu-ration parameter on the Integration Server; for more information see webMethods Integration Server Admin-istrator’s Guide.

pub.securi ty.outboundPasswords:getPasswordWmPublic. Retrieves a password from the password store for a given key.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This is the basic process a flow service should follow to retrieve an outbound password:

1 Call pub.security.outboundPasswords:getPassword with the key to the password to be retrieved.

If the key is unknown, you can call pub.security.outboundPasswords:listKeys to retrieve a list of keys currently in the outbound password store.

The pub.security.outboundPasswords:getPassword service returns a WmSecureString object containing the retrieved password.

2 Call pub.security.util:convertSecureString to convert the password to a usable format.

The password can then be passed to the authenticating mechanism of the secure resource.

3 When done accessing the secure resource, call pub.security.util:destroySecureString to remove the password from memory.

key String Key of the password entry to be retrieved.

isInternal String “true” if this is an internal password; “false” if it is public. By default, this is “false”. If you specify incorrectly whether the password is internal or public, the retrieve operation will fail. (For more information about internal and public passwords, see “Internal and Public Passwords”.)

value WmSecureString Value of the retrieved password.

result String “true” if the password value was successfully retrieved; “false” otherwise.

message String “successful” or reason for failure.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 363

Page 364: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty.outboundPasswords: l istKeysWmPublic. Lists the keys in the password store.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.outboundPasswords:removePasswordWmPublic. Removes a password from the password store for a given key.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.outboundPasswords:updatePasswordWmPublic. Changes the password value for a key already in the password store.

Input Parameters

isInternal String “true” if you want keys for internal passwords; “false” if you want keys for public passwords. By default this is “false”. (For more information about internal and public passwords, see “Internal and Public Passwords”.)

key IData List of keys in the password store.

result String “true” if the list of keys was successfully retrieved; “false” otherwise.

key String Key of the password to be removed.

isInternal String “true” if this is an internal password; “false” if it is public. By default, this is “false”. If you specify incorrectly whether the password is internal or public, the remove operation will fail. (For more information about internal and public passwords, see “Internal and Public Passwords”.)

result String “true” if the password was successfully removed; “false” otherwise.

message String “successful” or reason for failure.

key String Key of the password to be updated.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 364

Page 365: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.pkcs7:signWmPublic. Creates a PKCS7 SignedData object.

This service enables multiple entities to sign the specified data. Each signerInfo block contained in the resulting signature contains two authenticated attributes: the content type and a timestamp.

Input Parameters

newPassword WmSecureString New password value for the key.

isInternal String “true” if this is an internal password; “false” if it is public. By default, this is “false”. If you specify incorrectly whether the password is internal or public, the update operation will fail. (For more information about internal and public passwords, see “Internal and Public Passwords”.)

result String “true” if the password value was successfully changed; “false” otherwise.

message String “successful” or reason for failure.

signerInfo Document List Information about a single signer of the signed data object. Each signerInfo requires either a certificate chain and a private key or a key alias that references them.

Key Description

certChain java.security.cert.X509Certificate[ ] or byte[ ][ ] Certificate chain of the signer. The subject that is performing the signature should be the first certificate in this chain, while the root Certifying Authority should be the last. The key provided should correspond to the public key contained in the first certificate of the chain.

key java.security.PrivateKey or byte[ ] Private key that will be used to digitally sign the data. The private key can be any asymmetric encryption key that is supported by the webMethods Integration Server (for example, DSA or RSA).

keyAlias String Alias of the certificate chain and private key in the key store. This key is not currently used.

hashAlgorithm String The algorithm to use when computing the digest of the provided data (SHA-1 or MD5). The default value is MD5.

data byte[ ] Data to be digitally signed.

detachedSignature String Flag specifying whether to generate a detached signature. A detached signature does not include the data that was signed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 365

Page 366: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.pkcs7:veri fyWmPublic. Processes a digital signature to make sure that the provided data has not been modified.

Input Parameters

Set to... To...

true Generate a detached signature.

false Default. Generate an implicit signature (one that includes the signed data).

signature byte[ ] Signature generated from the supplied data. This is a DER-encoded representation of the SignedData object as specified in PKCS#7.

signature byte[ ] Signature to use to determine whether the signed data is intact (a DER-encoded representation of the SignedData object as specified in PKCS#7). If you are processing a detached signature, pass the signature in signature. If you are processing an implicit signature, pass the entire signed message in signature.

data byte[ ] Optional. The data that was signed. If you are processing a detached signature, you must supply data. If you are processing an implicitly signed message, you do not need to supply data because both the message and the signature reside in signature.

detachedSignature String Optional. Flag indicating whether the message has a detached signature.

Set to... When...

true The message has a detached signature.

false Default. The message has an implicit signature.

signerCertChain byte[ ][ ] Optional. Certificate chains of the parties that signed the message.

Note: If the signers included the certificate chain with the digital signature, you do not need to supply signerCertChain.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 366

Page 367: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:deleteAl lConnect ionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Deletes all registration connections to a proxy server from an internal server.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

content byte[ ] Conditional. The data (for example, the document that was originally signed) extracted from an implicit signature. If you are verifying a detached signature, content is not returned.

Note: The extracted data is returned in content even if signature verification fails.

signerInfo Document List Information about the signers. Each document in the list provides the following information about a single signer:

Key Description

certChain java.security.cert.X509Certificate[ ] Certificate chain of the signer. The chain will appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s X.509 certificate in element 0.

timeStamp java.util.Date Time at which the signer signed the data.

trusted String Flag indicating whether the certificate chain presented by the signer is trusted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The chain is trusted.

false The chain is not trusted.

status String Flag indicating whether the signatures were successfully verified. If successful, status contains verified. If the signatures were not successfully verified, status contains an error message.

message String Text message indicating whether the connections were successfully removed or not.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 367

Page 368: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:deleteConnect ionWmPublic. Deprecated—Deletes registered connections to a proxy server from an internal server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:disableListenersWmPublic. Deprecated—Disables specified listener on a proxy or relay server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:getNumConnect ionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Gets number of connections to a proxy server. (For use on an internal server only.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

alias String Remote connection alias to delete.

numConnections String Number of connections to delete. If you specify more connections than are registered, all connections for the alias are deleted.

numDeletedConnections String Number of connections that were deleted.

listenerType String Type of listener to disable.

Set to... To...

proxy Disable the proxy listener.

registration Disable the relay listener.

alias String Alias of the proxy server for which you want to get the number of connections.

numConnections String Number of current connections to proxy server specified in alias.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 368

Page 369: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:getServerTypeWmPublic. Deprecated—Reports the type that this server is running as.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:keepAl iveConnect ionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Creates the maximum number of configured connections to the proxy server.

(For use on an internal server only.) This service compares the number of actual connections to a proxy server to the number of connections that are configured for that server. If the number of actual connections is less than the number of configured connections, the service creates additional connections so that all configured connections are available.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

serverType String Flag indicating the server’s type.

A value of... Indicates that...

proxy The server is functioning as a proxy server.

relay The server is functioning as a relay server.

internal The server is functioning as an internal server.

totalConnections String The resulting number of connections to the proxy server, including the number of existing connections and the number of connections the service created.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 369

Page 370: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke: l istProxyListenersWmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the details about the proxy ports through which external clients make requests to the internal server. (For use on the reverse invoke server.)

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

proxyListeners Document List Details about the proxy listeners. Each document in the list contains the following information about a proxy listener.

Key Description

port Object Port number on which the server is listening.

protocol String Protocol the internal service is using.

A value of... Indicates that...

HTTP The connection is through HTTP.

HTTPS The connection is through HTTPS.

pkg String Name of the package to which this listener belongs.

enabled String Flag indicating whether the package in pkg is currently enabled.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The package is enabled.

false The package is disabled.

key String Unique key for this listener.

hostAccessMode String Default access mode set on the proxy port.

A value of... Indicates that...

include The port allows all hosts except those identified in hostDeny.

exclude The port denies all hosts except those identified in hostAllow.

hostAllow String List List of hosts that are allowed access to the listening port (if value of hostAccessMode is exclude).

hostDeny String List List of hosts that are denied access to the listening port (if value of hostAccessMode is include).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 370

Page 371: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

configURL String Name of the dynamic server page (dsp) that can be used to configure this proxy listener.

provider String Name of the entity that provided this listener (that is, webMethods).

listenerType String Type of listener the port functions as. The value will always be proxy, since this service returns information about a proxy listening port.

status String Flag indicating whether this proxy listener is active or inactive.

A value of... Indicates that...

Active The listener is currently enabled.

Inactive The listener is currently disabled.

listening String Flag indicating whether this proxy listener is listening.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The proxy listener is listening.

false The proxy listener is not listening.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 371

Page 372: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke: l istRegisteredConnect ionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the connections to a proxy (when executed on an internal server) or lists the connections to an internal server (when executed on a proxy server).

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

registeredConnections Document List List of connections. Each document (IData) in registeredConnections has the following structure:

Key Description

remoteEndPoint String IP address and port of remote machine. If the connection is to a proxy server, this parameter is null.

secure String Flag indicating whether the connection is secure.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The connection is secure.

false The connection is not secure.

isOpen String Flag indicating whether the connection is open.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The connection is open.

false The connection is not open.

pendingRequests String Number of requests pending on this connection.

alias String Alias of the remote host. Returned only if the connection is to a proxy server.

totalRegisteredConnections String Total number of remote connections.

reqThreshold String Maximum number of pending requests per connection.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 372

Page 373: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke: l istRegistrat ionListenersWmPublic. Deprecated—Lists the details about registration listeners that accept connections from internal servers (for use on the reverse invoke server).

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

registrationListeners Document List List of registration listeners. Each document (IData) in registrationListeners has the following structure:

port Object Port number of the listener.

protocol String Protocol used by listener.

A value of... Indicates that...

SOCK The listener uses SOCK.

SSLSOCK The listener uses SSLSOCK.

pkg String Name of the package to which this listener belongs.

enabled String Flag indicating whether the package in pkg is currently enabled.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The package is enabled.

false The package is disabled.

key String Unique key for this listener.

hostAccessMode String Default access mode set on the listening port.

A value of... Indicates that...

include The port allows all hosts except those identified in hostDeny.

exclude The port denies all hosts except those identified in hostAllow.

hostAllow String List List of hosts that are allowed access to the listening port (if value of hostAccessMode is exclude).

hostDeny String List List of hosts that are denied access to the listening port (if value of hostAccessMode is include).

factoryKey String Key to the factory that is used to create this listener.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 373

Page 374: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty. reverseInvoke:registerReverseConnect ionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Registers connections to the proxy server.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

configURL String Name of the dynamic server page (dsp) that can be used to configure this listener.

provider String Name of the entity that provided this listener (that is, webMethods).

listenerType String Type of listener the port functions as. The value will always be Registration.

status String Flag indicating whether this listener is active.

A value of... Indicates that...

Active The listener is currently enabled.

Inactive The listener is currently disabled.

listening String Flag indicating whether this listener is listening.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The listener is listening.

false The listener is not listening.

alias String Alias of the remote server on which connections will be registered.

numConnections String Number of connections to register.

message String Text message indicating whether the connections were successfully registered or not.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 374

Page 375: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty.ut i l :createMessageDigestWmPublic. Generates a message digest for a given message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.ut i l :getCert i f icateInfoWmPublic. Retrieves information such as serial number, issuer, and expiration date from a digital certificate.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

algorithm String Name of the algorithm that you want to use to compute the message digest. Must be either MD5 or SHA-1.

input byte[ ] Message for which you want the digest generated.

output byte[ ] Computed digest.

certificate byte[ ] java.security.cert.X509Certificate The certificate whose information you want to retrieve.

info Document Information from the certificate.

Key Description

version java.lang.Number X509 certificate version number.

serialNumber String Serial number of the certificate.

signature String Signature algorithm used by the issuer to sign this certificate.

issuer Document Detailed information about the CA that signed the certificate, such as name, location, and email address.

validity Document The time period over which the certificate is valid.

Key Description

notBefore String First date on which this certificate is valid (for example, 3/15/00 3:36PM).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 375

Page 376: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

pub.securi ty.ut i l : loadPKCS7CertChainWmPublic. Converts a certificate chain that is in PKCS #7 format to a list of byte arrays.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.ut i l :createSecureStr ingWmPublic. Creates a WmSecureString object from either a Java String, byte array, or character array.

WmSecureString is a mutable alternative to Java String. It allows the characters in the string to be explicitly removed from memory. Any password you wish to store in the Integration Server’s outbound password store must be converted to a WmSecureString.

Input Parameters

notAfter String Last date on which this certificate is valid (for example, 3/15/00 3:36PM).

subject Document Detailed information about the owner of the certificate, such as name, location, and email address.

subjectPublicKeyAlgorithm String Encryption algorithm with which the certificate’s key is designed to be used (for example, RSA or DSA).

certificateChain byte[ ] The certificate chain in PKCS #7 format.

certificates byte[ ] [ ] List of byte arrays in which each byte[ ] in the list contains a certificate from certificateChain.

string String Java String to made into a WmSecureString.

bytes byte[ ] Byte array to be made into a WmSecureString.

chars char[ ] Character array to be made into a WmSecureString.

encoding String If a byte array is supplied as an input parameter, encoding specifies the Java encoding of the byte array. This may be any encoding supported by Java String. By default, if no encoding is specified, then the default JVM encoding is used.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 376

Page 377: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Only one of the input parameters (i.e. string, bytes, or chars) may be specified. If more than one is specified, an exception will be thrown. An exception is also thrown if none of these is specified.

pub.securi ty.ut i l :convertSecureStringWmPublic. Returns a WmSecureString in Java String, byte array, or character array format.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.securi ty.ut i l :destroySecureStringWmPublic. Destroys a WmSecureString such that it no longer resides in memory and is removed from the pipeline.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

secureString WmSecureString WmSecureString created from the supplied input parameters.

secureString WmSecureString WmSecureString to be converted.

returnAs String Format into which the WmSecureString is to be converted. Valid options are byte[], char[], and Java String. If a value for this parameter is not specified, the default is to convert the WmSecureString to a String.

string String The WmSecureString converted to a Java String.

bytes byte[ ] The WmSecureString converted to a native Java byte array.

chars char[ ] The WmSecureString converted to a native Java character array.

secureString WmSecureString WmSecureString to be destroyed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 377

Page 378: Integration Server Bis Reference

25. Security Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 378

Page 379: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 26. SMIME Folder

You use the elements in the smime folder to create digitally signed and/or encrypted MIME messages. You also use the services in this folder to process signed and encrypted MIME messages that are passed into the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 379

Page 380: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.smime:createCertsOnlyDataWmPublic. Generates a PKCS #7 certs-only S/MIME entity from an array of certificates.

This service can be used to develop mechanisms for transmitting certificates and certificate chains to other parties.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

Element Package and Description

pub.smime:createCertsOnlyData WmPublic. Generates a PKCS #7 certs-only S/MIME entity from an array of certificates.

pub.smime:createEncryptedData WmPublic. Encrypts a MIME message.

pub.smime:createSignedAndEncryptedData WmPublic. Digitally signs a MIME message and then encrypts it.

pub.smime:createSignedData WmPublic. Digitally signs a MIME message.

pub.smime:processCertsOnlyData WmPublic. Extracts the certificates from a PKCS #7 certs-only S/MIME entity.

pub.smime:processEncryptedData WmPublic. Decrypts an encrypted S/MIME message.

pub.smime:processSignedData WmPublic. Verifies the signature from a signed S/MIME entity and extracts the message from it.

certificates byte[ ][ ] The certificates that are to be encapsulated within the S/MIME entity. Each byte[ ] represents a single certificate.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream S/MIME entity.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 380

Page 381: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

pub.smime:createEncryptedDataWmPublic. Encrypts a MIME message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.smime:createSignedDatapub.smime:processEncryptedDatapub.mime:getEnvelopeStream

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.smime:build_EncryptedSMime

envStream java.io.InputStream MIME message that you want to encrypt (for example, the output produced by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream).

recipientCerts byte[ ][ ] The X.509 certificates of the recipients for whom this message will be encrypted. Each element in the list represents a certificate for a single recipient in the form of a byte[ ].

Note: When you have multiple recipients, createEncryptedData creates a single message that is encrypted for all recipients. It does not create a separate message for each recipient.

encryptionAlg String Optional. Code specifying the encryption algorithm to use. Must be TripleDES (default), DES, or RC2.

keyLength String Optional. Length of the encryption key for RC2 encryption. Must be 40, 64, or 128 (default).

This parameter is ignored if encryptionAlg is not RC2.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream The encrypted MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 381

Page 382: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

pub.smime:createSignedAndEncryptedDataWmPublic. Digitally signs a MIME message and then encrypts it.

Important! You must use this service when you want to create a message that is both signed and encrypted. You cannot produce this type of message using the pub.smime:createSignedData and pub.smime:createEncryptedData services.

Input Parameters

envStream java.io.InputStream The MIME message that you want to sign and encrypt (for example, the output produced by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream).

privKey byte[ ] Private key of the party signing the message.

certificates byte[ ] [ ] Optional. The certificate chain of the party signing the message, where each byte[ ] represents a single certificate in the chain. Certificates must appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s certificate in element 0. The following list shows how the elements of a complete chain would appear for a certificate that was issued through two intermediate CAs:

Element Contents

0 Signer’s certificate.

1 Intermediary CA Certificate.

2 Intermediary CA Certificate.

3 Root CA Certificate.

Note: Although this parameter is optional, it should only be omitted if the party receiving the message is able to process this signature without an accompanying certificate chain.

signerCert byte[ ] Digital certificate of the party signing the message.

explicit String Optional. Flag indicating whether an implicit or explicit signature is to be generated.

Set to... To...

true Default. Generate an explicit (detached) signature.

false Generate an implicit signature.

recipientCerts byte[ ][ ] X.509 certificates of the recipients for whom this message will be encrypted. Each element in the list contains the certificate for a single recipient in the form of a byte array.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 382

Page 383: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.smime:createEncryptedDatapub.smime:processEncryptedDatapub.smime:createSignedDatapub.smime:processSignedDatapub.mime:getEnvelopeStream

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.smime:build_SignedAndEncryptedSMime

pub.smime:createSignedDataWmPublic. Digitally signs a MIME message.

Input Parameters

encryptionAlg String Optional. Code specifying the encryption algorithm to use. Must be TripleDES (default), DES, or RC2.

keyLength String Optional. Length of the encryption key for RC2 encryption. Must be 40, 64, or 128 (default).

This parameter is ignored if encryptionAlg is not RC2.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream Signed and encrypted MIME message.

envStream java.io.InputStream MIME message that you want to sign (for example, the output produced by pub.mime:getEnvelopeStream).

privKey byte[ ] Private key of the party signing the message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 383

Page 384: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For general information about MIME messages and using the MIME services, see the MIME-S/MIME Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.smime:createEncryptedDatapub.mime:getEnvelopeStream

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.smime:build_SignedSMime

certificates byte[ ][ ] Optional. Certificate chain of the party that signed the message, where each byte[ ] represents a single certificate in the chain. Certificates must appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s certificate in element 0. The following shows how the elements of a complete chain would appear for a certificate that was issued through two intermediate CAs:

Element Contents

0 Signer’s certificate.

1 Intermediary CA Certificate.

2 Intermediary CA Certificate.

3 Root CA Certificate.

Although this parameter is optional, it should only be omitted if the party receiving the message is able to process this signature without an accompanying certificate chain.

signerCert byte[ ] Digital certificate of the party signing the message.

explicit String Optional. Flag indicating whether an implicit or explicit signature is generated.

Set to... To...

true Default. Generate an explicit (detached) signature.

false Generate an implicit signature.

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream The signed MIME message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 384

Page 385: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

pub.smime:processCertsOnlyDataWmPublic. Extracts the certificates from a PKCS #7 certs-only S/MIME entity.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.smime:processEncryptedDataWmPublic. Decrypts an encrypted S/MIME message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream The certs-only S/MIME entity.

certificates byte[ ][ ] The extracted certificates. Each element in the list contains one of the extracted certificates represented as a byte[ ].

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream The encrypted S/MIME entity (for example, the output produced by pub.smime:createEncryptedData).

recipientCert byte[ ] Digital certificate of the party receiving the message.

privKey byte[ ] Private key of the party receiving the message (that is, the party whose public key was used to encrypt the message).

mimeData Document MIME object containing the decrypted MIME message.

contentDigest String Message digest of the encrypted content, base64-encoded. (Some sites return this digest to the sender to acknowledge their receipt of the message.)

encrypted String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is encrypted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is encrypted.

false The MIME entity is not encrypted.

signed String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is signed.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is signed.

false The MIME entity is not signed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 385

Page 386: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

Usage Notes

If the decrypted message is signed or encrypted, mimeData will be empty, and the decrypted message will reside in stream. You can check the state of the signed and encrypted output variables to determine whether the decrypted message requires additional processing, and pass stream to the pub.smime:processSignedData or pub.smime:processEncryptedData service as necessary.

Important! You can examine the contents of mimeData during testing and debugging. However, because the internal structure of mimeData is subject to change without notice, do not explicitly set or map data to/from these elements in your service. To manipulate or access the contents of mimeData, use only the MIME services that webMethods provides.

See Also

pub.smime:processSignedDatapub.smime:createEncryptedData

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.smime:extract_EncryptedSMimesample.smime:extract_SignedAndEncryptedSMime

certsOnly String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the decrypted MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

false The MIME entity is not a certs-only entity.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. The decrypted MIME entity.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 386

Page 387: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

pub.smime:processSignedDataWmPublic. Verifies the signature from a signed S/MIME entity and extracts the message from it.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

SMimeEnvStream java.io.InputStream Signed MIME entity (for example, the output produced by pub.smime:createSignedData).

signerCertChain byte[ ][ ] Optional. Certificate chain of the party that signed the message, where each byte[ ] represents a single certificate in the chain. Certificates must appear in hierarchical order, starting with the signer’s certificate in element 0. The following shows how the elements of a complete chain would appear for a certificate that was issued through two intermediate CAs:

Element Contents

0 Signer’s certificate.

1 Intermediary CA Certificate.

2 Intermediary CA Certificate.

3 Root CA Certificate.

Note: If the signer included the certificate chain with the digital signature, you do not need to supply signerCertChain.

mimeData Document MIME object containing the extracted MIME entity.

contentDigest String Message digest (base64-encoded) that was recalculated by processSignedData.

signerCert java.security.cert.X509Certificate Signer’s X.509 certificate.

encrypted String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is encrypted.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is encrypted.

false The MIME entity is not encrypted.

signed String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is signed.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is signed.

false The MIME entity is not signed.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 387

Page 388: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

certsOnly String Conditional. Flag indicating whether the extracted MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The MIME entity is a certs-only entity.

false The MIME entity is not a certs-only entity.

stream java.io.InputStream Conditional. Extracted MIME entity.

verify String Flag indicating whether the signature was successfully processed. Success indicates that the signature was successfully verified with the supplied public key.

A value of... Indicates that...

true Signature processing was successful.

false Signature processing failed. The signature could not be verified because an errorCode 1, 2, 3, or 4 occurred.

trusted String Flag indicating whether the signer certificate is trusted or not.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The signer certificate is trusted.

false The signer certificate is not trusted.

errorCode String Conditional. Number indicating the kind of error that occurred while processing the signature. See errorMessage for possible values.

If no error occurred, errorCode will not be returned.

errorMessage String Conditional. Textual error message indicating what kind of error occurred while processing the signature. Error codes and messages are as follows:

errorCode errorMessage

1 Invalid signer certificate file information.

2 Certificate at index ‘i’ is not in recognizable format.

3 Invalid certificate input at index ‘i’.

4 Signature cannot be verified.

5 Expired certificate chain.

6 Error in certificate chain.

7 Untrusted certificate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 388

Page 389: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

Usage Notes

If verify is false, the errorCode and errorMessage values will indicate the error that caused the failure. Note that errorCode values 5 through 7 do not represent signature-validation failures and, therefore, do not cause the verify flag to be set to false.

If the extracted entity is signed or encrypted, mimeData will be empty, and the extracted entity will reside in stream. You can check the state of the signed and encrypted output variables to determine whether the extracted entity requires additional processing, and pass stream to the pub.smime:processEncryptedData service as necessary.

Important! You can examine the contents of mimeData during testing and debugging. However, because the internal structure of mimeData is subject to change without notice, do not explicitly set or map data to/from these elements in your service. To manipulate or access the contents of mimeData, use only the MIME services that webMethods provides.

See Also

pub.smime:processEncryptedDatapub.smime:createSignedData

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.smime:extract_SignedSMimesample.smime:extract_SignedAndEncryptedSMime

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 389

Page 390: Integration Server Bis Reference

26. SMIME Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 390

Page 391: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 27. SOAP Folder

You use the elements in the soap folder to compose and send SOAP messages and to receive and retrieve data from within them. You also use SOAP services to register custom SOAP processors.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 391

Page 392: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.soap.processor:list WmPublic. Returns a list of the SOAP processors that are currently registered on the Integration Server.

pub.soap.processor:processMessage WmPublic. Executes the Integration Server’s default SOAP processor.

pub.soap.processor:processRPCMessage WmPublic. Executes the Integration Server’s SOAP RPC processor.

pub.soap.processor:registerProcessor WmPublic. Registers a service as a SOAP processor on the Integration Server.

pub.soap.processor:unregisterProcessor WmPublic. Unregisters a SOAP processor by removing it from the registry.

pub.soap.schema:encoding WmPublic. Schema that defines the data types SOAP supports.

pub.soap.schema:envelope WmPublic. Schema that defines the structure of a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry WmPublic. Inserts an entry into the body element of a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry WmPublic. Inserts an entry into the header element of a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:addTrailer WmPublic. Inserts a trailer in a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:createSoapData WmPublic. Creates an empty SOAP object.

pub.soap.utils:exitUnableToUnderstand WmPublic. Terminates processing and returns a mustUnderstand fault to the client.

pub.soap.utils:getActor WmPublic. Retrieves the value of the actor attribute from a given header entry.

pub.soap.utils:getBody WmPublic. Retrieves the body from a SOAP message as a single node object.

pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries WmPublic. Retrieves the body entries from a SOAP message as an array of node objects.

pub.soap.utils:getDocument WmPublic. Retrieves an entire SOAP message as a node object.

pub.soap.utils:getHeader WmPublic. Retrieves the header from a SOAP message as a single node object.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 392

Page 393: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries WmPublic. Retrieves the header entries from a SOAP message as an array of node objects.

pub.soap.utils:getMustUnderstand WmPublic. Returns the mustUnderstand status for a given header entry.

pub.soap.utils:getQName WmPublic. Returns the qualified name for a given node.

pub.soap.utils:getTrailers WmPublic. Retrieves the trailers from a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:QName WmPublic. Document type that defines the structure of a qualified name.

pub.soap.utils:removeBodyEntry WmPublic. Deletes a body entry from a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:removeHeaderEntry WmPublic. Deletes a header entry from a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:removeTrailer WmPublic. Deletes a trailer from a SOAP message.

pub.soap.utils:requestResponseSpec WmPublic. Defines the input/output signature for a custom processor and a target service for the default processor.

pub.soap.utils:soapDataToString WmPublic. Converts a SOAP object to a String.

pub.soap.utils:streamToSoapData WmPublic. Converts an InputStream containing a SOAP message to a SOAP object.

pub.soap.utils:stringToSoapData WmPublic. Converts a String containing a SOAP message to a SOAP object.

pub.soap.utils:validateSoapData WmPublic. Verifies that a SOAP object represents a valid SOAP message.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 393

Page 394: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.processor: l istWmPublic. Returns a list of the SOAP processors that are currently registered on the Integration Server.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.soap.processor:registerProcessorpub.soap.processor:unregisterProcessor

list Document List List of processors currently registered on the server. Each document in the list contains the following information:

Key Description

directive String Process directive that is assigned to the SOAP processor.

svcName String Fully qualified name of the service that functions as the SOAP processor.

descriptiveName String Descriptive comment that was given to the SOAP processor when it was registered. This element will be empty if the processor was not registered with a descriptive comment.

validateSOAPMessage String Flag indicating whether the SOAP message handler validates the SOAP messages that this processor sends and receives.

A value of... Indicates that...

true Messages are validated by the SOAP message handler. Be aware that the validation process checks only that the message envelope is structured correctly. For example, it checks the message has at least one body element and there is at most one header element. It does not validate any of the data carried by the message.

This setting overrides the server’s global watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting.

false Messages are not validated by the SOAP message handler.

This setting overrides the server’s global watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting.

If validateSOAPMessage is null, message validation for the processor is determined by the server’s watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 394

Page 395: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.processor:processMessage WmPublic. Executes the Integration Server’s default SOAP processor.

This service behaves exactly like the built-in default SOAP processor. However, this service can be wrapped in a flow service, which enables you to create an access-controlled SOAP processor. For information about creating and registering access-controlled SOAP processors, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You invoke processMessage from a wrapper service that you create and register as a SOAP processor on the Integration Server. To impose access control on the processor, you assign an access control list (ACL) to the wrapper service. For information about how to use this service, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

pub.soap.processor:processRPCMessage WmPublic. Executes the Integration Server’s SOAP RPC processor.

This service behaves exactly like the built-in SOAP RPC processor. However, this service can be wrapped in a flow service, which enables you to create an access-controlled SOAP processor. For information about creating and registering access-controlled SOAP processors, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

Input Parameters

soapRequestData Object SOAP object containing the SOAP request submitted to the Integration Server by a client.

soapResponseData Object Empty SOAP object that the service will use to compose the SOAP response message.

soapResponseData Object SOAP object containing the SOAP response message that is to be returned to the client.

soapRequestData Object SOAP object containing the SOAP request submitted to the Integration Server by a client.

soapResponseData Object Empty SOAP object that the service will use to compose the SOAP response message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 395

Page 396: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You invoke processRPCMessage from a wrapper service that you create and register as a SOAP processor on the Integration Server. To impose access control on the processor, you assign an access control list (ACL) to the wrapper service. For information about how to use this service, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

pub.soap.processor:registerProcessorWmPublic. Registers a service as a SOAP processor on the Integration Server.

Input Parameters

soapResponseData Object SOAP object containing the SOAP response message that is to be returned to the client.

directive String Process directive that you want to assign to the SOAP processor.

Note: Use only letters, digits, or the characters -_.!~*'( ) in the name you specify in directive.

svcName String Fully qualified name of the service that you are registering as a SOAP processor.

descriptiveName String Descriptive comment for this SOAP processor. This comment is shown when you run the utility service pub.soap.processor:list to get a list of the registered SOAP processors.

validateSOAPMessage String Optional. Flag indicating whether the SOAP message handler validates the SOAP messages that this processor sends and receives.

Set to... To...

true Validate messages sent and received by this SOAP processor. Be aware that the validation process checks only that the message envelope is structured correctly. For example, it checks the message has at least one body element and there is at most one header element. It does not validate any of the data carried by the message.

This setting overrides the server’s global watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting.

false Bypass validation on messages sent and received by this SOAP processor.

This setting overrides the server’s global watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 396

Page 397: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

For information about creating and registering SOAP processors, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.processor:listpub.soap.processor:unregisterProcessor

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:registerProcessor

pub.soap.processor:unregisterProcessorWmPublic. Unregisters a SOAP processor by removing it from the registry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If the directive specified in directive is not registered on the Integration Server, unregisterProcessor throws an exception.

See Also

pub.soap.processor:listpub.soap.processor:registerProcessor

Or, leave validateSOAPMessage null to validate messages according to the Integration Server’s watt.server.SOAP.validateSOAPMessage setting. This is the default.

directive String Process directive that you want to remove from the registry. Directive names are case sensitive.

Tip! To obtain a list of the current SOAP processor directives registered on the server, run the pub.soap.processor:list service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 397

Page 398: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.schema:encodingWmPublic. Schema that defines the data types SOAP supports.

pub.soap.schema:envelopeWmPublic. Schema that defines the structure of a SOAP message.

pub.soap.ut i ls:addBodyEntryWmPublic. Inserts an entry into the body element of a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

A SOAP object is an object that represents a SOAP message.

If you are composing a new SOAP message, you must first create an empty SOAP object (called soapData) with the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData service and then add body entries to with addBodyEntry.

If you are composing a SOAP response, you use pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry to populate the soapResponseData object that the SOAP message handler generates and puts in the pipeline.

For information about composing SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

soapData Object SOAP object to which you want the body entry added.

bodyEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node containing the body entry that you want to add to soapData.

Note: An XML node is a parsable representation of a node in an XML document. You generate an XML node using services such as pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode.

Important! This service adds a single body entry to a SOAP object. If you need to add more than one entry, execute pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry once for each entry.

Important! In webMethods versions 6.0.1 and later, this service expects the node in bodyEntry to be namespace qualified. If the node is not qualified, the service throws an exception. If you created solutions based on the earlier behavior of this service (which permitted non-qualified entries), you can disable namespace enforcement by setting the server’s watt.server.SOAP.EnforceMsgPartNS parameter to false. For information about this parameter, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide

soapData Object SOAP object to which the body entry was added.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 398

Page 399: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

See Also

pub.soap.utils:createSoapDatapub.soap.utils:addBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:addTrailerpub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:buildMsg_sendHTTPsample.soap:customProc_msgQuwuesample.soap:targetSvc_defaultProc

pub.soap.ut i ls:addHeaderEntryWmPublic. Inserts an entry into the header element of a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

soapData Object SOAP object to which you want the header entry added.

headerEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node containing the entry that you want to add to soapData.

Note: An XML node is a parsable representation of a node in an XML document. You generate an XML node using services such as pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode.

Important! This service adds a single header entry to a SOAP object. If you need to add more than one entry, execute addHeaderEntry once for each entry.

Important! In webMethods versions 6.0.1 and later, this service expects the node in headerEntry to be namespace qualified. If the node is not qualified, the service throws an exception. If you created solutions based on the earlier behavior of this service (which permitted non-qualified entries), you can disable namespace enforcement by setting the server’s watt.server.SOAP.EnforceMsgPartNS parameter to false. For information about this parameter, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

mustUnderstand String Optional. Value to which you want the mustUnderstand attribute set.

The mustUnderstand attribute specifies whether recipients are required to process a header entry (that is, whether processing of the entry is mandatory or optional). Recipients that cannot process a mandatory header entry must reject the message and return a SOAP fault.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 399

Page 400: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

A SOAP object is an object that represents a SOAP message.

If you are composing a new SOAP message, you must first create an empty SOAP object (called soapData) with the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData service and then add your header entries to with addHeaderEntry.

If you are composing a SOAP response, you use addHeaderEntry to populate the soapResponseData object that the SOAP message handler generates and puts in the pipeline.

For information about composing SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:createSoapDatapub.soap.utils:addBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:addTrailerpub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:buildMsg_sendHTTP sample.soap:targetSvc_defaultProc

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The header is optional.

1 The header is mandatory.

For additional information about the mustUnderstand attribute, see the Simple Object Access Protocol (SOAP) 1.1 - W3C Note 08 May 2000 at http://www.w3.org/TR/SOAP/.

Note: If you do not set mustUnderstand, the mustUnderstand attribute is omitted from the header entry, which is equivalent to setting mustUnderstand to 0.

actor String Optional. Value to which you want the actor attribute set.

The actor attribute specifies a URI that identifies the recipient to which a header entry is targeted. For additional information about the mustUnderstand attribute, see the Simple Object Access Protocol (SOAP) 1.1 - W3C Note 08 May 2000 at http://www.w3.org/TR/SOAP/.

soapData Object SOAP object to which the header entry was added.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 400

Page 401: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:addTrai lerWmPublic. Inserts a trailer in a SOAP message.

(A trailer is an arbitrary element that follows the Body element in the SOAP envelope.)

Important! It appears likely that trailers will not be permitted in future versions of SOAP (versions 1.2 and later). If you are designing a completely new solution, we recommend that you avoid using trailers. However, if you exchange SOAP messages with older systems that already make use of trailers, this service allows you to insert them into a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

A SOAP object is an object that represents a SOAP message.

If you are composing a new SOAP message, you must first create an empty SOAP object (called soapData) with the createSoapData service and then add your header entries to with pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry.

If you are composing a SOAP response, you use pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry to populate the soapResponseData object that the SOAP message handler generates and puts in the pipeline.

For information about composing SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:createSoapDatapub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:addBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:getTrailers

soapData Object SOAP object to which you want the trailer added.

trailer com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node containing the trailer that you want to add to soapData.

Note: An XML node is a parsable representation of a node in an XML document. You generate an XML node using services such as pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode.

Important! This service adds a single trailer to a SOAP object. If you need to insert more than one trailer in the message, execute addTrailer once for each trailer that needs to be added.

Note: The SOAP specification states that trailers must be namespace qualified, so be sure that the node in trailer specifies a namespace.

soapData Object SOAP object to which the trailer was added.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 401

Page 402: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:createSoapDataWmPublic. Creates an empty SOAP object.

To compose a new SOAP message, you first use this service to create an empty SOAP object, and then you add content to the SOAP object using services such as pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry and pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The encoding parameter can support incoming SOAP messages in any encoding. Outgoing messages, however, are always encoded in UTF-8.

For information about composing SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:addBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:addTrailer

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:buildMsg_sendHTTP

encoding String Optional. Specifies the encoding method. Default value is UTF-8.

Note: To change the encoding specified by the Web service connector, you must set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline. For a Web service connector that uses the SOAP message protocol, set the value of the encoding parameter in the pipeline for the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData Invoke step. The subsequent pub.client:soapHTTP Invoke step will honor the encoding specified when the SOAP message was created.

soapData Object Empty SOAP object.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 402

Page 403: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:exi tUnableToUnderstandWmPublic. Terminates processing and returns a mustUnderstand fault to the client.

You execute this service when your SOAP processor detects a mandatory header entry that it cannot process.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service throws an exception, which is meant to be caught by the message handler so that the appropriate SOAP fault will be returned to the client. Your processor should not catch this exception.

pub.soap.ut i ls:getActorWmPublic. Retrieves the value of the actor attribute from a given header entry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For general information about the SOAP header entries and attributes, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

headerEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node containing the header entry that cannot be understood.

headerEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node The header entry whose actor value you want to retrieve.

If you use pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries to retrieve header entries, you can loop over the list of header nodes to retrieve the actor value from each entry.

If you use pub.soap.utils:getHeader to retrieve header entries, you must query the node returned by that service (using the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service) to extract a node for an individual header entry. Then you can run getActor on the resulting node.

actor String Value of the header entry’s actor attribute. If the header entry does not have an actor attribute, actor will be null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 403

Page 404: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

See Also

pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:getMustUnderstandpub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries

pub.soap.ut i ls:getBodyWmPublic. Retrieves the body from a SOAP message as a single node object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service returns the entire Body element in body. To extract data from the Body element, query body with the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service.

If you want to extract the body of the message as an array of nodes, use the pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries service.

For additional information about extracting information from SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:buildMsg_sendHTTPsample.soap:customProc_msgQueuesample.soap:targetSvc_defaultProc

soapData Object SOAP object containing the message whose Body node you want to retrieve.

body com.wm.lang.xml.Node The Body node from the SOAP message (that is, <SOAP-ENV:Body> to </SOAP-ENV:Body>).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 404

Page 405: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:getBodyEntr iesWmPublic. Retrieves the body entries from a SOAP message as an array of node objects.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service returns each body entry as a separate node. You can loop over bodyEntries and extract data from each node with the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service.

If you want to extract the body of the message as a single node, use the pub.soap.utils:getBody service.

For additional information about extracting information from SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry

pub.soap.ut i ls:getDocumentWmPublic. Retrieves an entire SOAP message as a node object.

This service is useful when you want to use pub.xml:queryXMLNode to query an entire SOAP message. Since queryXMLNode requires a node as input, you cannot use it to query a SOAP object directly. Instead, you must convert the SOAP object to a node and then query the resulting node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

soapData Object The SOAP object containing the message whose body entries you want to retrieve.

bodyEntries com.wm.lang.xml.Node[ ] An array of XML nodes, where each node represents a body entry from the message.

soapData Object SOAP object for which you want a node representation.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node Node representation of the entire SOAP message in soapData (that is, <SOAP-ENV:Envelope> to </SOAP-ENV:Envelope>.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 405

Page 406: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

Usage Notes

For additional information about extracting information from SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntriespub.soap.utils:getTrailers

pub.soap.ut i ls:getHeaderWmPublic. Retrieves the header from a SOAP message as a single node object.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service returns the entire Header element in header. To extract data from the Header element, query header with the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service. If you want to extract the contents of the header as an array of nodes, use the pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries service.

For additional information about extracting information from SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntriespub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:getTrailerspub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples package in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:customProc_msgQueue

soapData Object SOAP object containing the message whose Header node you want to retrieve.

header com.wm.lang.xml.Node Header node from the SOAP message (that is, <SOAP-ENV:Header> to </SOAP-ENV:Header>).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 406

Page 407: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:getHeaderEntr iesWmPublic. Retrieves the header entries from a SOAP message as an array of node objects.

This service is useful when you want to build a process that loops through all the header entries in a message and identify entries with specific QNames (using the pub.soap.utils:getQName service) or actor attributes (using the pub.soap.utils:getActor service).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service returns each header entry as a separate node. You can loop over headerEntries and extract data from each node with the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service or get the entry’s QName and/or actor value using the pub.soap.utils:getQName and pub.soap.utils:getActor services.

If you want to extract the message header as a single node, use the pub.soap.utils:getHeader service.

For additional information about extracting information from SOAP messages, see the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:getDocumentpub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:getActorpub.soap.utils:getQName

soapData Object SOAP object containing the message whose header entries you want to retrieve.

headerEntries com.wm.lang.xml.Node[ ] Header entries from the SOAP message. Each node in the array represents a header entry from the message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 407

Page 408: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:getMustUnderstandWmPublic. Returns the mustUnderstand status for a given header entry.

The mustUnderstand status specifies whether recipients are required to process a header entry (that is, whether processing of the entry is mandatory or optional). Recipients that cannot process a mandatory header entry must reject the message and return a SOAP fault. (See the pub.soap.utils:exitUnableToUnderstand service.)

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For additional information about the mustUnderstand attribute, see the Simple Object Access Protocol (SOAP) 1.1 - W3C Note 08 May 2000 at http://www.w3.org/TR/SOAP/ and the SOAP Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:getActorpub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntriespub.soap.utils:exitUnableToUnderstand

headerEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node The header entry whose mustUnderstand status you want to retrieve.

If you use pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries to retrieve header entries, you can loop over the list of header nodes to check the status of each entry.

If you use pub.soap.utils:getHeader to retrieve header entries, you will need to query the node returned by that service (using the pub.xml:queryXMLNode service) to extract a node for an individual header entry. Then you can run pub.soap.utils:getMustUnderstand on the resulting node.

mustUnderstand String Header entry’s mustUnderstand status. If the header entry has a mustUnderstand attribute, mustUnderstand will return one of the following values:

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The header is optional.

1 The header is mandatory.

If the header entry does not have a mustUnderstand attribute, mustUnderstand will return 0.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 408

Page 409: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:getQNameWmPublic. Returns the qualified name for a given node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Generally, you use this service in conjunction with the pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries or pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries service to loop over the message’s header or body entries and identify entries with a particular qualified name.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries

pub.soap.ut i ls:getTrai lersWmPublic. Retrieves the trailers from a SOAP message.

(A trailer is an arbitrary element that follows the Body element in the SOAP envelope.)

Important! It appears likely that trailers will not be permitted in future versions of SOAP (versions 1.2 and later). If you are designing a completely new solution, we recommend that you avoid using trailers. However, if you exchange SOAP messages with older systems that already make use of trailers, this service allows you to retrieve them from a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node The XML node whose qualified name you want to discover.

Qname Document The node’s qualified name. Qname will contain the following keys:

Key Description

namespaceName String Namespace portion of the node’s qualified name.

localName String Local portion of the node’s qualified name.

soapData Object SOAP object containing the message whose trailers you want to retrieve.

trailers com.wm.lang.xml.Node[ ] Array of nodes wherein each node represents a trailer from the message. If the message does not contain trailers, trailers will be null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 409

Page 410: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

See Also

pub.soap.utils:addTrailerpub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntriespub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntriespub.soap.utils:getDocument

pub.soap.ut i ls:QNameWmPublic. Document type that defines the structure of a qualified name.

Parameters

pub.soap.ut i ls:removeBodyEntryWmPublic. Deletes a body entry from a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

When you use the bodyEntry parameter, be sure that it specifies the correct node. This service deletes whatever node is specified in bodyEntry, even if the node is not a body entry. For example, if bodyEntry contains the whole Body element, removeBodyEntry will delete the body of the message.

Note: Be aware that if you use the index parameter to delete an entry, you will change the index numbers (positions) of all entries following the one you deleted. For example, if your message

namespaceName String The namespace portion of a qualified name.

localName String The local portion of a qualified name.

soapData Object SOAP object containing the body entry that you want to delete.

bodyEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node Optional. The entry that you want to remove from soapData. (You would obtain the node with the pub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries service.)

Note: You can use bodyEntry or index to specify the entry that you want removeBodyEntry to delete.

index String Optional. Index of the entry that you want to remove (where index 0 represents the first body entry). index is ignored if bodyEntry is specified.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 410

Page 411: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

contains four body entries (0, 1, 2, 3) and you delete entry 1, then the entries originally at positions 2 and 3 will subsequently occupy positions 1 and 2.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:removeHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:removeTrailerpub.soap.utils:addBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:getBodypub.soap.utils:getBodyEntries

pub.soap.ut i ls:removeHeaderEntryWmPublic. Deletes a header entry from a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

When you use the headerEntry parameter, be sure that it specifies the correct node. This service deletes whatever node is specified in headerEntry, even if the node is not a header entry. For example, if headerEntry contains the whole Header element, removeHeaderEntry will delete the entire header from the message.

Note: Be aware that if you use the index parameter to delete an entry, you will change the index numbers (positions) of all entries following the one you deleted. For example, if your header contains four entries (0, 1, 2, 3) and you delete entry 1, then the entries originally at positions 2 and 3 will subsequently occupy positions 1 and 2.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:removeBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:removeTrailerpub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry

soapData Object SOAP object containing the header entry that you want to delete.

headerEntry com.wm.lang.xml.Node Optional. The header entry that you want to remove from soapData. (You would obtain the node with the pub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries service.)

Note: You can use headerEntry or index to specify the entry that you want removeHeaderEntry to delete.

index String Optional. Index of the entry that you want to remove (where index 0 represents the first header entry). index is ignored if headerEntry is specified.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 411

Page 412: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.utils:getHeaderpub.soap.utils:getHeaderEntries

pub.soap.ut i ls:removeTrai lerWmPublic. Deletes a trailer from a SOAP message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

When you use the trailer parameter, be sure that it specifies the correct node. This service deletes whatever node is specified in trailer, even if the node is not a trailer. For example, if trailer contains the Body element, removeTrailer will delete the entire body of the message.

Note: Be aware that if you use the index parameter to delete a trailer, you will change the index numbers (positions) of all trailers following the one you deleted. For example, if your message contains four trailers (0, 1, 2, 3) and you delete trailer 1, then the trailers originally at positions 2 and 3 will subsequently occupy positions 1 and 2.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:removeHeaderEntrypub.soap.utils:removeBodyEntrypub.soap.utils:addTrailerpub.soap.utils:getTrailers

soapData Object SOAP object containing the trailer that you want to delete.

trailer com.wm.lang.xml.Node Optional. The trailer that you want to remove from soapData. (You would obtain the node with the pub.soap.utils:getTrailers service.)

Note: You can use trailer or index to specify the trailer that you want removeTrailer to delete.

index String Optional. Index of the trailer that you want to remove (where index 0 represents the first trailer). index is ignored if trailer is specified.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 412

Page 413: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:requestResponseSpecWmPublic. Defines the input/output signature for a custom processor and a target service for the default processor.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the WmSamples packages in the certified samples area of the Knowledge Base on the Advantage Web Site:

sample.soap:customProc_msgQueuesample.soap:targetSvc_defaultProc

pub.soap.ut i ls:soapDataToStr ingWmPublic. Converts a SOAP object to a String.

This is useful when you want to use the message with a process that requires the message to be in the form of a String.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.soap.utils:streamToSoapDatapub.soap.utils:stringToSoapData

soapRequestData Object SOAP object containing the SOAP request submitted to the Integration Server by the client.

soapResponseData Object Empty SOAP object that the custom processor or target service uses to compose the SOAP response message.

soapResponseData Object SOAP object containing the message that is to be returned to the client.

soapData Object SOAP object that you want to convert to a String.

string String Entire SOAP message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 413

Page 414: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:streamToSoapDataWmPublic. Converts an InputStream containing a SOAP message to a SOAP object.

(A SOAP message must be represented as a SOAP object to be used with the data-retrieval services such as pub.soap.utils:getHeader and pub.soap.utils:getBody).

Note: This service is a convenient way to produce a SOAP object during development and testing. It is not meant to be used for production purposes because it does not ensure that a valid SOAP message is produced. For production purposes, we recommend that you create SOAP objects with the pub.soap.utils:createSoapData service and populate them with the message-composition services (for example, pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry and pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Be aware that if stream does not contain a valid SOAP message, this service does not throw an exception. Instead, it produces a soapData that contains a representation of whatever it received in stream (which might not even be an XML document). This will cause problems later when you attempt to use the soapData with other SOAP utilities or pass it to the message handler. To determine whether soapData represents a valid SOAP message, we recommend that you always execute the pub.soap.utils:validateSoapData service immediately after using streamToSoapData.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:stringToSoapDatapub.soap.utils:validateSoapData

stream java.io.InputStream SOAP message that is to be converted to a SOAP object.

soapData Object SOAP object representation of the SOAP message in stream.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 414

Page 415: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:str ingToSoapDataWmPublic. Converts a String containing a SOAP message to a SOAP object.

(A SOAP message must be represented as a SOAP object to be used with the data-retrieval services such as pub.soap.utils:getHeader and pub.soap.utils:getBody).

Note: This service is a convenient way to produce a SOAP object during development and testing. It is not meant to be used for production purposes because it does not ensure that a valid SOAP message is produced. Additionally, producing a SOAP object from a String is a very time-consuming process. For production purposes, we recommend that you create SOAP objects with the such as pub.soap.utils:getHeader and pub.soap.utils:getBody).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Be aware that if string does not contain a valid SOAP message, this service does not throw an exception. Instead, it produces a soapData that contains a representation of whatever it received in string (which might not even be an XML document). This will cause problems later when you attempt to use the soapData with other SOAP utilities or pass it to the message handler. To determine whether soapData represents a valid SOAP message, we recommend that you always execute the pub.soap.utils:validateSoapData service immediately after using stringToSoapData.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:streamToSoapDatapub.soap.utils:validateSoapData

string String SOAP message that is to be converted to a SOAP object.

soapData Object SOAP object representation of the SOAP message in string.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 415

Page 416: Integration Server Bis Reference

27. SOAP Folder

pub.soap.ut i ls:val idateSoapDataWmPublic. Verifies that a SOAP object represents a valid SOAP message.

You can use this service to validate a SOAP object that was generated directly from an InputStream or String with pub.soap.utils:stringToSoapData or pub.soap.utils:streamToSoapData. If soapData does not contain a valid SOAP message, validateSoapData will throw an exception.

This service validates the SOAP object against the schema in pub.soap.schema:envelope.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

If you create SOAP objects using the standard message-composition services (for example, pub.soap.utils:createSoapData, pub.soap.utils:addBodyEntry, pub.soap.utils:addHeaderEntry) there is no need to use this service. This service is only necessary when you generate a SOAP object directly from an InputStream or a String.

See Also

pub.soap.utils:stringToSoapDatapub.soap.utils:streamToSoapData

soapData Object SOAP object that you want to validate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 416

Page 417: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 28. Storage Folder

You use the elements in the storage folder to create, close, delete, and register repository data stores and insert and retrieve information from repository data stores. Each entry in a data store consists of a key (which identifies the entry) and a value.

When a flow service retrieves an entry from a data store, the entry is locked to prevent modification by other users. The entry, which needs to be unlocked before the flow completes, remains locked until released via a put (pub.storage:put) or an explicit unlock (pub.storage:unlock).

Note: If you include storage services in a flow and you want to test the flow from Developer, use Run or Run in Browser. Trace and Step cannot be used to test storage services.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 417

Page 418: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.storage:addWmPublic. Inserts a new entry into a repository data store.

If the key already exists in the data store, the pub.storage:add service does nothing.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.storage:add WmPublic. Inserts a new entry into a repository data store.

pub.storage:closeStore WmPublic. Closes a repository data store and unregisters the data store with the server.

pub.storage:deleteStore WmPublic. Deletes a repository data store and unregisters the data store with the server.

pub.storage:get WmPublic. Retrieves a value from a repository data store and locks the entry on behalf of the flow that invoked the service.

pub.storage:keys WmPublic. Obtains a list of all the keys in a repository data store.

pub.storage:lock WmPublic. Locks an entry on behalf of the flow invoking this service.

pub.storage:put WmPublic. Inserts or updates an entry in a repository data store. If the key does not exist in the data store, then the entry is inserted.

pub.storage:registerStore WmPublic. Opens or creates a repository data store and registers the store with the server.

pub.storage:remove WmPublic. Removes an entry from a repository data store.

pub.storage:unlock WmPublic. Unlocks an entry in the repository data store.

storeName String Name of the data store in which to insert the entry.

key String Key under which the entry is to be inserted.

value Document Value (IData object) to be inserted.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 418

Page 419: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

Output Parameters

pub.storage:closeStoreWmPublic. Closes a repository data store and unregisters the data store with the server.

If the data store is not registered with the server, an exception will be thrown. A data store cannot be accessed after it has been unregistered. If you want to access the data in the data store, you need to register the data store again using pub.storage:registerStore.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service does not delete the contents of the data store. If you want to delete the contents of a data store in addition to closing and unregistering the data store, use the pub.storage:deleteStore service.

pub.storage:deleteStoreWmPublic. Deletes a repository data store and unregisters the data store with the server.

Any data in the data store is deleted. If the data store is not registered with the server, an exception will be thrown.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

result String Flag indicating whether the entry was successfully added.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The new entry was inserted successfully.

false The entry was not inserted (usually because an entry for key already exists).

storeName String Name of the data store to close and unregister.

storeName String Name of the data store to delete and unregister.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 419

Page 420: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

Usage Notes

If you want to close and unregister a data store without deleting the contents of the data store, use the pub.storage:closeStore service.

pub.storage:getWmPublic. Retrieves a value from a repository data store and locks the entry on behalf of the flow that invoked the service.

Locking the entry prevents other services from modifying the entry before the initial flow completes.

Important! The lock needs to be released, via a put (pub.storage:put) or an explicit unlock (pub.storage:unlock), before the flow completes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

storeName String Name of the data store from which you want to retrieve the entry.

key String Key of the entry whose value you want to retrieve.

waitLength String Optional. Length of time, in milliseconds, that you want to wait for this entry to become available if it is already locked by another thread. The default is the default Maximum Lock Wait value configured on the repository server (4 minutes).

lockMode String Optional. Type of lock you want to place on the entry.

Set to... To...

Exclusive Default. Prevent other threads from reading or updating the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to modify the entry.

Share Prevent other threads from updating the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to modify the entry.

Read Allow other threads to read and update the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to read, but not modify, an entry.

value Document Retrieved entry (IData object). If the requested entry does not exist, the value of this parameter is null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 420

Page 421: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

pub.storage:keysWmPublic. Obtains a list of all the keys in a repository data store.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.storage: lockWmPublic. Locks an entry on behalf of the flow invoking this service.

Locking an entry prevents other services from modifying it before your flow completes.

Important! When you lock an entry using this service, the lock must be released, using a put (pub.storage:put) or an explicit unlock (pub.storage:unlock), before the flow completes.

Input Parameters

storeName String Name of the data store from which you want to obtain a list of keys.

keys String List Keys for the data store specified in storeName.

storeName String Name of the data store containing the entry.

key String Optional. Key of the entry that you want to lock. If key is not supplied, the lock will be applied to the entire data store specified in storeName.

waitLength String Optional. Length of time, in milliseconds, that you want to wait for this entry to become available if it is already locked by another thread. The default is the default Maximum Lock Wait value configured on the repository server (4 minutes).

lockMode String Optional. Type of lock you want to place on the entry.

Set to... To...

Exclusive Default. Prevent other threads from reading or updating the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to modify the entry.

Share Prevent other threads from updating the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to modify the entry.

Read Allow other threads to read and update the entry while you are using it. This type of lock allows you to read, but not modify, an entry.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 421

Page 422: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Note

If you have not specified a key, and your flow throws an exception before invoking pub.storage:put or pub.storage:unlock, the entire datastore remains locked indefinitely. To prevent this, specify a key.

pub.storage:putWmPublic. Inserts or updates an entry in a repository data store. If the key does not exist in the data store, then the entry is inserted.

If the key already exists in the store, then its value is updated and the associated entry is unlocked.

If the requested entry is not currently locked by the flow that invoked this service, the pub.storage:put service will automatically attempt to lock the entry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.storage:registerStoreWmPublic. Opens or creates a repository data store and registers the store with the server.

A data store must be registered before it can be accessed. If the store is already registered with the server, this service does nothing.

Input Parameters

storeName String Name of the data store into which you want to insert or update the entry.

value Document Value (IData object) to be inserted or updated.

waitLength String Optional. Length of time, in milliseconds, that you want to wait for this entry to become available if it is already locked by another thread. The default is the default Maximum Lock Wait value configured on the repository server (4 minutes). This parameter is used only when your service did not explicitly lock the entry beforehand.

key String Key where you want to insert or update the entry.

storeName String Name of the data store to register.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 422

Page 423: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To unregister and close a store, use the service pub.storage:closeStore.

pub.storage:removeWmPublic. Removes an entry from a repository data store.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.storage:unlockWmPublic. Unlocks an entry in the repository data store.

When a flow retrieves an entry using the pub.storage:get service, the entry is locked to prevent modification by other users before the flow completes. The entry remains locked until the lock owner invokes a pub.storage:put service. To unlock a service without using the pub.storage:put service, use the pub.storage:unlock service.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

storeName String Name of the data store from which to remove an entry.

key String Key of the entry that you want to remove.

result String Flag indicating whether the entry was successfully removed.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The entry was removed successfully.

false The entry was not removed (usually because an entry for key does not exist).

storeName String Name of the data store in which to unlock an entry.

key String Optional. Key of the entry that you want to unlock. If key is not supplied, the lock will be removed from the entire data store specified in storeName.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 423

Page 424: Integration Server Bis Reference

28. Storage Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 424

Page 425: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 29. Str ing Folder

You use the elements in the string folder to perform string manipulation and substitution operations.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 425

Page 426: Integration Server Bis Reference

2 9 . S t r i n g F o l d e r

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.string:base64Decode WmPublic. Decodes a Base-64 encoded string into a sequence of bytes.

pub.string:base64Encode WmPublic. Converts a sequence of bytes into a Base64-encoded String.

pub.string:bytesToString WmPublic. Converts a sequence of bytes to a String.

pub.string:concat WmPublic. Concatenates two strings.

pub.string:HTMLDecode WmPublic. Replaces HTML character entities with native characters.

pub.string:HTMLEncode WmPublic. Replaces HTML-sensitive characters with equivalent HTML character entities.

pub.string:indexOf WmPublic. Returns the index of the first occurrence of a sequence of characters in a string.

pub.string:length WmPublic. Returns the length of a string.

pub.string:lookupDictionary WmPublic. Looks up a given key in a hash table and returns the string to which that key is mapped.

pub.string:lookupTable WmPublic. Locates a key in a String Table and returns the string to which that key is mapped.

pub.string:makeString WmPublic. Builds a single string by concatenating the elements of a String List.

pub.string:messageFormat WmPublic. Formats an array of strings into a given message pattern.

pub.string:numericFormat WmPublic. Formats a number into a given numeric pattern.

pub.string:padLeft WmPublic. Pads a string to a specified length by adding pad characters to the beginning of the string.

pub.string:padRight WmPublic. Pads a string to a specified length by adding pad characters to the end of the string.

pub.string:replace WmPublic. Replaces all occurrences of a specified substring with a substitute string.

pub.string:stringToBytes WmPublic. Converts a string to a byte array.

pub.string:substring WmPublic. Returns a substring of a given string.

pub.string:toLower WmPublic. Converts all characters in a given string to lowercase.

pub.string:toUpper WmPublic. Converts all characters in a given string to uppercase.

pub.string:tokenize WmPublic. Tokenizes a string using specified delimiter characters and generates a String List from the resulting tokens.

426 webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2

Page 427: Integration Server Bis Reference

pub.str ing:base64DecodeWmPublic. Decodes a Base-64 encoded string into a sequence of bytes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:base64EncodeWmPublic. Converts a sequence of bytes into a Base64-encoded String.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:bytesToStr ingWmPublic. Converts a sequence of bytes to a String.

Input Parameters

pub.string:trim WmPublic. Trims leading and trailing white space from a given string.

pub.string:URLDecode WmPublic. Decodes a URL-encoded string.

pub.string:URLEncode WmPublic. URL-encodes a string.

Element Package and Description

string String A Base64-encoded String to decode into bytes.

value byte[ ] The sequence of bytes decoded from the Base64-encoded String.

bytes byte[ ] Sequence of bytes to encode into a Base64-encoded String.

value String Base64-encoded String encoded from the sequence of bytes.

bytes byte[ ] Sequence of bytes to convert to a String.

encoding String Optional. Name of a registered, IANA character set (for example, ISO-8859-1). If you specify an unsupported encoding, the system throws an exception.

To use the default encoding, set encoding to autoDetect.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 427

Page 428: Integration Server Bis Reference

2 9 . S t r i n g F o l d e r

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:concatWmPublic. Concatenates two strings.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:HTMLDecodeWmPublic. Replaces HTML character entities with native characters.

Specifically, the service:

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

string String String representation of the contents of bytes.

inString1 String String to which you want to concatenate another string.

inString2 String String to concatenate to inString1.

value String Result of concatenating inString1 with inString2 (inString1 + inString2).

Replaces this HTML character entity... With...

&gt; >

&lt; <

&amp; &

&quot; "

inString String An HTML-encoded String.

value String Result from decoding the contents of inString. Any HTML character entities that existed in inString will appear as native characters in value.

428 webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2

Page 429: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:HTMLEncodeWmPublic. Replaces HTML-sensitive characters with equivalent HTML character entities.

Specifically, this service:

These translations are useful when displaying text in an HTML context.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing: indexOfWmPublic. Returns the index of the first occurrence of a sequence of characters in a string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Replaces this native language character... With...

> &gt;

< &lt;

& &amp;

" &quot;

inString String The character you want to encode in HTML.

value String Result from encoding the contents of inString. Any HTML-sensitive characters that existed in inString (for example, > or &) will appear as the equivalent HTML character entities in value.

inString String String in which you want to locate a sequence of characters.

subString String Sequence of characters to locate.

fromIndex String Optional. Index of inString from which to start the search. If no value is specified, this parameter contains 0 to indicate the beginning of the string.

value String Index of the first occurrence of subString in inString. If no occurrence is found, this parameter contains -1.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 429

Page 430: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing: lengthWmPublic. Returns the length of a string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing: lookupDict ionaryWmPublic. Looks up a given key in a hash table and returns the string to which that key is mapped.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing: lookupTableWmPublic. Locates a key in a String Table and returns the string to which that key is mapped.

Input Parameters

inString String String whose length you want to discover.

value String The number of characters in inString.

hashtable java.util.Hashtable Hash table that uses String objects for keys and values.

key String Key in hashtable whose value you want to retrieve.

Note: The key is case sensitive.

value String Value of the string to which key is mapped. If the requested key in hashtable is null or if key is not mapped to any value in hashtable, the service returns null.

lookupTable String [ ] [ ] A multi-row, multi-column string table in which to search.

keyColumnIndex String Index of the “key” column. Default is 0.

valueColumnIndex String Index of the “value” column. Default is 1.

key String Key to locate.

Note: The key is case sensitive.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 430

Page 431: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:makeStringWmPublic. Builds a single string by concatenating the elements of a String List.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

ignoreCase String Optional. Flag indicating whether to perform a case-sensitive or case-insensitive search.

Set to... To...

true Perform a case-insensitive search.

false Default. Perform a case-sensitive search.

useRegex String Optional. Flag indicating whether the values in the table are to be interpreted as regular expressions.

Note: The regular expressions in the table should not include slashes. For example, use hello.*, not /hello.*/.

Set to... To...

true Interpret the key column values in the table as regular expressions.

false Default. Interpret the key column values in the table as literal values (that is, not regular expressions).

value String First value in the “value” column whose key matches key. If no match is found, this parameter is null.

elementList String List Strings to concatenate.

separator String String to insert between each non-null element in elementList.

value String Result from concatenating the strings in elementList. Strings are separated by the characters specified in separator.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 431

Page 432: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:messageFormatWmPublic. Formats an array of strings into a given message pattern.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:numericFormatWmPublic. Formats a number into a given numeric pattern.

Input Parameters

pattern String Message that includes “placeholders” where elements from argumentList are to be inserted. The message can contain any sequence of characters. Use the {n} placeholder to insert elements from argumentList, where n is the index of the element that you want to insert. For example, the following pattern string inserts elements 0 and 1 into the message:

Test results: {0} items passed, {1} items failed.

Note: Do not use any characters except digits for n.

argumentList String List Optional. List of strings to use to populate pattern. If argumentList is not supplied, the service will not replace placeholders in pattern with actual values.

value String Result from substituting argumentList into pattern. If pattern is empty or null, this parameter is null.

num String The number to format.

pattern String A pattern string that describes the way in which num is to be formatted:

This symbol... Indicates...

0 A digit.

# A digit. Leading zeroes will not be shown.

. A placeholder for a decimal separator.

, A placeholder for a grouping separator.

; A separation in format.

- The default negative prefix.

% That num will be multiplied by 100 and shown as a percentage.

X Any character used as a prefix or suffix (for example, A, $).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 432

Page 433: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:padLeftWmPublic. Pads a string to a specified length by adding pad characters to the beginning of the string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If padString is longer than one character and does not fit exactly into the resulting string, the beginning of padString is aligned with the beginning of the resulting string. For example, suppose inString equals shipped and padString equals x9y.

' That special characters are to be used as literals in a prefix or suffix. Enclose the special characters within '' (for example, '#').

The following are examples of pattern strings:

Pattern Description

#,### Use commas to separate into groups of three digits.

#,#### Use commas to separate into groups of four digits.

$#.00 Show digits before the decimal point as needed and exactly two digits after the decimal point. Prefix with the $ character.

'#'#.0 Show digits before the decimal point as needed and exactly one digit after the decimal point. Prefix with the # character.

value String num formatted according to pattern. If pattern is an empty (not null) string, the default pattern of comma separators is used and the number of digits after the decimal point remains unchanged.

inString String String that you want to pad.

padString String Characters to use to pad inString.

length String Total length of the resulting string, including pad characters.

value String Contents of inString preceded by as many pad characters as needed so that the total length of the string equals length.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 433

Page 434: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

If inString is longer than length characters, only the last length characters from inString are returned. For example, if inString equals acct1234 and length equals 4, value will contain 1234.

pub.str ing:padRightWmPublic. Pads a string to a specified length by adding pad characters to the end of the string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If padString is longer than one character and does not fit exactly into the resulting string, the end of padString is aligned with the end of the resulting string. For example, suppose inString equals shipped and padString equals x9y.

If inString is longer than length characters, only the first length characters from inString are returned. For example, if inString equals 1234acct and length equals 4, value will contain 1234.

If length equals... Then value will contain...

7 shipped

10 x9yshipped

12 x9x9yshipped

inString String String that you want to pad.

padString String Characters to use to pad inString.

length String Total length of the resulting string, including pad characters.

value String Contents of inString followed by as many pad characters as needed so that the total length of the string equals length.

If length equals... Then value will contain...

7 shipped

10 shippedx9y

12 shippedx9y9y

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 434

Page 435: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:replaceWmPublic. Replaces all occurrences of a specified substring with a substitute string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:str ingToBytesWmPublic. Converts a string to a byte array.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inString String String containing the substring to replace.

searchString String Substring to replace within inString.

replaceString String Character sequence that will replace searchString. If this parameter is null or empty, the service removes all occurrences of searchString from inString.

useRegex String Optional. Flag indicating whether searchString is a regular expression. When regular expressions are used to specify a search string, replaceString may also contain interpolation variables (for example, “$1”) that match parenthetical subexpressions in searchString.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that searchString is a regular expression.

false Default. Indicate that searchString is not a regular expression.

value String Contents of inString with replacements made.

string String String to convert to a byte[ ].

encoding String Optional. Name of a registered, IANA character set that specifies the encoding to use when converting the String to an array of bytes (for example: ISO-8859-1).

To use the default encoding, set this value to autoDetect. If you specify an unsupported encoding, an exception will be thrown.

bytes byte[ ] Contents of string represented as a byte[ ].

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 435

Page 436: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:substr ingWmPublic. Returns a substring of a given string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:toLowerWmPublic. Converts all characters in a given string to lowercase.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inString String String from which to extract a substring.

beginIndex String Beginning index of the substring to extract (inclusive).

endIndex String Ending index of the substring to extract (exclusive). If this parameter is null or empty, the substring will extend to the end of inString.

value String Substring from beginIndex and extending to the character at endIndex - 1.

inString String String to convert.

language String Optional. Lowercase, two-letter ISO-639 code. If this parameter is null, the system default is used.

country String Optional. Uppercase, two-letter ISO-3166 code. If this parameter is null, the system default is used.

variant String Optional. Vendor and browser-specific code. If null, this parameter is ignored.

value String Contents of inString, with all uppercase characters converted to lowercase.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 436

Page 437: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:toUpperWmPublic. Converts all characters in a given string to uppercase.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:tokenizeWmPublic. Tokenizes a string using specified delimiter characters and generates a String List from the resulting tokens.

This service does not return delimiters as tokens.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inString String String to convert.

language String Optional. Lowercase, two-letter ISO-639 code. If this parameter is null, the system default is used.

country String Optional. Uppercase, two-letter ISO-3166 code. If this parameter is null, the system default is used.

variant String Optional. Vendor and browser-specific code. If null, this parameter is ignored.

value String Contents of inString, with all lowercase characters converted to uppercase.

inString String String you want to tokenize (that is, break into delimited chunks).

delim String Delimiter characters. If null or empty, the service uses the default delimiters \t\n\r, where t, n, and r represent the white space characters tab, new line, and carriage return).

valueList String List Strings containing the tokens extracted from inString.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 437

Page 438: Integration Server Bis Reference

29. String Folder

pub.str ing:tr imWmPublic. Trims leading and trailing white space from a given string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:URLDecodeWmPublic. Decodes a URL-encoded string.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.str ing:URLEncodeWmPublic. URL-encodes a string.

Encodes characters the same way that data posted from a WWW form is encoded (that is, the application/x-www-form-urlencoded MIME type).

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inString String String to trim.

value String Contents of inString with white space trimmed from both ends.

inString String URL-encoded string to decode.

value String Result from decoding inString. If inString contained plus (+) signs, they will appear in value as spaces. If inString contained %hex encoded characters, they will appear in value as the appropriate native character.

inString String String to URL-encode.

value String Result from URL-encoding inString. If inString contained non-alphanumeric characters (except [-_.*@]), they will appear in value as their URL-encoded equivalents (% followed by a two-digit hex code). If inString contained spaces, they will appear in value as plus (+) signs.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 438

Page 439: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 30. Sync Folder

You use the elements in the sync folder to coordinate the execution of services. You can coordinate services so that a waiting service will execute if and only if a notifying service produces the input required by the waiting service within a specified time period. The synchronization services wait for and send notification using a key. A notifying service only delivers input to waiting services with the same key.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 439

Page 440: Integration Server Bis Reference

30. Sync Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.sync:not i fyWmPublic. Notifies services waiting on the specified key and delivers the input document to the services.

Receives a count of the number of notified services.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.sync:wai tWmPublic. Allows one or more services to wait for delivery of data from a notifying service.

Notification must occur within a specified time period.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.sync:notify WmPublic. Notifies services waiting on the specified key and delivers the input document to the services.

pub.sync:wait WmPublic. Allows one or more services to wait for delivery of data from a notifying service.

key String Name of the key. Waiting services with the same key will receive notification and input from this service.

value Document Input for the waiting services.

notified String Number indicating how many services were notified.

key String Name of the key for which the service is waiting notification. The service receives notification and data from a notifying service with the same key.

time String Length of time, in seconds, the service waits for notification. If the request times out, an exception is thrown.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 440

Page 441: Integration Server Bis Reference

30. Sync Folder

Output Parameters

exclusive String Optional. Flag indicating whether other services can wait for notification from a notifying service with the specified key.

Set to... To...

yes Allow only one service to wait for notification.

no Default. Allow other services to wait for notification.

value Document Input delivered by the notifying service.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 441

Page 442: Integration Server Bis Reference

30. Sync Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 442

Page 443: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 31. Synchronizat ion Folder

You use the elements in the synchronization folder to perform latching and cross-referencing operations in a publish-and-subscribe integration.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 443

Page 444: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.synchronizat ion. latch:closeLatchWmPublic. Closes the latch for a resource.

The resource cannot be acted upon while the latch is closed. By closing a latch, you can prevent a circular update between the source and target resources.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatch WmPublic. Closes the latch for a resource.

pub.synchronization.latch:isLatchClosed WmPublic. Checks a resource’s latch status.

pub.synchronization.latch:openLatch WmPublic. Opens the latch for a resource.

pub.synchronization.xref:createXReference WmPublic. Creates a cross-reference between a canonical key and a native ID.

pub.synchronization.xref:deleteByObjectId WmPublic. Removes all cross-reference records associated with a particular process or synchronization.

pub.synchronization.xref:deleteXReference WmPublic. Deletes a cross-reference record from the cross-reference table.

pub.synchronization.xref:getCanonicalKey WmPublic. Retrieves the canonical key for a specified native ID.

pub.synchronization.xref:getNativeId WmPublic. Retrieves the native ID of a resource record associated with a canonical key.

pub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference WmPublic. Inserts a cross-reference between a native ID and a canonical key.

appId String A unique identifier for the target resource for which you want to close a latch. Typically, the appId is the name of the adapter or the resource.

canonicalKey String The canonical key. A unique identifier for the canonical document used in the synchronization.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 444

Page 445: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

Output Parameters

None.

pub.synchronizat ion. latch: isLatchClosedWmPublic. Checks a resource’s latch status.

By checking the latch status, you can determine whether a resource has been updated.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Use the latch status to determine whether or not to update the resource.

If the latch is closed (isLatchClosed is true), the resource is already updated. Use the pub.synchronization.latch:openLatch service to end execution of the update and open the latch in preparation for the next update to the resource.

If the latch is open (isLatchClosed is false), the resource has not yet been updated. Invoke services to locate and update the record in the target resource. Then invoke the pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatch service to close the latch and prevent circular updates.

For more information about using the pub.synchronization.latch services to prevent echo suppression, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatchpub.synchronization.latch:openLatch

appId String A unique identifier for the resource for which you want to check the latch status. Typically, the appId is the name of the adapter or the resource.

canonicalKey String The canonical key. A unique identifier for the canonical document used in the synchronization.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

isLatchClosed String The status of the latch.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The latch is closed. The resource has been updated.

false The latch is open. The resource has not been updated.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 445

Page 446: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

pub.synchronizat ion. latch:openLatchWmPublic. Opens the latch for a resource.

By opening the latch, you can end propagation of the update and make the resource available for future updates.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.synchronizat ion.xref :createXReferenceWmPublic. Creates a cross-reference between a canonical key and a native ID.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

appId String A unique identifier for the resources for which you want to open the latch. Typically, the appId is the name of the adapter or the resource.

canonicalKey String The canonical key. A unique identifier for the canonical document used in the synchronization.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

appId String A unique identifier for the resource (application) for which you want to create a cross-reference to a canonical key.

nativeId String A unique identifier for the resource record for which you want to create a cross-reference to a canonical key.

canonicalKey String Optional. A canonical key. If a canonical key is not provided as input, createXReference creates the canonical key and the cross-reference.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

canonicalKey String The canonical key. This key correlates native IDs of records from different resources. This will be a new, unique key if canonicalKey was not provided as an input parameter. If canonicalKey was provided as input, this output parameter returns the same value.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 446

Page 447: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

Usage Notes

The canonical document is the standard format that a document assumes while it travels through webMethods components. A source resource will convert or map data from its proprietary data format into the canonical format before publishing the document. A target resource (a subscriber to the canonical document) will map the canonical document to the target resource’s proprietary data format before processing the document. The canonical document acts as the intermediary data format between resources.

On the source side of the synchronization, use the createXReference service to create the canonical key for the canonical document and establish a cross-reference between the record in the source application and the canonical document. Before publishing the canonical document, link the generated canonicalKey to the canonical document.

On the target side of synchronization, use the pub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference service to insert the cross-reference between a canonical key and the native ID for the record in the target resource.

For more information about using the createXReference service to create synchronizations, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference

pub.synchronizat ion.xref :deleteByObject IdWmPublic. Removes all cross-reference records associated with a particular process or synchronization.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

You can use this service to purge unwanted cross-reference records from the cross-reference table. For example, if you wanted to delete all cross-reference records for the purchaseOrder synchronization, specify “purchaseOrder” as the objectId.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process for which you want to delete all cross-reference records. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 447

Page 448: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

pub.synchronizat ion.xref :deleteXReferenceWmPublic. Deletes a cross-reference record from the cross-reference table.

This service deletes only one cross-reference record.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

pub.synchronizat ion.xref :getCanonicalKeyWmPublic. Retrieves the canonical key for a specified native ID.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You can use this service to determine whether you need to insert or update a record in the resource.

If the canonical key exists (canonicalKey contains a value), a cross-reference between the native ID and the canonical key already exists. The record with the specified nativeId is not a new record.

appId String A unique identifier for the resource (application) for which you want to delete a cross-reference record.

canonicalKey String The canonical key. A unique identifier for the canonical document for which you want to delete a cross-reference.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process for which you want to delete a cross-reference. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

appId String A unique identifier for the resource (application) that contains the native ID for which you want to retrieve a canonical key.

nativeId String A unique identifier for the resource record for which you want to obtain the canonical key.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

canonicalKey String The canonical key for the provided native ID. If the requested key cannot be found or does not exist in the cross-reference table, an empty string is returned.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 448

Page 449: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

You can then invoke the pub.synchronization.latch:isLatchClosed service to determine whether the resource needs to be updated.

If the canonical key does not exist (canonicalKey contains an empty string), then the record with the native ID is a new record. You can use the pub.synchronization.xref:createXReference service to generate the canonical key and create the cross-reference to the native ID.

For more information about using the getCanonicalKey service in synchronizations, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.synchronization.latch:isLatchClosedpub.synchronization.xref:createXReference

pub.synchronizat ion.xref :getNat iveIdWmPublic. Retrieves the native ID of a resource record associated with a canonical key.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

You can use the getNativeID service on the target side of a synchronization to determine if the record in the target resource needs to be inserted or just updated.

If the native ID does not exist (the nativeId field contains an empty string) and you specified the correct input values, then the record does not exist in the resource. You will need to insert the record in the resource to generate the native ID. Then use the pub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference service to insert a cross-reference between the native ID and the canonical key.

If the native ID exists (the nativeId field contains a value), then a cross-reference between the canonical key and the record already exists. The record already exists in the resource and only needs to be updated.

appId String A unique identifier for the resource from which you want to retrieve the native ID associated with the provided canonical key.

canonicalKey String The canonical key for which you want to obtain the corresponding native ID.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

nativeId String A unique identifier for the resource record associated with the provided canonical key. If the requested nativeId cannot be found in the cross-reference table, an empty string is returned.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 449

Page 450: Integration Server Bis Reference

31. Synchronization Folder

After you insert or update the record in the resource, make sure to use pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatch to close the latch for the record to prevent circular updates (echoes).

For more information about using the getNativeId service in synchronizations, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatchpub.synchronization.xref:insertXReference

pub.synchronizat ion.xref : insertXReferenceWmPublic. Inserts a cross-reference between a native ID and a canonical key.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

Use this service on the target side of a synchronization to create a cross-reference between the new record in the target resource and the canonical document.

Most resources generate a unique ID for a new record. Invoke the insertXReference service after you add the new record in the resource.

After you insert the cross-reference between the new native ID and the canonical key, use pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatch to close the latch for the record to prevent circular updates (echoes).

For more information about using the insertXReference service in synchronizations, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.synchronization.latch:closeLatchpub.synchronization.xref:createXReference

appId String A unique identifier for the resource for which you want to establish a cross-reference between a native ID and a canonical key.

nativeId String A unique identifier for the resource record with which you want to establish a cross-reference to canonicalKey.

canonicalKey String The canonical key with which you want to establish a cross-reference to nativeId.

objectId String A unique identifier for the object or process being synchronized. Typically, the objectId field is set to the name of the business process for which you are performing synchronization, such as “order” or “customer.”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 450

Page 451: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 32. Table Folder

You use the elements in the table folder to convert instances of com.wm.util.Table to other data types.

Important! The services in this folder have been deprecated.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 451

Page 452: Integration Server Bis Reference

32. Table Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.table:recordListToTableWmPublic. Deprecated—Converts a list of documents into an instance of com.wm.util.Table.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.table:str ingTableToTableWmPublic. Deprecated—Converts a String Table into an instance of com.wm.util.Table.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.table:recordListToTable WmPublic. Deprecated—Converts a list of documents into an instance of com.wm.util.Table.

pub.table:stringTableToTable WmPublic. Deprecated—Converts a String Table into an instance of com.wm.util.Table.

pub.table:tableToRecordList WmPublic. Deprecated—Converts an instance of com.wm.util.Table into a document list.

pub.table:tableToStringTable WmPublic. Deprecated—Converts an instance of com.wm.util.Table into a two-dimensional String array.

recordList Document List Data for the new table. Each document represents a row for the new table.

columnNames String List Array of Strings representing the column names for the new table. Each document will be queried for a value for each column.

tableName String Optional. Name for the new table.

table com.wm.util.Table The resulting table with the supplied data.

columnNames String List Column names for the new table.

stringTable String Table Data for the new table.

tableName String Optional. Name for the new table.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 452

Page 453: Integration Server Bis Reference

32. Table Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

For example, to create a two-column table which maps ID numbers to names, you might use the following parameters:

columnNames = id, name

stringTable = (1099, Arthur), (3000, Dorothy), (2068, scott)

tableName = idTable

pub.table: tableToRecordListWmPublic. Deprecated—Converts an instance of com.wm.util.Table into a document list.

Note: In versions 3.5 and later, there is no need to use this service to convert a table to a document list in order to map it in a flow service. Objects in the pipeline that are of type com.wm.util.Table are automatically recognized and treated as document lists at run time.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.table: tableToStringTableWmPublic. Deprecated—Converts an instance of com.wm.util.Table into a two-dimensional String array.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

table com.wm.util.Table The resulting table with the supplied data.

table com.wm.util.Table Table to convert to a document list.

recordList Document List Data from the table. Each document represents a row from the table. The keys of the document are the column names and their values are the corresponding values in that row.

table com.wm.util.Table Table to convert to a String table.

columnNames String List Column names from the table.

stringTable String Table Data from the table.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 453

Page 454: Integration Server Bis Reference

32. Table Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 454

Page 455: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 33. Task Folder

You use the elements in the task folder to create, modify, locate, and delete tasks on the Task Engine to which the Integration Server is connected.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 455

Page 456: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.task:TaskCallbackService WmTaskClient. Specification that describes the inputs and outputs required for a callback service.

pub.task:TaskCompletionInfo WmTaskClient. Document type containing information about the completion of a task. The Task Engine uses this document type to return data about the completion of a task to a callback service.

pub.task:TaskInfo WmTaskClient. Document type that contains standard information about a task. You specify certain fields in TaskInfo when you enqueue a task using pub.task.taskclient:queueTask.

pub.task:TaskQueueInfo WmTaskClient. Document type used by pub.task.taskclient:queueTask to set basic values in TaskInfo.

pub.task:TaskSearchQuery WmTaskClient. Document type used as input to the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service.

pub.task:TaskSearchQueryTerm WmTaskClient. Document type that you use to specify search criteria for the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service.

pub.task.taskclient:deleteTask WmTaskClient. Service that deletes an instance of a task on the Task Engine to which the Integration Server is connected.

pub.task.taskclient:getTask WmTaskClient. Service that returns the TaskInfo object, and optionally the TaskData object, for a specified task.

pub.task.taskclient:queueTask WmTaskClient. Service that adds a task instance to the Task Engine’s queue.

pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks WmTaskClient. Service that is used to retrieve tasks that match specified search criteria.

pub.task.taskclient:updateTask WmTaskClient. Service that modifies a task on the Task Engine that is connected to the Integration Server. You use this service to change information in the task’s TaskInfo and TaskData documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 456

Page 457: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskCal lbackServiceWmTaskClient. Specification that describes the inputs and outputs required for a callback service.

A callback service is a service (on the Integration Server) that the Task Engine invokes when a task ends. The callback service is assigned to a task instance when the task instance is queued. The callback service is invoked when the status of the task changes to “completed,” “cancelled,” “expired,” or “error.”

If the Task Engine cannot reach the Integration Server to invoke the service, it will, by default, attempt to re-invoke the service every minute for one hour.

If the callback service cannot be reached or if it throws an exception, the error will be recorded in the Task Engine logs on My webMethods Server. Additionally, the task instance itself will be placed in an “error” state and detailed information about the error will be available in the task audit information.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

TaskData Document The business data associated with the task.

TaskCompletionInfo Document TaskCompletionInfo document, which contains information about the completion of the task See pub.task:TaskCompletionInfo on page 458 for a description of the fields in this document.

CallbackData Document Information the task is configured to pass to the callback service. The data in CallbackData is given to the task when the task is initially queued. See pub.task.taskclient:queueTask on page 467 for information about queuing a task.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 457

Page 458: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskComplet ionInfoWmTaskClient. Document type containing information about the completion of a task. The Task Engine uses this document type to return data about the completion of a task to a callback service.

Parameters

taskID String The identifier of the task that ended.

status String The state of the task. Will be one of the following. completed Task has been successfully completed and is no longer

available in the user’s inbox queue. Completed tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

cancelled Task has been cancelled and is no longer available in the user’s inbox queue. Cancelled tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

expired Task has expired and is no longer available in the user’s inbox queue. Expired tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

error Task has failed or an unrecoverable error occurred during the processing of the task. This is often due to an incorrect task rule. The errorCode and errorMessage fields generally contain additional information about the error.

lastAcceptedBy String The user ID (on My webMethods Server) of the last user that accepted the task. If no user accepted the task, this field is null.

assignedToList String List The IDs of the principals (users or roles on My webMethods Server) to which this task had been assigned.

errorCode String A code that identifies the error condition that caused the task to end. This field is usually present when the value in status is “error.” However, the Task Engine does not require an application to report an error code, so this field might be null even if the task ends with an error.

errorMessage String A message describing the error condition that caused the task to end. This field is usually present when the value in status is “error.” However, the Task Engine does not require an application to report an error message, so this field might be null even if the task ends with an error.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 458

Page 459: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskInfoWmTaskClient. Document type that contains standard information about a task. You specify certain fields in TaskInfo when you enqueue a task using pub.task.taskclient:queueTask.

After a task is queued, you can modify fields in TaskInfo using pub.task.taskclient:updateTask.

Some fields that appear in TaskInfo can only be changed by the Task Engine. These fields are marked “read only” in the description below. If you attempt to assign a new value to a read-only field, the new value is ignored.

A task is not required to maintain information for every field in TaskInfo. Most fields are optional as noted in the description below.

Parameters

name String Optional. The name of the task. This name appears in various places in the My webMethods user interface, such as on the Details View tab in My Inbox and in the Task List Management Results list.

A task does not require a name. If a name is assigned, it does not need to be unique. Maximum length is 255 characters.

description String Optional. A descriptive comment or remark associated with the task. This description appears in various places in the My webMethods user interface, such as on the Details View tab in My Inbox and in the Task Management Results list.

Maximum length is 255 characters.

expireDate java.util.Date Optional. The date and time when the task expires. When expireDate is reached, the Task Engine switches the status value for the task to “expired.”

If an expire date is not specified, the task never expires.

createdDate java.util.Date Read-only. Date and time when the task was queued.

lastModifiedDate java.util.Date Read-only. Date and time when the task was last updated.

customTaskID String Optional. An optional, application-defined identifier for the task. This ID is separate from the internal taskID that the Task Engine uses to identify tasks. The identifier in customTaskID is visible in the user interface and is also searchable using the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service.

Note: Although customTaskID is meant to uniquely identify a task, the Task Engine does not enforce uniqueness of the value in this field. The application is responsible for assigning unique identifiers to customTaskID if they are needed.

createdBy String Read-only. The user ID (on My webMethods Server) of the user that initially queued the task.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 459

Page 460: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

lastModifiedBy String Read-only. The user ID (on My webMethods Server) of the user that last updated the task. If a process within the Task Engine was the last entity to modify the task (for example, if the Task Engine marked the task “expired”), this field will contain the name of the task rule associated with that process.

lastAcceptedBy String Read-only. The user ID (on My webMethods Server) of the last user to accept the task. If no user has accepted the task, this field is null.

priority String Optional. The priority of the task. Must contain one of the following values:

nonelowmediumhighcritical

Values are case-sensitive.

status String The state of the task. Must contain one of the following values:

Value Description

active Task is active and is available in the user’s inbox queue. Only active tasks can be modified by the user.

suspended Task is suspended and is not available in the user’s inbox queue. Suspended tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

completed Task has been successfully completed and is no longer available in the user’s inbox queue. Completed tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

cancelled Task has been cancelled and is no longer available in the user’s inbox queue. Cancelled tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

expired Task has expired and is no longer available in the user’s inbox queue. Expired tasks still appear in the Task Management Results list.

error Task has failed or an unrecoverable error occurred during the processing of the task. This is often due to an incorrect task rule. The errorCode and errorMessage fields generally contain additional information about the error.

acceptedByList String List The IDs (on My webMethods Server) of the users that have accepted this task. Setting this list accepts the task for the specified users.

assignedToList String List The IDs of the principals (users or roles on My webMethods Server) to which this task is assigned. Setting this list assigns the task to the specified users or roles. The Task Engine uses this list to route the task to the appropriate users.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 460

Page 461: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskQueueInfoWmTaskClient. Document type used by pub.task.taskclient:queueTask to set basic values in TaskInfo.

The fields in this document type constitute a subset of the fields in pub.task:TaskInfo.

Parameters

errorCode String Optional. A code that identifies the error condition that caused the task to end. This field is usually present when the value in status is “error.” However, the Task Engine does not require an application to report an error code, so this field might be null even if the task ends with an error.

errorMessage String Optional. A message describing the error condition that caused the task to end. This field is usually present when the value in status is “error.” However, the Task Engine does not require an application to report an error message, so this field might be null even if the task ends with an error.

taskUrl String Read only. The fully qualified URL for the task on the My webMethods Server. This URL can be used to open the task instance in a browser.

name String Optional. The name of the task. This name appears in various places in the My webMethods user interface, such as on the Details View tab in My Inbox and in the Task Management Results list.

A task does not require a name. If a name is assigned, it does not need to be unique. Maximum length is 255 characters.

customTaskID String Optional. An application-defined identifier for the task. This ID is separate from the internal taskID that the Task Engine automatically generates and assigns to a task instance. The identifier in customTaskID is visible in the user interface and is also searchable using the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service. For example, if a task relates to an order approval process, you might assign the order number to the customTaskID.

Note: Although customTaskID is meant to uniquely identify a task, the Task Engine does not enforce uniqueness of the value in this field. The application is responsible for assigning unique identifiers to customTaskID if they are needed.

assignedTaskList String List Optional. The IDs of the principals (users or roles on My webMethods Server) to which this task is assigned. Setting this list assigns the task to the specified users or roles. The Task Engine uses this list to route the task to the appropriate users.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 461

Page 462: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskSearchQueryWmTaskClient. Document type used as input to the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service.

Parameters

priority String Optional. The priority of the task. Must be one of the following values:nonelowmediumhighcritical

Values are case-sensitive.

expireDate java.util.Date Optional. The date and time when the task instance expires. When expireDate is reached, the Task Engine automatically switches the status value for the task to “expired.”

If an expire date is not specified, the task never expires.

MaxResults String Optional. The maximum number of tasks to return in the result set. If MaxResults is not specified, all results in the result set are returned.

Terms Document List An array of TaskSearchQueryTerm, in which each member of the array specifies query criteria for the search. See pub.task:TaskSearchQueryTerm on page 463 for a description of the fields in TaskSearchQueryTerm.

When a search is performed, the criteria specified by the TaskSearchQueryTerm documents in Terms are combined using the logical “AND” operator. Only tasks that satisfy all TaskSearchQueryTerm documents in the Terms array are returned in the result set.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 462

Page 463: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task:TaskSearchQueryTermWmTaskClient. Document type that you use to specify search criteria for the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service.

You use this document to specify 1) the field or fields that you want the service to search, 2) the value to which you want the field’s contents to be compared, and 3) the type of comparison that you want the service to make.

A task is included in the result set if the comparison evaluates to true in any of the fields you have specified (that is, the service performs a logical “OR” when asked to evaluate multiple fields).

Parameters

Fields String List A list of fields that are to be searched.

You can search the following fields in TaskInfo using these names:statusnamedescriptionpriorityexpireDatecreatedDatelastModifiedDatecreatedBylastModifiedBylastAcceptedBytaskIDtaskTypeIDacceptedByListassignedToListprocessInstanceIDprocessModelIDprocessModelVersionstepIDstepIterationauditContextcustomTaskID

To search fields in TaskData (the business data associated with the task), you must specify the field using a binding expression in the following format:

#{currentTask.taskData.pathToDataElement}

For example, the following binding expression:#{currentTask.taskData.travelReservation.reservationNo}

would search the “reservationNo” field within the “travelReservation” document in TaskData.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 463

Page 464: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

Operator String The comparison that the service will make when evaluating the contents of Value against the contents of the specified field(s).

Operator must be one of the following:

Operator Description

= Is equal to.<> Is not equal to.< Is less than. Valid only for numbers or date fields.> Is greater than. Valid only for numbers or date fields.<= Is less than or equal to. Valid only for numbers or date fields.>= Is greater than or equal to. Valid only for numbers or date

fields.like Matches the pattern string specified in Value. See Value for

information about pattern strings.

This operator is only valid with String fields.contains Compares Value to the individual elements in a String List. The

comparison evaluates to true if any element in the list matches Value.

For example, if you have a String List field with three elements, this operator will evaluate to true if any one of the three elements contains a String that exactly matches the value in Value.

This operator is only valid with String List fields.

Value Object The value to which the contents of the field specified in Field will be compared.

When the like operator is used, Value specifies a pattern string that can include the * wildcard character. For example:

A Value of... Would return tasks whose field contents...

abc Contains only the character sequence abc.abc* Starts with the character sequence abc.*abc Ends with the character sequence abc.*abc* Includes the character sequence abc anywhere within the field.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 464

Page 465: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task. taskcl ient:deleteTaskWmTaskClient. Service that deletes an instance of a task on the Task Engine to which the Integration Server is connected.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To delete a task using this service, you must supply the ID of the task that you want to delete. To obtain this ID, use the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service to locate the task and then extract the task ID from the result set that the searchTasks service returns.

To delete a task successfully, the user ID in user must have permission to access the specified task. If the supplied ID does not have access to the task, or if the specified task does not exist, an exception will be thrown.

See Also

pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks

user String Optional. The user ID of the My webMethods Server user on whose behalf this service will execute.

If user is not specified, the user ID associated with the WmTaskClient package is used. For information about configuring this user ID, see the webMethods Task Engine User's Guide.

taskID String The ID that identifies the task that you want to delete.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 465

Page 466: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task. taskcl ient:getTaskWmTaskClient. Service that returns the TaskInfo object, and optionally the TaskData object, for a specified task.

The TaskInfo object contains standard information about a task, including its status, expiration date, and the list of users to which it is assigned. The TaskData object contains the business data that is associated with the task.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

To get a task using this service, you must supply the ID of the task that you want to retrieve. To obtain this ID, use the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service to locate the task and then extract the task ID from the result set that the searchTasks service returns.

To retrieve a task successfully, the user ID specified in user must have permission to access that task. If the supplied ID does not have access to the task, or if the task does not exist, an exception is thrown.

See Also

pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks

user String Optional. The user ID of the My webMethods Server user on whose behalf this service will execute.

If user is not specified, the user ID associated with the WmTaskClient package is used. For information about configuring this user ID, see the webMethods Task Engine User's Guide.

taskID String The ID that identifies the task that you want to retrieve.

includeTaskData String Optional. Specifies whether you want to retrieve the TaskData document as well as the TaskInfo document.

Set to... To...

true Retrieve TaskData in addition to TaskInfo. false Default. Get TaskInfo only.

TaskInfo Document TaskInfo document containing standard information about the task. See pub.task:TaskInfo on page 459 for a description of the fields in this document.

TaskData Document Document containing the business data associated with the task. TaskData does not have a specified structure. Its content varies according to the task.

TaskData is returned only if includeTaskData is set to true.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 466

Page 467: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

pub.task. taskcl ient:queueTaskWmTaskClient. Service that adds a task instance to the Task Engine’s queue.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

user String Optional. The user ID of the My webMethods Server user on whose behalf this service will execute.

If user is not specified, the user ID associated with the WmTaskClient package is used. For information about configuring this user ID, see the webMethods Task Engine User's Guide.

taskTypeID String Specifies the type of task that you want to queue. Each task type that is deployed on the Task Engine has a unique ID. This ID is assigned by the developer when he or she creates a task application using webMethods Designer.

If you do not know the ID for the task type that you want to queue, contact the administrator of the Task Engine to which Integration Server is connected. An administrator can obtain a list of the task types deployed on the Task Engine by viewing the Task Configuration panel on the Task Engine Administration page in My webMethods.

Task type IDs are case-sensitive. The ID in taskTypeID must exactly match the ID as it is specified on the Task Engine.

TaskQueueInfo Document Optional. A TaskQueueInfo document containing basic information about the task (e.g., name, priority, list of users to which the task is assigned). See pub.task:TaskQueueInfo on page 461 for a description of the fields in this document.

TaskData Document Optional. The business data, if any, associated with this task.

CallbackServiceName String Optional. The name of a service on this Integration Server that will execute when the task ends (that is, when the status of the task changes to “completed,” “cancelled,” “expired,” or “error”).

Example: customer.accounts:closeAccount

The signature of the callback service must match the specification described in pub.task:TaskCallbackService on page 457 .

CallbackData Document Optional. Any data that you want the task to pass back to the callback service.

taskID String The identifier that the Task Engine assigns to the task.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 467

Page 468: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

Usage Notes

The user ID specified in user must have permission to queue tasks on the Task Engine. If the supplied ID does not have this permission, an exception is thrown.

pub.task. taskcl ient :searchTasksWmTaskClient. Service that is used to retrieve tasks that match specified search criteria.

Input Parameters

user String Optional. The user ID of the My webMethods Server user on whose behalf this service will execute.

If user is not specified, the user ID associated with the WmTaskClient package is used. For information about configuring this user ID, see the webMethods Task Engine User's Guide.

Note: Only tasks to which user has access are searched.

searchUserTasks String Optional. Specifies whether the service searches all tasks or just the user’s inbox.

Set to... To...

true Search only the inbox for user.false Default. Search all tasks to which user has access.

includeTaskData String Optional. Specifies whether the service will return the TaskData document as well as the TaskInfo document for each task matching the search criteria.

Set to... To...

true Include the TaskData document in the result set. false Default. Include only the TaskInfo document in the result set.

TaskSearchQuery Document Optional. TaskSearchQuery document, which specifies the search criteria. See pub.task:TaskSearchQuery on page 462 for a description of the fields in this document.

If TaskSearchQuery is null, all tasks for user will be returned.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 468

Page 469: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

Output Parameters

See Also

pub.task:TaskSearchQuery

pub.task. taskcl ient:updateTaskWmTaskClient. Service that modifies a task on the Task Engine that is connected to the Integration Server. You use this service to change information in the task’s TaskInfo and TaskData documents.

To end a task, you use this service to change the status field in the task’s TaskInfo document to “closed” or “cancelled” as appropriate.

Input Parameters

Tasks Document List Result set containing the tasks that match the search criteria in TaskSearchQuery. Each document in the result set has the following structure:

Key Description

TaskID String The identifier assigned to the task.

TaskInfo Document TaskInfo document containing standard information about the task. See pub.task:TaskInfo on page 459 for a description of the fields in this document.

TaskData Document TaskData document containing the business data associated with the task. Returned only if includeTaskData is set to true.

user String Optional. The user ID of the My webMethods Server user on whose behalf this service will execute.

If user is not specified, the user ID associated with the WmTaskClient package is used. For information about configuring this user ID, see the webMethods Task Engine User's Guide.

taskID String The ID that identifies the task you want to modify.

TaskInfo Document TaskInfo object that specifies the changes you want to make to the standard information maintained for the task. See pub.task:TaskInfo on page 459 for a description of the fields in this document.

TaskData Document TaskData object that contains the business data that you want to associate with the task.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 469

Page 470: Integration Server Bis Reference

33. Task Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

To modify a task using this service, you must supply the ID of the task that you want to update. To obtain this ID, use the pub.task.taskclient:searchTasks service to locate the task and then extract the task ID from the result set that the searchTasks service returns.

To modify a task successfully, the user ID in user must have permission to access the specified task. If the supplied ID does not have access to the task, or if the specified task does not exist, an exception will be thrown.

When you use this service to update information in the task’s TaskInfo document, the Task Engine modifies only the fields that have assigned values in TaskInfo. All other fields in the target task retain their existing values. For example, to change just the name assigned to a task, set only the name field in the TaskInfo document that you pass to this service.

When you use this service to update information in the task’s TaskData document, the TaskData document that you pass to the service replaces the task’s existing TaskData document in its entirety.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 470

Page 471: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 34. Trigger Folder

You can use the services in the trigger to folder to create and delete triggers and manage document retrieval and document processing for individual triggers.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 471

Page 472: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Summary of Elements in this FolderThe following elements are available in this folder:

pub.tr igger:createTriggerWmPublic. Creates a trigger.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.trigger:createTrigger WmPublic. Creates a trigger.

pub.trigger:deleteTrigger WmPublic. Deletes a trigger.

pub.trigger:resourceMonitoringSpec WmPublic. Specification for the signature of a resource monitoring service.

pub.trigger:resumeProcessing WmPublic. Resumes document processing for the specified trigger.

pub.trigger:resumeRetrieval WmPublic. Resumes retrieval of documents from the Broker for a specific trigger.

pub.trigger:suspendProcessing WmPublic. Suspends document processing for the specified trigger.

pub.trigger:suspendRetrieval WmPublic. Suspends retrieval of documents from the Broker for a specific trigger.

triggerName String Fully qualified name for the new trigger that uses any combination of letters, and/or the underscore character. Make sure to specify the name of the folder and subfolder in which you want to save the trigger.

Note: For a list of reserved words and symbols for element names, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

package String Name of the package in which you want to save the trigger.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 472

Page 473: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

properties Document Optional. Properties that you want to assign to the trigger.

Key Description

joinTimeOut String Number of milliseconds Integration Server waits for the other documents in the join condition. Integration Server starts the join time-out period when it pulls the first document that satisfies the join condition from the trigger queue.

You need to specify a join time-out only when your condition is an AND or XOR join type. You do not need to specify a join time-out for an OR join condition or a condition that does not use joins.

Set joinTimeOut to -1 to indicate that the join condition never expires.

The default is 1 day.

queueCapacity String Maximum number of documents that Integration Server maintains in the queue for this trigger.

The default is 10.

queueRefillLevel String Number of unprocessed documents that must remain in the trigger queue before Integration Server retrieves more documents for the trigger from the Broker.

The default is 4.

The queueRefillLevel value must be less than or equal to the queueCapacity value

ackQueueSize String Maximum number of pending document acknowledgements for the trigger. The value must be greater than zero.

The default is 1.

maxRetryAttempts String Maximum number of times Integration Server should attempt to re-execute the trigger service. If you want the trigger service to retry until it executes successfully, specify -1.

The default is 5 retries.

retryInterval String Number of seconds Integration Server waits between retry attempts.

The default is 10 seconds.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 473

Page 474: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

onRedeliveryFailure String Specifies how Integration Server handles retry failure for the trigger. Retry failure occurs when Integration Server reaches the maximum number of retry attempts and the trigger service still fails because of a run-time exception.

Specify one of the following values:

Set to... To...

Throw Exception Indicate that Integration Server throws a service exception when the last allowed retry attempt ends because of a run-time exception.

This is the default.

Suspend and Retry Later

Indicate that Integration Server suspends the trigger when the last allowed retry attempt ends because of a run-time exception. Integration Server retries the trigger service at a later time.

Note: If you set onRedeliveryFailure to Suspend and Retry later, you must specify a service for the resumeTaskSvcName parameter. If you do not specify a service and the trigger suspends because of retry failure, Integration Server will not resume the trigger automatically. You must resume the trigger manually.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 474

Page 475: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

resumeTaskSvcName String Fully qualified name of the service that Integration Server executes when one of the following occurs:

During exactly-once processing, the document resolver service ends because of a transient error. Integration Server suspends the trigger and invokes the resumeTaskSvcName to determine when the resources associated with the document resolver service are available. After the resources become available, Integration Server resumes document retrieval and document processing for the trigger.

A trigger ends because of retry failure and the onRedeliveryFailure variable is set to Suspend and Retry Later. Integration Server executes the resumeTaskSvcName to determine whether the resources associated with a trigger service are available. If the resources are available, Integration Server resumes document retrieval and document processing for the trigger.

isConcurrent String Indicates whether the trigger uses a concurrent processing mode or a serial processing mode. Specify one of the following values:

Set to... To...

true Specify a concurrent processing mode. Integration Server processes as many documents in the trigger queue as it can at once.

false Specify a serial processing mode. Integration Server processes documents in the trigger queue one after the other.

This is the default.

serialSuspendOnError String Indicates whether Integration Server suspends document processing and document retrieval automatically when a trigger service ends with an error.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that Integration Server suspends the trigger automatically if an error occurs during trigger service execution.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 475

Page 476: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

false Indicate that Integration Server should not suspend a trigger if an error occurs during trigger service execution.

This is the default

maxExecutionThreads String Maximum number of documents that Integration Server can process concurrently for this trigger. Integration Server uses one server thread to process each document in the trigger queue.

dupDetection String Indicates whether Integration Server performs exactly-once processing for guaranteed documents received by this trigger.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that Integration Server performs exactly-once processing for guaranteed documents received by this trigger.

false Indicate that exactly-once processing is not performed.

This is the default.

dupHistory String Indicates whether Integration Server uses a document history database as part of performing exactly-once processing.

Set to... To...

true Indicate that Integration Server uses a document history database as part of exactly-once processing.

false Indicate that Integration Server does not use a document history database as part of exactly-once processing.

This is the default

dupHistoryTTL String Number of milliseconds that the document history database maintains an entry for a document processed by this trigger.

The default is 2 hours.

dupResolverSvcName String Fully qualified name of the service used to determine conclusively whether a document’s status is New, Duplicate, or In Doubt.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 476

Page 477: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

conditions Document List Optional. Specifies the conditions for the trigger. A condition associates one or more publishable document types with a single service. The publishable document type acts as the subscription piece of the trigger. The service is the processing piece. When the trigger receives documents to which it subscribes, the Integration Server processes the document by invoking the service specified in the condition. Triggers can contain multiple conditions; however, a trigger can contain only one join condition.

Note: The order in which you list conditions in the conditions list is important because it indicates the order in which Integration Server evaluates the conditions at run time. When Integration Server receives a document, it invokes the service specified in the first condition that is satisfied by the document. The remaining conditions are ignored. For more information about the order in which conditions are evaluated, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

Key Description

conditionName String Name you want to assign to the condition.

By default, Integration Server assigns each condition a default name such as Condition1 or Condition2.

serviceName String Fully qualified name of the service that to be invoked when the trigger receives documents or messages to which it subscribes.

joinType String The join type for the condition. The join type determines whether Integration Server needs to receive all, any, or only one of the documents or messages in the condition to execute the trigger service

You must specify a joinType if the condition subscribes to more than one document type or message. That is, if messageTypeFilterPairs contains more than one pair, you must select a joinType. Specify one of the following:

Set to... To...

N/A Indicate this is not a join condition.

AND Integration Server invokes the trigger service when the server receives an instance of each specified message type within the join time-out period. The instance documents must have the same activation ID.

This is the default join type.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 477

Page 478: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

OR Integration Server invokes the associated trigger service when it receives an instance of any one of the specified publishable document types.

XOR Integration Server invokes the associated trigger service when it receives an instance of any of the specified document types. For the duration of the join time-out period, Integration Server discards (blocks) any instances of the specified publishable document types with the same activation ID.

messageTypeFilterPairs Document List Specifies the messages and document types to which a trigger subscribes and the filter that must be applied to instances of the message or document type

Key Description

messageType String Fully qualified name of the publishable document type or message to which the trigger subscribes.

filter String Filter that you want Integration Server to apply to each instance of this message. Integration Server executes the trigger service only if instances of the message meet the filter criteria. Filters are optional for a trigger condition. For more information about filters, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

Note: If multiple conditions in the trigger specify the same document type or message, the filter must be the same in the conditions. If the filters are not the same, Integration Server ignores the condition.

Note: If you specify multiple messageType values in one condition, you need to select a joinType.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 478

Page 479: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The client executing this service must have write access to the folders and packages in which the client wants to save the new trigger. If the client does not have write access, Integration Server throws a write permissions error. For more information about assigning access permissions to folders and packages, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

If you are connected to a Broker, Integration Server registers the trigger subscription with the Broker by creating a client for the trigger on the Broker. Integration Server also creates a subscription for each messageType specified in the trigger conditions and saves the subscriptions with the trigger client.

If you are not connected to a Broker when you save the trigger, the trigger will only receive documents published locally. When you reconnect to a Broker, the next time Integration Server restarts, Integration Server will create a client for the trigger on the Broker and create subscriptions for the publishable document types identified in the trigger conditions. Broker validates the filters in the trigger conditions when Integration Server creates the subscriptions.

If messageType specifies a publishable document type that does not exist on the Broker (that is, there is no associated Broker document type), Integration Server still creates the trigger client on the Broker, but does not create any subscriptions. Integration Server creates the subscriptions when you synchronize (push) the publishable document type with the Broker.

For more information about creating triggers, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

See Also

pub.trigger:deleteTrigger

pub.tr igger:deleteTr iggerWmPublic. Deletes a trigger.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

The trigger must be unlocked for this service to execute successfully. If the trigger is locked when this service executes, Integration Server throws an error stating “Trigger is locked, change not permitted.”

triggerName String Fully qualified name of the trigger that you want to delete.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 479

Page 480: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

See Also

pub.trigger:createTrigger

pub.tr igger:resourceMonitoringSpec WmPublic. Specification for the signature of a resource monitoring service.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

The pub.trigger:resourceMonitoringSpec must be used as the service signature for any service used as a resource monitoring service. A resource monitoring service determines whether the resources associated with a trigger are available for exactly-once processing or document pre-processing. Integration Server executes a resource monitoring service after retry failure occurs for the trigger or when the document resolver service fails because of a run-time exception. For more information about building a resource monitoring service, see the Publish-Subscribe Developer’s Guide.

isAvailable String Indicates whether the resources needed by the trigger to perform exactly-once processing or to execute the trigger service are available. The value of this field determines whether Integration Server resumes document processing and document retrieval for the trigger or re-executes the resource monitoring service. Integration Server continues to execute a resource monitoring service until the value of isAvailable is “true”. The isAvailable field must have one of the following values:

Value Description

true Indicates that the resources associated with the trigger are available. Integration Server resumes document retrieval and document processing for the trigger.

false Indicates that the resources associated with the trigger are not available. Integration Server will not resume the trigger.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 480

Page 481: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

pub.tr igger:resumeProcessingWmPublic. Resumes document processing for the specified trigger.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

triggerName String. Fully qualified name of the trigger for which you want to resume document processing.

persistChange String. Optional. Flag indicating whether the document processing change should be permanent or temporary.

Set to... To...

true Save the change to file. Integration Server persists the change across server restarts, package reloads, and changes to trigger properties. The trigger will continue to process documents until it is actively suspended via the Integration Server Administrator or by execution of the pub.trigger:suspendProcessing service.

false Default. Indicate that the change is temporary and will not be maintained when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

applyChangeAcrossCluster String. Optional. Flag indicating whether document processing should be resumed for this trigger across all the servers in the cluster.

Set to... To...

true Resume document processing for the specified trigger on all the nodes in the cluster.

Note: To make the document processing change on all the servers in a cluster, the Integration Server must belong to a properly configured cluster and it must be configured to synchronize trigger changes across the cluster. For more information about configuring an Integration Server to synchronize trigger management changes across a cluster, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

false Default. Indicate that document processing for this trigger should be resumed on the local Integration Server only.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 481

Page 482: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Usage Notes

This service affects all documents in the specified trigger queue on the Integration Server, including documents retrieved from the Broker and from local publishing.

If you do not persist the change, the trigger reverts to the previously saved document processing state when the Integration Server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

After this service executes, the Integration Server resumes document processing for this trigger at the percentage specified in the Execution Threads Throttle field on the Settings > Resources > Trigger Management > Edit Global Trigger Controls page in the Integration Server Administrator.

The Integration Server resumes document processing for the specified trigger even if document processing is suspended for all triggers on the Integration Server (that is, the Processing State for all triggers is set to Suspended).

The Integration Server will not resume document processing for the specified trigger if the trigger is locked by a user. For more information about locking elements, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

If you set applyChangeAcrossCluster to true and the synchronization is not successful, the following occurs:

If the Integration Server does not update all the Integration Servers in the cluster successfully, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry for each server that could not be updated: [ISS.0098.0107E] Error occurred during cluster invoke: Alias = remoteAliasName; Service = serviceName; Exception = exceptionName

The Integration Server Administrator also displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9203] Errors occurred while updating remote aliases (x of y updates failed). See server logs for more details.

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because the change could not be made locally, the Integration Server Administrator displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9204] Local update failed: Exception providing reason for failure. (Note: The cluster synchronization will not run until all local errors are resolved.)

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because cluster synchronization is not configured, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry: [ISS.0033.0156W] Cluster invoke did not complete successfully. Cluster Synchronization feature is not configured.

You can use the Integration Server Administrator to view and change cluster synchronization status for triggers. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

In a Java service, you can resume document processing using com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade.setProcessingSuspended(). For more information about this method, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade class.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 482

Page 483: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

You can resume and suspend document processing for an individual trigger or all triggers using the Integration Server Administrator. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

See Also

pub.trigger:suspendProcessing

pub.tr igger:resumeRetr ievalWmPublic. Resumes retrieval of documents from the Broker for a specific trigger.

Input Parameters

triggerName String. Fully qualified name of the trigger for which you want to resume document retrieval.

persistChange String. Optional. Flag indicating whether the document retrieval change should be permanent or temporary.

Set to... To...

true Save the change to file. Integration Server persists the change across server restarts, package reloads, and changes to trigger properties. The trigger will continue to retrieve documents until it is actively suspended via the Integration Server Administrator or by execution of the pub.trigger:suspendRetrieval service.

false Default. Indicate that the change is temporary and will not be maintained when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 483

Page 484: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service does not affect document retrieval for locally published documents to which this trigger subscribes.

If you do not persist the change, the trigger reverts to the previously saved document retrieval state when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

After this service executes, the Integration Server resumes document retrieval for this trigger at the percentage specified in the Queue Capacity Throttle field on the Settings > Resources > Trigger Management > Edit Global Trigger Controls page in the Integration Server Administrator.

The Integration Server resumes document retrieval for the specified trigger even if document retrieval is suspended for all the triggers on the Integration Server (that is, the Retrieval State for all triggers is set to Suspended).

The Integration Server will not resume document retrieval for the specified trigger if the trigger is locked by a user. For more information about locking elements, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

If you set applyChangeAcrossCluster to true and the synchronization is not successful, the following occurs:

If the Integration Server does not update all the Integration Servers in the cluster successfully, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry for each server that could not be updated:

applyChangeAcrossCluster String. Optional. Flag indicating whether document retrieval should be resumed for this trigger across all the servers in the cluster.

Set to... To...

true Resume document retrieval for the specified trigger on all the servers in the cluster.

Note: To make the document retrieval change on all the servers in a cluster, the Integration Server must belong to a properly configured cluster and it must be configured to synchronize trigger changes across the cluster. For more information about configuring an Integration Server to synchronize trigger management changes across a cluster, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

false Default. Indicate that document retrieval for this trigger should be resumed on the local Integration Server only.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 484

Page 485: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

[ISS.0098.0107E] Error occurred during cluster invoke: Alias = remoteAliasName; Service = serviceName; Exception = exceptionName

The Integration Server Administrator also displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9203] Errors occurred while updating remote aliases (x of y updates failed). See server logs for more details.

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because the change could not be made locally, the Integration Server Administrator displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9204] Local update failed: Exception providing reason for failure. (Note: The cluster synchronization will not run until all local errors are resolved.)

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because cluster synchronization is not configured, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry: [ISS.0033.0156W] Cluster invoke did not complete successfully. Cluster Synchronization feature is not configured.

You can use the Integration Server Administrator to view and change cluster synchronization status for triggers. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide

In a Java service, you can resume document retrieval by calling com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade.setRetrievalSuspended(). For more information about this method, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade class.

You can resume and suspend document retrieval for an individual trigger or all triggers using the Integration Server Administrator. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

See Also

pub.trigger:suspendRetrieval

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 485

Page 486: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

pub.tr igger:suspendProcessingWmPublic. Suspends document processing for the specified trigger.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

triggerName String. Fully qualified name of the trigger for which you want to suspend document processing.

persistChange String. Optional. Flag indicating whether the document processing change should be permanent or temporary.

Set to... To...

true Save the change to file. Integration Server persists the change across server restarts, package reloads, and changes to trigger properties. The trigger will not process documents until processing is actively resumed via the Integration Server Administrator or by execution of the pub.trigger:resumeProcessing service.

false Default. Indicate that the change is temporary and will not be maintained when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

applyChangeAcrossCluster String. Optional. Flag indicating whether document processing should be suspended for this trigger across all the servers in the cluster.

Set to... To...

true Suspend document processing for the specified trigger on all the servers in the cluster.

Note: To make the document processing change on all the servers in a cluster, the Integration Server must belong to a properly configured cluster and it must be configured to synchronize trigger changes across the cluster. For more information about configuring an Integration Server to synchronize trigger management changes across a cluster, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

false Default. Indicate that document processing for this trigger should be suspended on the local Integration Server only.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 486

Page 487: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Usage Notes

This service affects all documents in the specified trigger queue on the Integration Server, including documents retrieved from the Broker and from local publishing.

When you suspend document processing, the Integration Server will not dispatch any more server threads to process documents in the trigger's queue. Any server threads currently processing documents for the trigger will execute to completion. This includes documents that are being retried.

When you suspend document processing, documents that the trigger retrieves will collect in the trigger queue until the trigger resumes document processing. If the server restarts before document processing resumes, volatile documents are discarded.

If you do not persist the change, the trigger reverts to the previously saved document processing state when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

The Integration Server will not suspend document processing for the specified trigger if the trigger is locked by a user. For more information about locking elements, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

If you suspend document processing, but do not suspend document retrieval for a trigger, the trigger queue fills to capacity and Integration Server stops retrieving documents for this trigger from the Broker.

If you set applyChangeAcrossCluster to true and the synchronization is not successful, the following occurs:

If the Integration Server does not update all the Integration Servers in the cluster successfully, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry for each server that could not be updated: [ISS.0098.0107E] Error occurred during cluster invoke: Alias = remoteAliasName; Service = serviceName; Exception = exceptionName

The Integration Server Administrator also displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9203] Errors occurred while updating remote aliases (x of y updates failed). See server logs for more details.

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because the change could not be made locally, the Integration Server Administrator displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9204] Local update failed: Exception providing reason for failure. (Note: The cluster synchronization will not run until all local errors are resolved.)

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because cluster synchronization is not configured, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry: [ISS.0033.0156W] Cluster invoke did not complete successfully. Cluster Synchronization feature is not configured.

You can use the Integration Server Administrator to view and change cluster synchronization status for triggers. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide

In a Java service, you can suspend document processing by calling com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade.setProcessingSuspended(). For more

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 487

Page 488: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

information about this method, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade class.

You can resume and suspend document processing for an individual trigger or all triggers using the Integration Server Administrator. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

See Also

pub.trigger:resumeProcessing

pub.tr igger:suspendRetrievalWmPublic. Suspends retrieval of documents from the Broker for a specific trigger.

Input Parameters

triggerName String. Fully qualified name of the trigger for which you want to suspend document retrieval.

persistChange String. Optional. Flag indicating whether the document retrieval change should be permanent or temporary.

Set to... To...

true Save the change to file. Integration Server persists the change across server restarts, package reloads, and changes to trigger properties. The trigger will not retrieve documents until retrieval is actively resumed via the Integration Server Administrator or by execution of the pub.trigger:resumeProcessing service.

false Default. Indicate that the change is temporary and will not be maintained when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 488

Page 489: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service does not affect document retrieval for locally published documents to which the specified trigger subscribes.

When you suspend document retrieval, the specified trigger will continue to receive documents delivered to the default client.

The Integration Server will not suspend document processing for the specified trigger if the trigger is locked by a user. For more information about locking elements, see the webMethods Developer User’s Guide.

When you suspend document retrieval, the Integration Server will not dispatch any server threads to retrieve documents from the Broker for the trigger. Any server threads currently retrieving documents for the trigger will execute to completion.

When you suspend document retrieval, documents to which this trigger subscribes will collect in the trigger’s client queue on the Broker. Documents remain in the trigger's client queue until document retrieval resumes for the trigger or the documents expire.

If you do not resume document retrieval before the server restarts, the trigger package reloads, or the trigger properties are modified, the Broker discards any volatile documents in that trigger's client queue.

If you do not persist the change, the trigger reverts to the previously saved document retrieval state when the server restarts, the trigger is enabled or disabled, or the package containing the trigger reloads.

applyChangeAcrossCluster String. Optional. Flag indicating whether document retrieval should be suspended for this trigger across all the servers in the cluster.

Set to... To...

true Suspend document retrieval for the specified trigger on all the servers in the cluster.

Note: To make the document retrieval change on all the servers in a cluster, the Integration Server must belong to a properly configured cluster and it must be configured to synchronize trigger changes across the cluster. For more information about configuring an Integration Server to synchronize trigger management changes across a cluster, see webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

false Default. Indicate that document retrieval for this trigger should be suspended on the local Integration Server only.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 489

Page 490: Integration Server Bis Reference

34. Trigger Folder

If you suspend document retrieval for a trigger, but do not suspend document processing for the trigger, the trigger eventually processes all the documents that were retrieved from the Broker for the trigger.

If you set applyChangeAcrossCluster to true and the synchronization is not successful, the following occurs:

If the Integration Server does not update all the Integration Servers in the cluster successfully, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry for each server that could not be updated: [ISS.0098.0107E] Error occurred during cluster invoke: Alias = remoteAliasName; Service = serviceName; Exception = exceptionName

The Integration Server Administrator also displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9203] Errors occurred while updating remote aliases (x of y updates failed). See server logs for more details.

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because the change could not be made locally, the Integration Server Administrator displays the following message: [ISS.0085.9204] Local update failed: Exception providing reason for failure. (Note: The cluster synchronization will not run until all local errors are resolved.)

If the Integration Server cannot update the Integration Servers in the cluster because cluster synchronization is not configured, the Integration Server writes the following server log entry: [ISS.0033.0156W] Cluster invoke did not complete successfully. Cluster Synchronization feature is not configured.

You can use the Integration Server Administrator to view and change cluster synchronization status for triggers. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide

In a Java service, you can suspend document retrieval by calling setRetrievalSuspended(). For more information about this method, see the webMethods Integration Server Java API Reference for the com.wm.app.b2b.server.dispatcher.trigger.TriggerFacade class.

You can resume and suspend document retrieval for an individual trigger or all triggers using the Integration Server Administrator. For more information, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

See Also

pub.trigger:resumeRetrieval

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 490

Page 491: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 35. UDDI Folder

The UDDI folder provides services, specifications, and document types for UDDI inquiry and publishing. You can use these elements to:

query about Web service information

publish an existing Integration Server service as a Web service to a UDDI server.

The UDDI services, specifications, and document types are compliant with UDDI Version 2.04. For more information, see:

UDDI Version 2.04 Specification

UDDI Version 2.03 Data Structure Reference

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 491

Page 492: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

Summary of Elements in this FolderThe following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.uddi.client.doc:accessPoint WmUDDI. Document type that conveys the entry point address suitable for calling a particular Web service. The accessPoint document type is an attribute-qualified pointer to a service entry point.

pub.uddi.client.doc:address WmUDDI. Document type that is a simple list of pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine elements within the address container.

pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine WmUDDI. Document type that contains the address line information.

pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusItem WmUDDI. Document type that contains the assertion status information.

pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusReport WmUDDI. Document type that reports all complete and incomplete assertions and serves an administrative use, including determining if there are any outstanding, incomplete assertions about relationships involving businesses with which the publisher account is associated.

pub.uddi.client.doc:authToken WmUDDI. Document type that contains a single authInfo element that contains an access token that is to be passed back in all Publisher’s API messages that change data.

pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingDetail WmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more bindingTemplate structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingKey WmUDDI. Document type that contains a unique key for a given bindingTemplate.

pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingTemplate WmUDDI. Document type that holds technical service description information related to a given business service family.

pub.uddi.client.doc:bindingTemplates WmUDDI. Document type that contains list of bindingTemplates.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessDetail WmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more businessDetail structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessDetailExt WmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more businessDetailExt structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 492

Page 493: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity WmUDDI. Document type that represents all known information about a business or entity that publishes descriptive information about the entity as well as the services that it offers.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntityExt WmUDDI. Document type that contains a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity document.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessInfo WmUDDI. Document type that contains company name and optional description data, along with a collection element named serviceInfos that in turn can contain one or more serviceInfo structures.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessInfos WmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of businessInfo documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessKey WmUDDI. Document type that contains the unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessList WmUDDI. Document type that contains zero or more businessInfos structures.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessService WmUDDI. Document type that represents a logical service classification.

pub.uddi.client.doc:businessServices WmUDDI. Document type that lists the businessService documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:categoryBag WmUDDI. Document type that allows pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity, businessService, and tModel structures to be categorized according to any of several available taxonomy based classification schemes.

pub.uddi.client.doc:contact WmUDDI. Document type that lets you record contact information for a person.

pub.uddi.client.doc:contacts WmUDDI. Document type that provides a way for information to be registered with a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity record so that someone that finds the information can make human contact for any purpose.

pub.uddi.client.doc:discoveryURL WmUDDI. Document type that consists of an attribute whose value designates the URL use type convention, and a string, found within the body of the element.

pub.uddi.client.doc:discoveryURLs WmUDDI. Document type that is used to hold pointers to URL addressable discovery documents.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 493

Page 494: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.doc:dispositionReport WmUDDI. Document type that is used to report status of various publish operations.

pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_categoryBag WmUDDI. Document type that allows pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity, businessService and tModel structures to be categorized according to any of several available taxonomy based classification schemes.

pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_description WmUDDI. Document type that contains the description with language resource information.

pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_keyedReference WmUDDI. Document type that designates the relationship type for which the assertion is made, represented by the included tModelKey and described by the included keyName keyValue pair.

pub.uddi.client.doc:docType_name WmUDDI. Document type that describes a name.

pub.uddi.client.doc:email WmUDDI. Document type that describes the e-mail information.

pub.uddi.client.doc:errInfo WmUDDI. Document type that describes the error information.

pub.uddi.client.doc:findQualifier WmUDDI. Document type that provides a means to allow the caller to override default search behaviors.

pub.uddi.client.doc:findQualifiers WmUDDI. Document type that contains a list of find qualifiers.

pub.uddi.client.doc:fromKey WmUDDI. Document type that contains a UUID reference to a business Entity.

pub.uddi.client.doc:hostingRedirector WmUDDI. Document type that is used to designate that a bindingTemplate entry is a pointer to a different bindingTemplate entry.

pub.uddi.client.doc:identifierBag WmUDDI. Document type that is a general-purpose placeholder for any number of distinct identifiers.

pub.uddi.client.doc:instanceDetails WmUDDI. Document type that holds service instance specific information that is required to either understand the service implementation details relative to a specific tModelKey reference, or to provide further parameter and settings support.

pub.uddi.client.doc:instanceParms WmUDDI. Document type that is used to contain settings parameters or a URL reference to a file that contains settings or parameters required to use a specific facet of a bindingTemplate description.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 494

Page 495: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.doc:keyedReference WmUDDI. Document type that designates the relationship type for which the assertion is made, represented by the included tModelKey and described by the included keyName keyValue pair.

pub.uddi.client.doc:keysOwned WmUDDI. Document type that designates those business keys the publisher manages.

pub.uddi.client.doc:overviewDoc WmUDDI. Document type that is used to house references to remote descriptive information or instructions related to proper use of a bindingTemplate technical sub-element.

pub.uddi.client.doc:phone WmUDDI. Document type that is used to hold telephone numbers for the contact.

pub.uddi.client.doc:publisherAssertion WmUDDI. Document type that describes a publisher assertion structure.

pub.uddi.client.doc:publisherAssertions WmUDDI. Document type that returns all assertions made by the publisher who was authenticated in the preceding set_publisherAssertions or the get_publisherAssertions API calls.

pub.uddi.client.doc:registeredInfo WmUDDI. Document type that contains overview information that is suitable for identifying all pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity and tModel data published by the requester.

pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessInfo WmUDDI. Document type that contains information about a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity that relates to the specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity by at least one relationship.

pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessInfos WmUDDI. Document type that contains information about a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity that relates to the specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity by at least one relationship.

pub.uddi.client.doc:relatedBusinessesList WmUDDI. Document type that contains list of related business lists.

pub.uddi.client.doc:result WmUDDI. Document type that defines the result structure.

pub.uddi.client.doc:schema_uddiv2 WmUDDI. Schema created using the webMethods schema generator as part of creating document types. It is created from the XSD document specified by UDDI Version 2.0 UDDI XML Schema 2001.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 495

Page 496: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceDetail WmUDDI. Schema created using the webMethods schema generator as part of creating document types. It is created from the XSD document specified by UDDI Version 2.0 UDDI XML Schema 2001.

pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceInfo WmUDDI. Document type that are abbreviated versions of businessService data, suitable for populating a list of services associated with a business and that match a pattern as specified in the inputs to the find_service API.

pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceInfos WmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of serviceInfo documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceKey WmUDDI. Document type that is a UUID key to identify a service.

pub.uddi.client.doc:serviceList WmUDDI. Document type that contains list of serviceInfo documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:sharedRelationships WmUDDI. Document type that contains the keyed references and direction to it.

pub.uddi.client.doc:SOAPFault WmUDDI. Document type that contains the SOAP Fault structure.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModel WmUDDI. Document type that takes the form of keyed metadata (data about data). In a general sense, the purpose of a tModel within the UDDI registry is to provide a reference system based on abstraction.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelBag WmUDDI. Document type that contains a list of tModelKeys.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelDetail WmUDDI. Document type that contains list of tModel documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInfo WmUDDI. Document type that contains overview data about business and tModel information published by a given publisher.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInfos WmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of tModelInfo documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceDetails WmUDDI. Document type that is a simple accessor container for one or more pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo documents.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo WmUDDI. Document type that is a tModelInstanceInfo structure representing the bindingTemplate instance specific details for a single tModel by reference.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 496

Page 497: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelKey WmUDDI. Document type that contains a tModelKey UUID.

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelList WmUDDI. Document type that contains zero or more tModelInfo structures in response to a find_tModel inquiry message.

pub.uddi.client.doc:toKey WmUDDI. Document type that contains the toKey UUID.

pub.uddi.client.doc:uploadRegister WmUDDI. Document type that contains the uploadRegister string.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_binding WmUDDI. Locates specific bindings within a registered business service.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_business WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses. It then returns a businessList message that matches the conditions specified in the argument.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByCategory WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on category references passed.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByDiscURLs WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on discoveryURLs.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByIdentity WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on business identifier references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessByName WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on names.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_businessBytModel WmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on tModel references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_relatedBusinesses WmUDDI. Locates information about pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity registrations that are related to the specific business entity whose key is passed in the inquiry.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_service WmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByBusKey WmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on business key identifier.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByCategory WmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of category key identifiers.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceByName WmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of service names.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 497

Page 498: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_serviceBytModel WmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of tModel references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModel WmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures matching the set of specific criteria.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByCategory WmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of category references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByIdentity WmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of business identity references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:find_tModelByName WmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of business identity references.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_bindingDetail WmUDDI. Retrieves full binding template information suitable for making one or more service requests.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_businessDetail WmUDDI. Retrieves the full pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information for one or more businesses or organizations.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_businessDetailExt WmUDDI. Retrieves extended pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information for one or more specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity registrations.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_serviceDetail WmUDDI. Retrieves full details for a given set of registered businessService data.

pub.uddi.client.inquiry:get_tModelDetail WmUDDI. Retrieves full details for a given set of registered tModel data.

pub.uddi.client.publish:add_publisherAssertions WmUDDI. Adds relationship assertions to the existing set of assertions.

pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_binding WmUDDI. Deletes one or more instances of bindingTemplate data from the UDDI registry.

pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_business WmUDDI. Removes one or more business registrations (for example, registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data) and all direct contents from a UDDI registry.

pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_publisherAssertions WmUDDI. Removes one or more publisherAssertion elements to be removed from a publisher’s assertion collection.

pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_service WmUDDI. Removes one or more previously businessService elements from the UDDI registry and from its containing pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity parent.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 498

Page 499: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi.client.publish:delete_tModel WmUDDI. Logically deletes one or more tModel structures. Logical deletion hides the deleted tModels from find_tModel result sets, but does not physically delete it.

pub.uddi.client.publish:discard_authToken WmUDDI. Informs an Operator Site that the authentication token is to be discarded, effectively ending the session.

pub.uddi.client.publish:get_assertionstatusReport WmUDDI. Provides administrative support for determining the status of current and outstanding publisher assertions that involve any of the business registrations managed by the individual publisher account.

pub.uddi.client.publish:get_authToken WmUDDI. Obtains an authentication token.

pub.uddi.client.publish:get_publisherAssertions WmUDDI. Obtains the full set of publisher assertions that is associated with an individual publisher account.

pub.uddi.client.publish:get_registeredInfo WmUDDI. Gets an abbreviated list of all pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity and tModel data that are controlled by the individual associated with the credentials passed.

pub.uddi.client.publish:save_binding WmUDDI. Saves or updates a complete bindingTemplate element.

pub.uddi.client.publish:save_business WmUDDI. Saves or updates information about a complete pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity element.

pub.uddi.client.publish:save_service WmUDDI. Adds or updates one or more businessService elements.

pub.uddi.client.publish:save_tModel WmUDDI. Adds or updates one or more registered tModel elements.

pub.uddi.client.publish:set_publisherAssertions WmUDDI. Manages all of the tracked relationship assertions associated with an individual publisher account.

Element Package and Description

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 499

Page 500: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:accessPointWmUDDI. Document type that conveys the entry point address suitable for calling a particular Web service. The accessPoint document type is an attribute-qualified pointer to a service entry point.

Parameters

See Also

pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelpub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_bindingTemplate

*body String Optional. Body of the URL.

@URLType String Type of URL.

A value of... Indicates that...

mailto The entry service point is formatted as an electronic mail address reference, for example, mailto:[email protected].

http The entry service point is formatted as an HTTP-compatible URL, for example, http://www.fabrikam.com/purchasing.

https The entry service point is formatted as a secure HTTP-compatible URL, for example, https://www.fabrikam.com/purchasing.

ftp The entry service point is formatted as a FTP directory address, for example, ftp://ftp.fabrikam.com/public.

fax The entry service point is formatted as a telephone number that will connect to a facsimile machine, for example, 1 425 555 5555.

phone The entry service point is formatted as a telephone number that will connect to voice or tone response based system, for example, 1 425 555 5555.

other The entry service point is formatted as some other address format. When this value is used, one or more of the pub.uddi.client.doc:tModel signatures found in the pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo collection must specify that a particular format or transport type is required.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 500

Page 501: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:addressWmUDDI. Document type that is a simple list of pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine elements within the address container.

Parameters

See Also

pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLinepub.uddi.client.doc:tModel

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:addressLineWmUDDI. Document type that contains the address line information.

addressLine elements contain string data with a line length limit of 80 character positions. Each addressLine element can contain two optional descriptive attributes, keyName and keyValue.

Parameters

@useType String Optional. Description of the type of address, for example, “billing department,” or “main office.”

@sortCode String Optional. Used to drive the behavior of external display mechanisms that sort addresses.

A value of... Indicates...

numeric Numeric ordering (for example, 1, 2, 3).

alphabetic Alphabetic ordering (for example, a, b, c).

first n Ordering of the first n positions of data in the address.

@tModelKey String Optional. Unique key reference that implies that the keyName keyValue pairs given by subsequent pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine elements are to be interpreted by the taxonomy associated with the pub.uddi.client.doc:tModel that is referenced.

addressLine Document type List Optional. List of pub.uddi.client.doc:addressLine documents.

*body String Optional. Body of the address line.

@keyName String Optional. Key name of the address line.

@keyValue String Optional. Key value of the address line.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 501

Page 502: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:assert ionStatusI temWmUDDI. Document type that contains the assertion status information.

It also forms the part of the pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusReport document.

Parameters

See Also

pub.uddi.client.doc:assertionStatusReportpub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntitypub.uddi.client.doc:businessKey

@completionStatus String Assertion completion status.

Value Description

status:complete Returns only the publisher assertions that are complete.

status:toKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the toKey value has not made a matching assertion.

status:fromKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the fromKey value has not made a matching assertion.

tromKey String Unique key reference to the first pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made.

toKey String Unique key reference to the second pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made.

keyedReference Document type The relationship type for which the assertion is made.

keysOwned Document type List of the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessKey elements the publisher manages.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 502

Page 503: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:assert ionStatusReportWmUDDI. Document type that reports all complete and incomplete assertions and serves an administrative use, including determining if there are any outstanding, incomplete assertions about relationships involving businesses with which the publisher account is associated.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:authTokenWmUDDI. Document type that contains a single authInfo element that contains an access token that is to be passed back in all Publisher’s API messages that change data.

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

assertionStatusItem Document type Optional. Assertion status information.

A value of... Indicates...

status:complete Returns only the publisher assertions that are complete.

status:toKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the toKey value has not made a matching assertion.

status:fromKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the fromKey value has not made a matching assertion.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

authInfo String An access token that is to be passed back in all Publisher’s API messages that change data.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 503

Page 504: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:deleteMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyBindingsamples.uddi.client:publishMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyService

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:bindingDetai lWmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more bindingTemplate structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:publishMyBinding

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:bindingKeyWmUDDI. Document type that contains a unique key for a given bindingTemplate.

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

bindingTemplate Document type Optional. Technical service description information related to a given business service family.

bindingKey String Unique key for a given bindingTemplate.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 504

Page 505: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:bindingTemplateWmUDDI. Document type that holds technical service description information related to a given business service family.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_bindingTemplate

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:bindingTemplatesWmUDDI. Document type that contains list of bindingTemplates.

Parameters

@serviceKey String Optional. Unique key for a given service.

@bindingKey String Unique key for a given bindingTemplate.

description Document type Optional repeating element. Zero or more language-qualified text descriptions of the technical service entry point.

accessPoint Document type Text field that is used to convey the entry point address suitable for calling a particular Web service.

hostingRedirector Document type Required element if accessPoint not provided. This element has a bindingKey attribute, giving the redirected reference to a different bindingTemplate.

tModelInstanceDetails Document type List of zero or more tModelInstanceInfo elements. This data, taken in total, should form a distinct fingerprint that can be used to identify compatible services.

bindingTemplate Document type List Technical service description information related to a given business service family.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 505

Page 506: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessDetai lWmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more businessDetail structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:publishMyBusiness

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessDetai lExtWmUDDI. Document type that consists of one or more businessDetailExt structures that are returned according to the data requested in the request message.

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

businessEntity Document type List List of pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity documents.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

BusinessEntityExt Document type List List of businessEntityExt structures.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 506

Page 507: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessEnt i tyWmUDDI. Document type that represents all known information about a business or entity that publishes descriptive information about the entity as well as the services that it offers.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessEnt i tyExtWmUDDI. Document type that contains a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity document.

Parameters

@businessKey String A unique UUID identifier for a specific instance of businessEntity.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@authorizedName String Recorded name of the individual that published the businessEntity data.

discoveryURLs Document type A discoverURLs document.

name Document type List of name documents.

description Document type List of description documents.

contacts Document type A contacts document.

businessServices Document type A businessServices document.

identifierBag Document type An identiferBag document.

categoryBag Document type A categoryBag document.

businessEntity Document type A pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 507

Page 508: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessInfoWmUDDI. Document type that contains company name and optional description data, along with a collection element named serviceInfos that in turn can contain one or more serviceInfo structures.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessInfosWmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of businessInfo documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessKeyWmUDDI. Document type that contains the unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessListWmUDDI. Document type that contains zero or more businessInfos structures.

Parameters

@businessKey String A unique UUID identifier for a specific instance of pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity.

name Document type List List of name documents.

description Document type List List of description documents.

serviceInfos Document type List A serviceInfos document.

businessInfo Document type List List of businessInfo documents.

@businessKey String A unique UUID identifier for a specific instance of pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 508

Page 509: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessServiceWmUDDI. Document type that represents a logical service classification.

The name of the element includes the term “business” in an attempt to describe the purpose of this level in the service description hierarchy.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessService

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:businessServicesWmUDDI. Document type that lists the businessService documents.

Parameters

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

businessInfos Document type list List of businessInfos documents

@businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

@serviceKey String Unique key for a given service.

name Document type List List of name documents.

description Document type List List of description documents.

BindingTemplates Document type List A bindingTemplates document.

categoryBag Document type A categoryBag document.

businessService Document reference List List of businessService document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 509

Page 510: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:categoryBagWmUDDI. Document type that allows pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity, businessService, and tModel structures to be categorized according to any of several available taxonomy based classification schemes.

Operator Sites automatically provide validated categorization support for three taxonomies that cover industry codes (via NAICS), product and service classifications (via UNSPC) and geography (via ISO 3166).

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:contactWmUDDI. Document type that lets you record contact information for a person.

This information can consist of one or more optional elements, along with a person’s name. Contact information exists by containment relationship alone, and no mechanisms for tracking individual contact instances is provided by UDDI specifications.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

keyedReference Document reference List List of keyedReference documents.

@useType String Optional. Description of the type of contact in freeform text, for example, “sales contact,” or “technical services contact.”

description Document type List List of description documents.

personName String Name of the person or name of the job role.

phone Document type List Telephone numbers for the contact. List of phone documents.

email Document type List Email addresses for the contact. List of email documents.

address Document type List Printable lines suitable for addressing an envelope. List of email documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 510

Page 511: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:contactsWmUDDI. Document type that provides a way for information to be registered with a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity record so that someone that finds the information can make human contact for any purpose.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:discoveryURLWmUDDI. Document type that consists of an attribute whose value designates the URL use type convention, and a string, found within the body of the element.

Each time a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure is saved via a call to save_business, the UDDI Operator Site will generate one URL. The generated URL will point to an instance of either a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity or businessEntityExt structure, and the useType attribute of the discoveryURL will be set to either "businessEntity" or "businessEntityExt" according to the data type found while processing the save_business message.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:discoveryURLsWmUDDI. Document type that is used to hold pointers to URL addressable discovery documents.

Parameters

contact Document type List List of contact documents.

*body String Body of the URL.

@useType String Name of the convention that the referenced document follows.

discoveryURL Document type List List of discoveryURL documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 511

Page 512: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:disposi t ionReportWmUDDI. Document type that is used to report status of various publish operations.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:deleteMyBusiness

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:docType_categoryBagWmUDDI. Document type that allows pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity, businessService and tModel structures to be categorized according to any of several available taxonomy based classification schemes.

Operator Sites automatically provide validated categorization support for three taxonomies that cover industry codes (via NAICS), product and service classifications (via UNSPC) and geography (via ISO 3166).

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

Result Document type list List of result documents.

keyedReference Document reference List List of keyedReference documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 512

Page 513: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:docType_descript ionWmUDDI. Document type that contains the description with language resource information.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:docType_keyedReferenceWmUDDI. Document type that designates the relationship type for which the assertion is made, represented by the included tModelKey and described by the included keyName keyValue pair.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:docType_nameWmUDDI. Document type that describes a name.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:emai lWmUDDI. Document type that describes the e-mail information.

Parameters

*body String Body of the description.

@xml:lang String Language type of the description.

@tModelKey String Unique key reference to tModel.

@keyName String Key name.

@keyValue String Key value.

*body String Name.

@xml:lang String Language type of the description.

*body String E-mail information.

@useType String Description of the e-mail information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 513

Page 514: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:err InfoWmUDDI. Document type that describes the error information.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:f indQual i f ierWmUDDI. Document type that provides a means to allow the caller to override default search behaviors.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:f indQual i f iersWmUDDI. Document type that contains a list of find qualifiers.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:fromKeyWmUDDI. Document type that contains a UUID reference to a business Entity.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:host ingRedirectorWmUDDI. Document type that is used to designate that a bindingTemplate entry is a pointer to a different bindingTemplate entry.

Parameters

*body String Error string.

@errCode String Error code.

findQualifier String Qualifier from a list of qualifiers.

findQualifier String List List of find qualifiers.

fromKey String A UUID reference to a business Entity.

@bindingKey String Binding key.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 514

Page 515: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc: ident i f ierBagWmUDDI. Document type that is a general-purpose placeholder for any number of distinct identifiers.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc: instanceDetai lsWmUDDI. Document type that holds service instance specific information that is required to either understand the service implementation details relative to a specific tModelKey reference, or to provide further parameter and settings support.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc: instanceParmsWmUDDI. Document type that is used to contain settings parameters or a URL reference to a file that contains settings or parameters required to use a specific facet of a bindingTemplate description.

Parameters

keyedReference Document reference List List of keyedReference documents.

description Document reference List Language-qualified text element that describes of the purpose and/or use of the particular instanceDetails entry. List of doctype_description documents.

overviewDoc Document type References to remote descriptive information or instructions related to proper use of a bindingTemplate technical sub-element. Contains a overviewDoc document.

instanceParms String Settings parameters or a URL reference to a file that contains settings or parameters required to use a specific facet of a bindingTemplate description.

instanceParms String Setting parameters or URL reference to a file that contains these settings.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 515

Page 516: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:keyedReferenceWmUDDI. Document type that designates the relationship type for which the assertion is made, represented by the included tModelKey and described by the included keyName keyValue pair.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:keysOwnedWmUDDI. Document type that designates those business keys the publisher manages.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:overviewDocWmUDDI. Document type that is used to house references to remote descriptive information or instructions related to proper use of a bindingTemplate technical sub-element.

Parameters

@tModelKey String Unique key reference to tModel.

@keyName String Key name.

@keyValue String Key value.

FromKey String Unique key reference to the first pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made.

toKey String Unique key reference to the second pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made.

description Document type Language-qualified string containing a short descriptive overview of how a particular tModel is to be used.

overviewURL String URL reference to a long form of an overview document that covers the way a particular tModel specific reference is used as a component of an overall web service description.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 516

Page 517: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:phoneWmUDDI. Document type that is used to hold telephone numbers for the contact.

This element can contain an optional useType attribute for descriptive purposes.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_businessEntity

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:publ isherAssert ionWmUDDI. Document type that describes a publisher assertion structure.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:publ isherAssert ionsWmUDDI. Document type that returns all assertions made by the publisher who was authenticated in the preceding set_publisherAssertions or the get_publisherAssertions API calls.

Parameters

*body String Telephone number.

@useType String More description of body.

FromKey String Unique key reference to the first pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made.

toKey String Unique key reference to the second pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made

KeyedReference Document type Relationship type for which the assertion is made.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@authorizedName String Recorded name of the individual that published the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data.

publisherAssertion Document type List of PublisherAssertion document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 517

Page 518: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:registeredInfoWmUDDI. Document type that contains overview information that is suitable for identifying all pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity and tModel data published by the requester.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:relatedBusinessInfoWmUDDI. Document type that contains information about a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity that relates to the specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity by at least one relationship.

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

businessInfos Document type A businessInfos document.

tModelInfos Document type A tModelInfos document.

@businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

name Document type List List of name documents.

description Document type List List of description documents.

sharedRelationships Document type A sharedRelationships document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 518

Page 519: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:relatedBusinessInfosWmUDDI. Document type that contains information about a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity that relates to the specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity by at least one relationship.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:relatedBusinessesListWmUDDI. Document type that contains list of related business lists.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:resul tWmUDDI. Document type that defines the result structure.

Parameters

@businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

name Document type List List of name documents.

description Document type List List of description documents.

sharedRelationships Document type A sharedRelationships document.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

@businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

relatedbusinessInfos Document type List of relatedbusinessInfos documents.

@keyType String Key type.

@errno String The error identifier

errInfo Document type The errInfo document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 519

Page 520: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:schema_uddiv2WmUDDI. Schema created using the webMethods schema generator as part of creating document types. It is created from the XSD document specified by UDDI Version 2.0 UDDI XML Schema 2001.

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:serviceDetai lWmUDDI. Document type that contains complete descriptive and technical details about registered services.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:findAllServicesOfBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyService

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:serviceInfoWmUDDI. Document type that are abbreviated versions of businessService data, suitable for populating a list of services associated with a business and that match a pattern as specified in the inputs to the find_service API.

Parameters

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

businessService Document type List of businessService documents.

@serviceKey String Unique key for a given service.

businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

name Document type List List of name documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 520

Page 521: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:serviceInfosWmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of serviceInfo documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:serviceKeyWmUDDI. Document type that is a UUID key to identify a service.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:serviceListWmUDDI. Document type that contains list of serviceInfo documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:sharedRelat ionshipsWmUDDI. Document type that contains the keyed references and direction to it.

Parameters

serviceInfo Document type List List of serviceInfo documents.

@serviceKey String Unique key for a given service.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

serviceInfo Document type List List of serviceInfo documents.

@direction String Direction to keyedReference document.

keyedReference Document reference List List of keyedReference documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 521

Page 522: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:SOAPFaultWmUDDI. Document type that contains the SOAP Fault structure.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModelWmUDDI. Document type that takes the form of keyed metadata (data about data). In a general sense, the purpose of a tModel within the UDDI registry is to provide a reference system based on abstraction.

The information that makes up a tModel is quite simple. There’s a key, a name, an optional description, and then a URL that points to a location to go to find out more about the actual concept represented by the metadata in the tModel itself.

Parameters

faultcode String Optional. SOAP Fault code.

faultstring String Optional. SOAP Fault string.

faultactor String Optional. SOAP Fault actor.

detail Document type Optional. Details of the fault. The detail structure contains the pub.uddi.client.doc:dispositionReport document.

tModelKey String Unique key for a given tModel structure.

@operator String Certified name of the UDDI registry site operator that manages the master copy of the tModel data.

@authorizedName String Recorded name of the individual that published the tModel data.

Name Document type List Name recorded for the tModel. Name search is provided via find_tModel call.

description Document type List One or more short language-qualified descriptions.

overviewDoc Document type List References to remote descriptive information or instructions related to the tModel.

identifierBag Document type List Optional. List of name-value pairs that can be used to record identification numbers for a tModel.

categoryBag Document type List Optional. List of name-value pairs that are used to tag a tModel with specific taxonomy information.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 522

Page 523: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModelBagWmUDDI. Document type that contains a list of tModelKeys.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModelDetai lWmUDDI. Document type that contains list of tModel documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModel InfoWmUDDI. Document type that contains overview data about business and tModel information published by a given publisher.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_bindingTemplate

tModelKey String List List unique key for a given tModel structure.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

tModel Document type List List of tModel documents. The structure of this document is defined in pub.uddi.client.doc:tModel.

tModelKey String Unique key for a given tModel structure. The structure of this document is defined in pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelKey.

name Document type List Name recorded for the tModel. Name search is provided via find_tModel call.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 523

Page 524: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModel InfosWmUDDI. Document type that consists of list of tModelInfo documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModel InstanceDetai lsWmUDDI. Document type that is a simple accessor container for one or more pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelInstanceInfo documents.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModel InstanceInfoWmUDDI. Document type that is a tModelInstanceInfo structure representing the bindingTemplate instance specific details for a single tModel by reference.

Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:create_bindingTemplate

tModelInfo Document type List List of tModelInfo documents.

tModelInstanceInfo Document type List List of tModelInstanceInfo documents.

@tmodelKey String Unique key for a given tModel structure.

description Document type List List of description documents. This is one or more language-qualified text descriptions that designate what role a tModel reference plays in the overall service description.

instanceDetails Document type List An instanceDetail document. This element can be used when tModel reference specific settings or other descriptive information are required to either describe a tModel specific component of a service description or support services that require additional technical data support (for example, via settings or other handshake operations)

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 524

Page 525: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModelKeyWmUDDI. Document type that contains a tModelKey UUID.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:tModelListWmUDDI. Document type that contains zero or more tModelInfo structures in response to a find_tModel inquiry message.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:toKeyWmUDDI. Document type that contains the toKey UUID.

Parameters

pub.uddi .cl ient .doc:uploadRegisterWmUDDI. Document type that contains the uploadRegister string.

Parameters

@tmodelKey String Unique key for a given tModel structure.

@generic String General information, such as version.

@operator String UDDI operator information.

@truncated String A flag that indicates whether or not to truncate the returned messages.

A value of... Indicates that...

true The results are truncated to the value specified in maxrows.

false The results are not truncated.

tModelInfos Document type List List of tModelInfo documents.

toKey String Unique key reference to the second pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity for which the assertion is made

uploadRegister String The uploadRegister key.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 525

Page 526: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_bindingWmUDDI. Locates specific bindings within a registered business service.

It then returns a bindingDetail message containing zero or more bindingTemplate structure matching the criteria specified in the argument list. Only the bindings specified by serviceKey will be searched.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

serviceKey String A UUID key to specify a particular instance of a businessService element.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

tModelBag Document type List of tModel UUID keys that represent the technical fingerprint of a bindingTemplate.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

document Document type The returned businessDetail object that contains the binding template information.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 526

Page 527: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_businessWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses. It then returns a businessList message that matches the conditions specified in the argument.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters-

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessNameList String List Optional. List of names of business to search.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

tModelBag Document type Optional. List of tModel UUID keys that represent the technical fingerprint of a bindingTemplate.

identifierBag Document type Optional. List of business identifier references.

categoryBag Document type Optional. List a list of category references.

discoveryURLs Document type Optional. List of URLs to be matched against the discoveryURL data associated with any registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

document Document type The returned businessList object that contains the business, and summaries of the businessServices.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 527

Page 528: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:f ind_businessByCategoryWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on category references passed.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

Marrows String Optional. A limit to the number of results returned.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

categoryBag Document type A list of category references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

document Document type The returned businessList object that contains the business, and summaries of the businessServices.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 528

Page 529: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:f ind_businessByDiscURLsWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on discoveryURLs.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

discoveryURLs Document type Optional. List of URLs to be matched against the discoveryURL data associated with any registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessDetail object that contains the binding template information.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 529

Page 530: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:f ind_businessByIdent i tyWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on business identifier references.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

identifierBag Document type Optional. List of business identifier references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessList object that contains the business, and summaries of the businessServices.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 530

Page 531: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:f ind_businessByNameWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on names.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:findAllServicesOfBusiness

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

businessNameList String List Optional. List of names of business to search.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessList object that contains the business, and summaries of the businessServices.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 531

Page 532: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_businessBytModelWmUDDI. Locates one or more businesses based on tModel references.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

Marrows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

tModelBag Document type List of tModel UUID keys that represent the technical fingerprint of a bindingTemplate.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessList object that contains the business, and summaries of the businessServices.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 532

Page 533: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_relatedBusinessesWmUDDI. Locates information about pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity registrations that are related to the specific business entity whose key is passed in the inquiry.

The service returns a relatedBusinessList document type.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

keyedReference Document type Optional. Used to specify that only businesses that related to the focal point in a specific way should be included in the results.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned relatedBusinessList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 533

Page 534: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_serviceWmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity.

The service returns a serviceList message that matches the conditions specified in the arguments.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

tModelBag Document type List of tModel UUID keys that represent the technical fingerprint of a bindingTemplate to find.

categoryBag Document type List of category references.

ServiceNameList String List Optional. List of names of services to be searched.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 534

Page 535: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_serviceByBusKeyWmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on business key identifier.

The service returns a serviceList message that matches the conditions specified in the arguments.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessKey String Unique identifier for a given instance of a pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structure.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 535

Page 536: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_serviceByCategoryWmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of category key identifiers.

The service returns a serviceList message that matches the conditions specified in the arguments.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

categoryBag Document type List of category references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 536

Page 537: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_serviceByNameWmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of service names.

The service returns a serviceList message that matches the conditions specified in the arguments.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

Document Document type Stores the serviceList object.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

ServiceNameList String List List of names of services to be searched.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 537

Page 538: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_serviceBytModelWmUDDI. Locates specific services within a registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity based on list of tModel references.

The service returns a serviceList message that matches the conditions specified in the arguments.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

tModelBag Document type [pub.uddi.client.doc:tModelBag]List of tModel UUID keys that represent the technical fingerprint of a bindingTemplate.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 538

Page 539: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_tModelWmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures matching the set of specific criteria.

The response is returned in the tModelList message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

tModelName String Optional. tModel name.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

identifierBag Document type Optional. List of business identifier references.

categoryBag Document type Optional. List of category references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 539

Page 540: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_tModelByCategoryWmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of category references.

The found tModel information is returned in the tModelList message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

categoryBag Document type List of category references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 540

Page 541: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_tModelByIdent i tyWmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of business identity references.

The found tModel information is returned in the tModelList message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

identifierBag Document type Optional. List of business identifier references.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 541

Page 542: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry: f ind_tModelByNameWmUDDI. Locates one or more tModel information structures based on list of business identity references.

The found tModel information is returned in the tModelList message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

tModelName String Optional. tModel name.

maxRows String Optional. Maximum number of results returned in response to a service call.

findQualifiers String List Optional. FindQualifier elements to alter the default behavior of search functionality. Details about findQualifier is available in Appendix E of the UDDI specification.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelList object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 542

Page 543: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:get_bindingDetai lWmUDDI. Retrieves full binding template information suitable for making one or more service requests.

The information is returned in bindingDetail message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

bindingKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent the UDDI assigned keys for specific instances of registered bindingTemplate data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned bindingDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 543

Page 544: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:get_businessDetai lWmUDDI. Retrieves the full pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information for one or more businesses or organizations.

The information is returned in the businessDetail document type.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent UDDI assigned businessKey values for specific instances of known pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 544

Page 545: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:get_businessDetai lExtWmUDDI. Retrieves extended pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity information for one or more specified pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity registrations.

This message returns exactly the same information as the get_businessDetail document, but may contain additional attributes if the source is an external registry (for example, not an Operator Site) that is compatible with this API specification.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

businessKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent UDDI assigned businessKey values for specific instances of known pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 545

Page 546: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:get_serviceDetai lWmUDDI. Retrieves full details for a given set of registered businessService data.

The data is returned in serviceDetail document.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:findAllServicesOfBusiness

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

serviceKeyList String List The UUID key values that represent UDDI assigned serviceKey values of specific instances of known businessService data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 546

Page 547: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient . inquiry:get_tModelDetai lWmUDDI. Retrieves full details for a given set of registered tModel data.

The service returns a tModelDetail message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

inquiryURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

tModelKeyList String List One or more URN qualified uuid_key values that represent UDDI assigned tModelKey values of specific instances of known tModel data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 547

Page 548: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:add_publ isherAssert ionsWmUDDI. Adds relationship assertions to the existing set of assertions.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

publisherAssertionList Document type One or more relationship assertions.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 548

Page 549: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:delete_bindingWmUDDI. Deletes one or more instances of bindingTemplate data from the UDDI registry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

bindingKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent specific instances of known bindingTemplate data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 549

Page 550: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:delete_businessWmUDDI. Removes one or more business registrations (for example, registered pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data) and all direct contents from a UDDI registry.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:deleteMyBusiness

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

businessKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent specific instances of known pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 550

Page 551: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:delete_publ isherAssert ionsWmUDDI. Removes one or more publisherAssertion elements to be removed from a publisher’s assertion collection.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

publisherAssertionList Document type One or more relationship assertion structures exactly matching an existing assertion that can be found in the publisher’s assertion.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 551

Page 552: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:delete_serviceWmUDDI. Removes one or more previously businessService elements from the UDDI registry and from its containing pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity parent.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

serviceKeyList String List One or more UUID key values that represent specific instances of known businessService data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 552

Page 553: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:delete_tModelWmUDDI. Logically deletes one or more tModel structures. Logical deletion hides the deleted tModels from find_tModel result sets, but does not physically delete it.

Deleting an already deleted tModel has no effect.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

TmodelKeyList String List One or more URN qualified UUID key values that represent UDDI assigned tModelKey values of specific instances of known tModel data.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 553

Page 554: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:discard_authTokenWmUDDI. Informs an Operator Site that the authentication token is to be discarded, effectively ending the session.

Subsequent calls that use the same authToken will be rejected. This message is optional for Operator Sites that do not manage session state or that do not support the get_authToken message.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:deleteMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyBindingsamples.uddi.client:publishMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyService

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned dispositionReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this API call.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 554

Page 555: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:get_assert ionstatusReportWmUDDI. Provides administrative support for determining the status of current and outstanding publisher assertions that involve any of the business registrations managed by the individual publisher account.

Using this message, a publisher can see the status of assertions that they have made, as well as see assertions that others have made that involve pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity structures controlled by the calling publisher account.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

completionstatus String Optional. One of the following values:

Value Description

status:complete Returns only the publisher assertions that are complete.

status:toKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the toKey value has not made a matching assertion.

status:fromKey_incomplete Returns only those publisher assertions where the party that controls the pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity referenced by the fromKey value has not made a matching assertion.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned assertionstatusReport object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 555

Page 556: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:get_authTokenWmUDDI. Obtains an authentication token.

Authentication tokens are opaque values that are required for all other publisher API calls. This API is provided for implementations that do not have some other method of obtaining an authentication token or certificate, or that choose to use user ID and password based authentication.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

uddiUserID String User ID that the individual authorized user was assigned by an Operator Site.

uddiPassword String The password or credential that is associated with the user ID.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned authToken object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this API call.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 556

Page 557: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:deleteMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyBindingsamples.uddi.client:publishMyBusinesssamples.uddi.client:publishMyService

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:get_publ isherAssert ionsWmUDDI. Obtains the full set of publisher assertions that is associated with an individual publisher account.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned publisherAssertions object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 557

Page 558: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:get_registeredInfoWmUDDI. Gets an abbreviated list of all pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity and tModel data that are controlled by the individual associated with the credentials passed.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned registeredInfo object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 558

Page 559: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:save_bindingWmUDDI. Saves or updates a complete bindingTemplate element.

This message can be used to add or update one or more bindingTemplate elements as well as the container/contained relationship that each bindingTemplate has with one or more existing businessService elements.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:publishMyBinding

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

bindingTemplateList Document type One or more complete bindingTemplate elements.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned bindingDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 559

Page 560: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:save_businessWmUDDI. Saves or updates information about a complete pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity element.

The pub.uddi.client.publish:save_business service has the broadest scope of all of the save_xx services, and can be used to make sweeping changes to the published information for one or more pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity elements.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:publishMyBusiness

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

businessEntityList Document type One or more complete pub.uddi.client.doc:businessEntity elements.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned businessDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 560

Page 561: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:save_serviceWmUDDI. Adds or updates one or more businessService elements.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Examples

See the following in the Samples folder in the WmUDDI package:

samples.uddi.client:publishMyService

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

businessServiceList Document type One or more complete businessService elements can be passed.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned serviceDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 561

Page 562: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:save_tModelWmUDDI. Adds or updates one or more registered tModel elements.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

tModelList Document type One or more complete tModel elements can be passed.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the UDDI server.

Document Document type The returned tModelDetail object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 562

Page 563: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

pub.uddi .cl ient .publ ish:set_publ isherAssert ionsWmUDDI. Manages all of the tracked relationship assertions associated with an individual publisher account.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

publishURL String URL indicating the path of the UDDI server.

authInfo String Authentication token.

PublisherAssertionList Document type Optional. Zero or more relationship assertions.

rawXMLResponse String Raw XML response from the Usamples.uddi.client.DDI server.

Document Document type The returned publisherAssertions object.

SOAPFault Document type SOAP Fault information.

status String Status of this service.

A value of... Indicates that...

0 The service completed successfully.

1 The service terminated on a SOAP fault from the UDDI server.

2 The service did not complete due to an HTTP connection error, for example, HTTP 404.

-1 The service did not complete due to another error condition, for example, ServiceException.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 563

Page 564: Integration Server Bis Reference

35. UDDI Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 564

Page 565: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 36. UniversalName Folder

You use the elements in the universalName folder to list the contents of the Universal Registry and to look up services by their universal names.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 565

Page 566: Integration Server Bis Reference

36. UniversalName Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.universalName:f indWmPublic. Returns the fully qualified service name for an explicit universal name.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.universalName: l istWmPublic. Returns the contents of the current universal-name registry.

Input Parameters

None.

Element Package and Description

pub.universalName:find WmPublic. Returns the fully qualified service name for an explicit universal name.

pub.universalName:list WmPublic. Returns the contents of the current universal-name registry.

namespaceName String Namespace portion of the universal name.

localName String Local portion of the universal name.

svcName String Conditional. Fully qualified name of the service associated with the universal name in namespaceName and localName. If the specified universal name is not in the registry, svcName will be null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 566

Page 567: Integration Server Bis Reference

36. UniversalName Folder

Output Parameters

names Document List Entries in the universal name registry. Each document (IData object) in the list represents an entry in the universal-name registry. (There is one entry for every explicit universal name that has been defined on the server. Implicit universal names are not maintained in the registry.)

Each document in the list contains the following information:

Key Description

universalName Document The universal name associated with the entry. This document contains the following information:

Key Description

namespaceName String Namespace portion of the universal name.

localName String Local portion of the universal name.

svcName String Fully qualified webMethods service name associated with the entry (for example, gl.post:postEntry).

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 567

Page 568: Integration Server Bis Reference

36. UniversalName Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 568

Page 569: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 37. VCS Folder

You use the elements in the VCS folder to manage user associations for the VCS Integration feature.

Note: For more information about the VCS Integration feature, see the webMethods Version Control System Integration Developer’s Guide located in the ..\webMethods6\Developer\doc\guides directory of your webMethods installation.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 569

Page 570: Integration Server Bis Reference

37. VCS Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.vcs:getUsersWmVCS. Returns a list of the Developer user accounts that are associated with a corresponding version control system (VCS) user account on the VCS server.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

This service is available only to administrator users.

Element Package and Description

pub.vcs:getUsers WmVCS. Returns a list of the Developer user accounts that are associated with a corresponding version control system (VCS) user account on the VCS server.

pub.vcs:removeCurrentUser WmVCS. Removes the currently logged in Developer user account from the list of users associated with a version control system (VCS) user account on the VCS server.

pub.vcs:removeMultipleUsers WmVCS. Removes the specified Developer user accounts from the list of users associated with a version control system (VCS) user account.

pub.vcs:setCurrentUser WmVCS. Associates a version control system (VCS) user account with the currently logged in Developer user account. For information about restrictions on account association, see the Usage Notes.

pub.vcs:setMultipleUsers WmVCS. Associates a version control system (VCS) user account with the specified Developer user accounts. For information about restrictions on account association, see the Usage Notes.

users Document List List of Developer user accounts with associations to a VCS user account on the VCS server.

Key Description

devName String The name of the Developer user account.

vcsName String The name of the VCS user account associated with the devName account.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 570

Page 571: Integration Server Bis Reference

37. VCS Folder

pub.vcs:removeCurrentUserWmVCS. Removes the currently logged in Developer user account from the list of users associated with a version control system (VCS) user account on the VCS server.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available to all users. After running this service, the currently logged in Developer user account is no longer associated with a VCS user account. Nominally, this prevents the Developer user from checking elements in to and out of the VCS repository. However, on Windows operating systems, VCS actions will still be submitted by the VCS client with the user’s current Windows user name. If the credentials of the Windows user account match the credentials of a VCS account on the VCS server, the VCS actions will be completed successfully.

The user is advised to check in all checked out elements before running this service. The VCS Integration feature will not permit an element to be checked in by other than the user who checked it out. This service has no effect on the VCS user account.

pub.vcs:removeMult ip leUsersWmVCS. Removes the specified Developer user accounts from the list of users associated with a version control system (VCS) user account.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available only to administrator users. The user account name is case-sensitive. After running this service, the Developer user accounts specified in the input parameters are no longer associated with a VCS user account. Nominally, this prevents the specified Developer users from checking elements in to and out of the VCS repository. However, on Windows operating systems, VCS actions will still be submitted by the VCS client with the user’s current Windows user name. If the credentials of the Windows user account match the credentials of a VCS account on the VCS server, the VCS actions will be completed successfully.

devNames String List The names of the Developer user accounts.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 571

Page 572: Integration Server Bis Reference

37. VCS Folder

Administrators are advised to verify that all elements checked out by the specified Developer users are checked in before running this service. The VCS Integration feature will not permit an element to be checked in by other than the user who checked it out. This service has no effect on the VCS user account.

pub.vcs:setCurrentUserWmVCS. Associates a version control system (VCS) user account with the currently logged in Developer user account. For information about restrictions on account association, see the Usage Notes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available to all users. A Developer user name does not have to be the same as the associated VCS server user name, and all user account credentials are case-sensitive. Each Developer user can have one VCS user account associated with the Developer user account. Although it is possible for more than one Developer user to be associated with the same VCS user account, webMethods recommends that you avoid this configuration as it may result in errors or unpredictable results.

After running this service, the currently logged in Developer user account is associated with a user account on the VCS server, enabling the Developer user to check elements in to and out of the VCS repository (with proper ACL permissions). This association is maintained until it is removed with the pub.vcs:removeCurrentUser or pub.vcs:removeMultipleUsers services. This service does not validate, create, or modify VCS server accounts.

vcsName String The name of an existing VCS user account on the VCS server.

vcsPassword String The password of the VCS user account specified in vcsName.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 572

Page 573: Integration Server Bis Reference

37. VCS Folder

pub.vcs:setMult ip leUsersWmVCS. Associates a version control system (VCS) user account with the specified Developer user accounts. For information about restrictions on account association, see the Usage Notes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

Usage Notes

This service is available only to administrator users. A Developer user name does not have to be the same as the associated VCS server user name, and the user account name is case-sensitive. Each Developer user can have one VCS user account associated with the Developer user account. Although it is possible for more than one Developer user to be associated with the same VCS user account, webMethods recommends that you avoid this configuration as it may result in errors or unpredictable results.

After running this service, the Developer user accounts specified in the input parameters are associated with a corresponding user account on the VCS server, enabling the Developer users to check elements in to and out of the VCS repository (with proper ACL permissions). This association is maintained until it is removed with the pub.vcs:removeCurrentUser or pub.vcs:removeMultipleUsers services. This service does not validate, create, or modify VCS server accounts.

devNames Document List Information required to associate each Developer user account with a VCS user account on the VCS server:

Key Description

devName String The name of the Developer user account.

vcsName String The name of an existing VCS user account on the VCS server.

vcsPassword String The password of the VCS user account specified in vcsName.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 573

Page 574: Integration Server Bis Reference

37. VCS Folder

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 574

Page 575: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 38. Ut i ls Folder

You use the elements in the utils folder to retrieve the values of server properties.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 575

Page 576: Integration Server Bis Reference

38. Utils Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

pub.ut i ls:getServerPropertyWmUtils. Retrieves the value of a specified server property.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.utils:getServerProperty WmUtils. Retrieves the value of a specified server property.

propertyName String The name of the server property whose value you want to retrieve (for example, watt.server.SOAP.directive).

defaultValue String Optional. The default value to return if the server property specified in propertyName does not exist. If the server property does exist, getServerProperty ignores this value.

propertyValue String The value of the requested server property. If the property does not exist, and you did not set a defaultValue, getServerProperty returns null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 576

Page 577: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 39. Web Folder

You use the elements in the web folder to perform operations on XML and HTML documents.

Important! The services in this folder have been deprecated. To operate on XML and HTML documents, use the services in the xml folder.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 577

Page 578: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.web:createRegions WmPublic. Deprecated—Defines regions, which are named portions of an HTML or XML document between two delimiting nodes.

pub.web:documentToRecord WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:xmlNodeToDocument. Converts an XML node to an IData object.

pub.web:freeDocument WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:freeXMLNode. Frees the resources allocated for a given XML node.

pub.web:getDocumentType WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getXMLNodeType. Returns information about an XML node.

pub.web:getNextNode WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getNextXMLNode. Gets the next node from a NodeIterator.

pub.web:getNodeIterator WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator. Creates and returns a NodeIterator.

pub.web:loadDocument WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:loadXMLNode. Retrieves an XML or HTML document via HTTP or HTTPS, parses it, and returns an XML node.

pub.web:makeArrays WmPublic. Deprecated—Produces a list of the repeating elements in an XML document based on the document’s DTD.

pub.web:queryDocument WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:queryXMLNode. Queries an XML node.

pub.web:recordToDocument WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:documentToXMLString. Converts a document (IData object) to an XML String.

pub.web:stringToDocument WmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode. Converts an XML document (represented as a String, byte[ ], or InputStream) to an XML node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 578

Page 579: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:createRegionsWmPublic. Deprecated—Defines regions, which are named portions of an HTML or XML document between two delimiting nodes.

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node from which you want to create regions.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes used in regions/start/query and regions/end/query. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

regions Document List Region definitions. A region is a portion of an HTML or XML document between two delimiting nodes, possibly including either or both delimiting nodes. Each document in regions describes a single region as follows:

Key Description

name String Name to assign to the resulting region.

structured String Optional. Not used. Reserved for future use.

start Document Optional. Parameters that define the starting node of the region. When start is not specified, the region starts with the first node and includes the first node. Specify start as follows:

Key Description

queryType String Query language in which the query for the starting node is expressed. Valid values are WQL and XQL.

query String Query identifying the starting node. If the identified node cannot be found, the region is not produced.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 579

Page 580: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

Values retrieved by the regions input specifications. There will be one output parameter for each region, which will go directly into the IData object passed to the service (usually the IData object representing the pipeline).

include String Flag indicating whether to include the starting node in the region.

Set to... To...

true Include the starting node in the region.

false Exclude the starting node from the region.

end Document Optional. Parameters that define the ending node of the region. When end is not specified, the region ends with the last node and includes the last node. Specify end as follows:

Key Description

queryType String Query language in which the query for the ending node is expressed. Valid values are WQL and XQL.

query String Query identifying the ending node. If the identified node cannot be found, the region cannot be found.

include String Flag indicating whether to include the ending node in the region.

Set to... To...

true Include the ending node in the region.

false Exclude the ending node from the region.

Key Description

pattern String Not implemented.

nullok String Optional. Flags that indicates whether the service should fail if the resulting region is null.

Set to... To...

true Default. Signal failure when region is null.

false Signal success even if region is null.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 580

Page 581: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:documentToRecordWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:xmlNodeToDocument. Converts an XML node to an IData object.

This service transforms each element and attribute in the XML node (a parsable representation of an XML document) to an element in an IData object. For example:

Note that:

The XML version attribute is converted to an element named @version.

The resulting IData is given the same name as the XML document’s root element (AcctInfo in the example above) and is a child of the boundNode IData that this service returns.

Simple elements (such as <name> and <rep> in the example above) are converted to String elements within the parent IData.

Complex elements (that is, elements with children, such as <address> in the example above) and simple elements that have attributes (such as <acctNum> and <phoneNum>) are converted to IData objects within the parent IData. Note that keys derived from attributes are prefixed with a ‘@’ character to distinguish them from keys derived from elements. Also note that when a simple element has an attribute, its value is placed in an element named *body.

This service would convert this XML document... To an IData that looks like this...

<?xml version="1.0" ?><AcctInfo> <name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name> <rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> <acctNum type=platinum>G97041A</acctNum> <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum> <address county=USA> <street1>10211 Brook Road</street1> <city>Cleveland</city> <state>OH</state> <postalCode>22130</postalCode> </address> <serialNum>19970523A</serialNum> <serialNum>20001106G</serialNum> <serialNum>20010404K</serialNum></AcctInfo>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 581

Page 582: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Repeated elements (such as <serialNum>) can be collected into arrays using the makeArrays and/or arrays parameters. See makeArrays and arrays below for additional information about producing arrays from the source document.

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node that is to be converted to a document.

attrPrefix String Optional. Prefix to be used to designate keys containing attribute values. The default is “@”.

For example, if you set attrPrefix to ATT_ and node contained the following element:<tx currency=dollars> <acct>cash</acct> <amt>120.00</amt></tx>

documentToRecord would convert the currency attribute as follows:

arrays String List Optional. Names of elements that are to be generated as arrays, regardless of whether they appear multiple times in node. For example, if arrays contains the following values for the XML document shown in Description above:

repaddress

documentToRecord would generate element rep as a String list and element address as a document list. You may optionally include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify in arrays; however, if you do, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

makeArrays String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want documentToRecord to automatically create an array for every element that appears in node more than once.

Set to... To...

true Default. Automatically create arrays for every element that appears more than once in node.

false Create arrays for only those elements specified in arrays or defined as arrays in the document type specified in recordName.

Important! You must set makeArrays to false when using recordName to define the structure of an element. Otherwise, an exception will be thrown at run time.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 582

Page 583: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

collect Document Optional. Elements that are to be placed into a new, named array (that is, a “collection”). Within collect, set the key names to specify the names of those elements that are to be included in the collection. Set the value of each key to the name of the collection in which you want that element placed. For example, if you wanted to place <name> and <rep> in an array called originator, you would set collect as follows:

Key Value

name originator

rep originator

If the set of elements placed in a collection are all simple elements, a String List (a String[ ]) will be produced. If the set is made up of complex elements, or a combination of simple and complex elements, a Document List (an IData[ ]) will be produced. In this case, each member of the array will include a child element called *name that contains the name of the element from which that member was derived.

You may optionally include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify in collect; however, if you do, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

Important! You cannot include an element in more than one collection.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespace prefixes to use for the conversion. This parameter specifies the prefixes that will be used when namespace-qualified elements are converted to key names in the resulting IData object. For example, if you want elements belonging to a particular namespace to have the prefix GSX in the resulting IData (for example, GSX:acctNum), you would associate the prefix GSX with that namespace in nsDecls. (This is important because incoming XML documents can use any prefix for a given namespace, but the key names expected by a target service or MAP step on the Integration Server will have a fixed prefix.)

Namespace prefixes in nsDecls also define the prefixes used by the arrays, records, recordName, and collect parameters.

Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 583

Page 584: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

records String List Optional. Names of any simple elements that are to be generated as documents (IData objects) instead of Strings. The document produced for each element specified in records will have the same name as the source element from which it was derived and will contain a String element named *body that holds the element’s value.

For example, if records contained the Strings name and rep and the source document contained the following:

. . .<name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name><rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> . . .

documentToRecord would produce the following:

recordName String Optional. Fully qualified name of a document type that defines the structure that is to be imposed on the elements in the resulting document (IData object). You can use this parameter to explicitly specify the order and dimensionality of elements. It is an alternative to using makeArrays and arrays to specify which elements are to be generated as arrays.

For example, if you had the XML document shown in the description of this service, and you wanted the <name> and <rep> elements to be generated as String Lists, you would define them as such in a document type and then specify that document type in recordName.

Note: recordName does not need to specify every element that will appear in the resulting document. It only needs to specify those elements whose structure you want to explicitly set.

Important! When you use recordName, set makeArrays to false and do not set arrays or records. Otherwise, documentToRecord will throw an exception at run time.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 584

Page 585: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Following are examples of XML documents and the documents (IData objects) that documentToRecord would produce.

mixedModel String Optional. Flag specifying how mixed-content elements (elements containing both text values and child elements) are to be converted.

The following is an example of a mixed-content element:<comment> This job is <status>pending</status>. Estimated completion date is <edc>Feb 14, 2000</edc>.</comment>

Set to... To...

true Place text in an element named *body. This setting would produce the following document for the <comment> element shown above:

Important! When you set mixedModel to true, you must also use recordName to specify a document type that describes the structure of the document that you want documentToRecord to produce. Within the document type, mixed-content elements must be defined as documents that include a String field named *body.

false Omit top-level text and include only the child elements from mixed-content elements. This setting would produce the following document for the <comment> element shown above:

document Document Document (IData object) representation of the nodes and attributes in node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 585

Page 586: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

XML Document Output generated by documentToRecord

<myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue">e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1>e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 586

Page 587: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue2">e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

Note: This example assumes that makeArrays is set to true. Note that an array e1 was created, which holds both <e1> elements that were in the source document.

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue2">e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

Note: This example assumes that makeArrays is set to false. Note that only the last <e1> element in the source document was retained in the resulting IData.

XML Document Output generated by documentToRecord

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 587

Page 588: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:freeDocumentWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:freeXMLNode. Frees the resources allocated for a given XML node.

You can optionally call this service when you are using a NodeIterator to iterate over an XML node and you decide to stop processing the node before reaching the end. By explicitly calling freeDocument, you immediately free the resources associated with the node instead of waiting for Java garbage collection to do this. Although it is not mandatory to call this service when you finish processing an XML node with a NodeIterator, doing so can boost server performance. Note that after you have freed an XML node using this service, the node becomes unstable and should not be used by any subsequent processes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2> <e3>e3Value</e3> <e4 e4Attr="attrValue4" 4Attrb="attrValue4b">e4Value </e4> </e2></myDoc>

XML Document Output generated by documentToRecord

document com.wm.lang.xml.Document XML node whose resources you want to release.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 588

Page 589: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:getDocumentTypeWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getXMLNodeType. Returns information about an XML node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.web:getNextNodeWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getNextXMLNode. Gets the next node from a NodeIterator.

A NodeIterator is acquired via the service pub.web:getNodeIterator (deprecated) or pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator. Output is a document (IData object) containing the element type name of the node and the node itself. The instance of this document is only valid until the next getNextNode call on the same NodeIterator, because getNextNode uses the same document object for each call.

Input Parameters

document com.wm.lang.xml.Document XML node about which you want information.

systemID String System identifier, as provided by the DTD associated with the document. If document does not have a system identifier, this value is null.

publicID String Public identifier, as provided by the DTD associated with the document. If document does not have a public identifier, this value is null.

rootNamespaceURI String URI of the XML namespace to which the document’s root element belongs, if any.

rootNSPrefix String Namespace prefix of the root element in the document, if any.

rootLocalName String Local name (excluding the namespace prefix) of the root element in the document.

iterator com.wm.app.b2b.util.NodeIterator NodeIterator from which to retrieve the next node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 589

Page 590: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

pub.web:getNodeIteratorWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator. Creates and returns a NodeIterator.

A NodeIterator iterates over the element node descendants of a given node and returns the element nodes that satisfy the indicated criteria. The client application or flow service uses the service pub.web:getNextNode to get each node in turn. NodeIterators can only be created for XML nodes (not for HTML nodes).

pub.web:getNodeIterator is useful for loading and parsing XML documents on demand. Large or slow documents need only be loaded as far as needed to get the desired data. NodeIterators are also useful for providing service as the pertinent information in the document arrives rather than first waiting for the entire document to load. This service is primarily intended to deal with large documents or documents that arrive slowly.

NodeIterator provides a moving-window mode, in which the only node that is resident in memory is the last node returned by pub.web:getNextNode. In this mode, when pub.web:getNextNode is called, all nodes preceding the newly returned node become invalid, including all nodes previously returned by pub.web:getNextNode. The client must fully complete processing preceding nodes before advancing the window by calling pub.web:getNextNode again. In moving-window mode, the document consumes at least enough memory to hold the most recently returned node.

Moving-window mode allows the server to process multi-megabyte XML documents using very little memory. Moving-window mode may only be used on a node that represents an entire XML document and not on any descendant node.

next Document Conditional. The requested node. Will be null when the NodeIterator has no more nodes to return. Otherwise, next will contain the following:

Key Description

name String Element type name of the node. If the element belongs to a namespace and the namespace was declared at the time the NodeIterator was constructed, name will have the prefix declared for that namespace. If the namespace is not declared, name will use prefix that occurs in the XML.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node identified by the input criteria used to originally generate the NodeIterator.

It is possible that all calls to getNextNode on a given NodeIterator will yield the same document instance, where the values of the instance’s entries vary. For this reason, applications should assume that each call to getNextNode invalidates the document returned by the previous call. This approach maximizes the speed of the server and minimizes the use of resources.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 590

Page 591: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node for which you want to produce a NodeIterator. The node can represent either an XML document or an element of an XML document; however, if the NodeIterator will be used in moving-window mode, a whole XML document must be used. This is because moving window mode is only meaningful for managing the loading process of a document, and to operate on a node is to have already loaded the node.

criteria String List Optional. Pattern strings identifying the nodes that the iterator is to return. A pattern string may take either the form <localName> or the form <prefix>:<localName>.

When a pattern takes the first form, it identifies an element whose local name is <localName> and that belongs to the default XML namespace. When a pattern takes the second form, it identifies an element whose local name is <localName> and whose XML namespace is given by the prefix <prefix>. If the input parameter nsDecls declares this prefix, the namespace URI of the element must match the URI declared for the prefix. If the prefix is not declared in nsDecls, the prefix is matched against prefixes found in the XML.

<prefix> and <localName> can each optionally take the value “*” (asterisk) to match any namespace or local name. A “*” prefix also matches elements residing in the default namespace.

If you do not specify criteria, all element node children of the root element are returned.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes used in criteria. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

movingWindow String Optional. Flag indicating whether the NodeIterator is to iterate using a moving window, as described above. In moving-window mode, the entire document preceding the node most recently returned by getNodeIterator is discarded. Subsequent attempts to return preceding portions of the document will return either the repeating text *PURGED* or the proper data, depending on whether the data falls within an area that the server was able to discard. When iterating with a moving window, the current node should be queried and completely examined prior to requesting the next node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 591

Page 592: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

pub.web: loadDocumentWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:loadXMLNode. Retrieves an XML or HTML document via HTTP or HTTPS, parses it, and returns an XML node.

Input Parameters

Set to... To...

true To use the NodeIterator in moving-window mode.

false Default. To use the NodeIterator in normal mode.

iterator com.wm.app.b2b.util.NodeIterator A NodeIterator for use with the service pub.web:getNextNode.

url String The URL of the document you want to load. This string must begin with http: or https:. For example:

http://www.rubicon.com/orders/orders.html

—OR—https://localhost:5555/WmPublic/index.html

method String Flag indicating the HTTP method you want loadDocument to use to retrieve the requested resource. Set method to get or post.

auth Document Optional. Authentication and authorization information that loadDocument will use if the requested resource is protected.

Key Description

type String Type of authentication loadDocument will use to submit this request. If you are accessing a protected resource, set auth to Basic.

user String User name that loadDocument will submit if the requested resource is protected.

pass String Password associated with user.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 592

Page 593: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

data Document Optional. The data that you want loadDocument to submit with the request. Specify data using one or more of the following elements.

Key Description

args Document The name=value pairs that loadDocument is to submit to the resource in url.

You can use args to submit data via either the POST or GET method.

To specify data using args, create one element for each name=value pair that you want to submit, where the key represents the name portion of the pair and the value represents the value portion of the pair.

Note that when you use args, loadDocument will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in args.

Insert the “&” character between pairs, so you do not need to include it in args.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in args via a GET. You do not need to include this character in args.

When you submit data using the args variable, the Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded. If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type, you must submit your data using the string or bytes variable.

table String Table Specifies data that loadDocument will use to construct a query string to submit to the resource specified in url.

table is similar to args, but it allows you to submit unnamed values in a query string, not just name=value pairs.

To specify data using table, create one row for each value that you want to submit, where:

The contents of column 0 represent the name portion of the pair (leave this column null to submit an unnamed value, and…

The contents of column 1 represent the value portion of the pair.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 593

Page 594: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

When you submit data using the table variable, the Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded. If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type, you must submit your data using the string or bytes variable.

Note that when you use table, loadDocument will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in table.

Insert the “&” character between the pairs (or unnamed values) that it constructs, so you do not need to include it in table.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in table via the GET method. You do not need to include this character in table.

string String Text that you want loadDocument to submit to the resource in url.

You can use string to submit data via either the POST or GET method.

If you use string to specify your data, make sure that you specify the string exactly as you want it presented in the HTTP request. (If you are using the GET method, make sure you URL-encode the contents of string). When performing a POST the string is submitted to the resource as the body of the document.

bytes byte[ ] Data that loadDocument is to submit to the resource in url. You can use bytes only to submit data via the POST method.

Note: When you use bytes and another element (args, table, or string) to submit data with loadDocument, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the bytes element in the body of the post.

stream java.io.InputStream Data that loadXMLNode is to submit to the resource in url. You can use stream only to submit data via the POST method.

Note: When you use stream and another element (args, table, or string) to submit data with loadXMLNode, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the stream element in the body of the post. If stream is specified, bytes is ignored.

encoding String Name of a registered IANA character set.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 594

Page 595: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

headers Document Optional. Fields that you want to explicitly override in the HTTP request header issued by loadDocument.

Specify one element for each header field that you want to set, where the key represents the name of the header field and the value represents the value of that header field.

If headers is not set, loadDocument uses its default header values.

encoding String Character set in which the returned document is encoded. The parser requires this value in order to interpret a document correctly.

Set to... To...

autoDetect Determine the document’s character set based on document type, where:

ISO-8859-1 is used for HTML.

UTF-8 is used for XML.

The name of a registered IANA character set

Decode the document using that character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

If you do not specify an encoding value, loadDocument decodes the returned document using the following defaults:

If the document is... It is decoded using...

HTML ISO-8859-1

XML UTF-8

expandDTD String Flag indicating whether or not loadDocument is to process references to parameter entities in the returned document’s DTD.

Set to... To...

true Expand references to parameter entities to their full definition.

false Default. Ignore references to parameter entities.

isXML String Flag indicating whether the returned document is XML or HTML. loadDocument must know this in order to parse a document correctly.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 595

Page 596: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If pub.web:loadDocument does not receive a response within the timeout period specified in the server’s watt.net.timeout parameter, it will throw an exception. For information about the watt.net.timeout parameter, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

Set to... To...

autoDetect Default. Parse the document based on its type. When you use this option, loadDocument senses the document’s type based on its <!DOCTYPE…> or <?XML…> tag. If it cannot determine a document’s type, it parses it as HTML.

true Parse the document as XML.

false Parse the document as HTML.

loadAs String Flag that specifies the form in which you want loadDocument to make the returned document available to subsequent services.

Set to... To...

bytes Make the document available as a byte array.

Use this option if the document will be used as input to a service that operates on whole documents (for example, pub.web:queryDocument or pub.xml:queryXMLNode).

stream Make the document available as an InputStream.

Use this option if the document will be used as input to a service that can process a document incrementally, for example, pub.web:getNodeIterator (deprecated) or Usage Notes.

failOnHTTPError String Determines whether loadDocument will fail (throw an exception) if the requested URL is not loaded correctly based on an HTTP status code. This parameter allows for customized error handling of the load failure.

Set to... To...

true Throw a service exception if the URL is not loaded as indicated by an HTTP status code between 400 and 599, inclusive.

false Default. Ignore HTTP errors. If there is an error, the HTML page returned by the web server will be sent to the parser.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node representing the returned HTML or XML document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 596

Page 597: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:makeArraysWmPublic. Deprecated—Produces a list of the repeating elements in an XML document based on the document’s DTD.

This list can be used as input to the arrays parameter in pub.web:documentToRecord.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

pub.web:queryDocumentWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:queryXMLNode. Queries an XML node.

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node for which you want to generate a String List. An XML node can be produced by pub.web:loadDocument, pub.web:stringToDocument, or an XML content handler.

arrays String List Names of each repeating element in node. This variable will be null if the DTD for node cannot be found or if there are no DTD references in node.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node that you want to query. An XML node can be produced by pub.web:loadDocument, pub.web:stringToDocument, or an XML content handler.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes used to specify elements in fields/query. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 597

Page 598: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

Document Results from the queries specified in fields. This service returns one element for each query specified in fields. The specific names and types of the returned elements is determined by the fields/name and field/resultType parameters of the individual queries.

Usage Notes

The fields parameter specifies how data is extracted from the node to produce an output variable. This output variable is called a “binding,” because the fields parameter binds a certain part of the document to a particular output variable. The service must include at least one entry in fields. The result of each query you specify in fields is returned in a variable whose name and type you specify.

fields Document List Optional. Parameters describing how data is to be extracted from node. Each document in the list contains parameters for a single query, as follows:

Key Description

name String Name to assign to resulting value.

resultType String Type of value that the query is to yield. Valid values are Object, Object[ ], Object[ ][ ], Record, Record[ ], String, String[ ], and String[ ][ ].

query String Query identifying the data to be extracted from node.

queryType String Query language in which query is expressed. Valid values are WQL and XQL.

onnull String Code indicating what you want queryDocument to do when the result is null. Set to one of the following:

Set to... To indicate that...

continue All result values are acceptable for this query (including null).

fail The service should fail if the result of this query is null and continue in all other cases.

succeed The service should continue if the result of this query is null and fail in all other cases.

fields Document List Parameters that support recursive execution of bindings. Each fields list defines bindings for one level of the output with the top level being the pipeline and the first level down being contents of a document or document list in the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 598

Page 599: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:recordToDocumentWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:documentToXMLString. Converts a document (IData object) to an XML String.

This service recurses through a given document, building an XML representation of the elements within it. The service turns key names into XML elements and key values into the contents of those elements.

Note that key names that start with the attribute prefix (which, in this example, is the “@” character) are turned into attributes of the elements in which they occur. For example, the @type key in the acctNum element is converted to the type=platinum attribute of the <acctNum> element in the resulting XML String.

Also note that the *body key is used to represent the value of a simple element that contains both a text value and an attribute. See the acctNum and phoneNum keys for an example of this kind of element.

This service would convert this document (IData)... To an XML document that looks like this...

<?xml version="1.0" ?><AcctInfo> <name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name> <rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> <acctNum type=platinum>G97041A</acctNum> <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum> <address county=USA> <street1>10211 Brook Road</street1> <city>Cleveland</city> <state>OH</state> <postalCode>22130</postalCode> </address> <serialNum>19970523A</serialNum> <serialNum>20001106G</serialNum> <serialNum>20010404K</serialNum></AcctInfo>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 599

Page 600: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Input Parameters

attrPrefix String Optional. Prefix that designates keys containing attributes. The default prefix is “@”.

For example, if you set attrPrefix to ATT_ and boundNode contained the following element:

recordToDocument would convert the ATT_currency key to the attribute, currency=dollars, in the <tx> element as shown below:

<tx currency=dollars> <acct>cash</acct> <amt>120.00</amt></tx>

boundNode Document Document (IData object) to be converted to XML. Note that if you want to produce a valid XML document (one with a single root node), boundNode must contain only one top-level document (that is, a single IData object). The name of that document will serve as the name of the XML document’s root element.

For example, boundNode shown in the description of this service contains one top-level document named AcctInfo, which would result in one root element named <AcctInfo> in the resulting XML String.

If you needed to produce an XML fragment (for example, a loose collection of elements that are not encompassed within a single root element), boundNode can contain multiple top-level elements. To produce this type of output, you must also set the addHeader and enforceLegalXML parameters to false.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes that are used in the key names in boundNode. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 600

Page 601: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

addHeader String Optional. Flag indicating whether the header element:<?xml version=”1.0”?>

is to be included in the resulting XML String.

Set to... To...

true Default. Include the header.

false Omit the header. (You would omit the header to generate an XML fragment or to insert a custom header.)

encode String Optional. Flag indicating whether to HTML-encode the data.

Set to... To...

true HTML-encode the data.

false Default. Do not HTML-encode the data.

recordName String Optional. Fully qualified name of the document type that describes the structure and format of the output document (for example, examples.rtd:exampleRecord1).

This parameter can be used to ensure that the output includes elements that might not be present in boundNode at run time. It can also be used to describe the order in which elements are to appear in the resulting XML String.

generateRequiredTags String Optional. Flag indicating whether empty tags are to be included in the output document if a mandatory element appears in the document type specified in recordName but does not appear in boundNode.

Set to... To...

true Include mandatory elements if they are not present in boundNode.

false Default. Omit mandatory elements if they are not present in boundNode.

enforceLegalXML String Optional. Flag indicating whether the service throws an exception when boundNode contains multiple root elements or illegal XML tag names.

Set to... To...

true Throw an exception if boundNode produces an XML String containing multiple root elements and/or illegal XML tag names.

false Default. Allow the XML String to contain multiple root elements and/or illegal XML tag names. You would use this setting to create an XML fragment composed of multiple elements that were not all enclosed within a root element.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 601

Page 602: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Output Parameters

dtdHeaderInfo Document Optional. Contents of the DOCTYPE header to be inserted into the XML String. (You can retrieve this information from an incoming document using pub.web:getDocumentType.) Set the following elements in dtdHeaderInfo.

Key Description

systemID String Optional. System identifier for the DTD, if any.

publicID String Optional. Public identifier for the DTD, if any.

rootNSPrefix String Optional. Namespace prefix of the rootLocalName, if any.

rootLocalName String Optional. Local name (excluding the namespace prefix) of the root element.

bufferSize String Optional. Initial size (in bytes) of the String buffer that recordToDocument uses to assemble the output XML String. If the String buffer fills up before recordToDocument is finished generating the XML String, it reallocates the buffer, expanding it by this amount each time the buffer becomes full.

If you do not set bufferSize, recordToDocument looks to see whether a default buffer size is specified in the following parameter on the server:

watt.server.recordToDocument.bufferSize

If so, it uses this value to allocate the String buffer. If this parameter is not set, recordToDocument uses a default buffer size of 4096 bytes.

For best performance, you should always set bufferSize to a value that closely matches the size of the XML String that you expect recordToDocument to produce. This practice will spare the server from having to enlarge the buffer repeatedly if the XML String is many times larger than the default buffer or if you arbitrarily set bufferSize to a value that is too small.

Setting bufferSize to an appropriately sized value will also prevent your service from unnecessarily consuming more memory than it needs if the resulting XML String is much smaller than the default buffer size or if you arbitrarily set bufferSize to a value that is too large.

xmldata String XML document produced from boundNode.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 602

Page 603: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

Usage Notes

If you are building an IData that will be converted to an XML String, keep the following points in mind:

If you want to generate a simple element that contains only a character value, represent it with a String element in boundNode as follows:

If you want to generate an element that contains children, represent with an IData in boundNode, as follows:

To produce attributes, put the attribute values in keys whose name starts with the character(s) specified in attrPrefix. For example, if you use the default attrPrefix, the names of all keys containing attributes (and only those keys containing attributes) must start with the @ character (for example, @type, @xmlns).

Also, when you include attributes, make sure that keys representing attributes are direct children of the elements in which they are to be applied. For example, if you want to include an xmlns attribute to the <AcctInfo> element in the example shown in this service’s description, you must create a String element named @xmlns in the AcctInfo element within boundNode.

If you want to generate a simple element that contains a character value and one or more attributes, you must represent it as an IData that has one key for each attribute and a key named *body that contains element’s value. For example, if you wanted to produce the following element: <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum>

You would include the following IData in boundNode:

To include namespaces, make sure you do the following:

Include the appropriate namespace prefix in the key names in boundNode. For example, to produce an element called acctNum that belongs to a namespace that is represented by the “GSX” prefix, you would include a key named GSX:acctNum in boundNode.

Define the URIs for the prefixes that appear in boundNode. You can do this through nsDecls or by including an @xmlns key in the element where you want the xmlns attribute to be inserted. See the nsDecls description above for more information about declaring namespaces.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 603

Page 604: Integration Server Bis Reference

39. Web Folder

pub.web:str ingToDocumentWmPublic. Deprecated—Use pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode. Converts an XML document (represented as a String, byte[ ], or InputStream) to an XML node.

An XML node is a special representation of an XML document that can be consumed by the Integration Server. Most webMethods services that operate on XML documents require an XML node as input.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

xmldata String Optional. String containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

$filedata byte[ ] Optional. Byte array containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

$filestream java.io.InputStream Optional. InputStream containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

Note: Specify only one of the preceding parameters.

encoding String Optional. Character encoding in which text is represented. Specify UTF-8 for XML files and ISO-8859-1 for HTML files. To have stringToDocument attempt to detect the type of encoding, specify autoDetect (the default, if encoding is not specified).

expandDTD String Optional. Flag indicating whether references to parameter entities in the XML document’s DTD are to be processed.

Set to... To...

true Expand references to parameter entities to their full definition.

false Default. Ignore references to parameter entities.

isXML String Optional. Flag indicating whether the input document is XML or HTML. (stringToDocument must know this so it that it can parse the document correctly.)

Set to... To...

autoDetect Default. Parse the document based on its type. When you use this option, stringToDocument detects the document’s type based on its <!DOCTYPE…> or <?XML…> tag. If it cannot determine a document’s type, it parses it as HTML.

true Parse the document as XML.

false Parse the document as HTML.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node representation of the XML document in xmlData. This object can be used as input to webMethods services that consume XML nodes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 604

Page 605: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 40. XML Folder

You use the elements in the xml folder to perform operations on XML documents.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 605

Page 606: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

Element Package and Description

pub.xml:documentToXMLString WmPublic. Converts a document (IData object) to an XML string.

pub.xml:freeXMLNode WmPublic. Frees the resources allocated to a given XML node.

pub.xml:getNextXMLNode WmPublic. Gets the next XML node from a NodeIterator.

pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator WmPublic. Creates and returns a NodeIterator.

pub.xml:getXMLNodeType WmPublic. Returns information about an XML node.

pub.xml:loadXMLNode WmPublic. Retrieves an XML document via HTTP or HTTPS, parses it, and produces an XML node.

pub.xml:queryXMLNode WmPublic. Queries an XML node.

pub.xml:xmlNodeToDocument WmPublic. Converts an XML node to a document (an IData object).

pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode WmPublic. Converts an XML document (represented as a String, byte[ ], or InputStream) to an XML node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 606

Page 607: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml:documentToXMLStr ingWmPublic. Converts a document (IData object) to an XML string.

This service recurses through a given document, building an XML representation from the elements within it. Key names are turned into XML elements, and the key values are turned into the contents of those elements.

Note that:

Key names that start with the attribute prefix (which, in this example, is the “@” character) are turned into attributes of the elements in which they occur. For example, the @type key in the acctNum element is converted to the type=platinum attribute of the <acctNum> element in the resulting XML String.

Also note that the *body key is used to represent the value of a simple element that contains both a text value and an attribute. See the acctNum and phoneNum keys for an example of this kind of element.

Fields that are not String or Document based (for example, Floats or Integers) are converted to XML values using the underlying object’s toString method.

This service would convert this document (IData object).... To an XML document that looks like this...

<?xml version="1.0" ?><AcctInfo> <name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name> <rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> <acctNum type=platinum>G97041A</acctNum> <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum> <address country=USA> <street1>10211 Brook Road</street1> <city>Cleveland</city> <state>OH</state> <postalCode>22130</postalCode> </address> <serialNum>19970523A</serialNum> <serialNum>20001106G</serialNum> <serialNum>20010404K</serialNum></AcctInfo>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 607

Page 608: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Input Parameters

attrPrefix String Optional. Prefix that designates keys containing attributes. The default prefix is “@”.

For example, if you set attrPrefix to ATT_ and document contained the following element:

documentToXMLString would convert the ATT_currency key to the attribute, currency=dollars, in the <tx> element as shown below:

<tx currency=dollars> <acct>cash</acct> <amt>120.00</amt></tx>

document Document IData object that is to be converted to XML. Note that if you want to produce a valid XML document (one with a single root node), document must contain only one top-level IData object (that is, a single document). The name of that document will serve as the name of the XML document’s root element.

For example, document shown in the example in this service’s description contains one top-level document named AcctInfo, which would result in one root element named <AcctInfo> in the resulting XML String.

If you needed to produce an XML fragment (for example, a loose collection of elements that are not encompassed within a single root element) then document can contain multiple top-level elements. To produce this type of output, you must also set the addHeader and enforceLegalXML parameters to false.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes that are used in the key names in document. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 608

Page 609: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

For each prefix specified in nsDecls, documentToXMLString generates an xmlns attribute and inserts it into the top-most element of the resulting XML String. For example, if nsDecls had the two keys shown above, documentToXMLString would insert the following attributes into the root element of the XML String:

xmlns:gsx="http://www.gsx.com"xmlns:TxMon="http:www.acrtrak/txMonitor"

Note: You can also include a namespace declaration by including an @xmlns key in document (if you weren’t using the @ character to designate attributes, use the correct attribute prefix in your code). The advantage of this approach over nsDecls is that it lets you specify the point where you want the xmlns attribute to be inserted.

addHeader String Optional. Flag specifying whether the header element: <?xml version=”1.0”?>

is to be included in the resulting XML String.

Set to... To...

true Default. Include the header.

false Omit the header. (You would omit the header to generate an XML fragment or to insert a custom header.)

encode String Optional. Flag indicating whether to HTML-encode the data. Set this parameter to true if your XML data contains special characters, including the following: < > & " '

Set to... To...

true HTML-encode the data.

For example, the string expression 5 < 6 would be converted to <expr>5 &lt; 6</expr>, which is valid.

false Default. Do not HTML-encode the data.

For example, the string expression 5 < 6 would be converted to <expr>5 < 6</expr>, which is invalid.

documentTypeName String Optional. Fully qualified name of the document type that describes the structure and format of the output document (for example, examples.rtd:exampleRecord1).

You can use this parameter to ensure that the output includes elements that might not be present in document at run time, or to describe the order in which elements are to appear in the resulting XML String.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 609

Page 610: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

generateRequiredTags String Optional. Flag indicating whether empty tags are to be included in the output document if a mandatory element appears in the document type specified in documentTypeName but does not appear in document.

Set to... To...

true Include mandatory elements if they are not present in document.

false Default. Omit mandatory elements if they are not present in document.

enforceLegalXML String Optional. Flag indicating whether the service throws an exception when document contains multiple root elements or illegal XML tag names.

Set to... To...

true Throw an exception if document would produce an XML String containing multiple root elements and/or illegal XML tag names.

false Default. Allow the resulting XML String to contain multiple root elements and/or illegal XML tag names. You would use this setting, for example, to create an XML fragment composed of multiple elements that were not all enclosed within a root element.

dtdHeaderInfo Document Optional. Contents of the DOCTYPE header to be inserted into the XML String. (You can retrieve this information from an incoming document using pub.xml:getXMLNodeType.)

Key Description

systemID String Optional. System identifier for the DTD, if any.

publicID String Optional. Public identifier for the DTD, if any.

rootNSPrefix String Optional. Namespace prefix of the rootLocalName, if any.

rootLocalName String Optional. Local name (excluding the namespace prefix) of the root element.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 610

Page 611: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If you are building an IData that will be converted to an XML String, keep the following points in mind:

If you want to generate a simple element that contains only a character value, represent it with a String element in document as shown in the following:

If you want to generate an element that contains children, represent with an IData in document as shown in the following.

To produce attributes, put the attribute values in keys whose name starts with the character(s) specified in attrPrefix. For example, if you use the default attrPrefix, the names of all keys

bufferSize String Optional. Initial size (in bytes) of the String buffer that documentToXMLString uses to assemble the output XML String. If the String buffer fills up before documentToXMLString is finished generating the XML String, it reallocates the buffer, expanding it by this amount each time the buffer becomes full.

If you do not set bufferSize, documentToXMLString looks to see whether a default buffer size is specified in the following parameter on the server:

watt.server.recordToDocument.bufferSize

If so, it uses this value to allocate the String buffer. If this parameter is not set, documentToXMLString uses a default buffer size of 4096 bytes.

For best performance, you should always set bufferSize to a value that closely matches the size of the XML String that you expect documentToXMLString to produce. This practice will spare the server from having to enlarge the buffer repeatedly if the XML String is many times larger than the default buffer or if you arbitrarily set bufferSize to a value that is too small.

Setting bufferSize to an appropriately sized value will also prevent your service from unnecessarily consuming more memory than it needs if the XML String is much smaller than the default buffer size or if you arbitrarily set bufferSize to a value that is too large.

xmldata String XML String produced from document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 611

Page 612: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

containing attributes (and only those keys containing attributes) must start with the @ character (for example, @type, @xmlns).

Also, when you include attributes, make sure that keys representing attributes are direct children of the elements in which they are to be applied. For example, if you want to include an xmlns attribute in the <AcctInfo> element in the example shown in the description of this service, you must create a String field named @xmlns in the AcctInfo field within document.

If you want to generate a simple element that contains a character value and one or more attributes, you must represent it as an IData that has one key for each attribute and a key named *body that contains element’s value. For example, if you wanted to produce the following element: <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum>

You would include the following in document:

To include namespaces, make sure you do the following:

Include the appropriate namespace prefix in the key names in document. For example, to produce an element called acctNum that belongs to a namespace that is represented by the “GSX” prefix, you would include a key named GSX:acctNum in document.

Define the URIs for the prefixes that appear in document. You can do this through nsDecls or by including an @xmlns key in the element where you want the xmlns attribute to be inserted. See the nsDecls description above for more information about declaring namespaces.

pub.xml: freeXMLNodeWmPublic. Frees the resources allocated to a given XML node.

You can optionally call this service when you are using a NodeIterator to iterate over an XML node and you decide to stop processing the node before reaching the end. By explicitly calling pub.xml:freeXMLNode, you immediately free the resources associated with the node instead of waiting for Java garbage collection to do this. Although it is not mandatory to call this service when you finish processing an XML node with a NodeIterator, doing so can boost server performance. Note that after you have freed an XML node using this service, the node becomes unstable and should not be used by any subsequent processes.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

None.

rootNode com.wm.lang.xml.Document XML node whose resources you want to release.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 612

Page 613: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml:getNextXMLNodeWmPublic. Gets the next XML node from a NodeIterator.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

A NodeIterator is acquired via the service Usage Notes. The output of that service is a document (IData object) containing the element type name of the node and the node itself. The instance of this document is only valid until the next getNextXMLNode call on the same NodeIterator, because getNextXMLNode uses the same document object for each call.

pub.xml:getXMLNodeIteratorWmPublic. Creates and returns a NodeIterator.

A NodeIterator iterates over the element node descendants of an XML node and returns the element nodes that satisfy the given criteria. The client application or flow service uses the service pub.xml:getNextXMLNode to get each node in turn. NodeIterators can only be created for XML nodes (not for HTML nodes).

getXMLNodeIterator is useful for loading and parsing documents on demand. Large or slow documents need only be loaded as far as needed to get the desired data. NodeIterators are also useful for providing service

iterator com.wm.app.b2b.util.NodeIterator NodeIterator from which to retrieve the next node.

next Document Conditional. The requested node. Will be null when the NodeIterator has no more nodes to return. Otherwise, next will contain the following:

Key Description

name String Element type name of the node. If the element belongs to a namespace and the namespace was declared at the time the NodeIterator was constructed, name will have the prefix declared for that namespace. If the namespace is not declared, name will use prefix that occurs in the XML.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node identified by the input criteria used to originally generate the NodeIterator.

It is possible that all calls to getNextXMLNode on a given NodeIterator will yield the same document instance, where the values of the instance’s entries vary. For this reason, applications should assume that each call to getNextXMLNode invalidates the document returned by the previous call. This approach maximizes the speed of the server and minimizes the use of resources.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 613

Page 614: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

as the pertinent information in the document arrives rather than first waiting for the entire document to load. This service is primarily intended to deal with large documents or documents that arrive slowly.

NodeIterator provides a moving-window mode, in which the only node that is resident in memory is the last node returned by pub.xml:getNextXMLNode. In this mode, when pub.xml:getNextXMLNode is called, all nodes preceding the newly returned node become invalid, including all nodes previously returned by pub.xml:getNextXMLNode. The client must fully complete processing preceding nodes before advancing the window by calling pub.xml:getNextXMLNode again. In moving-window mode, the document consumes at least enough memory to hold the most recently returned node.

Moving-window mode allows the server to process multi-megabyte XML documents using very little memory. Moving-window mode may only be used on a node that represents an entire XML document and not on any descendant node.

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node for which you want to produce a NodeIterator. The node can represent either an XML document or an element of an XML document; however, if the NodeIterator will be used in moving-window mode, a whole XML document must be used. This is because moving window mode is only meaningful for managing the loading process of a document, and to operate on a node is to have already loaded the node.

criteria String List Optional. Pattern strings identifying the nodes that the iterator is to return. A pattern string may take either the form <localName> or the form <prefix>:<localName>.

When a pattern takes the first form, it identifies an element whose local name is <localName> and that belongs to the default XML namespace. When a pattern takes the second form, it identifies an element whose local name is <localName> and whose XML namespace is given by the prefix <prefix>. If the input parameter nsDecls declares this prefix, the namespace URI of the element must match the URI declared for the prefix. If the prefix is not declared in nsDecls, the prefix is matched against prefixes found in the XML.

<prefix> and <localName> can each optionally take the value “*” (asterisk) to match any namespace or local name. A “*” prefix also matches elements residing in the default namespace.

If you do not specify criteria, all element node children of the root element are returned.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes used in criteria. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 614

Page 615: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Output Parameters

pub.xml:getXMLNodeTypeWmPublic. Returns information about an XML node.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

movingWindow String Optional. Flag indicating whether the NodeIterator is to iterate using a moving window, as described above. In moving-window mode, the entire document preceding the node most recently returned by getXMLNodeIterator is discarded. Subsequent attempts to return preceding portions of the document will return either the repeating text *PURGED* or the proper data, depending on whether the data falls within an area that the server was able to discard. When iterating with a moving window, the current node should be queried and completely examined prior to requesting the next node.

Set to... To...

true To use the NodeIterator in moving-window mode.

false Default. To use the NodeIterator in normal mode.

iterator com.wm.app.b2b.util.NodeIterator NodeIterator for use with the service pub.xml:getNextXMLNode.

rootNode com.wm.lang.xml.Document XML node about which you want information.

systemID String Conditional. System identifier, as provided by the DTD associated with rootNode. If rootNode does not have a system identifier, this value is null.

publicID String Conditional. Public identifier, as provided by the DTD associated with rootNode. If rootNode does not have a public identifier, this value is null.

rootNamespace String URI of the XML namespace to which rootNode’s root element belongs.

rootNSPrefix String Conditional. Namespace prefix of root element in rootNode, if any.

rootLocalName String Conditional. Local name (excluding the namespace prefix) of the root element in rootNode, if any.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 615

Page 616: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml: loadXMLNodeWmPublic. Retrieves an XML document via HTTP or HTTPS, parses it, and produces an XML node.

Input Parameters

url String The URL of the document you want to load. This string must begin with http: or https:. For example:

http://www.rubicon.com/orders/orders.html

—OR—https://localhost:5555/WmPublic/index.html

method String Optional. Flag indicating the HTTP method you want loadXMLNode to use to retrieve the requested resource. Set to get or post.

auth Document Optional. Authentication and authorization information that loadXMLNode will use if the requested resource is protected.

Key Description

type String Type of authentication loadXMLNode will use to submit this request. Leave this field blank, as the only option currently available is basic HTTP authentication.

user String User name that loadXMLNode will submit if the requested resource is protected.

pass String Password associated with user.

data Document Optional. The data that you want loadXMLNode to submit with the request. Specify data using one or more of the following elements.

Note: When you use more than one element to submit data, args is appended first, table is appended second, and string is appended last.

Key Description

args Document Optional. Specifies name=value pairs that loadXMLNode is to submit to the resource in url.

You can use args to submit data via either the POST or GET method.

To specify data using args, create one element for each name=value pair that you want to submit, where the key represents the name portion of the pair and the value represents the value portion of the pair.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 616

Page 617: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Note that when you use args, loadXMLNode will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in args.

Insert the “&” character between pairs, so you do not need to include it in args.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in args via a GET. You do not need to include this character in args.

When you submit data using the args variable, the Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded. If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type, you must submit your data using the string or bytes variable.

table String Table Optional. Specifies data that loadXMLNode will use to construct a query string to submit to the resource specified in url.

table is similar to args, but it allows you to submit unnamed values in a query string, not just name=value pairs.

To specify data using table, create one row for each value that you want to submit, where:

The contents of column 0 represent the name portion of the pair (leave this column null to submit an unnamed value, and…

The contents of column 1 represent the value portion of the pair.

When you submit data using the table variable, the Integration Server automatically sets the value of the Content-Type header to application/x-www-form-urlencoded. If you want to explicitly specify a different Content-Type, you must submit your data using the string or bytes variable.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 617

Page 618: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Note that when you use table, loadXMLNode will automatically:

URL-encode name=value pair, so you do not need to URL-encode the values you specify in table.

Insert the “&” character between the pairs (or unnamed values) that it constructs, so you do not need to include it in table.

Prefix the entire query string with the “?” character if it submits the data in table via the GET method. You do not need to include this character in table.

string String Optional. Text that you want loadXMLNode to submit to the resource in url.

You can use string to submit data via either the POST or GET method.

If you use string to specify your data, make sure that you specify the string exactly as you want it presented in the HTTP request. (If you are using the GET method, make sure you URL-encode the contents of string). When performing a POST the string is submitted to the resource as the body of the document.

bytes byte[ ] Optional. Data that loadXMLNode is to submit to the resource in url. You can use bytes only to submit data via the POST method.

Note: When you use bytes and another element (args, table, or string) to submit data with loadXMLNode, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the bytes element in the body of the post.

stream java.io.InputStream Optional. Data that loadXMLNode is to submit to the resource in url. You can use stream only to submit data via the POST method.

Note: When you use stream and another element (args, table, or string) to submit data with loadXMLNode, the service appends the data from the args, table, or string element to url. The service appends args to url first, table second, and string last. The service encodes the data from the stream element in the body of the post. If stream is specified, bytes is ignored.

encoding String Optional. Name of a registered IANA character set.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 618

Page 619: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

headers Document Optional. Fields that you want to explicitly override in the HTTP request header issued by loadXMLNode.

Specify one element for each header field that you want to set, where the element’s name represents the name of the header field, and the element’s value represents the value of that header field.

If headers is not set, loadXMLNode will use its default header values.

encoding String Optional. Character set in which the returned document is encoded. The parser requires this value in order to interpret a document correctly.

Set to... To...

autoDetect Determine the document’s character set based on document type, where:

ISO-8859-1 is used for HTML.

UTF-8 is used for XML.

The name of a registered IANA character set

Decode the document using that character set (for example, ISO-8859-1).

If you do not specify an encoding value, loadXMLNode decodes the returned document using the following defaults:

If the document is... It is decoded using...

HTML ISO-8859-1

XML UTF-8

expandDTD String Optional. Flag indicating whether or not loadXMLNode is to process references to parameter entities in the returned document’s DTD.

Set to... To...

true Expand references to parameter entities to their full definition.

false Default. Ignore references to parameter entities.

isXML String Optional. Flag indicating whether the returned document is XML or HTML. loadXMLNode must know this in order to parse a document correctly.

Set to... To...

autoDetect Default. Parse the document based on its type. When you use this option, loadXMLNode senses the document’s type based on its <!DOCTYPE…> or <?XML…> tag. If it cannot determine a document’s type, it parses it as HTML.

true Parse the document as XML.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 619

Page 620: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

If loadXMLNode does not receive a response within the timeout period specified in the server’s watt.net.timeout parameter, it will throw an exception. For information about the watt.net.timeout parameter, see the webMethods Integration Server Administrator’s Guide.

false Parse the document as HTML.

loadAs String Optional. Flag that specifies the form in which you want loadXMLNode to make the parsed document available to subsequent services.

Set to... To...

bytes Default. Make the document available as a byte array.

Use this option if the document will be used as input to a service that operates on whole documents (for example, pub.xml:queryXMLNode).

stream Make the document available as an InputStream.

Use this option if the document will be used as input to a service that can process a document incrementally (for example, pub.xml:getXMLNodeIterator).

failOnHTTPError String Optional. Determines whether loadXMLNode will fail (throw an exception) if the requested URL is not loaded correctly based on an HTTP status code. This parameter allows for customized error handling of the load failure.

Set to... To...

true Throw a service exception if the URL is not loaded as indicated by an HTTP status code between 400 and 599, inclusive.

false Default. Ignore HTTP errors. If there is an error, the HTML page returned by the web server will be sent to the parser.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node representing the returned HTML or XML document.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 620

Page 621: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml:queryXMLNodeWmPublic. Queries an XML node.

The fields parameter specifies how data is extracted from the node to produce an output variable. This output variable is called a “binding,” because the fields parameter binds a certain part of the document to a particular output variable. At run time, this service must include at least one fields entry. The service must include at least one entry in fields. The result of each query you specify in fields is returned in a variable whose name and type you specify.

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node that you want to query. An XML node can be produced by pub.xml:loadXMLNode, pub.xml:xmlStringToXMLNode or an XML content handler.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespaces associated with any namespace prefixes used element to specify elements in fields/query. Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

fields Document List Optional. Parameters describing how data is to be extracted from node. Each document in the list contains parameters for a single query, as follows:

Key Description

name String Name to assign to resulting value.

resultType String Object type that the query is to yield. The following shows the allowed values for resultType. Because this parameter is typically set through the Variables tab in Developer, the setting you would select in Developer is also shown here.

Underlying Value Corresponding Selection in Developer

Object Object

Object[] Object List

Record Document

Record[] Document List

String String

String[] String List

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 621

Page 622: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Output Parameters

Document Results from the queries specified in fields. This service returns one element for each query specified in fields. The specific names and types of the returned elements are determined by the fields/name and field/resultType parameters of the individual queries.

String[][] String Table

query String Query identifying the data to be extracted from node.

queryType String Query language in which query is expressed. Valid values are WQL and XQL.

onnull String Code indicating what you want queryXMLNode to do when the result is null. Set to one of the following:

Set to... To indicate that...

continue All result values are acceptable for this query (including null).

fail The service should fail if the result of this query is null and continue in all other cases.

succeed The service should continue if the result of this query is null and fail in all other cases.

fields Document List Parameters that support recursive execution of bindings. Each fields list defines bindings for one level of the output with the top level being the pipeline and the first level down being contents of a document or document list in the pipeline.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 622

Page 623: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml:xmlNodeToDocumentWmPublic. Converts an XML node to a document (an IData object).

This service transforms each element and attribute in the XML node to an element in an IData object. For example:

Note that:

The XML version attribute is converted to an element named @version.

The resulting document is given the same name as the XML document’s root element (AcctInfo in the example above) and is a child of the document variable that this service returns.

Simple elements (such as <name> and <rep> in the example above) are converted to String elements.

Complex elements (that is, elements with children, such as <address> in the example above) and simple elements that have attributes (such as <acctNum> and <phoneNum>) are converted to documents (IData objects). Note that keys derived from attributes are prefixed with a “@” character to distinguish them from keys derived from elements. Also note that when a simple element has an attribute, its value is placed in an element named *body.

Repeated elements (such as <serialNum>) can be collected into arrays using the makeArrays and/or arrays parameters. See makeArrays and arrays below for additional information about producing arrays.

This service would convert this XML document... To an IData that looks like this...

<?xml version="1.0" ?><AcctInfo> <name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name> <rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> <acctNum type=platinum>G97041A</acctNum> <phoneNum cc=011>216-741-7566</phoneNum> <address country=USA> <street1>10211 Brook Road</street1> <city>Cleveland</city> <state>OH</state> <postalCode>22130</postalCode> </address> <serialNum>19970523A</serialNum> <serialNum>20001106G</serialNum> <serialNum>20010404K</serialNum></AcctInfo>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 623

Page 624: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Input Parameters

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node that is to be converted to a document (IData object).

attrPrefix String Optional. Prefix that is to be used to designate keys containing attribute values. The default is “@”. For example, if you set attrPrefix to ATT_ and node contained the following element:

<tx currency=dollars> <acct>cash</acct> <amt>120.00</amt></tx>

xmlNodeToDocument would convert the currency attribute as follows:

arrays String List Optional. Names of elements that are to be generated as arrays, regardless of whether they appear multiple times in node. For example, if arrays contained the following values for the XML document shown in the example in the description for this service:

repaddress

xmlNodeToDocument would generate element rep as a String List and element address as a Document List.

Important! If you include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify in arrays, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

makeArrays String Optional. Flag indicating whether you want xmlNodeToDocument to automatically create an array for every element that appears in node more than once.

Set to... To...

true Default. Automatically create arrays for every element that appears more than once in node.

false Create arrays for only those elements specified in arrays or defined as arrays in the document type specified in documentTypeName.

Important! You must set makeArrays to false when using documentTypeName to define the structure of an element. Otherwise, an exception will be thrown at run time.

The currency attribute is prefixed with the characters “ATT_”

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 624

Page 625: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

collect Document Optional. Elements that are to be placed into a new, named array (that is, a “collection”). Within collect, use key names to specify the names of the elements that are to be included in the collection. Then set the value of each key to specify the name of the collection in which you want that element placed. For example, if you wanted to place the <name> and <rep> elements in an array called originator, you would set collect as follows:

Key Value

name originator

rep originator

If the set of elements in a collection are all simple elements, a String List is produced. However, if the set is made up of complex elements, or a combination of simple and complex elements, a Document List is produced. When this is the case, each member of the array will include a child element called *name that contains the name of the element from which that member was derived.

You may optionally include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify in collect; however, if you do, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

Important! You cannot include an element in more than one collection.

nsDecls Document Optional. Namespace prefixes to use for the conversion. This parameter specifies the prefixes that will be used when namespace-qualified elements are converted to key names in the resulting IData object. For example, if you want elements belonging to a particular namespace to have the prefix GSX in the resulting IData (for example, GSX:acctNum), you would associate the prefix GSX with that namespace in nsDecls. (This is important because incoming XML documents can use any prefix for a given namespace, but the key names expected by a target service or MAP step on the Integration Server will have a fixed prefix.)

Namespace prefixes in nsDecls also define the prefixes used by the arrays, documents, documentTypeName, and collect parameters.

Each entry in nsDecls represents a namespace prefix/URI pair, where a key name represents a prefix and the value of the key specifies the namespace URI.

For example, to define the URIs associated with two prefixes called GSX and TxMon, you would set nsDecls as follows:

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 625

Page 626: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

documents String List Optional. Names of any simple elements that are to be generated as documents (IData objects) instead of Strings. The document produced for each element specified in documents will have the same name as the source element from which it is derived. It will contain a String element named *body that holds the element’s value.

For example, if documents contained the Strings name and rep and the source document contained the following:

. . .<name>Midwest Extreme Sports</name><rep>Laura M. Sanchez</rep> . . .

xmlNodeToDocument would produce the following:

Note: If you include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

documentTypeName String Optional. Fully qualified name of the document type that specifies the structure that is to be imposed on the resulting document. You can use this parameter to explicitly specify the order and dimensionality of elements. It is an alternative to using makeArrays and arrays to specify which elements are to be generated as arrays.

For example, if you had the XML document shown in the example in this service’s description, and you wanted the <name> and <rep> elements to be generated as String lists, you would define them as String Lists fields in a document type and then specify that document type in documentTypeName.

Note: The document type specified in documentTypeName does not need to specify every element that will appear in the resulting document. It only needs to specify the elements whose structure you want to explicitly set. However, if you include namespace prefixes in the element names that you specify, you must define the namespaces associated with those prefixes in nsDecls.

This service always converts XML nodes to String or Document object fields. It does not generate constrained objects (for example, Floats or Integers), even if the fields in the specified document are defined as constrained objects.

Important! When you use documentTypeName, set makeArrays to false and do not set arrays and documents. Otherwise, xmlNodeToDocument will throw an exception at run time.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 626

Page 627: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

Output Parameters

Usage Notes

Following are examples of XML documents and the documents (IData objects) that xmlNodeToDocument would produce.

mixedModel String Optional. Flag specifying how mixed-content elements (elements containing both text values and child elements) are to be converted. The following is an example of a mixed-content element:<comment> This job is <status>pending</status>. Estimated completion date is <edc>Feb 14, 2000</edc>.</comment>

Set to... To...

true Place top-level text in an element named *body. This setting would produce the following IData for the <comment> element shown above:

Important! When you set mixedModel to true, you must also use documentTypeName to specify a document type that describes the structure of the IData that you want xmlNodeToDocument to produce. Within the document type, mixed-content elements must be defined as documents that include a String field named *body.

false Omit top-level text and include only the child elements from mixed-content elements. This setting would produce the following IData for the <comment> element shown above:

document Document Document (IData object) representation of the nodes and attributes in node.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 627

Page 628: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

XML Document Output from xmlNodeToDocument

<myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue">e1Value</e1></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2></myDoc>

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" standalone="no"?><myDoc> <e1>e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1>e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 628

Page 629: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue2">e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

Note: This example assumes that makeArrays is set to true. Note that e1 was created as a document list, which holds both <e1> elements from the XML document.

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2>e2Value</e2> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue2">e1Value2</e1></myDoc>

Note: This example assumes that makeArrays is set to false. Note that only the last <e1> element in the source XML was retained in the resulting document.

<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?><myDoc> <e1 e1Attr="attrValue1">e1Value1</e1> <e2> <e3>e3Value</e3> <e4 e4Attr="attrValue4" e4Attrb="attrValue4b">e4Value </e4> </e2></myDoc>

XML Document Output from xmlNodeToDocument

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 629

Page 630: Integration Server Bis Reference

40. XML Folder

pub.xml:xmlStr ingToXMLNodeWmPublic. Converts an XML document (represented as a String, byte[ ], or InputStream) to an XML node.

An XML node is a special representation of an XML document that can be consumed by the Integration Server. Most webMethods services that operate on XML documents require an XML node as input.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

xmldata String Optional. String containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

$filedata byte[ ] Optional. byte[ ] containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

$filestream java.io.InputStream Optional. InputStream containing the XML document to convert to an XML node.

Note: Specify only one of the preceding parameters.

encoding String Optional. Character encoding in which text is represented. Specify UTF-8 for XML files and ISO-8859-1 for HTML files. To have the parser attempt to detect the type of encoding, specify autoDetect (the default, if encoding is not specified).

expandDTD String Optional. Flag indicating whether references to parameter entities in the XML document’s DTD are to be processed.

Set to... To...

true Expand references to parameter entities to their full definition.

false Default. Ignore references to parameter entities.

isXML String Optional. Flag specifying whether the input document is XML or HTML. (xmlStringToXMLNode must know this so that it can parse the document correctly.)

Set to... To...

autoDetect Default. Parse the document based on its type. When you use this option, xmlStringToXMLNode detects the document’s type based on its <!DOCTYPE…> or <?XML…> tag. If it cannot determine a document’s type, it parses it as HTML.

true Parse the document as XML.

false Parse the document as HTML.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node XML node representation of the XML document in xmlData. This object can be used as input to webMethods services that consume XML nodes.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 630

Page 631: Integration Server Bis Reference

Chapter 41. XSLT Folder

You use the elements in the XSLT folder to transform an XML stream into a byte array, file, or XML node, and to maintain the XSLT stylesheet cache.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 631

Page 632: Integration Server Bis Reference

41. XSLT Folder

Summary of Elements in this Folder The following elements are available in this folder:

The WmXSLT package also comes with sample services that show you how to use the public services.

pub.xsl t .Transformat ions:transformSeria lXMLWmXSLT. Uses an XSLT stylesheet to transform an XML stream, then stores the transformed XML in a byte array, file, or XML node.

To optimize performance, the service stores the XSLT stylesheet in a cache so the stylesheet will be instantly available to the service for later runs.

Input Parameters

Element Package and Description

pub.xslt.Transformations:transformSerialXML WmXSLT. Uses an XSLT stylesheet to transform an XML stream, then stores the transformed XML in a byte array, file, or XML node.

pub.xslt.Cache:removeAllTemplates WmXSLT. Clears the XSLT stylesheet cache.

pub.xslt.Cache:removeTemplate WmXSLT. Removes one stylesheet from the XSLT stylesheet cache.

stylesheetSystemId String URI for the XSLT stylesheet to use.

systemId String URL of the XML to transform. If you specify this parameter, do not specify the filename, bytes, or xmlStream parameter.

filename String Fully qualified name of the file that contains the XML to transform. The file must be located on the local machine. If you specify this parameter, do not specify the systemId, bytes, or xmlStream parameter.

bytes byte[] XML to transform. If you specify this parameter, do not specify the systemId, filename, or xmlStream parameter.

xmlStream Input stream XML to transform. If you specify this parameter, do not specify the systemId, filename, or bytes parameter.

xslParamInput Document Optional. Name/value pairs to pass to the stylesheet.

See the XSLT Services Developer’s Guide for instructions on setting up a stylesheet to work with this parameter.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 632

Page 633: Integration Server Bis Reference

41. XSLT Folder

Output Parameters

Example

You want to transform an XML document named cdCatalog.xml into an HTML document using an XSLT stylesheet named cdCatalog.xsl. You would pass the transformSerialXML service these values:

Input Parameters

The service transforms the XML stream into a byte array containing an HTML document and puts the byte array in the pipeline. You could convert the byte array into a String using the Integration Server built-in service pub.string:bytesToString, then display the String using a dynamic server page (DSP). For information on using DSPs, see Dynamic Server Pages and Output Templates Developer’s Guide.

resultType String Tells Developer what to transform the XML into. Must be one of these values:

Set to... To...

bytes Transforms the XML into a byte array.

file Transforms the XML into a file. If you specify file, you must also specify the outFileName parameter.

xmlNode Transforms the XML into an XML node.

outFileName String Fully qualified name of the file in which to store the transformed XML. The file must be located on the local machine. Use this parameter only if you specified file on the resultType parameter.

bytes byte[] Byte array that contains the transformed XML. The service places the byte array in the pipeline so that subsequent services can use it. This value is present only if you specified bytes in the resultType input parameter.

node com.wm.lang.xml.Node Node that contains the transformed XML. The service places the XML node in the pipeline so that subsequent services can use it. This value is present only if you specified xmlNode in the resultType input parameter.

xslParamOutput Document Document that contains name/value pairs that were returned by the stylesheet. The service places the document in the pipeline so that subsequent services can use it. This value is present only if you add name/value pairs to it within your stylesheet.

See “Pass Name/Value Pairs from the Stylesheet to the Pipeline” on page 20 for instructions on setting up your stylesheet to work with this parameter.

stylesheetSystemId http://localhost:5555/WmXSLT/samples/xdocs/cdCatalog.xsl

systemId http://localhost:5555/WmXSLT/samples/xdocs/cdCatalog.xml

resultType bytes

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 633

Page 634: Integration Server Bis Reference

41. XSLT Folder

pub.xsl t .Cache:removeAl lTemplatesWmXSLT. Clears the XSLT stylesheet cache.

Input Parameters

None.

Output Parameters

pub.xsl t .Cache:removeTemplateWmXSLT. Removes one stylesheet from the XSLT stylesheet cache.

Input Parameters

Output Parameters

message String Indicates whether the service was able to clear the cache.

stylesheetSystemId String URI for the XSLT stylesheet to remove from the cache.

message String Indicates whether the service was able to remove the stylesheet from the cache.

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 634

Page 635: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

Index

Aaccess permissions assigned to built-in services 25accessPoint 500ACLs assigned to built-in services 25activatePackage 252add_publisherAssertions 548addBodyEntry 398addBodyPart 233addComplexTask 336addFloatList 217addFloats 218addHeaderEntry 399adding

body parts to MIME messages 233documents to list 207entries into a data store 418LDAP server entries 194MIME message headers 237numeric values 217, 218, 219strings to list 208

addIntList 219addInts 219addMimeHeader 237addObjects 220addOnetimeTask 338addReleaseRegistryEntry 321addRepeatingTask 339address 501addressLine 501addSubscriber 141addTrailer 401alarm specification 144alarmInfo document type 145appending data to a remote file 54appendToDocumentList 207appendToRecordList 207appendToStringList 208arithmetic services 215ART services 27

assertionStatusItem 502assertionStatusReport 503asynchronous call to a remote server 314asynchronous request/reply

delivering request 289description of 290, 300publishing request 299publishing request to a specific client 289retrieving reply 302

attributesdefinition 197modifying in LDAP entries 203

audit events, logging 166audit log, event logging 166audit specification 145auditInfo document type 146authToken 503

Bbase64Decode 427base64Encode 427binding

entry into an LDAP server 194listing 199output template to Values object 332

bindingDetail 504bindingKey 504bindingTemplate 505bindingTemplates 505businessDetail 506businessDetailExt 506businessEntity 507businessEntityExt 507businessInfo 508businessInfos 508businessKey 508businessList 508businessService 509businessServices 509byte array from string 435byte[ ], converting to InputStream 187bytesToString 427

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 635

Page 636: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

Ccall 109calling stored procedures 109callStackItem document type 146cancelTask 340canonical document, definition 447canonical keys

creating 446inserting 450retrieving 448

categoryBag 510cd 55cdls 55, 66certificate chain 360certs-only S/MIME Message

creating 380extracting certificates from 385

changeProcessStatus 273changing the working directory 55character sequence, indexing first occurrence 429clearing transactional state 111clearKeyAndChain 360clearPipeline 175clearTransaction 111client services 49close connection 112closeAll 113closeLatch 444closeStore 419closing database connection 112cluster services 93committing changes to a database 113commitTransaction 45complex tasks

adding to scheduler 336updating to scheduler 344

concatenatingarray of strings 431strings 428

connecting to an LDAP server 195connections

closing 196creating 114deleting 367, 368

contact 510contacts 511content type, getting from MIME message 244conventions used in this document 25converting

date formats 97string list to document list 212time formats 97XML nodes to IData objects 623

copyListItem 209correlations, setting up 276CorrelationService specification 271createCertsOnlyData 380createEncryptedData 381createMessageDigest 375createMimeData 238createRegions 579createSignedAndEncryptedData 263, 382createSignedData 264, 383createSoapData 402createXReference 446createXSD 350creating MIME messages 238cross-references

creating 446deleting by object ID 447deleting individual records 448inserting 450

current VCS userremoving 571setting 572

currentDate 102

Ddata

converting 187waiting for delivery 440

data storesadding entries 418closing 419deleting 419inserting entries 422registering 422

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 636

Page 637: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

removing entries 423retrieving values 420unlocking entries 422, 423unregistering 419updating entries 422

database connection, closing 112, 113database services 107databases

clearing transactional state 111closing connections 112, 113committing changes 113creating connections 114deleting rows 116discarding changes 129invoking stored procedures 109querying 128retrieving names of stored procedures 122retrieving tables 125starting a transaction 130

datatypes in XML Schemas 355date/time transformation services 97dateBuild 102dates

converting formats 104formatting 105invalid dates 101returning current 102, 106symbols used for 98time zones 99

dateTimeBuild 103dateTimeFormat 104debug log 175debugging services 173decoding URL-encoded strings 438decrypting

MIME messages 385S/MIME messages 265

default key, associating with invoked services 360delete_binding 549delete_business 550delete_publisherAssertions 551delete_service 552delete_tModel 553

deleteAllConnections 367deleteByCID 280deleteByObjectId 447deleteConnection 368deleteCorrelation 276deleteProcess 274deleteReleaseRegistryEntry 322deleteStore 419deleteSubscriber 147deleteTask service 465deleteXReference 448deleting

cross-reference by object ID 447cross-references 448data stores 419entry from an LDAP server 196files in working directory 56rows from a database 116storage information for processes 274subscribers from subscription list 147

deliver service 287deliverAndWait service 288digital signatures

attaching to MIME messages 383verifying 266, 366, 387

dir 57directory

changing 55looking up entries on LDAP server 201searching for entries 202

disableConnection 30disableListener 33disableListenerNotification 37disableListeners 368disablePackage 253disablePollingNotification 38disableServiceRedir 94disableSessionRedir 95discard_authToken 554disconnecting from an LDAP server 196discoveryURL 511discoveryURLs 511dispositionReport 512

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 637

Page 638: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

distributeViaFTP 323distributeViaSvcPull 323distributeViaSvcPush 324divideFloats 220divideInts 221divideObjects 222docType_categoryBag 512docType_description 513docType_keyedReference 513docType_name 513document processing

resuming 481suspending 486

document retrievalresuming 483suspending 488

document services 133document types

alarmInfo 145audit event information 146callStackItem 146exception information 149gdEndInfo 150gdStartInfo 151portStatusInfo 157ProcessData 272QName 410replicationInfo 159sessionEndInfo 160sessionExpireInfo 161sessionStartInfo 162statInfo 163TaskCompletionInfo 458TaskInfo 459TaskQueueInfo 461TaskSearchQuery 462TaskSearchQueryTerm 463txEndInfo 165txStartInfo 165

documentationadditional 26conventions used 25feedback 26

documentListToDocument 135documentResolverSpec specification 291documents

adding to list 207constructing from a list of documents 135converting list from string list 212converting to a String 137converting to XML strings 607delivering 287delivering and waiting for reply 288expanding contents into a list of documents 136processing as part of business process 282publishing 297publishing and waiting for reply 298replacing 211replying to 301resolving status of 291retrieving redelivery count 296waiting for 302

documentToDocumentList 136documentToRecord 581documentToXMLString 607documentToXMLValues 137dynamic text generation 332

Eelements, number of in a list 211email 513enableConnection 31enableListener 34enableListenerNotification 38enablePackage 254enablePollingNotification 38encoding schema, SOAP 398encoding URL strings 438encrypting MIME messages 263, 381ending guaranteed delivery transactions 310entries

adding to LDAP server 194inserting into repository 418looking up on LDAP server 201searching for all matching 202

envelope schema, SOAP 398

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 638

Page 639: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

envelope stream, generating from MIME message 244envelope, for published documents 292errInfo 514error log, exception events 166error notification document type 304error service 304establishCorrelation 276event handlers 139

alarm specification 144alarmInfo document type 145audit logToFile service 166audit specification 145auditInfo document type 146callStackItem document type 146exception logToFile service 166exception specification 148exceptionInfo document type 149gdEnd specification 150gdEndInfo document type 150gdStart specification 150gdStartInfo document type 151get list of event types 151get list of subscribers 152modify subscriber info 153portStatus specification 156portStatusInfo document type 157reload event manager settings 158replication specification 158replicationInfo document type 159save event manager settings 159sessionEnd specification 159sessionEndInfo document type 160sessionExpire specification 160sessionExpireInfo document type 161sessionStart specification 161sessionStartInfo document type 162stat specification 162statInfo document type 163subscriptions for 141txEnd specification 164txEndInfo document type 165txStart specification 165txStartInfo document type 165unsubscribing from an event 147

events, creating subscriptions for 141

exception events, logging 166exception specification 148exceptionInfo document type 149exceptions for retry 182exceptions, last trapped in a flow 176execSQL 117exitUnableToUnderstand 403extensions

files with no extension, using with FTP put command 65extracting MIME content 241extracting MIME message headers 242, 246

Ffields, removing from pipeline 175file object, templates 330file services 169files

appending data to 54deleting 56listing 55, 57, 61, 66multiple delete 62multiple get 63multiple transfer 64renaming 67retrieving 57, 170saving pipeline contents 180transferring 65

find_binding 526find_business 527find_businessByCategory 528find_businessByDiscURLs 529find_businessByIdentity 530find_businessByName 531find_businessBytModel 532find_relatedBusinesses 533find_service 534find_serviceByBusKey 535find_serviceByCategory 536find_serviceByName 537find_serviceBytModel 538find_tModel 539find_tModelByCategory 540

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 639

Page 640: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

find_tModelByIdentity 541find_tModelByName 542finding universal names 566findQualifier 514findQualifiers 514fire-and-forget call 312floating point numbers

adding 217dividing 220multiplying 223subtracting 227

flow services 173forcing a response string 181formatDate 105formatting

array of strings 432number to numeric pattern 432

fragment files, processing 274freeDocument 588freeXMLNode 612fromKey 514FTP

changing directory and listing files 55, 66changing working directory 55client actions 52delete file 56executing non-standard FTP commands 66file transfer 65files with no extension 65ftp_no_extension key 65listing files 57, 61login 59logout 61multiple file delete 62multiple file get 63multiple file transfer 64renaming files 67retrieving files 57session info 67transferring files 65

FTP servers, submitting requests to 49, 68

GgdEnd specification 150gdEndInfo document type 150gdStart specification 150gdStartInfo document type 151generateReplicationEvent 324get (FTP) files 57get_assertionstatusReport 555get_authToken 556get_bindingDetail 543get_businessDetail 544get_businessDetailExt 545get_publisherAssertions 557get_registeredInfo 558get_serviceDetail 546get_tModelDetail 547getActor 403getAttributeDef 197getBody 404getBodyEntries 405getBodyPartContent 241getBodyPartHeader 242getCanonicalKey 448getCertificateInfo 375getClassDef 198getClusterHosts 95getConnectionStatistics 31getContentType 244getCurrentDate 106getCurrentDateString 106getDocument 405getDocumentType 589getEnvelopeStream 244getEventTypes 151getFile 170getHeader 406getHeaderEntries 407getLastError 176getListItem 209getLocalReleasedList 325getMimeHeader 246

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 640

Page 641: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

getMustUnderstand 408getNativeId 449getNextNode 589getNextXMLNode 613getNodeIterator 590getNumConnections 368getNumParts 247getPIDforCID 280getPrimaryContentType 248getProcInfo 121getProcs 122getQName 409getRecordListItem 210getRedeliveryCount service 296getRemoteReleasedList 326getRoleInfo 281getServerType 369getSession 177getStatus 310getStringListItem 210getSubContentType 249getSubscribers 152getTableInfo 123getTables 125getTask service 466getTaskIDs 341getTaskInfo 341getTrailer service 409getTransportInfo 177getUsers 570getXMLNodeIterator 613getXMLNodeType 615guaranteed delivery services 307guaranteed delivery transactions

ending 310getting status of 310invoking service 311restarting 311retrieving results of 312starting 313

guaranteed one-way call 312

HhandleBizDoc 282header fields, adding to MIME object 237headers, changing HTTP 68hostingRedirector 514HTMLDecode 428HTMLEncode 429HTTP

changing header variables 68response code 182submitting requests to servers 49, 68

IIData objects, converting to XML strings 607identifierBag 515IDs, retrieving list of 341indexOf 429InputStream, converting to byte 187inserting table rows 126insertXReference 450installPackage 255instanceDetails 515instanceParms 515integers

adding 219dividing 221multiplying 225subtracting 228

invalid dates 101invoke, guaranteed delivery service 311invoking

client services 49remote services 307report services 329stored procedures 109

invoking a serviceguaranteed delivery 314protocols used 184remote webMethods Integration Server 308

IO services 187isLatchClosed 445iterating through XML nodes 613

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 641

Page 642: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

JJDBC-related services 107

KkeepAliveConnections 369key string lookup 430keyedReference 516keys, obtaining a list in a data store 421keysOwned 516

Llatch operations

checking latch status 445closing 444opening 446

LDAP serveradding entries 194closing connections 196connecting to 195deleting entries 196listing bindings 199looking up an entry 201retrieving attribute definitions 197retrieving objectclass definitions 198searching for entries 202updating attributes for an entry 203

LDAP services 193length

of a string 430of documents in a list 316

listadding, retrieving, or replacing elements 205LDAP 199number of elements 211registered processors 394universal names 566

list services 205listAdapterConnections 32listAdapterListenerNotifications 39listAdapterListeners 34listAdapterPollingNotifications 40listAdapterServices 44

listProxyListeners 370listRegisteredAdapters 30listRegisteredConnections 372listRegistrationListeners 373load balancing, enabling and disabling 93loadDocument 592loadPKCS7CertChain 376loadXMLNode 616locking a repository entry 421log off of FTP server 61logActivityMessages 279logging

audit events 166exception events 166pipeline fields 183process activity messages 279

login to FTP server 59logToFile

audit events 166exception events 166

lookup entry in an LDAP server 201lookupCorrelation 277lookupDictionary 430lookupTable 430lowercase, converting to 436ls 61

MmakeArrays 597makeString 431mapCIDtoPID 283mapping

between conversation ID and process instance ID 283deleting between processes 276

math services 215mdelete 62mergeHeaderAndBody 250messageFormat 432mget 63MIME messages

adding body parts to 233adding headers to 237creating 238

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 642

Page 643: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

creating encrypted messages 381creating signed messages 383decrypting 385discovering content type 244discovering number of parts 247discovering subtype 249generating message stream 244getting content from 241getting headers from 246getting part headers from 242getting top-level portion 248merging HTTP response into InputStream 250sending through SMTP 84signing and encrypting 263, 382verifying signed messages 387

MIME services 231model index, updating 274modifySubscriber 153mput 64multiple VCS users

removing 571setting 573

multiplyFloatList 223multiplyFloats 224multiplyIntList 225multiplyInts 225multiplyObjects 226

Nnamespace components 355native ID, retrieving 449node iterator

creating 613freeXMLNode 612getNextXMLNode 613getXMLNodeIterator 613

notification error document type 304notifying services 440notifyPackageRelease 327numeric values

adding 217, 218, 219dividing 221, 222multiplying 223, 224, 225, 226subtracting 227, 228

numericFormat 432

Oobjectclass definitions 198objects

adding 220dividing 222multiplying 226subtracting 228

one-time tasksadding to scheduler 338updating to scheduler 346

one-way call, guaranteed 312openLatch 446outbound passwords 357

creating a WmSecureString 376internal vs. public 362listing keys 364removing 364retrieving 363setting 362updating 364

output templates 329overviewDoc 516

Ppackage management services 251Package Release Registry

adding entries 321deleting entries 322obtaining local server list 325

package replication services 319packageCreation 327packages

activating 252disabling 253enabling 254installing 255recovering 256reloading 257scanning 274

padLeft 433padRight 434partners, role information for processes 283pattern strings, date patterns 98

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 643

Page 644: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

phone 517pipeline

applying templates to 332information for processes 272inserting Session object 177removing fields 175restoring previously saved 178saving contents to a file 180saving into memory 180tracing 183using previously saved keys and values 179validating against a document type 354

pipeline services 173PKCS7 signatures 259PKCS7 SignedData objects 260

creating 365PKI profiles 259portStatus specification 156portStatusInfo document type 157process activity messages, logging 279Process Engine services 269process instance IDs, returning 277, 280process status, changing 273processCertsOnlyData 385ProcessData document type 272processEncryptedData 265, 385processes

changing status 273deleting 280deleting mapping between 276deleting storage information 274pipeline information for processes 272role information for 283specification for correlation services 271terminating 273

processingresuming for triggers 481suspending for triggers 486

processMessage 395processRPCMessage 395processSignedData 266, 387program code conventions in this document 25protocols, retrieving information about 177, 184

proxy serverdeleting connections to 368disabling listeners 368number of connections to 368

pseudorandom number generator 226pub.art

listRegisteredAdapters 30pub.art.connection

disableConnection 30enableConnection 31getConnectionStatistics 31queryConnectionState 32

pub.art.listenerdisableListener 33enableListener 34queryListenerState 35setListenerNodeConnection 36

pub.art.notificationdisableListenerNotification 37disablePollingNotification 38enableListenerNotification 38enablePollingNotification 38listAdapterPollingNotifications 40queryListenerNotificationState 41queryPollingNotificationState 41resumePollingNotification 42setListenerNotificationNodeListener 43setPollingNotificationNodeConnection 43suspendPollingNotification 44

pub.art.servicelistAdapterServices 44setAdapterServiceNodeConnection 45

pub.art.transactioncommitTransaction 45rollbackTransaction 46setTransactionTimeout 47startTransaction 47

pub.clientftp 52, 53http 68smtp 84soapHTTP 86soapRPC 88

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 644

Page 645: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

pub.client.ftpappend 54cd 55cdls 55delete 56dir 57get 57login 59logout 61ls 61mdelete 62mget 63mput 64put 65putCompletedNotification 66quote 66rename 67sessioninfo 67

pub.clusterdisableServiceRedir 94disableSessionRedir 95getClusterHosts 95

pub.datecurrentDate 102dateBuild 102dateTimeBuild 103dateTimeFormat 104formatDate 105getCurrentDate 106getCurrentDateString 106

pub.dbcall 109clearTransaction 111close 112closeAll 113commit 113connect 114delete 116execSQL 117getProcInfo 121getProcs 122getTableInfo 123getTables 125

insert 126query 128rollback 129startTransaction 130update 131

pub.documentdocumentListToDocument 135documentToDocumentList 136documentToXMLValues 137XMLValuesToDocument 137

pub.eventaddSubscriber 141alarm 144alarmInfo 145audit 145auditInfo 146callStackItem 146deleteSubscriber 147exception 148exceptionInfo 149gdEnd 150gdEndInfo 150gdStart 150gdStartInfo 151getEventTypes 151getSubscribers 152modifySubscriber 153portStatus 156portStatusInfo 157reloadEventManagerSettings 158replication 158replicationInfo 159saveEventManagerSettings 159sessionEnd 159sessionEndInfo 160sessionExpire 160sessionExpireInfo 161sessionStart 161sessionStartInfo 162stat 162statInfo 163txEnd 164txEndInfo 165txStart 165txStartInfo 165

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 645

Page 646: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

pub.event.auditlogToFile 166

pub.event.exceptionlogToFile 166

pub.filegetFile 170

pub.flowclearPipeline 175debugLog 175getLastError 176getRetryCount 176getSession 177getTransportInfo 177restorePipeline 178restorePipelineFromFile 179savePipeline 180savePipelineToFile 180setResponse 181setResponseCode 182throwExceptionForRetry 182tracePipeline 183transportInfo 184

pub.ioclose 189createByteArray 189mark 190markSupported 190read 191reset 191skip 192streamToBytes 192

pub.ldapbind 194connect 195delete 196disconnect 196getAttributeDef 197getClassDef 198list 199lookup 201search 202update 203

pub.listappendToDocumentList 207appendToRecordList 207appendToStringList 208copyListItem 209getListItem 209getRecordListItem 210getStringListItem 210setListItem 210setRecordListItem 211setStringListItem 211sizeOfList 211stringListToDocumentList 212stringListToRecordList 213

pub.mathaddFloatList 217addFloats 218addIntList 219addInts 219addObjects 220divideFloats 220divideInts 221divideObjects 222multiplyFloatList 223multiplyFloats 224multiplyIntList 225multiplyInts 225multiplyObjects 226randomDouble 226subtractFloats 227subtractInts 228subtractObjects 228

pub.mimeaddBodyPart 233addMimeHeader 237createMimeData 238getBodyPartContent 241getBodyPartHeader 242getContentType 244getEnvelopeStream 244getMimeHeader 246getNumParts 247getPrimaryContentType 248getSubContentType 249mergeHeaderAndBody 250

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 646

Page 647: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

pub.packagesactivatePackage 252disablePackage 253enablePackage 254installPackage 255recoverPackage 256reloadPackage 257

pub.pki.pkcs7sign 260verify 261

pub.pki.smimecreateSignedAndEncryptedData 263createSignedData 264processEncryptedData 265processSignedData 266

pub.prtCorrelationService 271ProcessData 272

pub.prt.adminchangeProcessStatus 273deleteProcess 274scanPackage 274

pub.prt.correlatedeleteCorrelation 276establishCorrelation 276lookupCorrelation 277

pub.prt.loglogActivityMessages 279

pub.prt.tndeleteByCID 280getPIDforCID 280getRoleInfo 281handleBizDoc 282mapCIDtoPID 283RoleInfo 283

pub.publishdeliver 287deliverAndWait 288documentResolverSpec 291envelope 292getRedeliveryCount 296publish 297publishAndWait 298reply 301waitForReply 302

pub.publish.notificationerror 304

pub.recordlength 316recordListToRecord 316recordToRecordList 317recordToXMLValues 318XMLValuesToRecord 318

pub.remoteinvoke 308

pub.remote.gdend 310getStatus 310invoke 311restart 311retrieve 312send 312start 313submit 314

pub.replicatoraddReleaseRegistryEntry 321deleteReleaseRegistryEntry 322distributeViaFTP 323distributeViaSvcPull 323distributeViaSvcPush 324generateReplicationEvent 324getLocalReleasedList 325getRemoteReleasedList 326notifyPackageRelease 327packageCreation 327

pub.reportrunFileTemplate 330runFileTemplateOnPipe 331runStringTemplate 331runStringTemplateOnPipe 332runTemplate 332runTemplateOnPipe 333

pub.scheduleraddComplexTask 336addOnetimeTask 338addRepeatingTask 339cancelTask 340getTaskIDs 341

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 647

Page 648: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

getTaskInfo 341resumeTask 343suspendTask 343updateComplexTask 344updateOneTimeTask 346updateRepeatingTask 347

pub.schemacreateXSD 350validate 352validatePipeline 354

pub.schema.w3cdatatypes 355xml 355xsi 355

pub.securityclearKeyAndChain 360setKeyAndChain 361setKeyAndChainFromBytes 361

pub.security.outboundPasswordslistKeys 364removePassword 364setPassword 362updatePassword 364

pub.security.pkcs7sign 365verify 366

pub.security.reverseInvokedeleteAllConnections 367deleteConnection 368disableListeners 368getNumConnections 368getServerType 369keepAliveConnections 369listProxyListeners 370listRegisteredConnections 372listRegistrationListeners 373registerReverseConnections 374

pub.security.utilconvertSecureString 377createMessageDigest 375createSecureString 376destroySecureString 377getCertificateInfo 375loadPKCS7CertChain 376

pub.smimecreateCertsOnlyData 380createEncryptedData 381createSignedAndEncryptedData 382createSignedData 383processCertsOnlyData 385processEncryptedData 385processSignedData 387

pub.soap.processorlist 394processMessage 395processRPCMessage 395registerProcessor 396unregisterProcessor 397

pub.soap.schemaencoding 398envelope 398

pub.soap.utilsaddBodyEntry 398addHeaderEntry 399addTrailer 401createSoapData 402exitUnableToUnderstand 403getActor 403getBody 404getBodyEntries 405getDocument 405getHeader 406getHeaderEntries 407getMustUnderstand 408getQName 409getTrailer 409QName 410removeBodyEntry 410removeHeaderEntry 411removeTrailer 412requestResponseSpec 413soapDataToString 413streamToSoapData 414stringToSoapData 415validateSoapData 416

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 648

Page 649: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

pub.storageadd 418closeStore 419deleteStore 419get 420keys 421lock 421put 422registerStore 422remove 423unlock 423

pub.stringbase64Decode 427base64Encode 427bytesToString 427concat 428HTMLDecode 428HTMLEncode 429indexOf 429length 430lookupDictionary 430lookupTable 430makeString 431messageFormat 432numericFormat 432padLeft 433padRight 434replace 435stringToBytes 435substring 436tokenize 437toLower 436toUpper 437trim 438URLDecode 438URLEncode 438

pub.syncnotify 440wait 440

pub.synchronization.latchcloseLatch 444isLatchClosed 445openLatch 446

pub.synchronization.xrefcreateXReference 446deleteByObjectId 447deleteXReference 448getCanonicalKey 448getNativeId 449insertXReference 450

pub.tablerecordListToTable 452stringTableToTable 452tableToRecordList 453tableToStringTable 453

pub.taskTaskCallbackService 457TaskCompletionInfo 458TaskInfo 459TaskQueueInfo 461TaskSearchQuery 462TaskSearchQueryTerm 463

pub.task.taskclientdeleteTask 465getTask 466queueTask 467searchTasks 468updateTask 469

pub.triggerresumeProcessing 481resumeRetrieval 483suspendProcessing 486suspendRetrieval 488

pub.uddi.client.docaccessPoint 500address 501addressLine 501assertionStatusItem 502assertionStatusReport 503authToken 503bindingDetail 504bindingKey 504bindingTemplate 505bindingTemplates 505businessDetail 506businessDetailExt 506

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 649

Page 650: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

businessEntity 507businessEntityExt 507businessInfo 508businessInfos 508businessKey 508businessList 508businessService 509businessServices 509categoryBag 510contact 510contacts 511discoveryURL 511discoveryURLs 511dispositionReport 512docType_categoryBag 512docType_description 513docType_keyedReference 513docType_name 513email 513errInfo 514findQualifier 514findQualifiers 514fromKey 514hostingRedirector 514identifierBag 515instanceDetails 515instanceParms 515keyedReference 516keysOwned 516overviewDoc 516phone 517publisherAssertion 517publisherAssertions 517registeredInfo 518relatedBusinessesList 519relatedBusinessInfo 518relatedBusinessInfos 519result 519schema_uddiv2 520serviceDetail 520serviceInfo 520serviceInfos 521serviceKey 521

serviceList 521sharedRelationships 521SOAPFault 522tModelBag 523tModelDetail 523tModelInfo 523tModelInfos 524tModelInstanceDetails 524tModelInstanceInfo 524tModelKey 525tModell 522tModelList 525toKey 525uploadRegister 525

pub.uddi.client.inquiryfind_binding 526find_business 527find_businessByCategory 528find_businessByDiscURLs 529find_businessByIdentity 530find_businessByName 531find_businessBytModel 532find_relatedBusinesses 533find_service 534find_serviceByBusKey 535find_serviceByCategory 536find_serviceByName 537find_serviceBytModel 538find_tModel 539find_tModelByCategory 540find_tModelByIdentity 541find_tModelByName 542get_bindingDetail 543get_businessDetail 544get_businessDetailExt 545get_serviceDetail 546get_tModelDetail 547

pub.uddi.client.publishadd_publisherAssertions 548delete_binding 549delete_business 550delete_publisherAssertions 551delete_service 552

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 650

Page 651: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

delete_tModel 553discard_authToken 554get_assertionstatusReport 555get_authToken 556get_publisherAssertions 557get_registeredInfo 558save_binding 559save_business 560save_service 561save_tModel 562set_publisherAssertions 563

pub.universalNamefind 566list 566

pub.utilsgetServerProperty

retrieves value of a server property 576pub.vcs

getUsers 570removeCurrentUser 571removeMultipleUsers 571setCurrentUser 572setMultipleUsers 573

pub.webcreateRegions 579documentToRecord 581freeDocument 588getDocumentType 589getNextNode 589getNodeIterator 590loadDocument 592makeArrays 597queryDocument 597recordToDocument 599stringToDocument 604

pub.xmldocumentToXMLString 607freeXMLNode 612getNextXMLNode 613getXMLNodeIterator 613getXMLNodeType 615loadXMLNode 616queryXMLNode 621xmlNodeToDocument 623xmlStringToXMLNode 630

pub.xslt.TransformationstransformSerialXML 632

publish service 297publish/subscribe, latching and cross-referencing operations 443publishAndWait service 298publisherAssertion 517publisherAssertions 517publishing packages 319

addReleaseRegistryEntry 321deleteReleaseRegistryEntry 322distributeViaFTP 323distributeViaSvcPull 323distributeViaSvcPush 324generateReplicationEvent 324getLocalReleasedList 325getRemoteReleasedList 326notifyPackageRelease 327packageCreation 327

put (FTP) files 65

QQName document type 410queryConnectionState 32queryDocument 597querying a database 128queryListenerNotificationState 41queryListenerState 35queryPollingNotificationState 41queryXMLNode 621queueTask service 467quote 66

Rrandom number generator 226randomDouble 226raw offset for time zones 99record services 315recordListToRecord 316recordListToTable 452records, deleting particular type 447recordToDocument 599recordToRecordList 317recordToXMLValues 318

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 651

Page 652: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

recoverPackage 256recurring tasks, adding to scheduler 339redelivery count, retrieving for documents 296regions, defining 579registeredInfo 518registering data stores 422registerProcessor 396registerReverseConnections 374registerStore 422relatedBusinessesList 519relatedBusinessInfo 518relatedBusinessInfos 519relay server, disabling listeners 368release registry. See Package Release RegistryreloadEventManagerSettings 158reloadPackage 257remote file, appending data to 54remote procedure call, submitting 88remote servers, invoking services on 307, 308removeBodyEntry 410removeCurrentUser 571removeHeaderEntry 411removeMultipleUsers 571removeTrailer 412removing entries from data stores 423renaming files on an FTP server 67repeating tasks, updating to scheduler 347replacing strings 435replication specification 158replicationInfo document type 159replicator services 319reply documents

for join conditions 302retrieving for asynchronous request 302sending 301volatile storage 301

reply service 301report services 329repository

closing data store 419creating/opening 422deleting data store 419inserting entries 418

inserting/updating entries 422list of keys in 421locking entries 421locking entries in 421registering 422removing entries 423retrieving keys from 421retrieving values from 420unlocking entries 423

request/reply modeldeliverAndWait service 290delivering a request 288multiple reply documents 299publishAndWait service 299publishing request 298publishing request to a specific client 288retrieving reply 302sending replies 301waitForReply service 302waiting for reply 289, 299

requestResponseSpec 413response string, forcing 181restarting a guaranteed delivery transaction 311restorePipeline 178restorePipelineFromFile 179result 519resumeListener 36resumePollingNotification 42resumeTask 343resuming

document processing for triggers 481document retrieval for triggers 483

retrievalresuming for triggers 483suspending for triggers 488

retrievingdocuments from a local file system 169files from FTP server 57MIME content 241MIME message headers 242, 246results of guaranteed delivery transaction 312

retrieving reply 302retry count, retrieving 176

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 652

Page 653: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

retry exception 182RoleInfo 283roles

fetching information 281information for 283

rollback 129rollbackTransaction 46RPC, submitting 88runFileTemplate 330runFileTemplateOnPipe 331runStringTemplate 331runStringTemplateOnPipe 332runTemplate 332runTemplateOnPipe 333

SS/MIME messages

creating certs-only message 380creating encrypted messages 381creating signed messages 383creating using PKI profiles 259decrypting 265, 385extracting certificates from certs-only message 385verifying signed messages 266, 387

S/MIME services 379save_binding 559save_business 560save_service 561save_tModel 562saveEventManagerSettings 159savePipeline 180savePipelineToFile 180scanPackage 274scheduler

adding complex tasks 336adding one-time tasks 338canceling tasks 340recurring tasks 339resuming tasks 343retrieving list of task IDs 341retrieving task info 341suspending tasks 343updating complex tasks 344updating one-time tasks 346updating repeating tasks 347

scheduler services 335schema services 349schema_uddiv2 520schemas

attribute definition 197creating 350for validating 352namespace components 355objectclass definitions 198retrieving tables 125SOAP encoding schema 398SOAP envelope schema 398XML datatypes 355

searching an LDAP directory for entries 202searchTasks service 468sending a guaranteed call 312sending STOR or STOU commands to remove server 53, 64, 65server log

pipeline field names and values 183writing to 175

servers, cluster listing 95serviceDetail 520serviceInfo 520serviceInfos 521serviceKey 521serviceList 521services

default access permissions 25listing of 23

Session object, inserting in pipeline 177sessionEnd specification 159sessionEndInfo document type 160sessionExpire specification 160sessionExpireInfo document type 161sessioninfo 67sessionStart specification 161sessionStartInfo document type 162set_publisherAssertions 563setAdapterServiceNodeConnection 45setCurrentUser 572setKeyAndChain 361setListenerNodeConnection 36setListenerNotificationNodeListener 43

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 653

Page 654: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

setListItem 210setMultipleUsers 573setPollingNotificationNodeConnection 43setResponse 181setResponseCode 182setStringListItem 211setTransactionTimeout 47sharedRelationships 521signed data object, creating 365SignedData objects 260signing and encrypting MIME messages 263signing MIME messages 264, 383, 387sizeOfList 211SMTP servers, submitting requests to 49, 68SMTP, sending MIME messages 84SOAP

actor attribute 403adding body entries 398adding header entries 399converting SOAP object to String 413converting stream to SOAP object 414converting string to SOAP object 415creating SOAP objects 402encoding schema 398envelope schema 398executing the default processor 395executing the default RPC processor 395getting body entries 404, 405, 409getting entire message 405getting header entries 406, 407getting QNames 409listing processors 394mustUnderstand attribute 403, 408registering a processor 396removing body entries 410removing header entries 411removing trailers 412sending a SOAP message 86specification for custom processor 413specification for target service 413submitting an RPC request 88unregistering processors 397validating SOAP objects 416

SOAP messages, inserting trailer 401SOAP services 391soapDataToString 413SOAPFault 522soapHTTP 86soapRPC 88special characters

handling in XML strings 609specifications

alarm event handler 144audit event handler 145CorrelationService 271exception event handler 148gdEnd 150gdStart 150portStatus event handler 156replication event handler 158sessionEnd event handler 159sessionExpire event handler 160sessionStart event handler 161stat event handler 162TaskCallbackService 457txEnd event handler 164txStart event handler 165

SQL statements, executing 117starting a guaranteed delivery transaction 313startTransaction 47, 130stat specification 162statInfo document type 163status of guaranteed delivery transactions 310STOR or STOU commands, sending to remote server

using pub.clientftp service 53

using pub.client.ftpmput service 64put service 65

storage information for processes, deleting 274storage services 417stored procedures

invoking 109retrieving information about 121retrieving names of 122

streamToBytes 192streamToSoapData 414

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 654

Page 655: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

string array, formatting 432stringListToDocumentList 212stringListToRecordList 213strings

adding to list 208base64 decoding 427base64 encoding 427byte array conversion 427concatenating 428concatenating an array of strings 431converted from documents 137converting list to document list 212converting to byte array 435converting to lowercase 436converting to uppercase 437decoding URL-encoded 438HTML to native characters 428length of 430native characters to HTML 429padding beginning 433padding end 434replacing all 435returning substring of 436tokenizing into an array 437transformation services 425trimming white space 438URL-encoding 438XML values to a document 137

stringTableToTable 452stringToBytes 435stringToDocument 604stringToSoapData 415submitting an asynchronous call to a remote server 314subscribing to packages 319subscriptions, creating 141substring 436

indexing first occurrence 429subtractFloats 227subtractInts 228subtractObjects 228subtype, getting from MIME message 249sum of numeric values 217, 218, 219suspended tasks, resuming 343

suspendingdocument processing for triggers 486document retrieval for triggers 488

suspendListener 37suspendPollingNotification 44suspendTask 343synchronization services

coordinating the execution of services 439performing latching and cross-referencing operations 443

synchronous call to a remote server 311synchronous request/reply

delivering a request 289description of 290, 300publishing a request 299

Ttable services 451tables

converting into two-dimensional array 453converting string table into 452inserting rows 126removing rows 116retrieving column information 123retrieving names of 125retrieving rows from 128updating all rows 131

tableToRecordList 453tableToStringTable 453task engine

deleteTask service 465getTask service 466queueTask service 467searchTasks service 468TaskCallbackService specification 457TaskCompletionInfo document type 458TaskInfo document type 459TaskQueueInfo document type 461TaskSearchQuery document type 462TaskSearchQueryTerm document type 463updateTask service 469

task services 455TaskCallbackService specification 457TaskCompletionInfo document type 458TaskInfo document type 459

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 655

Page 656: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

TaskQueueInfo document type 461tasks

adding complex to scheduler 336adding one-time to scheduler 338adding recurring to scheduler 339obtaining information about 341removing from scheduler 340resuming 343retrieving IDs for 341suspending 343updating complex to scheduler 344updating one-time to scheduler 346updating repeating to scheduler 347

TaskSearchQuery document type 462TaskSearchQueryTerm document type 463templates

applying to a document 330applying to pipeline 331, 332from string objects 331

time zones 99time, converting formats 104time/date transformation services 97tModel 522tModelBag 523tModelDetail 523tModelInfo 523tModelInfos 524tModelInstanceDetails 524tModelInstanceInfo 524tModelKey 525tModelList 525tokenizing a string 437toKey 525toLower 436toUpper 437tracePipeline 183Trading Networks

BixDocEnvelope 282correlating conversation IDs to process IDs 276returning internal ID 281

trailers, adding to SOAP messages 401transactional state, clearing 111transactions, ending guaranteed delivery 310

transformingdate formats 97time formats 97

transforming XML 632transient error, description of 182transportInfo 184trigger services

retry count 176retrying 182

triggersmanagement services 471resuming document processing 481resuming document retrieval 483suspending document retrieval 488suspending processing 486

trimming white space 438troubleshooting information 26txEnd specification 164txEndInfo document type 165txStart specification 165txStartInfo document type 165typographical conventions in this document 25

UUDDI services 491universal name services 565universal names

finding service names for 566listing the registry 566

unlocking entries in data stores 423unregisterProcessor 397unsubscribing from an event 147updateComplexTask 344updateOneTimeTask 346updateRepeatingTask 347updateTask service 469updating

attributes in an LDAP directory 203rows in a database table 131

uploadRegister 525uppercase, converting to 437URLDecode 438URLEncode 438

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 656

Page 657: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

user management, VCS 569get user names 570remove current user 571remove multiple users 571set current user 572set multiple users 573

Utils servicesretrieves value of server property 575

VvalidatePipeline 354validateSoapData 416validating an object 352VCS Integration feature 569

getting users 570remove current user 571remove multiple users 571set current user 572set multiple users 573

verifying digital signatures 366verifying signed data objects 261volatile storage, for reply documents 301

WwaitForReply service 302waiting for delivery from a notifying service 440watt.security.ope.AllowInternalPasswordAccess 363Web services 577white space, trimming 438WmSecureString 376

converting 377creating 376destroying 377

working directory, changing 55

XXML

datatypes 355pub.schema.w3c 355

XML documentsconverting to IData objects 623converting to XML nodes 630

XML nodesconverting 581creating from XML string 630extracting data from 621freeing 612freeing resources 588getting type info 615information about 589loading from URL 616querying 621

XML services 605XML strings, creating from documents 607

handling special characters 609XML values

converting from a document 137converting to a document 137

xmlNodeToDocument 623xmlStringToXMLNode 630XMLValuesToDocument 137XMLValuesToRecord 318XQL queries 621XSLT services

maintaining the stylesheet cache 631transforming an XML stream 631

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 657

Page 658: Integration Server Bis Reference

Index

webMethods Integration Server Built-In Services Reference Version 6.5, Service Pack 2 658